Documenti di Didattica
Documenti di Professioni
Documenti di Cultura
JOSEPH FOURIER
BY
ALEXANDER FREEMAN,
FELLOW OF
M.A.,
CDambntrge
CAMBRIDGE WAREHOUSE,
17,
PATERNOSTER ROW.
CO.
1878
[All Rights reserved.]
PRINTED BY
C. J.
CLAY, M.A.,
PREFACE.
IN preparing
this
version
in
English of Fourier
French
original.
He
will
has, however,
ap
pended brief
to
foot-notes, in
which
be found references
other writings
:
of Fourier
the subject
by the
initials
A. F.
belonged
to
the
late
is
Robert
Leslie
Ellis,
now
in the possession
John s
College.
It
to
have
of
been able to
s
life
prefix
Memoir
;
Fourier
however prevented
its
781452
TABLE
OF
CONTENTS OF THE
WORK
1
.
PAGE
PRELIMINARY DISCOURSE
CHAPTER
SECTION
ART.
I.
I.
I.
Introduction.
.14
210.
crosses a given surface in the interior of the solid, is also a function of the time elapsed, and of quantities which determine the form and
position of the surface.
The
functions
II.
15
specific
elements which must be observed, are the capacity, the conducibility proper or permeability, and the external conducibility or
The three
The coefficients which express penetrability. first as constant numbers, independent of the
12.
temperatures
...
at
19
First statement of the problem of the terrestrial . . temperatures 1315. Conditions necessary to applications of the theory. Object of the
20 21
experiments
16
21.
The rays
of heat
of a surface
The
is
proportional
Each paragraph
indicated at the left of that paragraph. the page marked on the right.
The
first
VI
ART.
TABLE OF CONTENTS.
PAGE
which its direction makes with the normal to the surface. Divers remarks, and considerations on the object and extent of thermological problems, and on the relations of general analysis with
to the cosine of the angle
22
SECTION
II.
25.
that of melting ice. The temperature of water boiling in a given vessel under a given pressure is denoted by 1 The unit which serves to measure quantities of heat, is the heat . . required to liquify a certain mass of ice
by
.27
ib.
26.
27
by increments of volume or by the addi tional quantities of heat. Those cases only are here considered, in which the increments of volume are proportional to the increments of the
quantity of heat. This condition does not in general exist in liquids sensibly true for solid bodies whose temperatures differ very much from those which cause the change of state
;
it is
28
ib.
30.
31.
Notion of external conducibility We may at first regard the quantity of heat lost as proportional to the temperature. This proposition is not sensibly true except for certain
limits of temperature . 35. The heat lost into the
.
.29
effect
ib.
32
medium
The
.
36. 37.
is compound and variable. Luminous heat Measure of the external conducibility . . . Notion of the conducibility proper. This property also may be observed
.
31
in liquids
38. 39.
^
32
40
49.
Equilibrium of temperatures. The effect is independent of contact . First notions of radiant heat, and of the equilibrium which is
established in spaces void of air ; of the cause of the reflection of rays of heat, or of their retention in bodies of the mode of communication
;
between the internal molecules; of the law which regulates the inten The law is not disturbed by the reflection of sity of the rays emitted.
heat
50, 51.
.
ibt
37
It is
52
56.
Remarks on the
statical or
the
The elastic force of aeriform fluids exactly indi principle of elasticity. cates their temperatures
.......
SECTION
III.
39
41
TABLE OF CONTEXTS.
ART.
60.
Vll
PAGE
placed in an aeriform medium at a lower tem perature, it loses at each instant a quantity of heat which may be regarded in the first researches as proportional to the excess of the temperature of the surface over the temperature of the medium
When
a heated body
is
43
61
propositions enunciated in the two preceding articles are founded on divers observations. The primary object of the theory is to discover can then measure all the exact consequences of these propositions.
64.
The
We
the variations of the coefficients, by comparing the results of calculation with very exact experiments
.........
IV.
t&.
SECTION
of
an
between two
maintained at fixed temperatures, are expressed by the a and 6 are the temperatures of the two equation (v - a) e = (b - a) z extreme planes, e their distance, and v the temperature of the section,
66, 67.
68,
70.
whose distance from the lower plane is z Notion and measure of the flow of heat 69. Measure of the conducibility proper Remarks on the case in which the direct action
. .
a sensible distance
71.
...........
when the upper plane is exposed the linear movement of heat
to the air
.
45
48
51
53
6.
State of the
same
solid
72.
General conditions of
.....
.
55
SECTION
LAW
V.
7380.
Equation of the linear movement of heat in the prism. consequences of this equation
.... .....
VI.
Different
56
SECTION
THE HEATING
81
84.
OF CLOSED SPACES.
The
solid
m-n^(a-n)
The value
air,
of
is
~
s
(
\fi
K + HJ
-f-
?n is
n the temperature
H measure
respectively
the penetrability of the heated surface that of the inner surface of the boundary s, and that of the external" surface s e is the thickness of the
boundary, and
85, 86.
.......
;
62
65
87
Remarkable consequences of the preceding equation 91. Measure of the quantity of heat requisite to retain at a constant temperature a body whose surface is protected from the external air by
Vlll
TABLE OF CONTENTS.
PAGE
several successive envelopes.
surfaces.
ABT.
Remarkable
the
.
67
SECTION
VII.
IN
THBEE DIMENSIONS.
The permanent temperatures of a solid enclosed between six rec tangular planes are expressed by the equation
v
x, y, z are
b, c
= A + ax + by + cz.
the coordinates of any point, whose temperature is v ; A, a, If the extreme planes are maintained by any causes at fixed temperatures which satisfy the preceding equation, the
are constant numbers.
final
system of
all
same equation
94, 95.
SECTION VHI.
MEASUKE OF THE MOVEMENT OF HEAT AT A GIVEN POINT OF A GIVEN SOLID.
96
99.
The
variable system of temperatures of a solid is supposed to be (x, y, z, t), where v denotes the variable
vF
t had elapsed, at the point whose coordinates are x, y, z. Formation of the analytical expres sion of the flow of heat in a given direction within the solid 100. Application of the preceding theorem to the case in which the function
...
.
78
.82
CHAPTER
II.
SECTION
EQUATION OF THE VARIED
I.
MOVEMENT OF HEAT
IN A RING.
101105.
The
variable
movement
by the
equation
dv_K^
di~~CD
d*v
dy?
hi
The arc x measures the distance of a section from the origin v ; the temperature which that section acquires after the lapse of the time K, C, D, h are the specific coefficients ; S is the area of the
the revolution of which the ring the section
is
t
;
..........
is
section,
by
85
generated;
is
the perimeter of
TABLE OF CONTENTS.
AET.
IX
PAGE
points situated at equal distances are represented by the terms of a recurring series. Observation of the temperatures vlt v z v3 of three consecutive points gives the measure
110.
at
,
106
The temperatures
of the
ratio*:
We
have
is X,
.
The
and log w
. .
is
the decimal
.
.86
SECTION
II.
shell,
the
movement
of heat in the
sphere
dv
d*v
2dv
114
117.
92
SECTION
IH.
^X
by three equations; the first relates to the internal temperatures, the second expresses the continuous state of the surface, the third expresses the initial state of
the solid
120.
The temperatures
95
SECTION
IV.
The system
d^v
dtf
v
is
d^v
d 2v
dfi
d^
124, 125.
first
. the temperature at a point whose coordinates are x, y, z . . Equation relative to the state of the surface and to that of the
97
section
99
SECTION
V.
126131.
The system of variable temperatures is determined by three equations one expresses the internal state, the second relates to the state of the surface, and the third expresses the initial state
;
101
"
TABLE OF CONTENTS.
SECTION
VI.
IN
THE INTERIOR
PAGE
132139.
Elementary proof of properties of the uniform movement of heat in a solid enclosed between six orthogonal planes, the constant tem
peratures being expressed by the linear equation,
v = A - ax - by -
cz.
The temperatures cannot change, since each point of the solid receives The quantity of heat which during the as much heat as it gives off.
unit of time crosses a plane at right angles to the axis of z is the same, through whatever point of that axis the plane passes. The value of this
common
were nul
140, 141.
flow is that
which would
exist, if
104
The
the function
-Ku
expresses the quantity of heat which during the instant dt crosses an infinitely small area w perpendicular to the axis of z, at the point whose coordinates are x, ?/, z, and whose temperature is v after the time t
has elapsed
142
109
easy to derive from the foregoing theorem the general equation of the movement of heat, namely
145.
It
is
dv
SECTION
VII.
proved that the variable temperatures at points on the is cooling in air, satisfy the equation
dv
dv
dv
being the differential equation of the surface which bounds the solid, and q being equal to (m? + n*+p To discover this equation we *)2. consider a molecule of the envelop which bounds the solid, and we express the fact that the temperature of this element does not a finite
change by
This condition holds and infinitely small instant. continues to exist after that the regular action of the medium has been
exerted during a very small instant. Any form may be given to the element of the envelop. The case in which the molecule is formed by rectangular sections presents remarkable properties. In the most simple case, which is that in which the base is parallel to the tangent plane, the truth of the equation is evident
magnitude during an
.....
115
TABLE OF CONTENTS.
XI
SECTION
ART.
155, 156.
VIII.
PAGE In applying the general equation (A) to the case of the cylinder
of the sphere,
and and
we
find the
of Section III.
123
SECTION
IX.
GENERAL BEMARKS.
157162.
x,
t,
Fundamental considerations on the nature of the quantities h, C, D, which enter into all the analytical expressions of the Theory of Heat. Each of these quantities has an exponent of dimension which relates to the length, or to the duration, or to the temperature. . These exponents are found by making the units of measure vary .
r,
K,
126
CHAPTER
Propagation of Heat in an
III.
infinite
rectangular solid.
SECTION
I.
163166.
of a rectangular
-^ + -^=0
131
167 170. we consider the state of the plate at a very great distance from the transverse edge, the ratio of the temperatures of two points whose
coordinates are a^, y and xz ,y changes according as the value of y increases x l and x.2 preserving their respective values. The ratio has a limit to which it approaches more and more, and when y is infinite,
;
it is
expressed by the product of a function of x and of a function of This remark suffices to disclose the general form of v, namely,
^
y.
S): i
V~
(2<
~ 1)a:
.
cos(2i-l).y.
of heat in the plate is
It
is
easy to ascertain
how
the
movement
effected
134
Xll
TABLE OF CONTENTS.
SECTION
II.
PAGE
178.
171
or
etc.
SECTION
III.
179181.
To
the number
m of
terms
is
which forms the second member, supposed to be limited, and the series becomes This function is developed according to powers of
m is made infinite
is
......
.
182184.
. . . applied to several other series 185 188. In the preceding development, which gives the value of the function of x and m, we determine rigorously the limits within which the sum of all the terms is included, starting from a given term , .
189.
for
SECTION
IV.
GENERAL SOLUTION.
190, 191.
slab
it is
Analytical expression of the movement of heat in a rectangular decomposed into simple movements
.....
. .
192
195.
Measure
Consequences of this solution. The rectangular slab must be considered as forming part of an infinite plane the solution expresses the permanent temperatures at all points of this plane . . 200204. It is proved that the problem proposed admits of no other solu
;
196199.
we have
just stated
....
TABLE OF CONTENTS.
SECTION
ART.
Xlll
V.
PAGE
205, 206.
The temperature
y, is
expressed thus
SECTION
VI.
IN
TRIGONOMETRIC SERIES.
known
A=
&c.
To solve these equations, we first suppose the number of equations to be m, and that the number of unknowns a, b, c, d, &c. is m only, omitting all the subsequent terms. The unknowns are determined for a certain value of the number ni, and the limits to which the values of the coeffi
cients continually approach are sought; these limits are the quantities
which
&G.
215,
it is.
required to determine.
.........
Expression of the values of
the form
.
a, 6, c, d,
168
which
217, 218.
is first
.179
.
same development.
.....
...
j
Application to the
. .
181
219
Any
function whatever
<p(x)
may
^ sin
The value
+ a 2 sin^x + Og
sin3.z+
is
a<
7T
J/
(x)
sin ix.
Whence we
<()
= sin
a:
/""da
0{a) sina
IT
-f
sm2xj ^da^a)
sin2a + sin3a;
/""da^a)
sin3a + &c.,
whence
2
222, 223.
series,
0(x)
=S
f=3
.
r 1*
sin ix
t=i
:
Jo
sin fa
da<f>(a.)
....
sin
9^;
184
from
it
is
*i
cos x =
.
A *9
sin x
+
.
sin 4.r
sin 7x
D.I
+ &c.
188
xiv
ART. 224, 225.
TABLE OF CONTENTS.
PAGE Second theorem on the development of functions in trigono
:
metrical series
*
Applications
:
-^(o5)=S
i=0
it
cosix r dacosia\!/(a). Jo
from
1
we
t
cos2x
cos 4x
226
230.
and
Daniel
The value
of the series,
is
if
we
attribute to
and
less
than
a;
and
any quantity included between a and |TT. Application to other remarkable examples curved lines or surfaces which coincide in a part of their course, and differ in all the other parts .
is 0, if
;
193
231
233.
Any
may
p)
^ sina; +
Z>
sin 2
-f
6 3 sin
3a + &c.
general
cos ix,
Each
We have in
f*JdxF(x)
2irA
=
f*"dx
F(x)
=
ira<
and
irb t
We thus
our analysis
2irF(x)
i=^+co
=S
i=
eo
.,J.jj
/*.Xf
(cos
\
ix
TT
If
daF(a) sin ia ) J
or 2irF(x)
234.
=2
i=+oo
P + ir
I
=_
daF(a)coa(ix-id)
199
The values of F(x) which correspond to values of x included between - TT and + TT must be regarded as entirely arbitrary. We may also choose any limits whatever for ic
.......
.
204
206
235.
SECTION
VII.
Expression of the
infinite rectangular
function
....
TABLE OF CONTENTS.
XV
CHAPTER
Of
the linear
IV.
ring.
PAGE
238241.
The
variable
movement which we
simple movements.
serve their primitive ratios, and decrease with the time, as the ordinates v is v=A. e~ mt . Formation of the general ex
...
213
218
242
244.
Application to
Different consequences
of the solution
245, 246.
and
of temperatures converges rapidly towards a regular final state, expressed by the first part of the integral. The sum of
The system
the temperatures of two points diametrically opposed is then the same, whatever be the position of the diameter. It is equal to the mean tem In each simple movement, the circumference is divided by perature.
equidistant nodes. All these partial movements successively disappear, except the first and in general the heat distributed throughout the solid . . assumes a regular disposition, independent of the initial state
;
221
SECTION
OP THE COMMUNICATION
247
250.
II.
OF
Of the communication of heat between two masses. Expression Remark on the value of the coefficient which measures the conducibility 251 255. Of the communication of heat between n separate masses, ar
of the variable temperatures.
225
ranged in a straight
line.
mass; it is given as a function of the time elapsed, of the coefficient which measures the couducibility, and of all the initial temperatures
regarded as arbitrary
256, 257.
258.
228
259
Remarkable consequences of this solution . Application to the case in which the number of masses is infinite . Of the communication of heat between n separate masses arranged 266.
236
237
circularly.
Differential equations suitable to the problem ; integration of these equations. The variable temperature of each of the masses is ex pressed as a function of the coefficient which measures the couducibility,
which has elapsed since the instant when the communication began, and of all the initial temperatures, which are arbitrary but in order to determine these functions completely, it is necessary to effect
of the time
;
238
initial
267271.
these
unknown
quantities
temperatures
247
XVI
ART.
272, 273. result
TABLE OF CONTENTS.
PAGE
Formation
274
276.
277, 278.
Application and consequences of this solution Examination of the case in which the number n
....
is
253
255
supposed
infinite.
We
obtain the solution relative to a solid ring, set forth in Article 241,
and the theorem of Article 234. We thus ascertain the origin of the analysis which we have employed to solve the equation relating to con
tinuous bodies
279.
280
Analytical expression of the two preceding results 282. It is proved that the problem of the movement of heat in a ring
....
dt
259 262
The
-^=
dx*
.
-=-?
is
263
CHAPTER
Of
the
V.
SECTION
The
I.
GENEBAL SOLUTION.
283
289.
is
in the
first
temperatures of two points in the solid place considered to approach continually a definite limit.
v=A
movement
by the
definite equation
- = 1 - hX. The nX
is
sphere, whose temperature is v after the lapse of the time t, by x\ h and are the specific coefficients; A is any constant. Constructions
adapted to disclose the nature of the definite equation, the limits and
values of
its
roots
of the general solution
;
268
final state of the solid
. .
290
293.
292.
Formation
274
Application to the case in which the sphere has been heated by a pro longed immersion
,..,..
277
SECTION n.
DlFFEBENT BEMABKS ON THIS SOLUTION.
294
296.
peratures of any sphere 298300. Variable temperature of a thermometer plunged into a liquid which is cooling freely. Application of the results to the comparison and
......
,
279
use of thermometers
282
TABLE OF CONTENTS.
ART.
XV11
PAGB
301.
Expression of the mean temperature of the sphere as a function of the time elapsed
Application to spheres of very great radius, and to those in which the radius is very small
304.
286
302
305.
287
all
the values
,289
CHAPTER
Of
306, 307.
VI.
the
Movement of Heat
in
solid cylinder.
We remark in the first place that the ratio of the variable tem peratures of two points of the solid approaches continually a definite limit, and by this we ascertain the expression of the simple movement. The function of x which is one of the factors of this expression is given
by a
differential equation of the
second order.
A number
g enters into
satisfy a definite equation 308, 309. Analysis of this equation. By means of the principal theorems of . . algebra, it is proved that all the roots of the equation are real .
this function,
and must
291
294
310.
The function u
of the variable
is
expressed by
i
=i
r
/
1*
r)
and the
311, 312.
definite equation is
hu +
=0, giving to x
its
complete value X.
296
The development
by
et*
"
22 1 t*
is
irJ Q
/
2 2 42
.
2 2 42 62
. .
f&C>
dii(f>(tsmu).
Remark on
313. 314.
.......
a;
as a continued fraction
315
319.
320.
318.
Formation of the general solution Statement of the analysis which determines the values of the co
General solution
efficients
309
XVI 11
TABLE OF CONTENTS.
CHAPTER
ART.
VII.
321
311
coefficients are
unknown
General solution of the problem 326. 327. The problem proposed admits no other solution 328, 329. Temperatures at points on the axis of the prism
330.
........ ....
.
313
314
315 317
....
is
very
318
331.
The
solution shews
how
the uniform
movement
of heat is established
319
.
322
CHAPTER
Of
333, 334.
VIII.
solid cube.
it enters an arc whose roots are real
e
.
the
Movement of Heat in a
all of
Into
which must satisfy a trigonometric equation 335, 336. Formation of the general solution . 337. The problem can admit no other solution
338.
339.
323
324
.
. .
327
ib.
328
of heat in
340.
Comparison of the
final
movement
movement which
341.
takes place in the sphere Application to the simple case considered in Art. 100
....
329
331
CHAPTER
Of
the Diffusion
IX.
of Heat.
I.
SECTION
IN AN INFINITE LlNE.
of heat in
We
movement
an
is
infinite line, a
part of which has been heated; the initial state v F(x). The following theorem is proved :
represented by
fl
dq cos qx
I
da F(a) cos
ga.
TABLE OF CONTENTS.
ABT.
XIX
PAGE
The function
348.
P (x)
satisfies
..........
the condition
F (x) = F
The
x).
Expression of
333
<case
initial
temperature.
integral
sin 2 cos qx is i
Jo
if
1
3-49.
we give to x a value included between 1 and - 1. The definite integral has a nul value, if a; is not included between and - 1
.............
.
338
339
Application to the case in which the heating given results from the final state which the action of a source of heat determines . .
350.
351
353.
We
movement
of heat in a line
whose
initial
temperatures are represented by vf(x) at the distance x to the right of the origin, and by v = -f(x) at the distance x to the left of the origin. The solution Expression of the variable temperature at any point. derived from the analysis which expresses the movement of heat in an
infinite line
..... ......
.
ib.
354.
Expression of the variable temperatures when the initial state of the . . part heated is expressed by an entirely arbitrary function
358.
343
345
355
The developments
.......
daf (a) sinqa.
is
proved
I
dqsinqx
Jo
Jo
:
satisfies
the condition
348
360
362.
Use
f+
da
<p
(a)
./-
Jo
(II)
This equation
(See Art. 397)
363.
is
The foregoing
infinite line,
movement
of heat in
an
352
354
356
364.
one point of which is submitted to a constant temperature . also be solved by means of another form of the Formation of this integral
365. 366.
Remarkable consequences
derive from
The same
The
solution which
we
....
it
....
362
XX
ART.
TABLE OF CONTENTS.
Bemarks on
forms of the integral of the equation
370, 371.
different
du
d?u
SECTION
The expression
for the variable
II.
IN
AN INFINITE SOLID.
of heat in
movement
an
infinite
movement.
dv Tt
_ ~
dx*
It
d 2v
dy*
d 2v
<P
cannot have a more extended integral derived also from the particular value
v = e~ n2t cos nx,
or from this
which both
=
^
The
tegrals obtained is
may
be
regarded as self-evident.
necessarily identical,
if
Two
dv
dt
x, y, z, t
are
=dv+d
dx?
dy*
+ ~dz?
"
ds v
and
of
t
if
....... .......
at the
377
The heat contained in a part of an infinite prism, all the other 382. points of which have nul initial temperature, begins to be distributed throughout the whole mass ; and after a certain interval of time, the
of the solid depends not upon the distribution of the but simply upon its quantity. The last result is not due to the increase of the distance included between any point of the mass and the part which has been heated; it is entirely due to the increase
state of
any part
initial heat,
time elapsed. In all problems submitted to analysis, the expo nents are absolute numbers, and not quantities. We ought not to omit the parts of these exponents which are incomparably smaller than the
of the
383
385.
solid
.
...... ....
SECTION
HI.
IN AN INFINITE SOLID.
infinite
The heat contained in part of the prism distributes itself through out the whole mass. The temperature at a distant point rises pro The time gressively, arrives at its greatest value, and then decreases.
TABLE OF CONTENTS.
ART.
after
PAGE
which this
maximum
occurs,
is
a function
of the
distance
x.
Expression of this function for a prism whose heated points have re ceived the same initial temperature
385 387
388391.
392
Different
The movement
of heat in
an
and
392
the highest temperatures, at parts very distant from the part originally
heated, are determined
SECTION
IV.
396.
the equation
-=-
the
397.
movement
of heat in a ring
(/3)
Second integral
of the
same equation
movement
398.
of heat in
an
infinite solid
other forms (7) and (5) of the integral, which are derived, like the preceding form, from the integral (a)
Two
development of the value of v according to increasing powers t. Second development according to the powers of v. The
single arbitrary function of
t
must contain a
-=-
(a).
(a).
398
t 6.
399
401.
Notation appropriate to the representation of these developments. The analysis which is derived from it dispenses with effecting the develop
ment
402.
in series
............
:
402
^ = d* +
403.
d*v
d 2v
:
"-
(e)l
nd
dz v
d?-:
d?
^=
d*v
......
(d)
404
(/)
405
of equation (/)
404.
405.
same theorem
belongs to elastic plates Second form of the same integral 407. Lemmas which serve to effect these transformations
406.
408.
407
to
of equation (d)
which
any number
402
.
409.
Use
of this proposition to
410.
Application of
(c)
of Art.
d-v
d-v
......
41S
xxii
ART.
TABLE OF CONTENTS.
411. 412.
413.
Integral of equation (e) of vibrating elastic surfaces Second form of the integral
....
by summing the
419
421
Use
series
of
the
same theorem
dv
dzv
414.
of t . . Integral under finite form containing two arbitrary functions The expressions change form when we use other limits of the definite
422 425
integrals 415. 416. Construction which serves to prove the general equation
417.
Any limits a and b may be taken for the integral with respect to a. These limits are those of the values of x which correspond to existing values of the function f(x). Every other value of x gives a nul result
forf(x)
429
applies to the general equation
418.
the second
419.
member
of
The
a,
432
unknown
. .
420.
and that the chief variable x is only under the symbol cosine Use of these theorems in the analysis of imaginary quantities
Application to the equation
433
435
421.
422.
-^ + dy* = ^4 dx*
.436
t,
423.
/ (x)
.
438
424
The method which consists in determining by definite integrals the unknown coefficients of the development of a function of x under
427.
the form
is
Example
relative to
the distribution of heat in a solid sphere. By examining from this point of view the process which serves to determine the coefficients, we
solve easily problems which may arise on the employment of all the terms of the second member, on the discontinuity of functions, on singular or infinite values. The equations which are obtained by this method ex
press either the variable state, or the initial state of masses of infinite dimensions. The form of the integrals which belong to the theory of
TABLE OF CONTENTS.
ART.
xxiii
PAGB
heat, represents at the
of simple
movements,
441
and that
the solid
428.
of
an
of all points of
General remarks on the method which has served to solve the analytical problems of the theory of heat
450
429.
General remarks on the principles from which we have derived the dif ferential equations of the movement of heat
Terminology relative to the general properties of heat 431. Notations proposed General remarks on the nature of the coefficients which enter into 432. 433.
430.
....
.
movement
of heat
ERRATA.
Page 9, line 28, for III. read IV. Pages 54, 55, for k read K. Page 189, line 2, The equation should be denoted Page 205, last line but one, for x read A
.
(A).
~
dr
read
^. dx
du
3,
(t
sin w)
=
44 A6
,
for
Az
read irA^,
7ivt
^^A^
12, for
d<f>
read dp.
CORRECTIONS to the Edition of Fourier s Analytical Theory of Heat, by A. FREEMAN, M.A., Cambridge, 1878.
PAGE LINE
9
ERROR
III.
et
CORRECTION
IV.
28
10
14
19
pa*sim.
Conductivity
in
Conductivity
inverse ratio of their capacities
26
melt
occupy
K
add, or
left
(pro re nata)
K
omit, as
add, 1
cos (2m
1
-3)x
+K
K
if
is
defined
K
- e -5a; cos oy
CORRECTIONS.
PAGE LINE
169
14 14
ERROR
CORRECTION
D
4
-B -D
should be squared
52
172
the numerals
62
A.2
1 2 2 2 3 2 42 5 2
10
26
174 180
181
30
last
23
9
to
215.
2
s
18
2
I*
denote the equation by
1
194
195
18
2*
2 - when
-/is
12
even
i)_ when
i is
of
form 2n+
cos x
cos 3x
cos 5x
cos 7^
"*"
220
221
31 36
27r
2-n-rM
ZwrMCDS
245,
through
17
226
227
a + (a-/3)
23
-3
&
twice
228
1317
18
5
229
232
/3+(a-/3)^
B
tiNsinmu,
and
?i-sm(msmw
v
_^_
s in
mu, and
sin
(m -
1)
CORRECTIONS.
PAGE LINE
232
16
2
5
CORRECTION
+ 2 = cost*
239
270
271 284
q a
+ 2=2
COS
20
3 4
oM
I
olul
hX
1-hX
0-006502
0-006500
286
14
last
295
2niX-&e. dm V
71.Z-&C.
da;
dx
(v)
dx
vx)
dx
dv
"
dz 16
~T~
dz
313
should be interchanged
27
n tan
vl
n tan
dele
nl
comma
do.
4
PAGE LINE
355 356
16
5
CORRECTIONS.
ERROR
a bracket
sign of last term
is
CORRECTION
missing should be
12 25
should be
e~*
ue CDS
i
e
_HLt GDS
_HLt_
23
18
1
0-00
e-u
*
>/TT
00 ~ ht
372
f/ie
denominator
392
396
I
3 in numerator
d(f>
S
3$
407 432
12
dP
integration (^- a )
28
13
equation
(a;
-a)
to
for
The Editor takes this opportunity of expressing his thanks ROBERT E. BAYNES, Esq. and to WALTER G. WOOLCOMBE, Esq.
the majority of these corrections.
written by ADDENDUM. An article "Ow the linear motion of heat, Part WM THOMSON under the signature N.N., will be found in the Cambridge Mathematical Journal, Vol. III. pp. 206211, and in Vol. I. of the Author s It examines the conditions, subject to which an arbitrary dis collected writings. tribution of heat in an infinite solid, bounded by a plane, may be supposed to have resulted, by conduction, in course of time, from some previous distribu
II.",
Sir
tion.
[A. F.]
PEELIMINARY DISCOURSE.
PRIMARY causes are unknown to us; but are subject to simple and constant laws, which may be discovered by observation, the
study of them being the object of natural philosophy. Heat, like gravity, penetrates every substance of the universe, its rays occupy all parts of space. The object of our work is to
set forth the
theory of heat will hereafter form one of the branches of general physics.
The knowledge of rational mechanics, which the most ancient nations had been able to acquire, has not come down to us, and the history of this science, if we except the first theorems in
harmony,
is
This great geometer explained the mathematical principles of the equilibrium of solids and fluids. About eighteen centuries
elapsed before Galileo, the originator of dynamical theories, dis covered the laws of motion of heavy bodies. Within this new
science
of the universe.
theories,
The
and
given them an admirable perfection: they have taught us that the most diverse phenomena are subject to a small number of
all
principles regulate all the move their form, the inequalities of their courses, stars, the equilibrium and the oscillations of the seas, the harmonic
same
ments of the
vibrations of air
plex effects of
F.
and sonorous bodies, the transmission of light, most com all the natural forces, and thus has the thought
1
H.
2
of
THEORY OF HEAT.
prcestet
geometria gloriatur\
These make up a special which cannot be explained by the principles order of phenomena, We have for a long time been in of motion and equilibrium. possession of ingenious instruments adapted to measure many of these effects; valuable observations have been collected but in this manner partial results only have become known, and not the mathematical demonstration of the laws which include
;
them
I
all.
tentive comparison of the facts known up to this time all these facts I have observed afresh in the course of several years with
To found the
distinguish
theory, it was in the first place necessary to and define with precision the elementary properties
I then perceived that all the which depend on this action resolve themselves into phenomena a very small number of general and simple facts whereby every physical problem of this kind is brought back to an investiga tion of mathematical analysis. From these general facts I have
;
concluded that to determine numerically the most varied move ments of heat, it is sufficient to submit each substance to three fundamental observations. Different bodies in fact do not possess in the same degree the power to contain heat, to receive or transmit
nor to conduct it through the interior of These are the three specific qualities which our theory clearly distinguishes and shews how to measure. It is easy to judge how much these researches concern the physical sciences and civil economy, and what may be their influence on the progress of the arts which require the employ ment and distribution of heat. They have also a necessary con nection with the -system of the world, and their relations become
it across their surfaces,
their masses.
known when we
place
Ac
gloriatur
quod
tarn
proestet.
[A. F.]
PRELIMINARY DISCOURSE.
In
fact,
sun in which this planet is the air, the earth, and the waters incessantly plunged, penetrates its elements are divided, change in direction every way, and, penetrating the mass of the globe, would raise its mean tem
the radiation of the
perature more and more, if the heat acquired were not exactly balanced by that which escapes in rays from all points of the surface and expands through the sky.
Different climates, unequally exposed to the action of solar
heat, have, after
proper to their situation. This effect is modified by several ac cessory causes, such as elevation, the form of the ground, the
seas,
The
succession
of
seasons occasion in the solid earth periodic variations, which are repeated every day or every year: but these changes become
less
and
less sensible as
the point at which they are measured No diurnal variation can be detected
at the depth, of about three metres [ten feet] ; variations cease to be appreciable at a depth The temperature at great depths sixty metres.
:
much
is
less
than
then sensibly
fixed at a given place but it is not the same at all points of the same meridian in general it rises as the equator is approached. The heat which the sun has communicated to the terrestrial
;
and which has produced the diversity of climates, is now movement which has become uniform. It advances within the interior of the mass which it penetrates throughout, and at the same time recedes from the plane of the equator, and
globe,
subject to a
proceeds to lose itself across the polar regions. In the higher regions of the atmosphere the air
is
very rare
up they are cooled by the very The great movements of the air, such as
rise
:
the trade winds which blow between the tropics, are not de termined by the attractive forces of the moon and sun. The
action
of these
celestial
bodies
produces
oscillations
in a fluid so rare
and at
so great
12
4
is
THEORY OF HEAT.
the changes of temperature which periodically displace every part of the atmosphere.
ocean are differently exposed at their surface to the rays of the sun, and the bottom of the basin which contains them is heated very unequally from the poles
The waters
of the
to the equator.
with gravity and the centrifugal force, keep up vast movements in the interior of the seas. They displace and mingle all the
parts,
and produce those general and regular currents which navigators have noticed. Radiant heat which escapes from the surface of all bodies, and traverses elastic media, or spaces void of air, has special The physical laws, and occurs with widely varied phenomena.
explanation of many of these facts is already known the mathe matical theory which I have formed gives an exact measure of
;
them.
has
its
It
consists,
in
a manner, in a
new
catoptrics
which
all
theorems, and serves to determine by analysis the effects of heat direct or reflected.
own
The enumeration
shews the nature of the questions which I have proposed to What are the elementary properties which it is requisite myself.
to
observe in each substance, and what are the experiments most suitable to determine them exactly? If the distribution
of heat in solid matter
is regulated by constant laws, what is the mathematical expression of those laws, and by what analysis may we derive from this expression the complete solution of
the principal problems ? Why do terrestrial temperatures cease to be variable at a depth so small with respect to the radius
Every inequality in the movement of this planet necessarily occasioning an oscillation of the solar heat beneath the surface, what relation is there between the duration of its period, and the depth at which the temperatures become con
of the earth
?
stant
What time must have elapsed before the climates could acquire the different temperatures which they now maintain; and what are the different causes which can now vary their mean heat ?
do not the annual changes alone in the distance of the sun from the earth, produce at the surface of the earth very considerable changes in the temperatures ?
Why
PRELIMINARY DISCOURSE.
From what
characteristic
its original
If, as several observations indicate, this fundamental heat not wholly dissipated, it must be immense at great depths, and nevertheless it has no sensible influence at the present time on the mean temperature of the climates. The effects which are observed in them are due to the action of the solar rays. But independently of these two sources of heat, the one funda
is
mental and primitive, proper to the terrestrial globe, the other due to the presence of the sun, is there not a more universal cause, which determines the temperature of the heavens, in that part
which the solar system now occupies? Since the ob served facts necessitate this cause, what are the consequences of an exact theory in this entirely new question; how shall we be able to determine that constant value of the temperature of
of space
space,
it
planet
these, questions must be added others which depend on the properties of radiant heat. The physical cause of the re flection of cold, that is to say the reflection of a lesser degree
To
of heat,
is
very distinctly
?
known
but what
is
the mathematical
general principles do the atmospheric temperatures whether the thermometer which measures them receives depend, the solar rays directly, on a surface metallic or unpolished, or whether this instrument remains exposed, during the night, under a sky free from clouds, to contact with the air, to radiation from terrestrial bodies, and to that from the most distant and
coldest parts of the atmosphere ? The intensity of the rays which escape from a point on the surface of any heated body varying with their inclination ac
On what
is there not a mathematical relation between this law and the general necessary and what is the physical cause of fact of the equilibrium of heat
;
Lastly, when heat penetrates fluid masses, and determines in them internal movements by continual changes of the temperature
still
express,
by
differential
THEORY OF HEAT.
;
equations, the laws of such a compound effect and what is the resulting change in the general equations of hydrodynamics ?
Such are the chief problems which I have solved, and which have never yet been submitted to calculation. If we consider further the manifold relations of this mathematical theory to civil uses and the technical arts, we shall recognize completely the extent of its applications. It is evident that it includes an
entire
series of distinct phenomena, and that the study of it cannot be omitted without losing a notable part of the science of
nature.
theory are derived, as are those of rational mechanics, from a very small number of primary facts, the causes of which are not considered by geometers, but which
The
principles of the
common
observations confirmed by
all
The differential equations of the propagation of heat express the most general conditions, and reduce the physical questions to problems of pure analysis, and this is the proper object of theory.
They are not
less rigorously established
and motion. In order to make this comparison more perceptible, we have always preferred demonstrations ana logous to those of the theorems which serve as the foundation of statics and dynamics. These equations still exist, but receive
of equilibrium
a different form, when they express the distribution of luminous heat in transparent bodies, or the movements which the changes
of temperature
interior
of fluids.
The
which they contain are subject to variations whose exact measure is not yet known but in all the natural problems which it most concerns us to consider, the limits of temperature
coefficients
differ
so
little
that
variations of these co
efficients.
of the movement of heat, like those which the vibrations of sonorous bodies, or the ultimate oscilla express tions of liquids, belong to one of the most recently discovered branches of analysis, which it is very important to perfect. After having established these differential equations their integrals must
The equations
be obtained
ditions.
this process consists in passing from a common expression to a particular solution subject to all the given con
;
This
difficult
analysis
PRELIMINARY DISCOURSE.
founded on new theorems, whose object we could not in this place make known. The method which is derived from them leaves nothing vague and indeterminate in the solutions, it leads
them up
The same theorems which have made known equations of the movement of heat, apply directly to
blems
of general analysis a.nd
us
the
dynamics whose
is
this study, in offering a de terminate object to investigation, the advantage of excluding vague questions and calculations without issue ; it is besides a
sure
method
elements which
of forming analysis itself, and of discovering the it concerns us to know, and which natural science
:
ought always to preserve these are the fundamental elements which are reproduced in all natural effects. We see, for example, that the same expression whose abstract
properties geometers
in this respect
motion of light
in the atmosphere, as it determines the laws of diffusion of heat in solid matter, and enters into all the chief problems of the
theory of probability.
The
analytical equations,
unknown
which Descartes was the first to introduce into the study of curves and surfaces, are not restricted to the properties of figures, and to those properties which are the object of rational mechanics they extend to all general phenomena. There cannot be a language more universal and more simple, more free from errors and from
;
more worthy
mathematical analysis
all
;
is
as
it
defines
perceptible
relations,
measures times, spaces, forces, temperatures this difficult science is formed slowly, but it preserves every principle which it has once acquired it grows and strengthens itself incessantly in the midst
;
of the
many
variations
and
errors of the
;
human mind.
it
THEORY OF HEAT.
fused notions. It brings together phenomena the most diverse, and discovers the hidden analogies which unite them. If matter escapes us, as that of air and light, by its extreme tenuity, if bodies are placed far from us in the immensity of space, if man
the aspect of the heavens at successive epochs a great number of centuries, if the actions of gravity separated by and of heat are exerted in the interior of the earth at depths
wishes to
know
which will be always inaccessible, mathematical analysis can yet It makes them present lay hold of the laws of these phenomena. and measurable, and seems to be a faculty of the human mind
destined to supplement the shortness of life and the imperfec and what is still more remarkable, it follows tion of the senses
;
the same course in the study of all phenomena it interprets them by the same language, as if to attest the unity and simplicity of
;
the plan of the universe, and to make still more evident that unchangeable order which presides over all natural causes.
The problems
many examples
of the simple and constant dispositions which spring from the general laws of nature ; and if the order which is established in
these
in us
senses, it
would produce
The forms
the distribution of
the heat which penetrates them seems to be arbitrary and confused ; but all the inequalities are rapidly cancelled and disappear as time
passes on.
The progress of the phenomenon becomes more regular and simpler, remains finally subject to a definite law which is the same in all cases, and which bears no sensible impress of the initial
arrangement.
All observation confirms these
consequences.
The
analysis
from which they are derived separates and expresses clearly, 1 the general conditions, that is to say those which spring from the
natural properties of heat, 2 the effect, accidental but continued, of the form or state of the surfaces 3 the effect, not
;
permanent,
In this work we have demonstrated all the principles of the theory of heat, and solved all the fundamental problems. They could have been explained more concisely by the
omitting simpler problems, and presenting in the first instance the most general results; but we wished to shew the actual origin of the theory and
PRELIMINARY DISCOURSE.
its
gradual progress. When this knowledge has been acquired and the principles thoroughly fixed, it is preferable to employ at once the most extended analytical methods, as we have done in
the later investigations.
hereafter follow in the
have reconciled, so far as it can depend on our the necessary development of principles with the precision selves, which becomes the applications of analysis.
shall
will
form in
This is also the course which we shall memoirs which will be added to this work, some manner its complement *; and by this
subjects of these memoirs will be, the theory of radiant the problem of the terrestrial temperatures, that of the heat, temperature of dwellings, the comparison of theoretic results with
The
those which we have observed in different experiments, lastly the demonstrations of the differential equations of the movement of heat in fluids.
different circumstances
it.
the printing of
In this
;
written a long time have delayed and often interrupted interval, science has been enriched by
the principles of our analysis, which had been grasped, have become better known the results which we had deduced from them have been discussed and con We ourselves have applied these principles to new firmed. problems, and have changed the form of some of the proofs.
important observations
not at
first
The delays
clearer
of publication will
The subject of our first analytical investigations on the transfer of heat was its distribution amongst separated masses these have been preserved in Chapter III., Section II. The problems relative
to continuous bodies, which form the theory rightly so called, were solved many years afterwards ; this theory was explained for the
time in a manuscript work forwarded to the Institute of France at the end of the year 1807, an extract from which was
first
10
THEORY OF HEAT.
void of air, the constructions suitable for exhibiting the chief theorems, and the analysis of the periodic movement at the sur Our second memoir, on the propagation of face of the earth.
was deposited in the archives of the Institute, on the 28th of September, 1811. It was formed out of the preceding memoir and the geometrical constructions and the notes already sent in those details of analysis which had no necessary relation to the physical problem were omitted, and to it was added the general equation which expresses the state of the surface. This second work was sent to press in the course of 1821, to be inserted in
heat,
;
of Sciences. It is printed without the text agrees literally with the deposited any manuscript, which forms part of the archives of the Institute \ In this memoir, and in the writings which preceded it, will be
Academy
;
change or addition
found a
first
1 It appears as a memoir and supplement in volumes IV. and V. of the Memoircs de V Academic des Sciences. For convenience of comparison with, the table
of contents of the Analytical Theory of Heat, we subjoin the titles and heads of the chapters of the printed memoir
:
THEORIE DU MOUVEMENT DE LA CHALEUR DANS LES CORPS SOLIDES, PAR M. FOURIER. [Memoires de VAcademic Hoy ale des Sciences de Vlnstitut de France.
Tome IV.
I.
(for
year 1819).
Paris 1824.]
Exposition. II. Notions generales et definitions preliminaires. III. Equations du mouvement de la chaleur.
IV.
Du
De
mouvement
une armille.
V.
VI.
VII.
la propagation de la chaleur
sont constantes.
De
la
VIII.
Du mouvement varie de la chaleur dans une sphere solide. Du mouvement varie de la chaleur dans un cylindre solide.
De la propagation de la chaleur dans un prisme dont Vextremite est assujcttie a une temperature constante. X. Du mouvement varie de la chaleur dans un solide de forme cubique. XI. Du mouvement lineaire et varie de la chaleur dans les corps dont une dimension
IX.
est infinie.
SUITE DU MEMOIRS INTITULE: THEORIE DU MOUVEMENT DE LA CHALEUR DANS LES CORPS SOLIDES; PAR M. FOURIER. [Memoires de V Academic Eoyale des Sciences
de rinstitut de France. XII.
Paris, 1826.] la chaleur dans Vinterieur d une sphere solide, dont la surface est assujettie a des changemens periodiques de temperature.
(for
Tome V.
year 1820).
Des temperatures
terrestres, et
du mouvement de
XIII.
Des
XIV.
lois mathematiques de Vequilibre de la chaleur rayonnante. Comparaison des resultats de la theorie avec ceux de diverses experiences
[A. P.]
PRELIMINARY DISCOURSE.
1 does not contain; they will be treated in the subsequent memoirs at greater length, and, if it be in our power, with greater clear
ness.
The
also
are
indicated in several
results of our labours concerning the same problems articles already published. The
We
extract inserted in the Annales de Chimie et de Physique shews the aggregate of our researches (Vol. in. page 350, year 1816). published in the Annales two separate notes,
concerning radiant heat (Vol. iv. page 128, year 1817, and Vol. vi. page 259,
year 1817). Several other articles of the same collection present the most constant results of theory and observation the and the
;
utility
extent of thermological knowledge could not be better appreciated than by the celebrated editors of the Annales *.
In the Bulletin des Sciences (Societe philomatique year 1818, page 1, and year 1820, page 60) will be found an extract from a memoir on the constant or variable temperature of dwellings,
the
great problems of natural philosophy, has considered the obser vations of the temperatures proper to the different climates
from a novel and very important point of view (Memoir on Iso lines, Societe d Arcueil, Vol. ill. page 462) (Memoir on the inferior limit of perpetual snow, Annales de Chimie et de
thermal
;
Physique, Vol. v. page 102, year 1817). As to the differential equations of the
fluids
3
movement
of heat in
mention has been made of them in the annual history of the Academy of Sciences. The extract from our memoir shews (Analyse des travaux de VAca clearly its object and principle.
demie des Sciences, by M. De Lambre, year 1820.) The examination of the repulsive forces produced by heat, which determine the statical properties of gases, does not belong
See note, page 9, and the notes, pages 11 13. Gay-Lussac and Arago. See note, p. 13. 3 Memoires de VAcademie des Sciences, Tome XII., Paris, 1833, contain on pp. 507514, Me moire d analyse sur le mouvement de la chaleur dans les fluides, par M. Fourier. Lu a VAcademie Royale des Sciences, 4 Sep. 1820. It is followed on pp.
1
515
is
The memoir
signed Jh. Fourier, Paris, 1 Sep. 1820, but was published after the death of the author. [A. F.]
12
THEORY OF HEAT.
to the analytical subject which, we have considered. This question connected with the theory of radiant heat has just heen discussed the illustrious author of the Me canique celeste, to whom all
by
The new
analysis owe important des Temps, years 1824-5.) (Connaissance theories explained in our work are united for ever of
mathematical
and
rest like
them on
invariable
the elements which they at present possess they foundations Instru will preserve, and will continually acquire greater extent. ments will be perfected and experiments multiplied. The analysis
all
which we have formed will be deduced from more general, that is to say, more simple and more fertile methods common to many For all substances, solid or liquid, for classes of phenomena. and permanent gases, determinations will be made of all vapours the specific qualities relating to heat, and of the variations of the 1 At different stations on the coefficients which express them earth observations will be made, of the temperatures of the
.
and
in lakes
constant or variable, in the atmosphere, in the ocean and the constant temperature of the heavens proper ;
become known 2
The theory
itself
pp. 581
Hemoires de VAcademie des Sciences, Tome VIII., Paris 1829, contain on 622, Memoire sur la Theorie Analytique de la Chaleur, par M. Fourier. This was published whilst the author was Perpetual Secretary to the Academy.
only of four parts of the memoir is printed. The contents of all are Determines the temperature at any point of a prism whose terminal temperatures are functions of the time, the initial temperature at any point being
The
first
stated.
I.
a function of its distance from one end. II. Examines the chief consequences of the general solution, and applies it to two distinct cases, according as the tempe Is historical, ratures of the ends of the heated prism are periodic or not. III.
enumerates the
earlier
experimental and analytical researches of other writers of the transcendental equations ; considers the nature
;
replies to the objections of M. Poisson ; adds some remarks on a problem of the motion of waves. IV. Extends the application of the theory of heat by taking
account, in the analysis, of variations in the specific coefficients which measure the capacity of substances for heat, the permeability of solids, and the penetra
bility of their surfaces.
2
[A. F.]
,
Memoircs de VAcademie des Sciences, Tome VII. Paris, 1827, contain on pp. 569 604, Memoire sur les temperatures du globe terrestre et des espaces planeThe memoir is entirely descriptive ; it was read before the taires, par M. Fourier. Academy, 20 and 29 Sep. 1824 (Annales de Chimie et de Physique, 1824, xxvu.
p. 136).
[A. F.]
PRELIMINARY DISCOURSE.
13
will direct all these measures, and assign their precision. No considerable progress can hereafter be made which is not founded on experiments such as these ; for mathematical analysis can
deduce from general and simple phenomena the expression of the laws of nature ; but the special application of these laws to very
complex
effects
demands a long
The complete list of the Articles on Heat, published by M. Fourier, in the Annales de Chimie et de Physique, Series 2, is as follows
:
Theorie de la Chaleur (Extrait). Description by the author of the 4to volume afterwards published in 1822 without the chapters on
1816.
III. pp.
350375.
radiant heat, solar heat as it affects the earth, the comparison of analysis with experiment, and the history of the rise and progress of the theory of heat.
145. Note sur la Chaleur rayonnante. 1817. IV. pp. 128 Mathematical sketch on the sine law of emission of heat from a surface. Proves the author s
paradox on the hypothesis of equal intensity of emission in all directions. VI. pp. 259 303. 1817. Questions sur la theorie physique de la chaleur An elegant physical treatise on the discoveries of Newton, Pictet, rayonnante.
Wells, TVollaston, Leslie and Prevost. 1820. XIII. pp. 418 438. Sur le refroidissement seculaire de la terre (Extrait). Sketch of a memoir, mathematical and descriptive, on the waste of the earth s
initial heat.
167. Eemarques generates sur Ics temperatures du globe pp. 136 des espaces planetaires. This is the descriptive memoir referred to above, Mem. Acad. d. Sc. Tome VII.
1824.
XXYII.
terrestre et
1824. XXYII. pp. 236 281. Eesume theorique des proprietes de la chaleur Elementary analytical account of surface-emission and absorption rayonnante. based on the principle of equilibrium of temperature. 1825. XXYIII. pp. 337 365. Eemarques sur la theorie mathematique de la
by walls
chaleur rayonnante. Elementary analysis of emission, absorption and reflection of enclosure uniformly heated. At p. 364, M. Fourier promises a Theorie
physique de la clialeur to contain the applications of the Theorie Analytique omitted from the work published in 1822.
1828. XXXYII. pp. 291 315. Eecherches experimentales sur la faculte conductrice des corps minces soumis a Vaction de la chaleur, et description d un nouveau thermometre de contact. A thermoscope of contact intended for lecture demonstra
tions is also described.
M. Ernile Yerdet in his Conferences de Physique, Paris, has stated the practical reasons against relying on the theoretical indications of the thermometer of contact. [A. F.]
1872.
Part
I.
p.
22,
of
des
Philomatique, and quoted here at pages 9 and 11, the first was written by M. Poisson, the mathematical editor of the Bulletin, the other two by
par
la Societe
M. Fourier.
[A. F.]
THEORY OF HEAT.
Et ignem rcgunt numeri.
PLATO*.
CHAPTER
I.
INTRODUCTION.
FIKST SECTION.
Statement of the Object of the Work.
1.
THE
effects of
cannot be discovered without the aid of mathematical analysis. The object of the theory which we are about to explain is to demonstrate these laws it reduces all physical researches on
;
the propagation of heat, to problems of the integral calculus whose elements are given by experiment. No subject has more extensive relations with the progress of industry and the natural
sciences
all
;
heat
is
bodies
and
all
spaces, it influences
and occurs in
the phenomena of the universe. unequally distributed among the different parts of a solid mass, it tends to attain equilibrium, and passes slowly from the parts which are more heated to those which are less; and at the same time it is dissipated at the surface, and lost
When
heat
is
in the
medium
or in the void.
The tendency
to uniform dis
tribution and the spontaneous emission which acts at the surface of bodies, change continually the temperature at their different
points.
1
The problem
Timaus, 53,
B.
<?7rexeipetro
of the
Cf. Plato,
Sre 5
/cat
yfjv Kal
depa
/cat
vdup
[A. F.]
CH.
I.
SECT.
I.]
INTRODUCTION.
15
determining what is the temperature at each point of a body at a given instant, supposing that the initial temperatures are known. The following examples will more clearly make known the nature of these problems.
2.
If
source of
is
we expose to the continued and uniform action of a heat, the same part of a metallic ring, whose diameter
and, after
molecules nearest to the source will be first heated, a certain time, every point of the solid will have acquired very nearly the highest temperature which it can attain. This limit or greatest temperature is not the same at different
large, the
points ; it becomes less and less according as they become more distant from that point at which the source of heat is directly
applied.
When
of heat supplies, at each instant, a quantity of heat which exactly compensates for that which is dissipated at all the points of the
external surface of the ring. If now the source be suppressed, heat will
continue to be
propagated in the interior of the solid, but that which is lost in the medium or the void, will no longer be compensated as
formerly by the supply from the source, so that
all
the tempe
ratures will vary and diminish incessantly until they have be come equal to the temperatures of the surrounding medium.
3.
remains, if at every point of the mean circumference of the ring an ordinate be raised perpendicular to the plane of the ring, whose length is proportional to the fixed temperature at that the curved line which passes through the ends of these
point, ordi nates will represent the permanent state of the temperatures, and it is very easy to determine by analysis the nature of this
line.
It is to be
is
small for the temperature to be supposed to be sufficiently of the same section perpendicular sensibly equal at all points When the source is removed, the to the mean circumference. line which bounds the ordinates proportional to the temperatures
at the different points will change problem consists in expressing, by
its
form continually.
The
variable
16
THEORY OF HEAT.
this curve,
[CHAP.
I.
form of
all
of the Let z be the constant temperature at a point circumference, x the distance of this point from the source, that is to say the length of the arc of the mean circumference,
4.
mean
included between the point m and the point o which corresponds the position of the source; z is the highest temperature can attain by virtue of the constant action which the point
to
function this permanent temperature z_ isj*^ of the distance x. The first part of theC^roblemj consists /(#) in determining the function f(x) which represents the permanent
of the source,
state of the solid.
and
been removed denote by t the time which has passed since the suppression of the source, and after the by v the value of the temperature at the point The quantity v will be a certain function F (x, t) of time t.
state as soon as the source has
;
t\
t),
F
is
o).
(x,
(x},
the object of the to (pf oblem^is of which we only Imowas yet so that we ought to have the
equation
5.
(.r)
=F
(x,
If
we
of a sphere or cube, in a
place a solid homogeneous mass, having the form medium maintained at a constant tem
perature, and if it remains immersed for a very long time, it will little from acquire at all its points a temperature differing
very
that of the
to transfer
fluid.
it
to
Suppose the mass to be withdrawn in order a cooler medium, heat will begin to be dissi
;
pated at
its
surface
mass
will not
the temperatures at different points of the be sensibly the same, and if we suppose it divided
into an infinity of layers by surfaces parallel to its external sur face, each of those layers will transmit, at each instant, a certain If it be quantity of heat to the layer which surrounds it.
imagined that each molecule carries a separate thermometer, -which indicates its temperature at every instant, the state of the solid will from time to time be represented by the variable It is required to system of all these thermometric heights.
express the successive states by analytical formulae, so that
we
SECT.
I.]
INTRODUCTION.
17
at any given instant the temperatures indicated by each thermometer, and compare the quantities of heat which flow during the same instant, between two adjacent layers, or into the surrounding medium.
G.
may know
If the
mass
of a point of this
is spherical, and we denote by x the distance mass from the centre of the sphere, by t the
time which has elapsed since the commencement of the cooling, and by v the variable temperature of the point m, it is easy to see that all points situated at the same distance x from the centre of the sphere have the same temperature v. This quantity v is a
certain function
be such that
it
F (x, t} of the radius x and of the time t becomes constant whatever be the value of
;
it
must
x,
when
by hypothesis, the temperature at all points is the same at the moment of emersion. The problem consists in determining that function of x and t which expresses
t
;
we suppose
to
be nothing
for
the value of
v.
In the next place it is to be remarked, that during the cooling, a certain quantity of heat escapes, at each instant, through
7.
the external surface, and passes into the medium. The value of this quantity is not constant it is greatest at the beginning of the
;
however we consider the variable state of the internal spherical surface whose radius is x, we easily see that there must be at each instant a certain quantity of heat which traverses that surface, and passes through that part of the mass which is more distant from the centre. This continuous flow of heat is variable
cooling.
If
like
that through the external surface, and both are quantities comparable with each other their ratios are numbers whose vary
;
ing values are functions of the distance x, and of the time has elapsed. It is required to determine these functions.
which
8. If the mass, which has been heated by a long immersion in a medium, and whose rate of cooling we wish to calculate, is of cubical form, and if we determine the position of each point mby
three rectangular co-ordinates x, y, z, taking for origin the centre of the cube, and for axes lines perpendicular to the faces, we see that the temperature v of the poiat after the time t, is a func
z,
and
t.
The
quantities of heat
H.
18
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
I.
which flow out at each instant through the whole external surface their of the solid, are variable and comparable with each other functions depending on the time t, the expres ratios are analytical sion of which must be assigned.
;
Let us examine also the case in which a rectangular prism of sufficiently great thickness and of infinite length, being sub mitted at its extremity to a constant temperature, whilst the air which surrounds it is maintained at a less temperature, has at last
9.
it is
required to determine.
All the
points of the
extreme section at the base of the prism have, by a common and permanent temperature. It is not the hypothesis, same with a section distant from the source of heat; each of the
to the base has acquired points of this rectangular surface parallel is not the same at different points of a fixed temperature, but this the same section, and must be less at points nearer to the surface
flows exposed to the air. We see also that, at each instant, there across a given section a certain quantity of heat, which always remains the same, since the state of the solid has become constant.
The problem
at
consists in
any given point of the solid, and the whole quantity of heat which, in a definite time, flows across a section whose position is
given.
10.
Take
as origin of co-ordinates
DC,
y, z,
base of the prism, and as rectangular axes, the axis of the prism the permanent itself, and the two perpendiculars on the sides
:
temperature v of the point m, whose co-ordinates are #, y, z, is a function of three variables F (x, y, z) it has by hypothesis a
:
constant value,
nothing, whatever be the values the unit of heat that quantity of y and z. which in the unit of time would emerge from an area equal to a unit of surface,
if the heated mass which that area bounds, and which is formed of the same substance as the prism, were continu ally maintained at the temperature of boiling water, and immersed in atmospheric air maintained at the temperature of melting ice.
We
permanent
state of the rectangular prism, flows, during a unit of time, across a certain section perpendicular to the axis, has a determinate ratio
SECT.
I.]
INTRODUCTION.
19
to the quantity of heat taken as unit. This ratio is not the same for all sections it is a function $ (#) of the distance r, at which
:
the section
is
situated.
<f>
It is required to find
(#).
an analytical expres
The foregoing examples suffice to give an exact idea of 11. the different problems which we have discussed. The solution of these problems has made us understand that the effects of the propagation of heat depend in the case of every solid substance, on three elementary qualities, which are, its capa
own conducMity, and the exterior conducibility. been observed that if two bodies of the same volume and of different nature have equal temperatures, and if the same
city for heat, its
It has
the, ratio of
manner, the first of the three elements which regulate the action of heat is exactly specific defined, and physicists have for a long time known several methods
this It is not the
In
theory which can fairly distinguish, define, and measure them with precision.
The proper
facility
or interior conducibility of a body expresses the is propagated in passing from one internal
molecule to another.
solid
The
body depends on the facility with which heat penetrates the surface, and passes from this body into a given medium, or passes from the medium into the solid. The last property is modified by
the more or less polished state of the surface it varies also accord but the ing to the medium in which the body is immersed
;
interior
solid.
conducibility can
formulae
These three elementary qualities are represented in our by constant numbers, and the theory itself indicates
As soon
as they
are determined, all the problems relating to the propagation of heat depend only on numerical analysis. The knowledge of these
specific properties
may
;
22
20
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
I.
It is a very imperfect know description of different substances. of bodies which ignores the relations which they have with ledge
one of the chief agents of nature. In general, there is no mathe matical theory which has a closer relation than this with public economy, since it serves to give clearness and perfection to the
practice of the ment of heat.
numerous
arts
The problem of the terrestrial temperatures presents 12. one of the most beautiful applications of the theory of heat the Different parts of the general idea to be formed of it is this.
;
course of the year, and is subject to other less perceptible in It is evident that, between the variable state of the equalities. surface and that of the internal temperatures, a necessary relation
exists,
know that, at a which may be derived from theory. certain depth below the surface of the earth, the temperature at a given place experiences no annual variation: this permanent
underground temperature becomes less and less according as the We may then place is more and more distant from the equator.
leave out of consideration the exterior envelope, the thickness of which is incomparably small with respect to the earth s radius,
We
and regard our planet as a nearly spherical mass, whose surface is subject to a temperature which remains constant at all points on a given parallel, but is not the same on another parallel. It follows from this that every internal molecule has also a fixed tem The mathematical problem perature determined by its position.
consists in discovering the fixed temperature at any given point, and the law which the solar heat follows whilst penetrating the interior of the earth.
still
more,
if
we
consider the changes which succeed each other in the envelope itself on the surface of which we dwell. Those alternations of
heat and cold which are reproduced everyday and in the course of every year, have been up to the present time the object of repeated
observations.
common
theory derive
These we can now submit to calculation, and from all the particular facts which experience
SECT.
I.]
INTRODUCTION.
us.
21
The problem is reducible to the hypothesis that of a vast sphere is affected by periodic temperatures ; every point analysis then tells us according to what law the intensity of these
has taught
variations decreases according as the depth increases, what is the amount of the annual or diurnal changes at a given depth, the
epoch of the changes, and how the fixed value of the underground temperature is deduced from the variable temperatures observed
at the surface.
13.
the
therefore deduce from them the values ing of the temperatures after a definite time. The numerical inter of the results of analysis is however necessary, and it pretation
is
and though their form is very simple do not furnish any general mode of integrat
it
to give
to every application of analysis to the natural sciences. So long as it is not obtained, the solutions may be said to remain in
complete and useless, and the truth which it is proposed to discover is no less hidden in the formulas of analysis than it was
much
We
the difficulty in all which contain the chief elements of the theory of heat. There is not one of the problems whose solution does not provide conve nient and exact means for discovering the numerical values of the
The fourth
Eiemann, Braunschweig, 2nd Ed., 1876. Bewegung der Warme in festen Korpern. Cours de physique mathematique, par E. Matthieu, Paris, 1873. The parts
Chapters XXI.
The Functions of Laplace, Lame, and Bessel, by I. Todhunter, London, 1875. XXV. XXIX. which give some of Lame s methods.
Conferences de Physique, par E. Verdet, Paris, 1872 [(Euvres, Vol. iv. Part i.]. Legons sur la propagation de la chaleur par conductibilite. These are followed by a very extensive bibliography of the whole subject of conduction of heat. For an interesting sketch and application of Fourier s Theory see
On
Theory of Heat, by Prof. Maxwell, London, 1875 [4th Edition]. Chapter XVIII. the diffusion of heat by conduction. Natural Philosophy, by Sir W. Thomson and Prof. Tait, Vol. i. Oxford, 1867.
On
[A. F.
22
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
I.
have flowed through, when the values of the time and of the Thus will be given not only the variable coordinates are known. differential equations which the functions that express the values of the temperatures must satisfy; but the functions themselves
will
be
facilitates
the
numerical
applications.
14.
an extent equal
to that of the problem, it was requisite that they accord with the initial state of the temperatures, which is should The examination of this condition shews that we may arbitrary.
develop in convergent series, or express by definite integrals, functions which are not subject to a constant law, and which
represent the ordinates of irregular or discontinuous lines. This property throws a new light on the theory of partial differen tial equations, and extends the employment of arbitrary functions
by submitting them
15.
remained to compare the facts with theory. With and exact experiments were undertaken, whose results were in conformity with those of analysis, and gave them an authority which one would have been disposed to refuse to them in a new matter which seemed subject to so much uncer These experiments confirm the principle from which we tainty. started, and which is adopted by all physicists in spite of the diversity of their hypotheses on the nature of heat.
It still
of contact,
is effected not only by way established also between bodies separated from each other, which are situated for a long time in the same region. This effect is independent of contact with a medium; we have
16.
Equilibrium of temperature
it is
observed
it
it
was necessary to examine the laws which radiant heat follows, on leaving the surface of a body. It results from the observations of many physicists and from our own experiments, that the inten sities of the different rays, which escape in all directions from any
point in the surface of a heated body, depend on the angles which their directions make with the surface at the same point.
We
SECT.
I.]
INTRODUCTION.
of surface, and that
23
it is
This general law of proportional to the sine of that angle \ emission of heat which different observations had already indi
cated, is a necessary consequence of the principle of the equilibrium of temperature and of the laws of propagation of heat in solid
bodies.
in
directed to one object only, that is to establish clearly the mathematical principles of the theory of heat, and to keep up in this way with the progress of the useful arts,
all
of nature.
From what
phenomena
precedes it is evident that a very extensive exists, not produced by mechanical forces, but
resulting simply from the presence and accumulation of heat. This part of natural philosophy cannot be connected with dy
namical theories, it has principles peculiar to itself, and is founded on a method similar to that of other exact sciences. The solar
heat, for example, which penetrates the interior of the globe, dis tributes itself therein according to a regular law which does not
depend on the laws of motion, and cannot be determined by the The dilatations which the repulsive principles of mechanics. force of heat produces, observation of which serves to measure
temperatures, are in truth dynamical effects; but
dilatations which we
calculate,
it
is
not these
when we
There are other more complex natural effects, depend at the same time on the influence of heat, and of tive forces: thus, the variations of temperatures which the ments of the sun occasion in the atmosphere and in the
18.
which
attrac
move
ocean,
change continually the density of the different parts of the air and the waters. The effect of the forces which these masses obey is modified at every instant by a new distribution of heat, and
it
cannot be doubted that this cause produces the regular winds, and the chief currents of the sea; the solar and lunar attractions and occasioning in the atmosphere effects but slightly sensible,
not general displacements.
1
It
V.
to
Mem. Acad.
d. Sc.
Tome
179213.
[A. F.]
24
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
I.
submit these grand phenomena to calculation, to discover the mathematical laws of the propagation of heat in the interior of
masses.
19.
It will
tains in bodies a regular disposition independent of the original distribution, which may be regarded as arbitrary.
first
distributed, the
system of temperatures altering more and more, tends to coincide sensibly with a definite state which depends only on the form of
the
In the ultimate state the temperatures of all the points are lowered in the same time, but preserve amongst each other the
solid.
:
same ratios in order to express this property the analytical for mulae contain terms composed of exponentials and of quantities
analogous to trigonometric functions. Several problems of mechanics present analogous results, such as the isochronism of oscillations, the multiple resonance of sonorous
bodies. Common experiments had made these results remarked, and analysis afterwards demonstrated their true cause. As to those results which depend on changes of temperature, they could not have been recognised except by very exact experiments but mathematical analysis has outrun observation, it has supplemented our senses, and has made us in a manner witnesses of regular and harmonic vibrations in the interior of bodies.
;
20.
relations
These considerations present a singular example of the which exist between the abstract science of numbers
causes.
and natural
is exposed at one end to the constant action and every point of it has attained its highest temperature, the system of fixed temperatures corresponds exactly to a table of logarithms the numbers are the elevations of ther mometers placed at the different points, and the logarithms are the distances of these points from the source. In general heat
When
a metal bar
of a source of heat,
distributes itself in the interior of solids according to a simple law expressed by a partial differential equation common to physical
The
an evident
relation to the tables of sines, for the rays which depart from the same point of a heated surface, differ very much from each other,
SECT.
I.]
INTRODUCTION.
25
and their intensity is rigorously proportional to the sine of the angle which the direction of each ray makes with the element of
surface.
If
we
stant at every point of a solid homogeneous mass, we should dis cover in these series of observations the properties of recurring series, as of sines and logarithms ; they would be noticed for
should recognise again the same results and all the chief elements of general analysis in the vibrations of elastic media, in
the
the properties of lines or of curved surfaces, in the movements of Thus the functions ob stars, and those of light or of fluids. tained by successive differentiations, which are in the
We
development of
infinite series
The first of equations, correspond also to physical properties. these functions, or the fluxion properly so called, expresses in geometry the inclination of the tangent of a curved line, and in
dynamics the velocity of a moving body when the motion varies ; in the theory of heat it measures the quantity of heat which flows at each point of a body across a given surface. Mathematical
analysis has therefore necessary relations with sensible
its
phenomena
object is not created by human intelligence; it is a pre-existent element of the universal order, and is not in any way contingent
;
or fortuitous
it is
imprinted throughout
all
nature.
21.
by causes which have not yet been perceived, and the theory will acquire fresh perfection by the continued comparison of its results with the results of experiment it will explain some important phenomena which we have not yet been able to submit to calculation it will shew how to determine all the therm ornetric effects of the solar
; ;
temperature which would be observed at from the equator, whether in the interior of the earth or beyond the limits of the atmosphere, whether in the ocean or in different regions of the air. From it will be derived the mathematical knowledge of the great movements which result
rays, the fixed or variable
different distances
The
26
THEORY OF HEAT.
principles will serve to
[CHAP.
I.
same
of heat at the tinguish all the causes which modify the emission surface of solids, and to perfect thermometric instruments.
The theory of heat will always attract the attention of ma thematicians, by the rigorous exactness of its elements and the all by the extent analytical difficulties peculiar to it, and above
for all its consequences con and usefulness of its applications cern at the same time general physics, the operations of the arts, domestic uses and civil economy.
;
SECTION
II.
OF the nature of heat uncertain hypotheses only could be but the knowledge of the mathematical laws to which its formed,
22.
effects are subject is
independent of all hypothesis it requires only an attentive examination of the chief facts which common obser vations have indicated, and which have been confirmed by exact
;
experiments.
It is necessary then to set forth, in the first place, the general results of observation, to give exact definitions of all the elements of the analysis, and to establish the principles upon which this
gaseous
Solids
and liquids
expand all bodies, solid, liquid or which gives evidence of its presence. if the increase in quantity of heat which volume^
;
they contain increases they contract if it diminishes. When all the parts of a solid homogeneous body, for example those of a mass of metal, are equally heated, and preserve without any change the same quantity of heat, they have also and retain
the same density. This state is expressed by saying that through out the whole extent of the mass the molecules have a common
is
;
it
by
SECT.
II.]
PRELIMINARY DEFINITIONS.
27
the dilatation of a fluid or of air. We assume the construction, use and properties of this instrument to be accurately known. The temperature of a body equally heated in every part, and
which keeps
when
it
is
heat, is that which the thermometer indicates and remains in perfect contact with the body in
its
is
question.
Perfect contact
mersed in a
the external surface of the instrument which is not touched by one of the points of the solid or liquid mass whose temperature is to be measured. In experiments it is not always necessary that this con dition should be rigorously observed but it ought to be assumed in order to make the definition exact.
;
fixed temperatures are determined on, namely the temperature of melting ice which is denoted by 0, and the ternperature of boiling water which we will denote by 1 the water is
24.
:
:
Two
supposed to be boiling under an atmospheric pressure represented by a certain height of the barometer (76 centimetres), the mercury
of the barometer being at the temperature
25.
0.
Different quantities of heat are measured by determining contain a fixed quantity which is taken as
Suppose a mass of
ice
to be at temperature 0,
by the addition of a certain quantity of heat the quantity of heat thus added is taken as the unit of measure. Hence the quantity of heat expressed by a number C contains C times the quantity required to diaoolvo a kilogramme of ice at the temperature zero into a mass of water at the same
zero temperature.
mass having a certain weight, a kilo to the example, from the temperature gramme a new quantity of heat must be added to that temperature 1, which is already contained in the mass. The number C which
26.
raise a metallic
for
To
of iron
denotes this additional quantity of heat, is the specific capacity of iron for heat; the number C has very different values for different
substances.
28
27.
THEORY OF HEAT.
If a
[CHAP.
I.
definite nature and weight (a kilogramme of a volume Fat temperature 0, it will oecupy a mercury) occupies A, when it has acquired the temperature 1, greater volume that is to say, when the heat which it contained at the tempera
body of
F+
ture
new
body
for heat.
this
quantity C, a quantity z C is added (z being a number + B instead positive or negative) the new volume will be
of
F + A.
increase of
experiments shew that if | is equal to J, the volume 8 is only half the total increment A, and
is
Now
^A,
of heat
28.
is
The
which and A, is that which is called the temperature; hence the quantity which expresses the actual temperature of a body represents the excess of its actual volume over the volume which it would occupy at the temperature of melting ice, unity representing the whole excess of volume which corresponds to the boiling point of water, over the volume which corresponds to the melting point
of ice.
ratio z of the two quantities zG and C of heat added, the same as the ratio of the two increments of volume 8
29.
The increments
of
in general pro
portional to
the increments
quantities
of heat
which
produce the dilatations, but it must be remarked that this propor tion is exact only in the case where the bodies in question are
subjected to temperatures remote from those which determine The application of these results to all their change of state.
liquids
must not be
dilatations
relied on;
particular, heat.
In general the temperatures are numbers proportional to the quantities of heat added, and in the cases considered by us,
these
numbers
are
proportional
also
to
the
increments
of
volume.
30.
a certain area
Suppose that a body bounded by a plane surface having (a square metre) is maintained in any manner
SECT.
II.]
PRELIMINARY DEFINITIONS.
29
whatever at constant temperature 1, common to all its points, and that the surface in question is in contact with air maintained at temperature the heat which escapes continuously at the surface and passes into the surrounding medium will be
:
replaced
always by the heat which proceeds from the constant cause to whose action the body is exposed; thus, a certain quantity of heat denoted by h will flow through the surface in a definite time (a
minute). This amount_ of a flow continuous and always similar to itself, which takes place at a unit of surface at a fixed temperature, is the measure of the external conducibility of the body, that is to say, of the facility with which its surface transmits heat to the
atmospheric
air.
supposed to be continually displaced with a given uniform velocity but if the velocity of the current increased, the quantity of heat communicated to the medium would vary also
air is
: :
The
if
medium were
31.
body
over the temperature of surrounding bodies, instead of being equal to 1, as has been supposed, had a less value, the quantity of heat
The result of observation is, dissipated would be less than k. as we shall see presently, that this quantity of heat lost may be regarded as sensibly proportional to the excess of the temperature
of the
body over that of the air and surrounding bodies. Hence the quantity h having been determined by one experiment in which the surface heated is at temperature 1, and the medium at temperature 0; we conclude that hz would be the quantity, if the
temperature of the surface were z, all the other circumstances remaining the same. This result must be admitted when z is a
small fraction.
of the quantity of heat which is dispersed across a heated surface is different for different bodies; and it
32.
The value h
The
of
irradiation
diminishes as the
surface
becomes more polished; so that by destroying the polish of the A heated surface the value of h is considerably increased.
30
metallic body will be
metallic lustre.
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
I.
more quickly cooled if its external surface is covered with a black coating such as will entirely tarnish its
rays of heat which escape from the surface of a body pass freely through spaces void of air; they are propagated also in atmospheric air: their directions are not disturbed by agitations
33.
The
in the intervening air: they can be reflected by metal mirrors and collected at their foci. Bodies at a high temperature, when plunged into a liquid, heat directly only those parts of the mass
is
in contact.
dis
is not extremely small, receive no direct not the same with aeriform fluids; in these the rays of
heat are borne with extreme rapidity to considerable distances, whether it be that part of these rays traverses freely the layers of
air,
or
body
is
heated, and
more quickly the more intensely it is another mass of cool air. A current replaced by
is vertical, and whose velocity is greater as the temperature of the body is higher. For this reason if the body cooled itself gradually the velocity of the current would diminish with the temperature, and the law of cooling would not be exactly the same as if the body were
exposed to a current of
35.
air at
a constant velocity.
When bodies
part of their radiant heat mixed with that light can traverse trans parent solids or liquids, and is subject to the force which
refraction.
produces
say,
The quantity
of heat
which possesses
;
this faculty
becomes
less as
it
is,
we may
insensiblefor very opaque bodies however highly theymaybe heated. thin transparent plate intercepts almost all the direct heat which proceeds from an ardent mass of metal ; but it becomes
SECT.
it
II.]
PRELIMINARY DEFINITIONS.
if it is
31
whence,
formed of
ice, it
becomes liquid
it
but
if
this
plate of ice is exposed to the rays of a torch amount of heat to pass with the
allows a sensible
through
light.
have taken as the measure of the external conducibody a coefficient h, which denotes the quantity of heat which would pass, in a definite time (a minute), from the
36.
bility of a solid
We
surface of this body, into atmospheric air, supposing that the sur had a definite extent (a square metre), that the constant temperature of the body was 1, and that of the air 0, and that
face
the heated surface was exposed to a current of air of a given in variable velocity. This value of h is determined by observation.
The quantity
two
of heat expressed
distinct parts
One is the heat communicated by way of contact to experiments. the surrounding air the other, much less than the first, is the radiant heat emitted. We must assume, in our first
that the quantity of heat lost does not change tures of the body and of the medium are
sufficiently small quantity.
investigations,
by
give exact measure, after having treated of the uniform and linear pro pagation of heat. Liquid substances possess also the property of transmitting heat from molecule to molecule, and the numerical value of their conducibility varies according to the nature of the
37. Solid substances differ again, as we have already remarked, their property of being more or less permeable to heat ; this its definition and quality is their conducibility proper: we shall
substances
but this
effect
is
since their molecules change places on change of temperature. The propagation q heat in them depends chiefly on this continual dis
placement, in all cases where the lower parts of the mass are most If, on the contrary, exposed to the action of the source of heat.
the source of heat be applied to that part of the mass which is highest, as was the case in several of our experiments, the transfer
of heat, at least
which
when
is
is very slow, does not produce any displacement, the increase of temperature does not diminish the
volume, as
of state.
32
38.
THEORY OF HEAT.
To
[CHAP.
I.
general remark must be added on equilibrium of temperatures; which consists in this, that different bodies placed in the same re gion, all of whose parts are and remain equally heated, acquire also a common and permanent temperature. have a common and Suppose that all the parts of a mass constant temperature a, which is maintained by any cause what
be placed in perfect contact with the a smaller body will assume the common temperature a. mass M, it In reality this result would not strictly occur except after an
ever:
if
but the exact meaning of the proposition is that if the temperature a before being placed in contact, The same would be the case it would keep it without any change. with a multitude of other bodies n, p, q, r each of which was
infinite
time
the body
m had
all would placed separately in perfect contact with the mass Thus a thermometer if suc the constant temperature a. acquire
:
q,
r would indicate
independent of contact, and would still occur, if every part of the body m were enclosed in the solid M, as in an enclosure, without touching any of its parts. For example, if the solid were a spherical envelope of a certain
39.
effect
The
in
question
is
thickness, maintained
by some external cause at a temperature a, and containing a space entirely deprived of air, and if the body m could be placed in any part whatever of this spherical space, with
out touching any point of the internal surface of the enclosure, it would acquire the common temperature a, or rather, it would pre serve it if it had it already. The result would be the same for all the other bodies n, p, q, r, whether they were placed separately or all together in the same enclosure, and whatever also their sub stance and form might be.
40.
Of
heat, that
all modes of presenting to ourselves the action of which seems simplest and most conformable to observa
tion, consists in
comparing
Mole
cules separated from one another reciprocally communicate, across empty space, their rays of heat, just as shining bodies transmit their light.
SECT.
II.]
GENERAL NOTIONS.
33
If within an enclosure closed in all directions, and maintained some external cause at a fixed temperature a, we suppose dif by ferent bodies to be placed without touching any part of the bound ary, different effects will be observed according as the bodies,
introduced into this space free from air, are more or less heated. If, in the first instance, we insert only one of these bodies, at the
same temperature
its
surface as
it,
much
is
heat as
it
rounds
and
maintained in
by
this
exchange
body whose temperature 6 is less than a, from the surfaces which surround it on all sides without touching it, a quantity of heat greater than that which it gives out it will be heated more and more and will absorb through its surface more heat than in the first instance.
it
The initial temperature b continually rising, will approach with so that after a certain time out ceasing the fixed temperature The effect would be op the difference will be almost insensible.
,
posite if
All bodies have the property of emitting heat through their surface; the hotter they are the more they emit; the of the emitted rays changes very considerably with the
Every surface which receives rays of heat from surround bodies reflects part and admits the rest the heat which is not ing within reflected, but introduced through the surface, accumulates
42.
:
the solid; and so long as it exceeds the quantity dissipated by irradiation, the temperature rises.
out of heated bodies are rays which tend to go force which reflects part of them into arrested at the surface by a The cause which hinders the incident the interior of the mass.
43.
The
and which divides these rays into rays from traversing the surface, two parts, of which one is reflected and the other admitted, acts in the same manner on the rays which are directed from the interior of the body towards external space.
F.
H.
34
If
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
I.
by modifying the state of the surface we increase the force by which it reflects the incident rays, we increase at the same time the power which it has of reflecting towards the interior of the The incident rays intro body rays which are tending to go out. duced into the mass, and the rays emitted through the surface, are
equally diminished in quantity.
44.
mentioned a number of
bodies were placed at the same time, separate from each other and unequally heated, they would receive and transmit rays of heat
exchange their temperatures would continually vary, and would all tend to become equal to the fixed temperature
so that at each
of the enclosure.
This
effect is precisely
when
heat
propagated within solid bodies for the molecules which compose these bodies are separated by spaces void of air, and
is
Each
have the property of receiving, accumulating and emitting heat. of them sends out rays on all sides, and at the same time
which surround
it.
45.
we may
by the nearest
;
It is
heat directly and act on more distant points. different with gaseous fluids the direct effects of radiation
sensible in
become
46.
them
of the surface of a solid, passes on in air to very distant points ; but is emitted only by those molecules of the body which are extremely
point of a heated mass situated at a very small distance from the plan^ superficies which separates the mass from external space, sends to that space an infinity of rays, but
they do not all arrive there; they are diminished by all that quan tity of heat which is arrested by the intermediate molecules of the
solid.
The part of the ray actually dispersed into space becomes according as it traverses a longer path within the mass. Thus the ray which escapes perpendicular to the surface has greater in
less
same
point, follows
SECT.
II.]
GENERAL NOTIONS.
35
an oblique direction, and the most oblique rays are wholly inter
cepted.
The same consequences apply to all the points which are near enough to the surface to take part in the emission of heat, from which it necessarily follows that the whole quantity of heat which escapes from the surface in the normal direction is very much We have submitted greater than that whose direction is oblique. this question to calculation, and our analysis proves that the in tensity of the ray is proportional to the sine of the angle which the ray makes with the element of surface. Experiments had
already indicated a similar result.
This theorem expresses a general law which has a neces connection with the equilibrium and mode of action of heat. sary If the rays which escape from a heated surface had the same in
47.
tensity in all directions, a thermometer placed at one of the points of a space bounded on all sides by an enclosure maintained at a
Bodies placed within this greater than -that of the enclosure enclosure would not take a common temperature, as is always
.
noticed; the temperature acquired by them would depend on the place which they occupied, or on their form, or on the forms of
neighbouring bodies.
would be observed, or other effects equally experience, if between the rays which escape from the same point any other relations were admitted different from those which we have enunciated. We have recognised this law as the only one compatible with the general fact of the equi
results
The same
opposed to
common
placed at any point whatever of the space, its temperature It will receive therefore at will continue without any change.
ture a,
is
as
each instant from the inner surface of the enclosure as much heat This effect of the rays of heat in a given it gives out to it.
space
1
is,
but
Ph. Ser.
2, iv. p. 128.
[A. F.]
32
36
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
I.
If
now between
the thermometer and a part of the surface of be placed whose temperature is a, the
thermometer
surface, but the rays will be replaced by those which it will re ceive from the interposed body M. An easy calculation proves
is
thermo
meter
of the
it is
will
be unchanged.
if
When from that of the enclosure. sends to the which the interposed body thermometer and which replace the intercepted rays convey more heat than the latter; the temperature of the thermometer must
body
is
the temperature
different
therefore rise.
on the contrary, the intervening body has a temperature a, that of the thermometer must fall; for the rays which this body intercepts are replaced by those which it gives out, that is to say, by rays cooler than those of the enclosure; thus the
If,
less
than
all
temperature
49.
a.
Up
which
all surfaces
to this point abstraction has been made of the power have of reflecting part of the rays w hich are
r
sent to them. If this property were disregarded we should have only a very incomplete idea of the equilibrium of radiant heat. Suppose then that on the inner surface of the enclosure, main
tained at a constant temperature, there is a portion which enjoys, in a certain degree, the power in question each point of the re the one go flecting surface will send into space two kinds of rays out from the very interior of the substance of which the enclosure is formed, the others are merely reflected by the same surface against
; ;
which they had been sent. But at the same time that the surface repels on the outside part of the incident rays, it retains in the
inside part of its
is
own rays. In this respect an exact compensation that is to say, every one of its own rays which the established, surface hinders from going out is replaced by a reflected ray of
The same
result would happen, if the power of reflecting rays any degree whatever other parts of the enclosure, or the
equal intensity.
affected in
II.]
GENERAL NOTIONS.
same space and already
37
at
the
common
Thus the
temperature.
reflection of heat does not disturb the equilibrium
of temperatures,
exists,
any change in the law according to which the intensity of rays which leave the same point decreases to the
sine of the angle of emission.
50. Suppose that in the same enclosure, all of whose parts maintain the temperature a, we place an isolated body M, and a polished metal surface R, which, turning its concavity towards the body, reflects great part of the rays which it received from the body; if we place a thermometer between the IT and the re
body
flecting surface R, at the focus of this mirror, three different effects will be observed according as the temperature of the body J/ is equal to the common temperature a, or is greater or less.
case, the thermometer preserves the temperature receives 1, rays of heat from all parts of the enclosure not hidden from" it by the body or by the mirror ; 2, rays given out the body ; 3, those which the surface R sends out to by the focus,
first
In the
it
whether they come from the mass of the mirror itself, or whether its surface has simply reflected them and ; amongst the last we may distinguish between those which have been sent to the mirror
the mass J/, and those which it has received from the enclosure. All the rays in question proceed from surfaces which, by hypo
thesis,
is
by
a,
so that the
body thermometer placed between the heated and the mirror, must acquire a temperature body greater than In reality, it receives the same rays as in the first a. hypothesis but with two remarkable differences one arises from the fact that the rays sent by the body J/ to the mirror, and reflected upon the thermometer, contain more heat than in the first case. The other difference depends on the fact that the rays sent directly by the to the thermometer contain more heat than body formerly. Both causes, and chiefly the first, assist in raising the tempera
In the second
precisely in the same state as if the space closure contained 110 other but itself.
case, the
is
to say,
when
38
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
I.
mass
is less
than
a.
a,
less
than
In
the temperature must assume also a tem fact, it receives again all the varieties of
first
we
distinguished in the
case
hypothesis,
by the body M, are reflected by the mirror upon the thermometer, and those which sends to it directly. Thus the thermometer floes the same body
which, being sent out
not receive
all
it
requires to preserve
its
original
temperature a. It gives out more heat than it receives. It is inevitable then that its temperature must fall to the point at which the rays which it receives suffice to compensate those which
This last effect is what is called the reflection of cold, and which, properly speaking, consists in the reflection of too The mirror intercepts a certain quantity of heat, and feeble heat.
it loses.
replaces
51.
a,
it
by a
less quantity.
whose temperature a is less than a, the presence of this body will lower the thermometer exposed to its rays, and we may remark that the rays sent to the thermometer from the surface of the body M, are in general of two kinds, namely, those which come from inside the mass M, and those which, coming from different parts of the enclosure, meet the sur and are reflected upon the thermometer. The latter rays face have the common temperature a, but those which belong to the contain less heat, and these are the rays which cool the body
a body
placed,
M be
M M
by changing the state of the surface of the body M, for example, by destroying the polish, we diminish the power which it has of reflecting the incident rays, the thermo meter will fall still lower, and will assume a temperature less than a. In fact all the conditions would be the same as in the
thermometer.
If now,
a"
if it were not that the body gives out a greater of its own rays and reflects a less quantity of the raysquantity which it receives from the enclosure; that is to say, these last rays,
preceding case,
which have the common temperature, are in part replaced by cooler rays. Hence the thermometer no longer receives so much
heat as formerly.
we
in
reflect
SECT.
II.]
GENERAL NOTIONS.
left
39
will
M, the temperature
assume a value
mirror, in fact, intercepts from the thermo meter part of the rays of the enclosure which all have the tem perature a, and replaces them by three kinds of rays ; namely,
less
a".
than
The
1, those which come from the interior of the mirror itself, and which have the common temperature 2, those which the different parts of the enclosure send to the mirror with the same tempera ture, and which are reflected to the focus 3, those which, coming from the interior of the body J/, fall upon the mirror, and are
;
;
upon the thermometer. The last rays have a tempera ture less than a hence the thermometer no longer receives so much heat as it received before the mirror was set up.
reflected
;
Lastly, if we proceed to change also the state of the surface of the mirror, and by giving it a more perfect polish, increase its power of reflecting heat, the thermometer will fall still lower. In
fact, all
Only,
it
the conditions exist which occurred in the preceding case. happens that the mirror gives out a less quantity of its
own
and replaces them by those which it reflects. Now, these last rays, all those which proceed from the interior amongst of the mass are less intense than if they had come from the
rays,
interior of the
less
a""
metal mirror
:
still
it
than
a"
By
all
the
known
The
effects of
It would be useless to attempt to deduce from this hypothesis the laws of propagation which we have explained in this work,
and which all experience has confirmed. The free state of heat is the same as that of light the active state of this element is then Heat acts in entirely different from that of gaseous substances. the same manner in a vacuum, in elastic fluids, and in liquid or
;
solid masses, it is
its
53.
Heat
is
the origin of
all elasticity
it
is
the repulsive
force
solid masses,
40
liquids.
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
I.
In solid masses, neighbouring molecules would yield to mutual attraction, if its effect were not destroyed by the heat which separates them.
their
This
higher
;
the temperature
is
which
is
the reason
why
when
The equilibrium which exists, in the interior of a solid between the repulsive force of heat and the molecular attrac mass,
tion, is stable
;
54
that
is to
when
disturbed
by an accidental cause.
proper for equilibrium,
this distance without
and
of
attraction begins by surpassing that of heat, and brings back the molecules to their original position, after a multitude of oscillations
which become
less
and
less sensible.
exerted in the opposite sense when a me similar chanical cause diminishes the primitive distance of the molecules
effect is
the origin of the vibrations of sonorous or flexible bodies, and of all the effects of their elasticity.
such
is
In the liquid or gaseous state of matter, the external pressure is additional or supplementary to the molecular attrac tion, and, acting on the surface, does not oppose change of form, but only change of the volume occupied. Analytical investigation
55.
will best shew how the repulsive force of heat, opposed to the attraction of the molecules or to the external pressure, assists in
the composition of bodies, solid or liquid, formed of one or more elements, and determines the elastic properties of gaseous fluids but these researches do not belong to the object before us, and
It cannot
always consists, like that of light, in the reciprocal communication of rays, and this explanation is at the present time adopted by
not necessary to consider the phenomena under this aspect in order to establish the theory of heat. In the course of this work it will be seen how the laws of equili
the majority of physicists
;
but
it is
SECT.
III.]
PRINCIPLE OF COMMUNICATION.
41
can be rigorously demonstrated, independently of any physical explanation, as the necessary consequences of common observations.
SECTION
III.
now proceed to examine what experiments teach us the communication of heat. concerning If two equal molecules are formed of the same substance and
57.
We
have the same temperature, each of them receives from the other as much heat as it gives up to it ; their mutual action may then be
regarded as null, since the result of this action can bring about no change in the state of the molecules. If, on the contrary, the first
is
from
hotter than the second, it sends to it more heat than it receives it the result of the mutual action is the difference of these
;
two quantities of heat. In all cases we make abstraction of the two equal quantities of heat which any two material points we conceive that the point most heated reciprocally give up acts only on the other, and that, in virtue of this action, the first loses a certain quantity of heat which is acquired by the second. Thus the action of two molecules, or the quantity of heat which the hottest communicates to the other, is the difference of the two quantities which they give up to each other.
;
Suppose that we place in air a solid homogeneous body, have unequal actual temperatures each of the molecules of which the body is composed will begin to receive heat from those which are at extremely small distances, or will
58.
whose
different points
communicate it to them. This action exerted during the same instant between all points of the mass, will produce an infinitesi mal resultant change in all the temperatures the solid will ex
:
effects, so
temperature will become more and more sensible. and n, equal and Consider only the system of two molecules, near, and let us ascertain what quantity of heat the extremely
first
can receive from the second during one instant we may then apply the same reasoning to all the other points which are
:
42
THEORY OF HEAT.
it
[CHAP.
I.
during the
first
The quantity
of heat
to the
depends on the duration of the instant, on the very small point distance between these points, on the actual temperature of each that is to say, if point, and on the nature of the solid substance one of these elements happened to vary, all the other remaining the same, the quantity of heat transmitted would vary also. Now
;
experiments have disclosed, in this respect, a general result it consists in this, that all the other circumstances being the same, the quantity of heat which one of the molecules receives from the
:
other is proportional to the difference of temperature of the two molecules. Thus the quantity would be double, triple, quadruple, if
everything else remaining the same, the difference of the tempera became double, triple, ture of the point n from that of the point or quadruple. To account for this result, we must consider that the
action of n on
difference
if
greater as there is a greater the temperatures of the two points it is null, between the temperatures are equal, but if the molecule n contains more
:
heat than the equal molecule m, that is to say, if the temperature of in being v, that of n is v + A, a portion of the exceeding heat will pass from n to m. Now, if the excess of heat were double, or,
the same thing, if the temperature of n were v + 2 A, the exceeding heat would be composed of two equal parts correspond ing to the two halves of the whole difference of temperature 2A
which
is
each of these parts would have its proper effect as if existed thus the quantity of heat communicated by n to
:
it
alone
m would
be twice as great as when the difference of temperature is only A. This simultaneous action of the different parts of the exceeding heat is that which constitutes the principle of the communication
of heat.
It follows
from
it
that the
sum
receives from n the total quantity of heat which to the difference of the two temperatures.
59.
proportional
Denoting by v and v the temperatures of two equal mole and n by p their extremely small distance, and by dt, the infinitely small duration of the instant, the quantity of heat which receives from n during this instant will be expressed by
cules m
t t
m
(v
v)<f)
(p)
dt.
We
denote by
SECT.
III.]
PRINCIPLE OF COMMUNICATION.
43
distance
when p
p which, in solid bodies and in liquids, becomes nothing has a sensible magnitude. The function is the same for
;
it
60.
face
is
The quantity of heat which bodies lose through their sur subject to the same principle. If we denote by a- the area,
v,
the surface, all of whose points have a represents the temperature of the atmospheric air, the coefficient h being the measure of the ex ternal conducibility, we shall have ah (v a) dt as the expression for the quantity of heat which this surface cr transmits to the air
finite or infinitely small, of
the temperature
and
if
during the instant dt. When the two molecules, one of which transmits to the other a certain quantity of heat, belong to the same solid, the exact expression for the heat communicated is that which we have and since the molecules are given in the preceding article
;
extremely near, the difference of the temperatures is extremely It is not the same when heat passes from a solid small. body into
a gaseous medium. But the experiments teach us that if the difference is a quantity sufficiently small, the heat transmitted is
sensibly proportional to that difference, and that the number h 1 may, in these first researches t be considered as having a constant
value, proper to each state of the surface,
temperature.
61. These propositions relative to the quantity of heat com municated have been derived from different observations. We
an evident consequence of the expressions in question, we increased by a common quantity all the initial tempe ratures of the solid mass, and that of the medium in which it is placed, the successive changes of temperature would be exactly the same as if this increase had not been made. Now this result is sensibly in accordance with experiment it has been admitted
see
first,
as
that
if
by the physicists
1
who
first
effects of heat.
vrill
More exact la^vs of cooling investigated experimentally by Dulong and Petit be found in the Journal de VEcole Poll/technique, Tome xi. pp. 234294, [A. F.] Paris, 1820, or in Jamin, Cours de Physique, Le$on 47.
44
62.
THEOHY OF HEAT.
If the
[CHAP.
I.
maintained at a constant temperature, and if the heated body which is placed in that medium has dimensions sufficiently small for the temperature, whilst falling more and more, to remain sensibly the same at all points of the body, it follows from the same propositions, that a quantity of heat
is
medium
will escape at
portional to the excess of its actual temperature over that of the medium. Whence it is easy to conclude, as will be seen in the
course of this work, that the line whose abscissae represent the times elapsed, and whose ordinates represent the temperatures corresponding to those times, is a logarithmic curve now, ob
:
servations also
temperature of
small quantity.
furnish the same result, when the excess of the the solid over that of the- medium is a sufficiently
Suppose the medium to be maintained at the constant temperature 0, and that the initial temperatures of different points a, b, c, d &c. of the same mass are a, ft, y, B &c., that at the end of the first instant they have become a ft y, S &c., that at the end of the second instant they have become ft &c., and so on. We may easily conclude from the propositions enun ciated, that if the initial temperatures of the same points had been get, g/3, gy, g$ &c. (g being any number whatever), they would have become, at the end of the first instant, by virtue of
63.
,
,
a",
8"
7",
the action of the different points, got. gff, gy g$ &c., and at the end of the second instant, For &c., and so on. g/3 -, gy",
, ,
gen",
gS"
instance, let us
medium preserving in both cases the temperature 0. In the second hypothesis, the difference of the temperatures of any two points whatever is double what it
was in the
first, and the excess of the temperature of each point, over that of each molecule of the medium, is also double con sequently the quantity of heat which any molecule whatever
;
compare the case when the initial temperatures I, c, d &c. were a, ft, 7, B &c. with that in which
sends to any other, or that which it receives, is, in the second The change hypothesis, double of that which it was in the first. of temperature which each point suffers being proportional to the quantity of heat acquired, it follows that, in the second case, this
change
is
double what
it
was
Now we
have
SECT. IV.]
4.5
temperature of the first point, which was end of the first instant hence if this initial temperature had been 2 a, and if all the other temperatures had been doubled, it would have become 2 a The same would be the
a,
became
at the
b, c, d, and a similar result would be derived, if the ratio instead of being 2, were any number whatever g. It follows then, from the principle of the communica
we
increase or diminish in
any given
ratio
the
initial
temperatures,
we
same
by observa the quantity of heat which passes from one molecule to another had not been, actually, pro portional to the difference of the temperatures.
tion.
ratio all the successive temperatures. This, like the two preceding results, is confirmed
It could not
have existed
if
64. Observations have been made with accurate on the permanent temperatures at different points of metallic ring, and on the propagation of heat in the and in several other solids of the form of spheres or
results of these experiments agree with those
instruments, a bar or of a
cubes.
which are derived would be entirely differ They ent if the quantity of heat transmitted from one solid molecule to another, or to a molecule of air, were not proportional to the
from the preceding propositions.
It is necessary first to know all the excess of temperature. of this proposition; by it we determine the rigorous consequences chief part of the quantities which are the object of the problem.
By comparing then the calculated values with those given by numerous and very exact experiments, we can easily measure the variations of the coefficients, and perfect our first researches.
SECTION
On
Go.
IV.
heat.
the
We
ment
shall consider, in the first place, the uniform move which is that of an infinite
solid enclosed
between two
parallel planes.
suppose a solid body formed of some homogeneous sub stance to be enclosed between two parallel and infinite planes;
We
46
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
I.
is maintained, by any cause whatever, at a the lower plane constant temperature a we may imagine for example that the mass is prolonged, and that the plane is a section common to
;
the solid and to the enclosed mass, and is heated at all its points by a constant source of heat; the upper plane B is also main tained by a similar cause at a fixed temperature b, whose value is
less
than that of a
the problem
if it
is
to determine
what would be
we suppose the
b,
it is
initial temperature of all parts of this body evident that the heat which leaves the source will
be propagated farther and farther and will raise the temperature of the molecules included between the two planes but the tem
:
perature of the upper plane being unable, according to hypothesis to rise above b the heat will be dispersed within the cooler mass,
}
contact with which keeps the plane at the constant temperature The system of temperatures will tend more and more to a b.
final state,
which
it
will
we shall proceed to shew, of existing and keeping up without any change if it were once formed. In the final and fixed state, which we are considering, the per manent temperature of a point of the solid is evidently the same at all points of the same section parallel to the base; and we
property, as
itself
common
an intermediate section, decreases in arithmetic progression from the base to the upper plane, that is to say, if we represent the constant temperatures a and b by the ordinates AOL and Bj3
of
\
Fig.
1.
(see Fig. 1), raised perpendicularly to the distance AB between the two planes, the fixed temperatures of the intermediate layers will be represented by the ordinates of the straight line aft which
SECT. IV.]
47
joins the extremities a. and /3; thus, denoting by z the height of an intermediate section or its perpendicular distance from the plane A, by e the whole height or distance AB, and by v the
-6
is z,
the temperatures were at first established in accord ance with this law, and if the extreme surfaces and were
fact, if
In
the temperatures a and b, no change would always kept in the state of the solid. To convince ourselves of this, happen
at
it will
traverse
sufficient to compare the quantity of heat which would an intermediate section A with that which, during the same time, would traverse another section B
.
be
Bearing in mind that the final state of the solid is formed and continues, wr e see that the part of the mass w hich is below
r
the plane must communicate heat to the part which that plane, since this second part is cooler than the first.
is
above
and m, very near to each Imagine two points of the solid, and placed in any manner whatever, the one m below the other, plane A and the other m above this plane, to be exerting their action during an infinitely small instant m the hottest point will communicate to m a certain quantity of heat which will Let x, y, z be the rectangular coordinates cross the plane A
,
: .
of the point m, and x, y z the coordinates of the point consider also two other points n and n very near to each other,
, :
in which
and situated with respect to the plane B in the same manner m and m are placed with respect to the plane A that is to say, denoting by f the perpendicular distance of the two sections A and J5 the coordinates of the point n will be x, y, z + f and those of the point n x, y z + % the two distances mm and nri will be equal further, the difference of the temperature v of the point m above the temperature v of the point m will be the same as the difference of temperature of the two points n and n In fact the former difference will be determined by
,
:
substituting
first
z and then
first,
whence the
48
THEORY OF HEAT.
v
[CHAP.
I.
result
""
a
(z
z).
We
shall
then
find,
by the sub-
stitution of z + % and z + f, that the excess of temperature of the point n over that of the point ri is also expressed by
Z>
It follows from this that the quantity of heat sent by the to the point will be the same as the quantity of heat point sent by the point n to the point ri, for all the elements which
we can apply
of heat
which
flows,
,
or the section J9
this quantity to be the same for both sections. From this it follows that the part of the solid included be
tween
and
receives always as much heat as it loses, and is applicable to any portion whatever of the
mass included between two parallel sections, it is evident that no part of the solid can acquire a temperature higher than that which it has at present. Thus, it has been rigorously demon
strated that the state of the prism will continue to exist just as was at first.
it
solid enclosed
Hence, the permanent temperatures of different sections of a between two parallel infinite planes, are represented
of a straight line
b
a/3,
by the ordinates
equation v
and
satisfy
the linear
=a
-\
--Q
a
z.
66. By what precedes we see distinctly what constitutes the propagation of heat in a solid enclosed between two parallel and infinite planes, each of which is maintained at a constant
Heat penetrates the mass gradually across the temperature. lower plane the temperatures of the intermediate sections are raised, but can never exceed nor even quite attain a certain limit which they approach nearer and nearer this limit or final
:
temperature
is
different
for
different
intermediate layers,
and
SECT. IV.]
decreases
upper plane. temperatures are those which would have to be given to the solid in order that its state might be permanent the variable state which precedes it may also be submitted to
The
final
analysis, as we shall see presently: but we are now considering only the system of final and permanent temperatures. In the last state, during each division of time, across a section parallel
the base, or a definite portion of that section, a certain quantity of heat flows, which is constant if the divisions of time
to
are equal. This uniform flow is the same for all the intermediate sections it is equal to that which proceeds from the source, and
;
to that
which
of the solid,
constant.
during the same time, at the upper surface by virtue of the cause which keeps the temperature
is lost
is to measure that quantity of heat propagated uniformly within the solid, during a given time, across a definite part of a section parallel to the base it depends, as we shall see, on the two extreme temperatures a
67.
which
is
and b, and on the distance e between the two sides of the solid it would vary if any one of these elements began to change, the other remaining the same. Suppose a second solid to be formed of the same substance as the first, and enclosed between two
I
Fig. 2.
infinite
fig.
parallel
planes,
is
2)
considered to be in that final and permanent state which has the property of maintaining itself as soon as it has been formed.
F.
H.
50
THEORY OF HEAT.
of the temperatures
v
is
[CHAP.
first
I.
body
by the equation
tion u
= aH
te
z,
and
by the equa
=a
H
H
&
-,
a
z,
the temperature of the section whose height is z. This arranged, we will compare the quantity of heat which, during the unit of time traverses a unit of area taken on an
intermediate section
the same
that
of the first solid, with that which during time traverses an equal area taken on the section
of the second, e being the height common to the two sections, is to say, the distance of each of them from their own
two very near points n and ri in the one of which n is below the plane L and the other body, and x y z ri above this plane x, y, z are the co-ordinates of n the co-ordinates of ri, e being less than z, and greater than z.
base.
first
We
shall consider
We
action of two points p and p, which are situated, with respect to the section U, in the same manner as the points n and ri with Thus the same co of the firsfc solid. respect to the section
ordinates x, y, z, and of, y z referred to three rectangular axes in the second body, will fix also the position of the points p
,
and p
Now, the
is
equal
to the distance from the point p to the point p , and since the two bodies are formed of the same substance, we conclude, ac
cording to the principle of the communication of heat, that the n on ri, or the quantity of heat given by n to ri, and the action of p on p are to each other in the same ratio as the
action of
,
which belongs to
6
(z
the
first solid,
/)
(z
we
z
},
u=
6
-,
whence the
a
ratio of the
two actions
in question is that of
to
-V
e
SECT. IV.]
51
now imagine many other systems of two molecules, which sends to the second across the plane L, a certain quantity of heat, and each of these systems, chosen in the first solid, may be compared with a homologous system situated in the second, and whose action is exerted across the section L we can then apply again the to previous that
the
first
We may
of
ratio of the
two actions
is
the
of heat which, during one instant, crosses the section Z, results from the simultaneous action of a multitude of systems each of which is formed of two points; hence this quantity of heat and that which, in the second solid, crosses during the same instant the section L are also to each
,
^
e
a
to
~
_
then to compare with each other the intensities of the constant flows of heat which are propagated uniformly in the two solids, that is to say, the quantities of heat which, during unit of time, "cross unit of surface of each of these bodies. The
ratio of these intensities
is
^~
and
-b
~i
If the
whatever in other respects the values in general, denoting the first flow by ~ we shall have == = ^~ -r- a
.
e,
a, U, e,
may be
68. Suppose that in the second solid, the permanent tempera ture a of the lower plane is that of that the boiling water, 1 temperature e of the upper plane is that of melting ice, 0; that the distance e of the two planes is the unit of measure (a
;
the constant flow of heat which, metre); let us denote by during unit of time (a minute) would cross unit of surface in this last solid, if it were formed of a exgiven substance
;
pressing a certain number of units of heat, that~is to say a certain number of times the heat necessary to convert a kilogramme of ice into water we shall have, in general, to determine the
:
42
52
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
I.
equation
F a-b - J\.
or
w H
&
A a-b 6
denotes the quantity of heat which, during the unit of time, passes across a unit of area of the surface taken on a section parallel to the base.
The value
of
between two whose perpendicular distance is e, and which are maintained at fixed temperatures a and b, is represented by the two equations
sides
=a+b
a
zt
and
a-b F=K-
or
^dv
F=-K-^.
equations expresses the law according to which the temperatures decrease from the lower side to the the quantity of heat which, opposite side, the second indicates a given time, crosses a definite part of a section parallel during
The
first
of these
to the base.
69.
We
coefficient
K, which enters
into
the second equation, to be the measure of the specific conduci this number has very different values bility of each substance
;
It represents, in general, the quantity of heat which, in a homogeneous solid formed of a given substance and enclosed
between two
infinite parallel planes, flows, during one minute, across a surface of one square metre taken on a section parallel to the extreme planes, supposing that these two planes are main
tained, one at the temperature of boiling water, the other at the temperature of melting ice, and that all the intermediate
planes have acquired and retain a permanent temperature. might employ another definition of conducibility, since we could estimate the capacity for heat by referring it to unit
We
of volume, instead
of referring
it
to unit of mass.
All these
We
value
stances.
shall
by observation the
SECT. IV.]
70.
53
these points had any magnitude whatever they would therefore apply also to the case where the direct action of heat extended within the interior of the mass to considerable distances, all the very circumstances which constitute the in other hypothesis
^
In order to establish the equations which we have 68, it would not -be necessary to suppose the points which exert their action across the planes to be at ex tremely small distances. The results would still be the same if the distances of
cited in Article
;
remaining
need only suppose that the cause which maintains the temperatures at the surface of the solid, affects not that only part of the mass which is extremely near to the surface, but that
its
We
The equation
=a-
~b
2
e
true sense of this proposition is that, if we give to all points of the mass the temperatures expressed by the equation, and if besides any cause whatever, acting on the two extreme laminae, retained always every one of their molecules at the temperature which the same equation assigns to them, the interior points of the solid would preserve without any change
solid.
the
The
by
should be at least equal to e. But the e in fact, in the natural state of solids, quantity having only an inappreciable value, we may make abstraction of this thick ness; and it is sufficient for the external cause to act on each of the two layers, extremely thin, which bound the solid. This
cause,
the
external
always what must be understood by the expression, the temperature of the surface constant.
is
to
maintain
71.
We
same
air
solid
proceed further to examine the case in which the would be exposed, at one of its faces, to atmospheric
maintained at a constant temperature. Suppose then that the lower plane preserves the fixed tem
a,
perature
54
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
I.
exposed to atmospheric air maintained at that temperature b, the perpendicular distance of the two planes being denoted always by e the problem is to determine
less
temperature
b,
is
solid,
the
common
temperature of its molecules is b or less than b, we can readily imagine that the heat which proceeds incessantly from the source
penetrates the mass, and raises more and more the tempera the upper surface is gradually and permits part of the heat which has penetrated the heated,
tures of the intermediate sections
;
to escape into the air. The system of temperatures con tinually approaches a final state which would exist of itself if
solid
it
final
state,
which
is
that which
we
has a fixed
but unknown value, which we will denote by ft, and since the lower plane A preserves also a permanent temperature a, the
system of temperatures
v
is
= a+
z,
section
whose height
,
The quantity
of heat
which flows
whatever
is
fr
% denoting
surface B, whose the escape into the air of a certain temperature permits quantity of heat which must be exactly equal to that which crosses any section whatever L of the solid. If it were not so,
is
ft,
We
the part of the mass included between this section L and the plane B would not receive a quantity of heat equal to that which it loses; hence it would not maintain its state, which is
contrary to hypothesis
;
is
there
fore equal to that which traverses the solid now, the quantity of heat which escapes, unit of time, from unit of surface during
is
which
will
SECT. IV.]
55
From
may
be derived a
is
/3=
for the
fl6
~\~
j-~ K
an equation
known
temperatures a and 6
the general equation
are given, as are also the quantities h, ^, e. ft into Introducing this value of
a-
=a+-
z,
we
any
section
of the solid,
the equation a
v=-^~
llG
j ~r~ rC
in
which
known
and
z.
72.
So
far
we have determined
of the temperatures in a solid enclosed between two infinite and parallel plane surfaces, maintained at unequal temperatures.
properly speaking, the case of the linear and is no transfer of heat in the plane parallel to the sides of the solid that which traverses the solid flaws uniformly, since the value of the flow is the same
first
This
case
is,
and
restate the three chief propositions which result from the examination of this problem they are susceptible of a
will
;
We
now
great
number
of applications,
first
elements of our
theory.
1st.
If at the
e of
the solid
we
of the
two
sides,
and
if
we draw the
straight line
temperatures
line
;
will
first ordinates, all the intermediate be proportional to the ordinates of this straight
z,
is z.
2nd. The quantity of heat which flows uniformly, during unit of time, across unit of surface taken on any section whatever parallel to the sides, all other things being equal, is directly
proportional to the difference a
b of
to
the
distance
is
which separates
The quantity
of heat
expressed by
^a-6 K
-
or
56
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
I.
K
-v-
if
we
which
is
may
always be repre
sented, for a given substance and in the solid under examination, by the tangent of the angle included between the perpendicular
e
line
tures.
One
always to the
of the extreme surfaces of the solid being submitted temperature a, if the other plane is exposed to air
;
maintained at a fixed temperature b the plane in contact with the air acquires, as in the preceding case, a fixed temperature /?, greater than b, and it permits a quantity of heat to escape into
the air across unit of surface, during unit of time, which is ex h denoting the external conducibility of pressed by h (/3 b)
,
the plane.
The same
flow
of heat
h(/3
b) is
the
equation h({3
=K
of
SECTION
Law
thickness.
V.
We shall easily apply the principles which have just 73. been explained to the following problem, very simple in itself, but one whose solution it is important to base on exact theory. A metal bar, whose form is that of a rectangular parallele
piped infinite in length, is exposed to the action of a source of heat which produces a constant temperature at all points of its
extremity A. It is required to determine the fixed temperatures at the different sections of the bar.
The
is
supposed to be a
sensible
we may without
error consider the temperatures to be equal at different points of the same section. The air in which the bar is placed is main-
SECT. V.]
57
tained
at
current with uniform velocity. Within the interior of the solid, heat will pass successively all the parts situate to the the source, and not exposed right^of
directly to its action; they will be heated more and more, but the temperature of each point will not increase beyond a certain limit. This maximum temperature is not the same for every section it in general decreases as the distance of the section
;
we
shall denote
by
v the fixed
tem
perature of a section perpendicular to the axis, and situate at a distance x from the origin
Before every point of the solid has attained its highest degree of heat, the system of temperatures varies continually, and ap
proaches more and more to a fixed state, which is that which we consider. This final state is kept up of itself when it has once been formed. In order that the system of temperatures
be permanent, it is necessary that the quantity of heat which, during unit of time, crosses a section made at a distance x from the origin, should balance exactly all the heat which, during
may
the same time, escapes through that part of the external surface of the prism which is situated to the right of the same section.
is dx, and whose external surface allows the escape into the air, during unit of time, of Sldx, a quantity of beat expressed by Shlv dx, h being the measure of is
.
we shall find the quantity to x tegral jShlv dx from of heat wr hich escapes from the whole surface of the bar durinooo
,
x=
in
unit of time
x=
and if we take the same integral from x = to have the quantity of heat lost through the part of the surface included between the source of heat and the section made at the distance x. Denoting the first integral by (7, whose value is constant, and the variable value of the second by
;
x,
we
shall
will express the whole jShlv.dx-, the difference C-/8hlv.dx of heat which escapes into the air across the part of quantity On the other the surface situate to the right of the section.
hand, the lamina of the solid, enclosed between two sections x and x + dx, must resemble an in infinitely near at distances
bounded by two parallel planes, subject to fixed temperatures v and v + dv, since, by hypothesis, the temperature
finite
solid,
58
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
I.
The
4/
2
:
does not vary throughout the whole extent of the same section. thickness of the solid is dx, and the area of the section is
according to the
preceding principles,
ducibility
:
4Z
-=-
k being the
we must
V"
whence
\\\
74.
We
equilibrium of heat in a single lamina infinitely thin, enclosed between two sections at distances x arid x + dx. In fact, the
quantity of heat which, during unit of time, crosses the
section situate at distance x,
is
first
4/
-r-
To
find
that which
flows during the same time across the successive section situate at distance x + dx, we must in the preceding expression change x
into
x + dx, which
gives
4Z &.
[dx
^~ + d
~
\dxjj
If
we
subtract
the second expression from the first we shall find how much heat is acquired by the lamina bounded by these two sections during unit of time and since the state of the lamina is per
;
follows that all the heat acquired is dispersed the air across the external surface Sldx of the same lamina
manent,
it
into
now
is
Shlvdx
we
same equation
8/uvdx
07
7
klkd
^727
A&A
-y,
\dxj
whence -^5 dx 2
^V =
27?,
-=-=
v.
kl
In whatever manner this equation is formed, it is 75. necessary to remark that the quantity of heat which passes into the lamina whose thickness is dx, has a finite value, and that
its
exact expression
is
4<l
^-
first
of
SECT. V.]
59
we
the difference v
is
receives through the first surface depends on v , and is proportional to it but this remark
:
not sufficient to complete the calculation. The quantity in question is not a differential it has a finite value, since it is equivalent to all the heat which escapes through that part of the external surface of the prism which is situate to the
:
right
of the section.
of
it,
we must compare
is dx, with a solid terminated by two parallel planes whose distance is e, and which are maintained at unequal temperatures a and b. The quantity of heat which
passes into such a prism across the hottest surface, is in fact b of the extreme temperatures, proportional to the difference a
but
does not depend only on this difference all other things being equal, it is less when the prism is thicker, and in general
it
:
it
is
proportional to
This
first
is
why
dx
is
proportional to
dx
We
we
been the
lay stress on this remark because the neglect of it has first obstacle to the establishment of the If theory.
make a complete analysis of the elements of the we should obtain an equation not homogeneous, and, problem, a fortiori, we should not be able to form the equations which express the movement of heat in more complex cases.
did not
It was necessary also to introduce into the calculation the dimensions of the prism, in order that we might not regard, as general, consequences which observation had furnished in a par
ticular case.
Thus,
it
of iron, heated at one extremity, could not acquire, at a distance of six feet from the source, a temperature of one degree (octo-
gesimal ) ; for to produce this effect, it would be necessary for the heat of the source to surpass considerably the point of fusion
of iron; but this result depends on the thickness of the prism* employed. If it had been greater, the heat would have been,
propagated to a greater distance, that is to say, the point of the bar which acquires a fixed temperature of one degree is
1
Reaumur
Scale of Temperature.
[A.
F.J
60
THEORY OF HEAT.
the source
[CHAP.
is
I.
thicker, all
can always raise by other conditions remaining the same. one degree the temperature of one end of a bar of iron, by heating
the solid at the other end
a sufficient length
:
We
we need only give the radius of the which is, we may say, evident, and base of which besides a proof will be found in the solution of the
;
problem
76.
(Art. 78).
The
is
being two arbitrary constants now, if we suppose the distance x infinite, the value of the temperature v must be
and
infinitely small;
:
75
in-
= Ae~* ^ u represents the permanent tegral thus the equation v the temperature at the origin is denoted by state of the solid
;
the constant
since that
is
the value of v
when x
is
zero.
This
is
the
have metal bar exposed at its extremity to the constant action of a source of heat, and they have ascertained that the distances from the origin represent logarithms, and the temperatures the
corresponding numbers.
77.
according temperatures decrease that given by experiment several physicists observed the fixed temperatures at different points of a
law
to
which
the
same
as
The numerical value of the constant quotient of two con by observation, we easily
-;
for,
denoting by v lt
,
va
the
tem
x^ x2 we have
1
A / --=A/ k
/2h
& = log v
loof
v9
,,
Jl.
As for the separate values of li and k, they cannot be deter mined by experiments of this kind we must observe also the
:
SECT. V.]
61
let lt be the side of a section in the first bar, and 1 ; perature 2 iii the second, we shall have, to express the temperatures of these
two
solids,
the equations
Vl
= Ae~
,
and
v9
=Ae~
made
temperature of a
i\,
at distance
in the first solid, denoting the temperature of a section x lf and vz in the second solid, the
section
made
at distance
xz
When
tem
perature of a section of the first, at a certain distance from the source, will not be equal to the temperature of a section of the second at the same distance from the focus in order that the
;
fixed temperatures may be equal, the distances must be different. If we wish to compare with each other the distances x^ and
x<
from the origin up to the points which in the two bars attain
the same temperature,
of
j.
2
Thus
79.
If
two metal bars of equal dimensions, but formed of with the same coating, which
1
,
gives
and if they are conducibility submitted at their extremities to the same temperature, heat will
be propagated most easily and to the greatest distance from the To compare origin in that which has the greatest conducibility. with each other the distances x l and xz from the common origin
to the points which acquire the same fixed temperature, we must, after denoting the respective conducibilities of the two substances by k^ and &2 write the equation
up
-W^ = e -W/^ w
/**
whence
^=k p x
*
2
-r
2 I*
.
Thus the
attain the
1
ratio of the
of the distances
is
to the
same
fixed temperature.
mgtaux comme conducteurs de Gren s Journal der Physik, Bd.
la chalenr.
I."
Ingenhousz
(1789),
Journal
[A. F.]
C2
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
I.
It is easy to ascertain how much heat flows during unit 80. of time through a section of the bar arrived at its fixed state
7
I2A
,
by
4K
-y-
or
kAjkhl*.e
* K and j
if we take its value at the origin, we shall have bAjZkh? as the measure of the quantity of heat which passes from the source thus the expenditure of the into the solid during unit of time
;
other things being equal, proportional to the square root of the cube of the thickness. We should obtain the same result on taking the integral
source of heat
is,
all
fShlv
dx from x nothing
to
infinite.
SECTION
On
81.
the heating
VI.
of closed spaces.
We
shall again
make
in the following problem, whose solution offers useful applications it consists in determining the extent of the heating of closed
spaces.
Imagine a closed space, of any form whatever, to be filled with all sides, and that all parts of the are homogeneous and have a common thickness e, so boundary
atmospheric air and closed on
small that the ratio of the external surface to the internal surface
from unity. The space which this boundary termi heated by a source whose action is constant for example, by means of a surface whose area is cr maintained at a constant
differs little
is
nates
temperature
a.
consider here only the mean temperature of the air con tained in the space, without regard to the unequal distribution of
We
thus we suppose that the existing causes the portions of air, and make their tem
;
which continually leaves the source the surrounding air and penetrates the mass of spreads which the boundary is formed, is partly dispersed at the surface,
see first that the heat
itself in
We
SECT. VJ.]
63
and passes into the external air, which we suppose to be main tained at a lower and permanent temperature n. The inner air is
heated more and more
:
the same is the case with the solid the system of temperatures steadily approaches a final boundary state which is the object of the problem, and has the property of
:
existing by itself and of being kept up unchanged, provided the surface of the source a be maintained at the temperature a, and
n.
we wish
the temperature of the inner preserves a fixed temperature m surface s of the solid boundary has also a fixed value a lastly, the
;
which terminates the enclosure, preserves a fixed b less than a, but greater than n. The quantities temperature cr, a, 5, e and n are known, and the quantities m, a and b are unknown.
outer surface
s,
The degree of heating consists in the excess of the temperature over n the temperature of the external air; this excess evi
}
temperature a
closure,
facility
and on its on the thickness e of the en depends on the area s of the surface which bounds it, on the with which heat penetrates the inner surface or that
of the heating surface
;
it
also
which is opposite to it finally, on the specific conducibility of the solid mass which forms the enclosure for if any one of these elements were to be changed, the others remaining the same, the
;
:
mine how
82.
degree of the heating would vary also. The problem all these quantities enter into the value of
is
to deter
n.
boundary is terminated by two equal surfaces, maintained at a fixed temperature; every element of the solid enclosed between two opposite por prismatic tions of these surfaces, and the normals raised round the contour of the bases, is therefore in the same state as if it belonged to an infinite solid enclosed between two parallel planes, maintained at unequal temperatures. All the prismatic elements which com
solid
is
The
each of which
of the
The points pose the boundary touch along their whole length. mass which are equidistant from the inner surface have
equal temperatures, to whatever prism they belong consequently there cannot be any transfer of heat in the direction perpendicular to the length of these prisms. The case is, therefore, the same
;
64
as that of
to it
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
I.
which we have already treated, and we must apply the linear equations which have been stated in former
articles.
83.
Thus
in the
permanent
state
equal to that which, during the same time, passes from the surrounding air into the inner surface of the enclosure it is
;
equal also to that which, in a unit of time, crosses an inter mediate section made within the solid enclosure by a surface
lastly, equal and parallel to those which bound this enclosure the same flow is again equal to that which passes from the solid
;
enclosure across
its
is
air.
If these four quantities of flow of heat were not equal, some variation would necessarily occur in the state of the temperatures,
which
is
quantity is expressed by a (a. the external conducibility of the surface g the source of heat.
The
cr,
The second is s (m a) h, the coefficient h being the measure of the external conducibility of the surface s, which is exposed to the action of the source of heat.
The
third
is s
K, the
coefficient
the conducibility proper to the homogeneous substance which forms the boundary.
The
fourth
is
s(b
n}H, denoting by
ducibility of the surface s, which the heat quits to be dispersed into the air. The coefficients h and may have very unequal
K: we
shall
6,
unknown
quantities m, a
and
(a
m) g = s
N
b r,
A,
H.
cr
(a
m) g =
s (b
n)
SECT. VI.]
84.
65
It
may
The value of m is the special object of the problem. be found by writing the equations in the form
adding,
we have
n=
(a.
- m)
P,
denoting by
P the
known quantity ^ (|
-f
-f
J^ J
whence we conclude
11
result shews how m n, the extent of the heating, on given quantities which constitute the hypothesis. depends We will indicate the chief results to be derived from it \
85.
The
1st. The extent of the heating n is directly proportional to the excess of the temperature of the source over that of the
external
air.
2nd:
The value
of
its
the
and
If
also
which the heat proceeds to the surface which receives on e the thickness of the boundary.
cr
we double
of the heating does not become double, but increases according to a certain law which the equation expresses.
1
These results
\vere stated
memoir published
by the author in a rather different manner in the in the Bulletin par la Society Philo[A. F.]
111.
66
3rd.
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
I.
action
to say, g,
K,
H and
h,
dimension
e,
in the value of
n a
single element
f + 77+
fr>
whose value may be determined by observation. If we doubled e the thickness of the boundary, we should have the same result if, in forming it, we employed a sub
a>s
Thus the stance whose conducibility proper was twice as great. employment of substances which are bad conductors of heat
permits us to
effect
make
which
is
4th.
that
is
:
source
If the conducibility is nothing, we find to say, the inner air assumes the temperature of the the same is the case if These con is zero, or h zero.
sequences are otherwise evident, since the heat cannot then be dispersed into the external air.
The values of the quantities g, H, h, 5th. and a, which we supposed known, may be measured by direct experiments, as we shall shew in the sequel but in the actual problem, it
;
will
be
value of
m
,
to given values of
and of
a,
and
this value
tion
(a
n}-p~
(1
+- p]
efficient sought.
We
must substitute in
instead
of s
and a
n,
we suppose
n which observation will have made given, and that of m known. From it may be derived the value of p, and we may then apply the formula to any number of other cases.
6th.
The
coefficient
enters
in
the same manner as the coefficient h; consequently the state of the surface, or that of the envelope which covers it, produces the same effect, whether it has reference to the inner or outer
surface.
We
it
SECT. VI.]
67
different consequences, if we were not treating here of entirely new problems, whose results may be of direct use.
86.
We
know
sensibly fixed, which we may regard as independent of the tem perature of the medium in which they live. These bodies are,
after
We
some fashion, constant sources of heat, just as inflamed substances are in which the combustion has become uniform. may then, by aid of the preceding remarks, foresee and
regulate exactly the rise of temperature in places where a great number of men are collected together. If we there observe the height of the thermometer under given circumstances, we shall determine in advance what that height would be, if the number
assembled in the same space became very much greater. there are several accessory circumstances which modify the results, such as the unequal thickness of the parts of the enclosure, the difference of their aspect, the effects which the outlets produce, the unequal distribution of heat in the air.
of
men
In
reality,
cannot therefore rigorously apply the rules given by analysis nevertheless these rules are valuable in themselves, because they contain the tine principles of the matter they prevent vague
;
:
We
If the
or
more sources
of different kinds, or if the first inclosure were itself contained in a second enclosure separated from the first by a mass of air,
we might
easily determine in like manner the degree of heating and the temperature of the surfaces.
If we suppose that, besides the first source u, there is a second heated surface TT, whose constant temperature is y&, and external
conducibility
j,
we
m n=
denominations being
n^jfe + I + l\ K H
t
h)
\&
H
if
,
If
itself
the
first
enclosure
is
K H
e, representing the
52
68
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
I.
elements of the second enclosure which correspond to those of we shall find, first which were denoted by 5, h, K, H, e the temperature of the air which surrounds the ex p denoting
the
;
The quantity
represents
7 \li s r
(9
+ 9* + j^^
K.
We
number
we had
these solid envelopes, separated by air, assist very much in in creasing the degree of heating, however small their thickness
may
be.
88.
To make
this
will
compare the
quantity of heat which escapes from the heated ^surface, with that which the same body would lose, if the surface which en
velopes it were separated from it by an interval filled with air. If the body be heated by a constant cause, so that its surface preserves a fixed temperature b, the air being maintained
at a less temperature a, the quantity of heat which escapes into the air in the unit of time across a unit of surface will be
expressed by h
ducibility.
(b
a),
Hence
b,
temperature
it
is
h being the measure of the external conmass may preserve a fixed that the source, whatever it may necessary
be, should furnish a quantity of heat equal to noting the area of the surface of the solid.
hS (b
a),
de
Suppose an extremely thin shell to be detached from the body A and separated from the solid by an interval filled with air; and suppose the surface of the same solid A to be still
between the
maintained at the temperature b. We see that the air contained shell and the body will be heated and will take a temperature a greater than a. The shell itself will attain
a permanent state and will transmit to the external air whose is a all the heat which the body loses. It
that the quantity of heat escaping from the solid will
fixed temperature
follows
SECT. VI.]
69
be hS(b
the
new
shell
hS(b a), for we suppose that and the surfaces which bound the have likewise the same external conducibility h. It is
},
instead of being
than
evident that the expenditure of the source of heat will be less The problem is to determine the exact ratio it was at first.
of these quantities.
89.
Let
its
shell,
ture of
its
We
shall have,
leaves
surface,
hS(b-a
As
).
any
whatever
same
shell.
KS
e
Lastly, as the expression of the quantity which passes through the outer surface into the air, hS (n a).
we have
therefore the
rr
h (n
a)
=
=h
(m
(a
ri),
h(n
a)
m),
h(n-a)=h(b-a).
If
k(n
and arrange them
all
a)
= h(n
n
a,
a),
m-n = I
(n-a)
a,
we
find,
on addition,
70
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
I.
The quantity
its
of heat lost
by the
solid
was hS(b
surface
communicated
a),
or
hS(n
The
which
is
equivalent to
hS
first
quantity
is
solid
whose
surface communicates directly to the air, more than three times as much heat is necessary than would be required to maintain
it
when its extreme surface is not adherent at temperature but separated from the solid by any small interval whatever filled with air. If we suppose the thickness e to be infinitely small, the
Z>,
be
were infinitely great. be the value if can easily account for this result, for the heat being We unable to escape into the external air, without penetrating several surfaces, the quantity which flows out must diminish as the but we should have of interposed surfaces increases been unable to arrive at any exact judgment in this case, if the problem had not been submitted to analysis.
3,
which would
also
number
90.
We
have not considered, in the preceding article, the the layer of air which separates the
nevertheless this circumstance modifies the prob
two surfaces
lem, since there is a portion of heat which passes directly across shall suppose then, to make the object the intervening air. of the analysis more distinct, that the interval between the sur
We
faces
is
free
from
air,
which escapes from the solid through its plane superficies maintained at a temperature b expanded itself freely in vacuo and was received by a parallel surface maintained at a less temperature a, the quantity which would be dispersed in unit of time across unit of surface would be proportional to (b a), the difference of the two constant temperatures this quantity
If the heat
:
SECT. VI.]
71
tive conducibility
would be represented by (b a), being the value of the rela which is not the same as h. The source which maintains the solid in its original state must
toHS(b-a).
We
successive laminae separated by intervals free from air, supposing always that the solid is subject to the action of any external
its surface at the temperature b. the whole system of temperatures to have become Imagine fixed ; let m be the temperature of the under surface of the first
is
consequently opposite to that of the solid, let n be the temperature of the upper surface of the same lamina,
e its thickness,
lamina which
and
K
,
its specific
??i , 4
,
conducibility
denote also by
w 4 &c. the temperatures of the under 77&J, 2 3 3 and upper surfaces of the different laminae, and by e, the con and thickness of the same laminae; lastly, suppose all ducibility these surfaces to be in a state similar to the surface of the solid,
n lt
,
n2
??
is
common
to them.
The quantity
of heat
a lamina corresponding to
J7-Q
which penetrates the under surface of any suffix i is HSfyi^mJ), that which
(
crosses this
lamina
is
mi~ n
t
i)f
which escapes
from
its
upper surface
is
HS(n
i+l }.
those which refer to the other laminae are equal ; we may therefore form the equation by comparing all these quantities
and
all
first
of them,
which
is
HS (b
\>y
mj we
;
shall
number
of laminae
ni
= He n ~ b
n,
= He
,,
(b
- IflJ,
.
72
THEOKY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
I.
He n m*- n*=~K ^~ m ^
rij
=b
find
The expenditure of the source of heat necessary to maintain at the temperature b is the surface of the body a), (b when this surface sends its rays to a fixed surface maintained at the temperature a. The expenditure is (b m^ when we place
US
HS
between the surface of the body A, and the fixed surface maintained
at temperature a, a numberj of isolated laminae; thus the quantity of heat which the source must furnish is very much less in the
first,
and the
ratio of the
e of
two
the
If
we suppose
the thickness
is
-. f+i
The expenditure
91.
obtained
The examination of these results and of those which we when the intervals between successive enclosures were
of surfaces
occupied by atmospheric air explain clearly why the separation and the intervention of air assist very much in re
Analysis furnishes in addition analogous consequences when source to be external, and that the heat which
taining heat.
we suppose the
emanates from it crosses successively different diathermanous envelopes and the air which they enclose. This is what has happened when experimenters have exposed to the rays of the sun thermometers covered by several sheets of glass within which have been enclosed. For similar reasons the temperature of the higher regions of the atmosphere is very much less than at the surface of the
different layers of air
earth.
SECT. VII.]
MOVEMENT
IX
THREE DIMENSIONS.
73
air in
closed spaces extend to a great variety of problems. It would be useful to revert to them when we wish to foresee and regulate
temperature with precision, as in the case of green-houses, dryinghouses, sheep-folds, work-shops, or in many civil establishments, such as hospitals, barracks, places of assembly.
In these different applications we must attend to accessory circumstances which modify the results of analysis, such as the unequal thickness of different parts of the enclosure, the intro
duction of
air,
&c.
but these details would draw us away from is the exact demonstration of general
only, in
For the
rest,
we have considered
AVe said, the permanent state of temperature in closed spaces. can in addition express analytically the variable state which
precedes, or that which begins to take place when the source of heat is withdrawn, and we can also ascertain in this way, how
the specific properties of the bodies which we employ, or their dimensions affect the progress and duration of the heating but
;
a different
analysis, the
principles
of
which
will
SECTION
On
92.
the
VII.
Up
ment same
of heat in one dimension only, but it is easy to apply the principles to the case in which heat is propagated uniformly
six planes
in three directions at right angles. Suppose the different points of a solid enclosed
by
at right angles to have unequal actual temperatures represented -f ax + by + cz, x, y, z, being the by the linear equation v =
rectangular co-ordinates of a molecule whose temperature is v. Suppose further that any external causes whatever acting on the six faces of the prism maintain every one of the molecules situated
on the surface, at
equation
its
by the general
(a),
A -f ax + by + cz
74
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
I.
shall prove that the same causes which, by hypothesis, keep the outer layers of the solid in their initial state, are sufficient to preserve also the actual temperatures of every one of the inner
we
molecules, so that their temperatures do not cease to be repre sented by the linear equation.
The examination
of
this
question
is
an
element of the
general theory, it movement of heat in the interior of a solid of any form whatever, for every one of the prismatic molecules of which the body is
composed is during an infinitely small time in a state similar which the linear equation (a) expresses. We may then, by following the ordinary principles of the differential calculus, easily deduce from the notion of uniform movement the general equations of varied movement.
to that
In order to prove that when the extreme layers of the temperatures no change can happen in the interior of the mass, it is sufficient to compare with each other
93.
solid preserve their
the quantities of heat which, during the same instant, cross two
parallel planes. Let b be the perpendicular distance of these two planes which we first suppose parallel to the horizontal plane of x and y. Let
and
is
above
let x, y, z be horizontal plane and the other below it f of the first molecule, and x, y , z those of the the co-ordinates
the
first
second.
In like manner
let
and
near molecules, separated by the second horizontal plane and and situated, relatively to that plane, in the same manner as
that
two molecules m and mf is equal of the two molecules and to the distance further, let v be the temperature of m, and v that of m, also let V and and be the temperatures of it is easy to see that the two differences v v and V are equal in fact, substituting first the co-ordinates of m and m in the general equation
that the distance
of the
mm
MM
A + ax
x)
-f
-f
by
cz,
we
find
= a (x -
b (y
y} +
c (z
z},
SECT. VII.]
MOVEMENT
IN
THREE DIMENSIONS.
75
,
and J/ we find also and then substituting the co-ordinates of = a (x x) + b (y y) +c(z /). Now the quantity of V heat which m sends to m depends on the distance mm, which separates these molecules, and it is proportional to the difference
of their temperatures.
may
be represented by
q(v-v )dt;
the value of the coefficient q depends in some manner on the distance mm, and on the nature of the substance of which the
solid is formed, dt is the duration of the instant.
M to M
or the action of
same
coefficient is dt, expressed likewise by q as in the expression q (v is v) dt, since the and the two actions are effected in the same solid equal to
(VV)
and the
M on M the q distance MM
The quantity
is
mm
furthermore
equal. If
other,
is
equal to v
we choose two other points n and ri, very near to each which transfer heat across the first horizontal plane, we shall find in the same manner that their action is equal to that and which communicate heat of two homologous points across the second horizontal plane. We conclude then that the whole quantity of heat which crosses the first plane is equal to
that which
We
crosses the second plane during the same instant. should derive the same result from the comparison of two
planes parallel to the plane of x and z, or from the comparison Hence of two other planes parallel to the plane of y and z. whatever of the solid enclosed between six planes at any part
right angles, receives through each of its faces as much heat as it loses through the opposite face ; hence no portion of the solid
one of the planes in which is the same at all in question, a quantity of heat flows
94).
From
this
we
see
that,
across
stants,
and which is also the same for all other parallel sections. In order to determine the value of this constant flow we shall compare it with the quantity of heat which flows uniformly The in the most simple case, which has been already discussed. case is that of an infinite solid enclosed between two infinite
76
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
I.
have seen that planes and maintained in a constant state. the temperatures of the different points of the mass are in this case represented by the equation v + cz we proceed to prove that the uniform flow of heat propagated in the vertical direction
We
is
by six planes at right angles. exists if the coefficient c in the equation This equality necessarily v cz, belonging to the first solid, is the same as the coeffi
=A+
cient c in the
A + ax + ~by + cz
t
which
represents the
Ha
two
is below molecules very near to each other, the first of which the plane H, and the second above this plane, let v be the temperature of m whose co-ordinates are x, y, z, and w the
temperature of whose co-ordinates are x -H a, y + /3. z + 7. Take a third molecule fi whose co-ordinates are x a., y /3, # + y, and
//,
fju
and whose temperature may be denoted by w. We see that are on the same horizontal plane, and that the vertical drawn from the middle point of the line fjup which joins these two points, passes through the point m, so that the distances mjj, and The action of m on ^ or the quantity of heat mfjf are equal.
fju
,
which the
first
- w
of their temperatures.
The
action of
v
m
w
difference
depends in the same manner on the of the temperatures of these molecules, since
on p
the distance of
expressing by q
time,
m
(v
from
fju
is
w) the action of
factor,
solid.
on
//,
we
shall
q being a
nifjb
on
fjf,
w+v w actions exerted during unit of time is q (v If instead of x, y, and z in the general equation
t
= A + ax + by + cz,
we we
//,
w=
act
c%
cy.
w = + ay. + bft
SECT. TIL]
MOVEMENT
IX
THREE DIMENSIONS.
77
on //
is
The sum
fore
of the
two actions of
on
fj,
and
of
there
2qcy.
belongs to Suppose then that the plane = A + cz, and that we denote whose temperature equation is v and p those molecules in this solid whose co also by m ordinates are x, y, z for the first, x + a, y + /3, z 4- 7 for the second,
t
JJL
and x
a,y
j3,z+y
for the
third
we
shall have, as
in the
the
sum
of the
two
between the
We
we
same height above the plane. Hence, the sum the actions of this kind, which are exerted across the plane
is
H, that
surface,
by virtue
is
of the
separates,
always the
95.
is
bounded
by two
temperature equation is that the quantity of heat which flows during unit of time across unit of area taken on any horizontal section the specific whatever is cK, c being the coefficient of z, and
v = A + cz, we know
planes, and
whose
in the prism conducibility ; hence, the quantity of heat which, crosses during unit enclosed between six planes at right angles, of time, unit of area taken on any horizontal section whatever, when the linear equation which represents the tem is also -
cK
is
= A + ax + by +
cz.
it
may be proved
which, during unit of time, flows uniformly across unit of area taken on any section whatever perpendicular to x, is expressed - aK, and that the whole quantity which, during unit of time, by
crosses unit of area taken
on a section perpendicular to
in this
y,
is
expressed by
bK.
and the
78
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
I.
interior of the mass to be limited to an extremely small distance, but they would still be true, if the rays of heat sent out by each molecule could penetrate directly to a quite appreciable distance, but it would be necessary in this case, as we have remarked in Article 70, to suppose that the cause which maintains the tem
peratures of the faces of the solid affects a part extending within the mass to a finite depth.
SECTION
VIII.
at
a given point of a
solid mass.
elements of the theory of heat, which consists in defining and in measuring exactly the quantity of heat which passes through every point of a solid mass across a plane whose direction is given.
unequally distributed amongst the molecules of the the temperatures at any point will vary every instant. same body, Denoting by t the time which has elapsed, and by v the tem
If heat
is
^
perature attained after a time t by an infinitely small molecule whose co-ordinates are oc, y, z ; the variable state of the solid will be
= F(x, y, z, t). expressed by an equation similar to the following v to be given, and that consequently we the function Suppose
can determine at every instant the temperature of any point we draw a hori whatever; imagine that through the point zontal plane parallel to that of x and y, and that on this plane
whose centre is at trace an infinitely small circle it is , ; required to determine what is the quantity of heat which during from the part of the the instant dt will pass across the circle
a>
we
below the plane into the part above it. All points extremely near to the point m and under the plane exert their action during the infinitely small instant dt, on all those which are above the plane and extremely near to the point m, that is to say, each of the points situated on one side of this
solid
which
is
plane will send heat to each of those which are situated on the other side.
We
an action whose
effect is
to
transport a certain quantity of heat above the plane, and as negative that which causes heat to pass below the plane. The
SECT. VIII.]
MOVEMENT
IX A SOLID MASS.
79
sum
co,
that
of all the partial actions which are exerted across the circle is to say the sum of all the quantities of heat which,
crossing any point whatever of this circle, pass from the part of the solid below the plane to the part above, compose the flow
whose expression
It is easy to
is
to be found.
imagine that this flow may not be the same throughout the whole extent of the solid, and that if at another point m we traced a horizontal circle co equal to the former, the
two quantities of heat which rise above these planes and the same instant might not be equal these quantities are during comparable with each other and their ratios are numbers which
o>
o>
may
be easily determined.
97.
We
know
and uniform movement; thus in the solid enclosed be tween two infinite horizontal planes, one of which is maintained at the temperature a and the other at the temperature b, the flow of heat is the same for every part of the mass we may regard it as
case of linear
;
),6 denoting
the perpendicular distance of the two planes, and the specific the temperatures at the different points of the conducibility
:
by the equation
is
that of a solid comprised between six rectangular planes, pairs of which are parallel, and the tem peratures at the different points are expressed by the equation
When
the problem
the propagation takes place at the same time along the directions of x, of y, of z\ the quantity of heat which flows across a definite
portion of a plane parallel to that of x and y is the same through out the whole extent of the prism ; its value corresponding to unit of surface, and to unit of time is cK, in the direction of z, it is
aK in that of x. IK, in the direction of y, and In general the value of the vertical flow in the two cases which we have just cited, depends only on the coefficient of z and on
the specific conducibility
K\
K-r-
80
THEORY OF HEAT.
The expression
[CHAP.
I.
stant
is
&>,
dt,
of the quantity of heat which, during the in flows across a horizontal circle infinitely small, whose area
and passes in this manner from the part of the solid which is below the plane of the circle to the part above, is, for the two cases
in question,
rr dv j, K -^- coat.
98.
It
is
easy
now
and to recognise
of heat ex
that
it
movement
= (x, y, z, t). pressed by the equation v Let us in fact denote by x, y, z the co-ordinates of this point Let x + f, y + rj, z -f f, be m, and its actual temperature by v.
JJL
whose temperature
to
is
f,
r\,
infinitely near to the point m, and are quantities infinitely small added
;
the co-ordinates x y z they determine the position of molecules infinitely near to the point m, with respect to three rectangular axes, whose origin is at m, parallel to the axes of
, ,
x, y,
and
z.
=/
z
0>
>
y>
we
,
w=v +
,
dv
j- + dx f
y, z,
,.
tions of x,
the linear equation dv ^ , dv dv dv m f ~j- v + -7- ? the coefficients v -y-, --,-, i- are funcdz dx dy dz dy z, t, in which the given and constant values of, y
+ dv,
,
dv
z. which belong to the point m, have been substituted for x, that the same point m belongs also to a solid enclosed Suppose between six rectangular planes, and that the actual temperatures of the points of this prism, whose dimensions are finite, are ex = A + a + Irj + c and that pressed by the linear equation w the molecules situated on the faces which bound the solid are maintained by some external cause at the temperature which is
y>
assigned to them by the linear equation, f, rj, are the rectangular co-ordinates of a molecule of the prism, whose temperature is w referred to three axes whose origin is at m.
t
This arranged,
cients
if
we take
dv
,
A,
a, 6,
,
c,
quantities v
tion
;
,.,.
dv
,
r
,
,
.
-ycLoc
-=cLz
dy
which belong
,.
SECT. VIII.]
MOVEMENT
,
IX
A SOLID MASS.
dv
81
dv
-j
dv
*?
dgp
will coincide as nearly as possible with the state of the solid ; that is to say, all the molecules will have infinitely near to the point
the same temperature, whether we consider them to be in the solid or in the prism. This coincidence of the solid and the prism is
quite analogous to that of curved surfaces with the planes which touch them.
It is evident, from this, that the quantity of heat which flows in the solid across the circle co, during the instant dt, is the same
which flows in the prism across the same circle; for all the molecules whose actions concur in one effect or the other, have the same temperature in the two solids. Hence, the flow in
as that
is
expressed by
K
is
-=-
wdt.
would be
-=- codt,
if
the circle
o>,
whose centre
codt, if
m, were
y,
and
-^-
this circle
were
in the solid
we have just determined varies from one point to another, and it varies also with the time. We might imagine it to have, at all the points of a unit of surface, the same value as at the point m, and to preserve this value during unit of time the flow would then be expressed
;
by
K-jdz,
it
would be
K-jdy
in the direction of y,
and
K~ dx
in that
of x.
We
shall
ordinarily
employ
in
calculation this
99. This theorem serves in general to measure the velocity with which heat tends to traverse a given point of a plane situated in any manner whatever in the interior of a solid whose
temperatures vary with the time. Through the given point m, a perpendicular must be raised upon the plane, and at every point of this perpendicular ordinates must be drawn to represent
the actual temperatures at
will thus
F. H.
its
different points.
is
82
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
I.
The
ra,
taken with the opposite sign, expresses the velocity with which heat is transferred across the plane. This fluxion of the ordinate is known to be the tangent of the angle formed by the element of the curve with a parallel to the abscissse. The result which we have just explained is that of which the most frequent applications have been made in the theory
of heat.
We
different
problems
without
forming a very exact idea of the value of the flow at every point It is necessary to of a body whose temperatures are variable. an example which we are insist on this fundamental notion
;
about to refer to will indicate more clearly the use which has been made of it in analysis.
100.
Suppose the different points of a cubic mass, an edge TT, to have unequal actual temperatures
= cos x cos y cos z. The co represented by the equation v ordinates x, y, z are measured on three rectangular axes, whose origin is at the centre of the cube, perpendicular to the faces.
points of the external surface of the solid are at the actual temperature 0, and it is supposed also that external causes
The
On this all these points the actual temperature 0. hypothesis the body will be cooled more and more, the tem peratures of all the points situated in the interior of the mass
maintain at
will
vary, and, after an infinite time, they will all attain the of the surface. Now, we shall prove in the sequel, temperature that the variable state of this solid is expressed by the equation
v
= e~
9t
cos
x cos y cos
71
z,
3/iT
the coefficient g
bility of the
is
equal to G
* .
-^
*s
^ ne
I)
specific
conduci-
density and
is formed, is the heat t is the time elapsed. specific We here suppose that the truth of this equation is admitted, and we proceed to examine the use which may be made of it
G the
to find the quantity of heat which crosses a given plane parallel to one of the three planes at the right angles.
If,
x, y, z,
we
we mode
SECT. VIII.]
MOVEMENT
IN
A CUBE.
83
of the preceding article, that the value of the flow, at this point
is
-jclz
or
Ke~3t cos x
cos
sin
z.
The
quantity of heat which, during the instant dt, crosses an infinitely small rectangle, situated on this plane, and whose sides are
dx and
dy,
is
dt.
Thus the whole heat which, during the instant same plane, is
dt, crosses
the
gf
sin z
dt
cos
x cos ydxdy;
x=
IT
up
to
TT,
and from y
TT
up
to
y=
TT.
We
find
4
If then
,
sin^.ok
= to t, from t which has crossed the same plane since the cooling began up to the actual moment.
we take the
we
This integral
is
sin z (1
e~
gt
),
its
is
so that after
an
infinite
is
.
lost
through
applicable
its
we conclude
SCD,
is
The
total heat
which
is
dissipated
during the cooling must indeed be independent of the special conducibility K, which can only influence more or less the
velocity of cooling.
C 2
84
100. A.
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CH.
I.
SECT. VIII.
We may
of heat which the solid loses during a given time, and this will In serve in some degree to verify the preceding calculation.
fact,
the mass of the rectangular molecule whose dimensions are dx dy dz, consequently the quantity of heat dx, dy, dz, is to which must be given to it to bring it from the temperature
is
CD dx dy dz,
and
v,
It follows from this, that in order to find the quantity by which the heat of the solid, after time t, exceeds that which
it
0,
we must take
the
mul
= iry
tiple integral
CD
dx dy
dz,
We
its value,
that
is
to say
x cos y cos z,
that the excess of actual heat over that which belongs to the gt after an infinite time, is 8 CD (1 e~ ) or, temperature
;
8 CD, as
it is
we found
before.
We have
which
necessary
relating to the
know in movement of
to
order to solve
heat in solid
different
of these principles, in order to shew the mode of employing them in analysis the most important use which we have been able to make of them, is to deduce
;
from them the general equations of the propagation of heat, which is the subject of the next chapter.
Note on Art. 76.
The researches
of J.
is not con iron bar heated at one end shew conclusively that the conducting power Transactions of the Eoyal stant, but diminishes as the temperature increases.
146 and Vol. xxiv. pp. 73 110. Society of Edinburgh, Vol. xxiu. pp. 133 Note on Art. 98. General expressions for the flow of heat within a
mass in
by
Lame
[A. F.]
CHAPTER
II.
SECTION
I.
WE
movement of heat in solid bodies of any form whatever, and apply them -to particular cases. But this method would often
the
involve very complicated calculations which may easily be avoided. There are several problems which it is preferable to treat in a
special manner by expressing the conditions which are appropriate to them; we proceed to adopt this course and examine
separately the problems which have been enunciated in the first section of the introduction we will limit ourselves at first to forming the differential equations, and shall give the integrals of them in the
;
following chapters.
have already considered the uniform movement of heat in a prismatic bar of small thickness whose extremity is immersed in a constant source of heat. This first case offered no
102.
We
there was no reference except to the permanent and the equation which expresses them is The following problem requires a more pro easily integrated. found investigation; its object is to determine the variable state
difficulties, since
of a solid ring whose different points have received initial tempe ratures entirely arbitrary. The solid ring or armlet is generated by the revolution of
86
the ring (see figure
*s
THEOKY OF HEAT.
3), I is
[CHAP.
II.
tne
coen<i
the perimeter of the section whose area c i en t h measures the external con-
the internal conducibility, the for heat, the density. The line specific capacity oxos represents the mean circumference of the
ducibility,
x"
armlet,
or
that
line
centres of figure of all the sections; the distance of a section from the origin o is measured by the
is the radius of the mean circumference. x\ that on account of the small dimensions and of supposed the form of the section, we may consider the temperature at the
arc
whose length
is
is
It
same
section to be equal.
103. Imagine that initial arbitrary temperatures have been given to the different sections of the armlet, and that the solid is then exposed to air maintained at the temperature 0, and dis
placed with a constant velocity; the system of temperatures will continually vary, heat will be propagated within the ring, and
dispersed at the surface: it is required to determine what will be the state of the solid at any given instant.
Let v be the temperature which the section situated at distance have acquired after a lapse of time t v is a certain function x and t, into which all the initial temperatures also must enter of
will
;
:
which
is
to be discovered.
104.
We
small
slice,
another section
made
at
movement of heat in an infinitely made at distance x and distance x -f dx. The state of this slice
;
is that of an infinite solid termi nated by two parallel planes maintained at unequal temperatures thus the quantity of heat which flows during this instant dt across
one instant
the
first section, and passes in this way from the part of the solid which precedes the slice into the slice itself, is measured according to the principles established in the introduction, by the product of four factors, that is to say, the conducibility K, the area of the
-=-
dx
its
expression
is
KS -j- dt.
of heat
SECT.
I.]
8?
passes into the contiguous part of the solid, it is only necessary to change x into x 4- dx in the preceding expression, or, which is
the same thing, to add to this expression its differential taken with respect to x thus the slice receives through one of its faces
;
KS-j-dt,
and
loses
through the
-,
dx
dt
n KS dx dx dt. T-O
-rr-
by reason of its position a quantity of heat equal to the difference of the two preceding quantities, that is
It acquires therefore
KSldxdt. dx?
On the other hand, the same slice, whose external surface is Idx and whose temperature differs infinitely little from v, allows a quantity of heat equivalent to hlvdxdt to escape into the air;
during the instant dt\ it follows from this that this infinitelysmall part of the solid retains in reality a quantity of heat
72
represented by
rature vary.
105.
K S -^ dx dt - hlv dx dt
clx
which makes
its
tempe-
The amount
coefficient
of this change
must be examined.
is
The
expresses
required
to raise unit of
tempe
Z>,
up volume Sdx
obtain
its
rature
consequently, multiplying the of the infinitely small slice by the density to and by C the specific capacity for heat, we shall weight,
to
temperature 1
have
CD Sdx
which would
raise
the
1.
volume of the
from temperature
J7
up
to
temperature
Hence the
KS -^ dx dt
hlv
dx
dt
will
be
found by dividing the last quantity by CD Sdx. Denoting there fore, according to custom, the increase of temperature which takes
y
-,
dt,
we
shall
88
THEORY OF HEAT.
~~
UiOC
j~Z$.
~nf)<3
[CHAP.
II.
7/7 CiU
TTr) \J
L/X/AJ
vv
We
this equation to
difficulty
determine the complete solution, and what the of the problem consists in; we limit ourselves here to
the
is dissipated through the surface being that which emanates from the sources, the incessantly replaced by temperature of every section of the solid will approach more and
solid,
more
another.
which varies from one section to by means of equation (b) the law of
the latter temperatures, which would exist of themselves if they were once established, we must suppose that the quantity v does not vary with respect to
t}
-j-.
We
thus
-T~*
ax
= ~T7
fill
-I
AD
v
>
whence v
1
.
= Me
-mif
X\f
T7-Q KS +
TIT Ne
"J^V
IfSf
,
This equation is the same as the equation for the steady temperature of a bar heated at one end (Art. 76), except that I here denotes the perimeter of a section whose area is 8. In the case of the finite bar we can determine two and relations between the constants for, if V be the temperature at the
finite
and if at the end of the bar remote from the source, where # = 0, + where x = L suppose, we make a section at a distance dx from that end, the flow
source,
,
VM
is,
in unit of time,
- KS
and
of heat through the periphery and free end of the hence ultimately, dx vanishing,
hv(ldx + S) namely;
=L
IT,
^
irr\
^
<*!.
rfjJf1
[A. F.]
SECT.
I.]
89
107. Suppose a portion of the circumference of the ring, situated between two successive sources of heat, to be divided
at the
into equal parts, and denote by v lt V 2 V 3 v 4 &c., the temperatures points of division whose distances from the origin are
,
x v xv xv
& c -j the relation between v and x will be given by the preceding equation, after that the two constants have been determined by means of the two values of v corresponding to
#4>
Ju KS
,
and
division,
relation
-=
*
ax
+ a~ A
We
temperatures are v 2 vs v4 and in general for any three consecutive It follows from this that if we observed the temperatures points.
v
between and n and separated by a constant interval X, we should perceive that any three consecutive tempe ratures are always such that the sum of the two extremes divided
\>
vv v
s>
vv V 5
&c
a~
A
.
lieat
If, in the space included between the next two sources of n and p, the temperatures of other different points separated by the same interval X were observed, it would still be found that for any three consecutive points, the sum of the two extreme temperatures, divided by the mean, gives the same quotient The value of this quotient depends neither on the k*. 4. a-\
108.
109.
V $.-;
s
by this that when the circumference is divided into equal the temperatures at the points of division, included between parts,
we
see
90
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
IT.
two consecutive sources of heat, are represented by the terms of a recurring series whose scale of relation is composed of two terms 1. q and Experiments have fully confirmed this result. We have ex posed a metallic ring to the permanent and simultaneous action of different sources of heat, and we have observed the stationary
temperatures of several points separated by constant intervals; we always found that the temperatures of any three consecutive
points, not separated relation in question.
by a source of heat, were connected by the Even if the sources of heat be multiplied, and in whatever manner they be disposed, no change can be
effected in the numerical value of the quotient v -1 ~\~
v3
;
it
depends
only on the dimensions or on the nature of the the manner in which that solid is heated.
110.
ring,
and not on
When we
constant quotient q or
the value of ax
may be
derived
from
is
A A by means of the equation a + of = q. One of the roots a\ and other root is a~\ This quantity being determined,
it
we may
o
2
derive from
it
J\.
^, which
is
j I
(log a)
x Denoting a by
co,
we
shall
have
is
2
o>
qw
+ 1 = 0. Thus
nr
found by multiplying
L
by the square
the equation
o>
+1=
0,
SECTION
Equation of
111.
the
A
at
solid
homogeneous mass, of the form of a sphere, for an infinite time in a medium main
1, is then exposed to air which and displaced with constant velocity kept temperature 0, it is required to determine the successive states of the body during the whole time of the cooling.
:
SECT.
II.]
91
Denote by x the distance of any point whatever from the and by v the temperature of the same point, after a time t has elapsed and suppose, to make the problem more general, that the initial temperature, common to all points situated at the distance x from the centre, is different for different values of x which is what would have been the case if the im mersion had not lasted for an infinite time. Points of the solid, equally distant from the centre, will not cease to have a common temperature v is thus a function of x and t. When we suppose t = 0, it is essential that the value of this function should agree with the initial state which is given, and which is entirely arbitrary.
centre of the sphere,
; ; ;
112.
in
We
movement
of heat
an infinitely thin shell, bounded by two spherical surfaces whose radii are x and x + dx: the quantity of heat which, during an infinitely small instant dt, crosses the lesser surface whose radius
is x, and so passes from that part of the solid which is nearest to the centre into the spherical shell, is equal to the product of four
factors
2
dt,
the extent
;
^Trx of surface,
and the
ratio -j-
it is
expressed by
AKirx*
dt.
-j-
of heat which flows during the the second surface of the same shell, and same instant through solid which envelops it, passes from this shell into the part of the
x must be changed
is
into
x + dx,
KTTX*
that
to say, to the
term
-T- dt
differen
tial of this
We thus
.
find
dt
dxj
as the expression of the quantity of heat which leaves the spheri cal shell across its second surface; and if we subtract this quantity
first
surface,
we
shall
have
xz --}
dt.
This difference
is
evidently the
quantity of
92
THEORY OF HEAT.
shell,
[CHAP.
II.
and whose
effect
to
vary
its
temperature.
coefficient
113.
The
C denotes
is
to temperature 1, a definite from temperature is the weight of unit of volume, ^Trx^dx is the volume of the intervening layer, differing from it only by a quantity which may be omitted hence kjrCDx^dx is the quantity
of heat necessary to raise the intervening shell from temperature Hence it is requisite to divide the quantity to temperature 1. 2 of heat which accumulates in this shell by 4 jrCDx dx ) and we
r
shall
dt.
its
We
_ ~
K
I
Jr
d(x \
2 dv\
-7-
CD
v
-r-a
5
dxj x*dx
or
-77
TTT:
+x
dxj
^ (c).
ment
The preceding equation represents the law of the move of heat in the interior of the solid, but the temperatures of points in the surface are subject also to a special condition which
114.
must be expressed.
surface
cussed
may vary according to the nature of the problems dis we may suppose for example, that, after having heated
all its
boiling water, the cooling is effected by giving to all points in the surface the temperature 0, and by retaining them at this tem perature by any external cause whatever. In this case we may
imagine the sphere, whose variable state it is desired to determine, to be covered by a very thin envelope on which the cooling agency
exerts its action. It may be supposed, 1, that this infinitely thin envelope adheres to the solid, that it is of the same substance as the solid and that it forms a part of it, like the other portions
of the mass
the molecules of the envelope are sub cause always in action which prevents the temperature from ever being above or below zero. To express this condition theoretically, the function v, which contains x and t,
all
Oby a
SECT.
II.]
93
must be made
value
of
t
become
nul,
when we
give to
its
complete
if
may
We
we
-F^ \jj-J
-T-2 \(zx
+ - 3x cl/jcj
) ,
and
(X,
t)
0.
Further, it is necessary that the initial state should be repre we shall therefore have as a sented by the same function (x, t)
<
second condition
(/>
(x, 0)
= 1.
Thus the
sphere on the hypothesis which we have first described will be represented by a function v, which must satisfy the three preceding
The first is general, and belongs at every instant to the second affects only the molecules at points of the mass the surface, and the third belongs only to the initial state.
equations.
all
;
115.
different
is
;
If the solid
it
is
being cooled in
air,
is
must then be imagined that the very thin envelope maintained by some external cause, in a state such as to pro
duce the escape from the sphere, at every instant, of a quantity of heat equal to that which the presence of the medium can carry
away from
it.
the quantity of heat which, during an infinitely small instant dt, flows within the interior of the solid across the spheri
cal surface situate at distance x, is equal to
z
4>K7rx
Now
-^-
dt
and
this general expression is applicable to all values of x. we shall ascertain the quantity of heat supposing x
=X
Thus, by
which in
the variable state of the sphere would pass across the very thin envelope which bounds it on the other hand, the external surface of the solid having a variable temperature, which we shall denote
;
by
would permit the escape into the air of a quantity of heat proportional to that temperature, and to the extent of the surface, 2 2 The value of this quantity is which is Vdt.
F,
4<7rX
4<h7rX
To express, as is supposed, that the action of the envelope supplies the place, at every instant, of that which would result from
the presence of the medium,
4>JnrX*Vdt
it is sufficient
to the
value which
the expression
4iKTrX*
-_,-
dt
94
receives
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAT*.
II.
when we
dx
-,-
give to x
its
complete value
X\ hence we
obtain
the equation
Ct ?J
-jyV,
dx
T and
we put
it
instead of x
value X, which
0.
we
shall denote
by writing
in the
form
K dV + h V ~jdoc
116.
The value
-+
of -=- taken
dx
when x = X, must
v,
therefore have
a constant ratio
to the value of
same point. Thus we shall suppose that the external cause of the cooling determines always the state of the very thin envelope,
in such a
of
C/1J -,
dx
v,
which
results
from
this
state, is proportional to
the value of
corresponding to x
is
= X,
This
ratio of these
two quantities
of
-^
means
present,
else
of -y-
CLX
^
air.
is
v,
thin,
not necessary to suppose the envelope to be extremely it will be seen in the sequel that it may have an indefinite thickness. Here the thickness is considered to be
and
117.
Hence
it
follows that the three equations which are $ (x, t} or v are the following,
dn
Tt~~
The
is
satisfied
is
third
applies to all possible values of x and t the second when x = X, whatever be the value of t; and the satisfied when t = 0, whatever be the value of x.
first
;
SECT.
It
III.]
95
the spherical
layers
might be supposed that in the initial state have not the same temperature which
:
what would
general
necessarily happen, if the immersion were imagined not to have lasted for an indefinite time. In this case, which is more
foregoing, the given function, which expresses the initial temperature of the molecules situated at distance x from
than
the
the centre of the sphere, will be represented by equation will then be replaced by the following,
<
F (x)
the third
(x, 0)
= F (x).
Nothing more remains than a purely analytical problem, whose solution w ill be given in one of the following chapters.
7
v, by means of the general and the two special conditions to which it is subject. condition,
It
SECTION
III.
heated, in such a manner that all points equally distant from the axis have acquired the same temperature it is then exposed to a current of colder air it is required to determine the
;
;
temperatures of the different layers, after a given time. x denotes the radius of a cylindrical surface, all of whose is the radius of points are equally distant from the axis
;
the cylinder
the temperature which points of the solid, axis, must have after the lapse of a time denoted by t, since the beginning of the cooling.
;
is
situated at distance
x from the
v is a function of x and t, and if in it t be made equal to the function of x which arises from this must necessarily satisfy the initial state, which is arbitrary.
Thus
0,
119.
The quantity of x, and that whose radius is x + dx. heat which this portion receives during the instant dt from the part of the solid which it envelops, that is to say, the quantity which during the same time crosses the cylindrical surface
y
portion radius is
of
Consider the movement of heat in an infinitely thin the cylinder, included between the surface whose
96
THEORY OF HEAT.
and whose length expressed by
is
[CHAP.
II.
whose radius
to unity,
is
x,
is
supposed to be equal
dx
To
whose
find the quantity of heat which, crossing the second surface radius is x dx, passes from the infinitely thin shell into
it,
we must,
which
is
in the foregoing
+ dx,
or,
2K7TX
dx
ys- dt,
the differential of this term, taken with respect to x. Hence the difference of the heat received and the heat lost, or the
quantity of heat which accumulating in the infinitely thin shell determines the changes of temperature, is the same differential taken with the opposite sign, or
*&..*(.*);
on the other hand, the volume of this intervening shell is Qirxdx, and ZCDjrxdx expresses the quantity of heat required to raise to the temperature 1, C being the it from the temperature and D the density. Hence the quotient specific heat,
~ dx
ZCDwxdx
is
instant
the increment which the temperature receives during the Whence we obtain the equation dt.
kdt
K (^ CD
\da?
ld JL\
x dx)
120.
The quantity
by 2Kirx
of heat which,
dt,
whose radius
shall
x being expressed
quantity which
we
find
that
-j-
escapes during the same time from the surface of the solid, by in the foregoing value; on the other hand, the making x =
SECT. IV.]
97
same quantity, dispersed into the air, is, by the principle of the communication of heat, equal to %7rXhvJt we must therefore
;
K-j- =hv.
The
which refer to the sphere, or in those wherein the general equations have been given for a body of any form what ever. The function t? which represents the movement of heat in an infinite cylinder must therefore satisfy, 1st, the general equa1 dv (tfv ~ dv\ wnicn tion ~r ~*~ ^PP^es whatever x and t may ~^T} [TJ J~)
-f -j-
= 0,
which
is
true,
whatever
the variable
v
= F(x).
r,
may
last
be,
when x
to 0,
X;
The
condition
must be
of
be.
F (x)
SECTION
of
121.
IV.
prismatic bar is immersed at one extremity in a constant source of heat which maintains that extremity at the
the rest of the bar, whose length is infinite, ; continues to be exposed to a uniform current of atmospheric air maintained at temperature 0; it is required to determine the
temperature
highest temperature which a given point of the bar can acquire. The problem differs from that of Article 73, since we now
all
solid,
which
is
necessary in order to obtain an exact solution. are led, indeed, to suppose that in a bar of very small thickness all points of the same section would acquire sensibly
We
equal temperatures
may
rest
on the
problem rigorously, and then to examine, by analysis, up to what point, and in what cases, we are justified in considering the
temperatures of different points of the same section to be equal.
F. H.
98
122.
THEORY OF HEAT.
The
section
[CHAP.
II.
made
bar, is a square
whose
at right angles to the length of the side is 2f, the axis of the bar is the axis
of x, and the origin is at the extremity A. The three rectangular co-ordinates of a point of the bar are xt y, z, and v denotes the fixed temperature at the same point.
The problem consists in determining the temperatures which must be assigned to different points of the bar, in order that
they may continue to exist without any change, so long as the extreme surface A, which communicates with the source of heat,
remains subject, at all its points, to the permanent tempera thus v is a function of x y, and z. ture A
; t
123.
enclosed between
Consider the movement of heat in a prismatic molecule, six planes perpendicular to the three axes
The first three planes pass through the point m of x, y, and z. whose co-ordinates are x, y, z, and the others pass through the point m whose co-ordinates are x -f dx, y + dy, z-\- dz. To find what quantity of heat enters the molecule during
unit of time across the
first
and perpendicular to xt we must remember that the extent of the surface of the molecule on this plane is dydz, and that the flow across this area is, according to the theorem of Article 98, equal
to
K dx
z
To
opposite face, and escapes from the molecule, we must substitute, in the preceding expression, x + dx for x, or, which is the same
thing, add to this expression its differential taken with respect to x only; whence we conclude that the molecule loses, at its
dx
\dxj
we must
opposite face
is
or,
\ctx/
dv A a x dydz -=-^ dx
SECT. IV.]
9D
this expresses the quantity of heat accumulated in the molecule in consequence of the propagation in direction of x ; which ac
cumulated heat would make the temperature of the molecule vary, if it were not balanced by that which is lost in some other
direction. It is
to
Kdz dx
enters
the
dy
\dy)
Hence
Kdxdydz
dy
j-$,
expresses
Now,
in order that
for the
molecule to retain as
the heat
it
so that
it
ities Hence the sum of the three quanti must be nothing; thus we form the equation acquired
loses in another.
of heat
d2 v
cPv
tfv
z
da?d** dz
124
surface.
It
_ ~
of the
see
remains now to express the conditions relative to the we suppose the point m to belong to one of the faces prismatic bar, and the face to be perpendicular to z, we
If
rectangle dxdy, during unit of time, permits a heat equal to Vh dx dy to escape into the air, V denoting the temperature of the point of the surface, namely what (x, y, z] the function sought becomes when z is made
that
the
quantity of
<f>
equal to I, half the dimension of the prism. On the other hand, the quantity of heat which, by virtue of the action of the
72
100
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
II.
molecules, during unit of time, traverses an infinitely small surface situated within the prism, perpendicular to z y is equal to
G>,
This ex-
to points for
which the co
it
we conclude from
that the
quantity of heat
surface
is
Kdxdy-j-, giving
I.
its
com
plete
value
quantities
h dx dy v, must be equal, in order that the action of the molecules may agree with that of the medium. This equality must also
exist
when we
-y-
dz
I,
which it has at the face opposite to that first considered. Further, the quantity of heat which crosses an infinitely small surface co,
perpendicular to the axis of
y,
being
Kco-j-,
it
follows that
prism perpendicular to y
function
-y- its
is
K dz dx
I.
(i rJ
-=,
giving to y in the
rectangle
complete value
Now
this
dz dx
dy
permits a quantity of heat expressed by hv dx dy to escape into
the air;
the equation hv
is
=
or
K^t/
when y
125.
made equal
to
in the functions v
and
-=-
dy
equal to
y and
z.
The value of the function v must by hypothesis be A, when we suppose a? = 0, whatever be the values of Thus the required function v is determined by the
z,
it
satisfies
the
general equation
d^v
dtf
d*v
d*v
_ = 0, when y
is
dy*
~dz*~
2nd,
it
satisfies
the equation
y^w
-r-
equal to
SECT. V.]
I
10 T
the equation
or
I,
may
I
be,
or
I,
satisfies*
-pV
+ ^- = 0, when
3rd,
it
equal to
or
whatever x and y
may
be
satisfies
the equation
v = A, when x = 0,
whatever
y and z may
be.
SECTION
126.
Y.
A solid in
atmospheric air, determine the successive states of the body during the whole time of the cooling.
The centre of the cube is taken as the origin of rectangular coordinates; the three perpendiculars dropped from this point on the faces, are the axes of x, y, and z ; 21 is the side of the cube,
v
the temperature to which a point whose coordinates are x, y z, is lowered after the time t has elapsed since the com mencement of the cooling the problem consists in determining
is
}
:
the function
127.
v,
which depends on
x, y, z
and
t.
we must
v must satisfy, what change of temperature an infinitely small portion of the solid must experience during the instant dt, by virtue of the action of the molecules which are extremely
ascertain
near to
it.
We
consider
enclosed
between
through
the point m, whose co-ordinates are x, y, z, and the three others, through the point m whose co-ordinates are
,
x+
dx,
y + dy,
+ dz.
The quantity of heat which during the instant dt passes into the molecule across the first rectangle dy dz perpendicular to x,
is
Kdy dz -T-
dt,
in the
the molecule, through the opposite face, is found by writing x-}- dx in place of x in the preceding expression, it is
- Kdy ^
-y-J dt.
102
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
II.
The quantity the differential being taken with respect to x only. of heat which during the instant dt enters the molecule, across the first rectangle dz dx perpendicular to the axis of y, is
Kdzdx--.~dt, and that which escapes from the molecule during
the same instant, by the opposite face,
is
Kdz
dx 4- dt ay
Kdz dx d
-y-
dt,
\dyJ
the differential being taken with respect to y only. The quantity of heat which the molecule receives during the instant dt, through
its
z,
is
Kdxdy-j-dt, dz
is
~Kdxdy^dt-Kdxdyd(~^dt,
the differential being taken with respect to z only. The sum of all the quantities of heat which escape from the
molecule must
the
which
it
receives,
Kdij dz d
-.
dt
+ Kdz dx d
dt
+ K dx dy d
dt,
128.
that which
to the
If the quantity which has just been found be divided by is necessary to raise the molecule from the temperature
temperature
1,
C denotes the capacity of CD its density, and dxdydz the volume the substance for heat; of the molecule. The movement of heat in the interior of the
:
by the equation
/
I
dv
.
K
~"
fd^v
7
*2
d^v
j_
*
d*v\
i
dt
f1 CD
7~\
__
\dx
dy*
dz
(fj \ Ji
^
SECT. V.]
VAIIIED
It
MOVEMENT
IX
A CUBE.
103
129.
remains to form the equations which relate to the which presents no difficulty, in accordance
In fact, the with the principles which we have established. of heat Avhich, during the instant dt crosses the rectangle quantity
:
is
K dy dz
-v- dt.
which applies to
is
all
equal to
I,
points of the solid, ought to hold half the thickness of the prism.
situated at the surface, the
is
In this
dyds being
quantity of heat which crosses it, during the instant dt, is expressed
fore to have,
and
when x =
be
l}
the equation hv
K-j-. CL*k
This con-
dition
must
also
satisfied
when x =
I.
be found also that, the quantity of heat which crosses the rectangle dz dx situated on a plane perpendicular to the axis
It will
of y being in general
we must have the equation hu + K-j- = Q, when y U Lastly, we obtain in like manner the definite equation
or
dz
which
is satisfied
when
=I
or
The function sought, which expresses the varied move 130. ment of heat in the interior of a solid of cubic form, must therefore
be determined by the following conditions
1st.
:
equation
2nd.
dx
which hold when
ay
1,
x=
1,
z=
1;
104
3rd.
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
II.
If in the function v which contains x, y, z, t, we make whatever be the values of x, y, and z, we ought to have, = A, which is the initial and common according to hypothesis, v
t
0,
The
represents the
equation arrived at in the preceding problem movement of heat in the interior of all solids.
the form of the body
Whatever, in
result.
fact,
it
may
be,
it is
evident that,
by decomposing
We
this
manner
into prismatic molecules, we shall obtain this may therefore limit ourselves to demonstrating in the equation of the propagation of heat. But in
order to
that
make the exhibition of principles more complete, and we may collect into a small number of consecutive articles
the theorems which serve to establish the general equation of the propagation of heat in the interior of solids, and the equations
which relate to the state of the surface, we shall proceed, in the two following sections, to the investigation of these equations, independently of any particular problem, and without reverting to the elementary propositions which we have explained in the
introduction.
SECTION
VI.
THEOREM
I.
If
of a homogeneous
solid mass, enclosed between six planes at right angles, have actual
=A
ax
by
cz,
(a),
the molecules situated at the external surface on the six which bound the prism are maintained, by any cause what planes
ever,
and if
at the temperature expressed by the equation (a) : all the molecules situated in the interior of the mass will of themselves
retain their actual temperatures, so that there will be no change in the state of the prism.
ordinates are x, y, z
denotes the actual temperature of the point whose co A, a, b, c, are constant coefficients.
;
To prove
this
proposition,
SECT. VI.]
105
denote by
temperature by y + /3, z + y, and its temperature by w, the co-ordinates of the point m by as a, y fi, z y, and its temperature by u we shall have
t
and
a,
its
x+
=A
ax
ly
cz,
whence we conclude
v
that,
w = az + 6/3 + cy,
v
and
u
v.
= az + b/3 +
cy
therefore
w=u
Now the quantity of heat which one point receives from another depends on the distance between the two points and on the difference of their temperatures. Hence the action of
on the point //, is equal to the action of m on M; the point as it gives up thus the point receives as much heat from to the point p.
obtain the same result, whatever be the direction and magnitude of the line which passes through the point J/, and Hence it is impossible for this is divided into two equal parts.
point to change its temperature, for as much heat as it gives up.
it
We
applies to all
other points
hence no
solid.
being enclosed between two if the actual temperature of its different points is supposed to be expressed by the equation v = lz, and the two planes which bound it are maintained
I.
COROLLARY
solid
and B,
this
if
we make A=l, a =
If in
0, &
= 0, c = 1.
II.
parallel to those which bound it, we see that a certain quantity of heat flows across this plane during and n, one unit of time ; for two very near points, such as
106
of
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
II.
is below the plane and the other above it, are unequally the first, whose temperature is highest, must therefore heated; send to the second, during each instant, a certain quantity of heat
which
which, in some cases, may be very small, and even insensible, according to the nature of the body and the distance of the two
molecules.
The same
by the plane.
is
true for any two other points whatever separated That which, is most heated sends to the other
a certain quantity of heat, and the sum of these partial actions, or of all the quantities of heat sent across the plane, composes
a continual flow whose value does not change,
molecules preserve their temperatures.
this floiv, or the quantity
since all
the
It is easy to
prove that
M during
the unit of
time, is
equivalent
is
to the first.
In
the part of
two surfaces
M and
N will
as
it
receive continually, across the plane M, as much heat N. If the quantity of heat, which
enters the part of the mass which is passing the plane were not equal to that which escapes by the opposite considered, surface N, the solid enclosed between the two surfaces would
in
acquire fresh heat, or would lose a part of that which it has, and its temperatures would not be constant; which is contrary to the preceding lemma.
135.
of the specific conducibility of a given taken to be the quantity of heat which, in an infinite formed of this substance, and enclosed between two parallel
is
The measure
substance
solid,
planes, flows during unit of time across unit of surface, taken on any intermediate plane whatever, parallel to the external
planes, the distance between which is equal to unit of length, one of them being maintained at temperature 1, and the other
at temperature 0.
the whole extent of the prism is denoted by the coefficient K, and is the measure of the conducibility.
136.
LEMMA. If we suppose
all the
question under the preceding article, to be multiplied by any number whatever g, so that the equation of temperatures is v = g gz, instead of bsing v = 1 z, and if the two external planes are main-
SECT. VI.]
107
flow of heat, in this second hypothesis, or the quantity which during unit of time crosses unit of surface taken on an
intermediate plane parallel to the bases,
is
equal
to
the product
of the first flow multiplied by g. In fact, since all the temperatures have been increased in
the ratio of 1 to g, the differences of the temperatures of any are increased in the same ratio. two points whatever m and Hence, according to the principle of the communication of heat, in order to ascertain the quantity of heat which in sends to ^ on the second hypothesis, we must multiply by g the quantity on the first hypothesis. which the same point m sends to The same would be true for any two other points whatever. results from Now, the quantity of heat which crosses a plane sum of all the actions which the points m, m the etc., situated on the same side of the plane, exert on the points Hence, if in the first etc., situated on the other side. //,
//.,
(JL
M
,
m"j
m",
//.,
fju
fj!" }
is
denoted by
it
will
be equal to
g.
all
the temperatures by
In a prism whose constant temperatures = A ax- by cz, and which six planes at right angles all of whose points are is bounded by maintained at constant temperatures determined by the preceding
137.
II.
THEOREM
equation, the quantity of heat which, during unit of time, crosses unit of surface taken on any intermediate plane whatever perpen
dicular to z, is the same as the constant flow in a solid of the same substance would be, if enclosed between two infinite parallel planes, and for which the equation of constant temperatures is
=c
cz.
To prove
infinite
solid,
this, let
and
p,
separated
r m
by the plane the plane, and
h
to the axis of z
fig. 4),
;
M perpendicular
m
below
it
^ being above
(see
108
let
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
II.
such that the perpendicular dropped from us take a point on the plane may also be perpendicular to the //, at its middle point h. Denote by x, y, z + h, the
mm
co-ordinates of the point //,, whose temperature z, the co-ordinates of m, whose temperature
is is
w, by x
v,
a,
y
a?
/3,
+ {3,
z,
the co-ordinates of
action of
and by
is
-fa,
whose temperature
v.
The
to
on
(JL,
which
sends
will therefore be expressed by action of m on and the factor q is the same as in the preceding w) q (v expression; hence the sum of the two actions of m on ft, and or the quantity of heat which receives from m and of m on from m, is expressed by
The a certain time, may be expressed by q(v w). jju during factor q depends on the distance nip, and on the nature of the
The
;
mass.
//,
//-,
//,
-f
w}.
Now,
if
the points m, p,
we have
b (y
;
w
and
and
if
ax
by
v
c (z -f h), v
=A -6
a (x
(y
a)
/3)
cz,
=A-a
(x
a)
+ /3)
- cz
solid,
we should
have,
by hypothesis,
w=c
In the
first case,
c(z+li)
=c
cz,
and
=c
cz.
we
find
(v
w+v
still
//,
w)
= 2qch,
result.
Hence
receives from
and from
on
the
is
first
hypothesis,
=A
ax
by
is
of constant temperatures to the quantity of heat equivalent and from when the equation of
cz. constant temperatures is The same conclusion might be drawn with respect to any three other points whatever m, /// provided that the second // be at equal distances from the other two, and the altitude of placed
,
m",
v = c
the isosceles triangle be parallel to z. Now, the quantity /jf of heat which crosses any plane whatever M, results from the sum of the actions which all the points m, etc., situated on ,
m"
in",
in"
SECT. VI.]
109
p" ,
one side of this plane, exert on all the points etc //, situated on the other side hence the constant flow, which, during in the infinite unit of time, crosses a definite part of the plane solid, is equal to the quantity of heat which flows in the same time across the same portion of the plane in the prism, all of whose
:
=A
The
ax
by
- cz.
138.
solid,
COROLLARY.
cK in
cK
the infinite
when the
In
surface.
or
-7-
It is proved in the same manner, that the constant flow which takes place, during unit of time, in the. same prism across unit of surfacet
to y, is
equal
to
bK
and
that which crosses
or
dv K 3<ty
a plane perpendicular
to
lias the
value
-.
dx
139.
articles
The
propositions which
we have proved
in the preceding
apply also to the case in which the instantaneous action of a molecule is exerted in the interior of the mass up to an appre
In this case, we must suppose that the cause which maintains the external layers of the body in the state
ciable distance.
expressed by the linear equation, affects the mass up to a finite depth. All observation concurs to prove that in solids and liquids the distance in question is extremely small.
THEOREM III. If the temperatures at the points of a are expressed by the equation v = (x, y, z, t), in which z are the co-ordinates of a molecule whose temperature is a?, y, equal to v after the lapse of a time t; the flow of heat which
140.
solid
crosses part of a plane traced in the solid, perpendicular to one of the three axes, is no longer constant ; its value is different for
different parts of the plane,
and
it
This
variable quantity
may be determined by
110
Let
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
II.
w be an
the point
vertical co-ordinate z
of the solid, and whose plane is perpendicular to the during the instant dt there will flow across
;
this circle a certain quantity of heat which will pass from the part of the circle below the plane of the circle into the upper
This flow is composed of all the rays of heat which depart part. from a lower point arid arrive at an upper point, by crossing a point of the small surface w. We proceed to shew that the
expression of the value of the flow is
K dv -7-
&>dt.
Let us denote by x, y, z the coordinates of the point m whose and suppose all the other molecules to be temperature is v referred to this point in chosen as the origin of new axes parallel
;
let f,
77,
f,
in order to express the actual temperature referred to the origin w of a molecule infinitely near to m, we shall have the linear
;
equation
w-v
The
coefficients
t/,
,.
dv -r+i7-7 dx dy
dv
dv
+-,-. dz
-j-
the variables
x,
z,
the constant quantities x y, z, which measure the dis from the first three axes of x, y, and z.
,
Suppose now that the point m is also an internal molecule of a rectangular prism, enclosed between six planes perpendicular to the three axes whose origin is m that w the actual temperature of each molecule of this prism, whose dimensions are finite, is ex = A + a% + brj + c and that the pressed by the linear equation w six faces which bound the prism are maintained at the fixed tem The state of peratures which the last equation assigns to them. the internal molecules will also be permanent, and a quantity of heat measured by the expression Kcwdt will flow during the
;
&>.
This arranged,
if
,-,-
we take
dv
,
as
constants
c
,1
A,
a, 6,
c,
the quantities v
xi
dv
,
dv
,
-5
-y-
-j-
,,
SECT. VI.]
Ill
w = v +-T-+-7-^+ dx *
dy
dv
dv
dv
JT~?I dz
will have, infinitely near to the point the same actual temperature in the solid dt, whose state is variable, and in the prism whose state is constant. Hence the flow which exists at the point m, during the instant dt,
is
&>,
it
therefore expressed
by
-7
codt.
CL2
this we derive the following proposition in a solid whose internal temperatures vary with the time, by If virtue of the action of the molecules, we trace any straight line what
ever,
From
and
of
ordinates
pm
to the
same moment;
the flow
of
a.
of the straight line, will be proportional to the tangent of the angle which the element of the curve makes with the parallel to the alscissw ; that is to say, if at the point p we place the centre of an
Fig.
5.
perpendicular to the line, the quantity of heat which has flowed during the instant dt, across this circle, in
o>
the direction in which the abscissae op increase, will be measured by the product of four factors, which are, the tangent of the angle of the circle, and the dura a, a constant coefficient K, the area
o>
141.
COROLLARY.
If
we represent by
112
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
II.
fixed point o, and by v the ordinate which represents the tem perature of the point p, v will vary with the distance e and will be a certain function /(e) of that distance; the quantity
of heat
circle
o>,
placed at the
wdt, or
point
will
be
-=-
-Kf
denoting the function \/ QJ.
(e)a>dt,
by/
(e).
We may
line
To obtain the actual flow of heat at a point p of a straight drawn in a solid, whose temperatures vary by action of the molecules, we must divide the difference of the temperatures at
two points infinitely near
these points.
to the
The flow
is
proportional
142.
THEOHEM
IV.
From
it
is
deduce the general equations of the propagation of heat. Suppose the different points of a homogeneous solid of any form whatever, to have received initial temperatures which vary successively by the effect of the mutual action of the molecules,
easy to
and suppose
states
the equation
= f (x,
y, z, t) to
of the solid, it
may now
2
be
dy
dt
"
CD
K_
/d v
Vdx
dV
dy*
dV\ dzV
In
fact, let
enclosed between six planes at right angles to the axes of x, y, and z\ the first three of these planes pass through the point m whose coordinates are x, y, z, the other three pass through the point m, whose coordinates are x + dx, y + dy,z + dz.
dt,
the
molecule receives,
across
the
m, a
K dx dy
-=- dt.
which escapes from the molecule by the opposite face, it is sufficient to change z into z -f dz in the preceding expression,
SECT. VI.]
113
taken
that
is
to say, to
own
differential
we then have
dz
^ dz
dz
as the value of the quantity which escapes across the upper The same molecule receives also across the first rectangle.
rectangle dz
of heat
dx which
equal to
K-j-
dz dx dt
and
if
we add
to this ex
r pression its ow n differential taken with respect to y only, we find that the quantity which escapes across the opposite face
dz dx
is
expressed by
K-jy
dz dx dt
^ y
dy dz dx
dt.
-y-
CiX
dy dz
dt,
it
rectangle which
passes through
is
expressed by
K-r
,^
dy dzdtK
777
-rr
dX
-r
dx dy dz dt.
7777
must now take the sum of the quantities of heat which the molecule receives and subtract from it the sum of those which it loses. Hence it appears that during the instant dt, a total quantity of heat equal to
We
It remains
result
only
which must
from
being the density of the solid, or the weight of unit of volume, and C the specific capacity, or the quantity of heat to the which raises the unit of weight from the temperature
temperature
F.
the product
CDdxdydz
H.
ll4
THEORY OF HEAT.
to 1 the molecule
this
[CHAP.
II.
whose volume
its
dx dydz.
Hence dividing by
heat which the molecule has just acquired, we shall have increase of temperature. Thus we obtain the general equation
^ - J^ (^
which
is
JL
^ + &1
143.
tures
is
Independently of this equation the system of tempera often subject to several definite conditions, of which no
general expression can be given, since they depend on the nature of the problem.
If the dimensions of the
finite,
and
if
;
the surface
is
given state for example, if all its points retain, by virtue of that cause, the constant temperature 0, we shall have, denoting the unknown function v by (x, y, z, t}, the equation of condition
(f> (j>
(x, y, 2, t)
which must be
satisfied
by
all
values of
x, y, z
Further, if we suppose the initial temperatures of the be expressed by the known function (x, y, z), we have body = (x, y, z) the condition ex also the equation (x, y, z, 0) pressed by this equation must be fulfilled by all values of the co-ordinates x, y z which belong to any point whatever of the
F
;
<f>
solid.
144.
stant temperature, we may suppose the temperature not to be the same at different points of the surface, and that it varies with
the time according to a given law ; which is what takes place in In this case the equation the problem of terrestrial temperature.
relative to the surface contains the variable
t.
In order to examine by itself, and from a very general problem of the propagation of heat, the solid whose initial state is given must be supposed to have all its dimensions infinite; no special condition disturbs then the dif145.
SECT. VII.]
115
submitted
it is
~
dt
to
CD
initial arbitrary
Suppose the initial temperature of a molecule, whose co ordinates are x, y, z to be a known function F(x y, z} and denote the unknown value v by (x, y, z, t), we shall have the definite
}
t
<f>
= (x, y, 2) thus the problem is reduced to equation (as, y, z, 0) the integration of the general equation (A) in such a manner that it may agree, when the time is zero, with the equation which con
<f>
SECTION
VII.
to the surface.
is
and if its original heat into atmospheric air maintained at a con dispersed gradually stant temperature, a third condition relative to the state of the
If the solid has a definite form,
must be added to the general equation (A) and to that which represents the initial state.
surface
proceed to examine, in the following articles, the nature of the equation which expresses this third condition. Consider the variable state of a solid whose heat is dispersed into air, maintained at the fixed temperature 0. be an Let
o>
We
through which a normal to the surface is of this line have at the same instant different temperatures. Let v be the actual temperature of the point p,, taken at a
;
&>,
definite instant, and w the corresponding temperature of a point v of the solid taken on the normal, and distant from //, by an in Denote by x, y, z the co-ordinates of finitely small quantity a.
the point p, and those of the point v by x + &, y + &y, z + Sz let/ (x, y, z) = be the known equation to the surface of the solid, and v = (x, y, z, f) the general equation which ought to give the
</>
82
116
THEORY OF HEAT.
y, z,
t.
[CHAP.
II.
value of v as a function of the four variables x, = 0, we shall have tiating the equation f(x, y, z)
Differen
being functions of x, y, z. from the corollary enunciated in Article 141, that the flow in direction of the normal, or the quantity of heat which
It follows
if it were placed during the instant dt would cross the surface at any point whatever of this line, at right angles to its direction, is proportional to the quotient which is obtained by dividing the
,
difference of temperature of
distance.
two points
infinitely near
by
their
end of the
normal
is T
^w K
GC
codt]
On
the other
hand, the surface co permits a quantity of heat to escape into the h being the conducibility air, during the time dt, equal to hvcodt Thus the flow of heat at the end of relative to atmospheric air.
;
is
to say
and
K;
codt
and
it is
by the expression
is
of this equality that the condition relative to the surface troduced into the analysis.
in
147.
We
have
w
Now,
+
,
ov
dv = v + -y.
ax
^ ox
+ -j- oy
dy
dv
dv
-f-
-j~ oz.
dz
it follows from the principles of geometry, that the co ordinates $x, &/, &z, which fix the position of the point v of the normal relative to the point satisfy the following conditions
We
have therefore
dv dv\ w -v = - (m-j- + n-j- + p^-) * dz dx p\ dy
1 /
dv
<*
oz:
SECT. VII.]
11?
we have
also
,^-s
Bi
a
&s
=-(m
or
a.
= ^ &z
hence
-vfdv
w
a
+ n* +
"
dy
This equation is definite and applies only to points at the surface ; it is that which must be added to the general equation of the propagation of heat (A), and to the condition which deter
mines the
initial state of the solid ; m, n, p, q, are of the co-ordinates of the points on the surface.
known
functions
148. The equation (B) signifies in general that the decrease of the temperature, in the direction of the normal, at the boundary of the solid, is such that the quantity of heat which tends to escape by virtue of the action of the molecules, is equivalent always to
that which the body must lose in the medium. The mass of the solid might be imagined to be prolonged, in such a manner that the surface, instead of being exposed to the
air,
to the
belonged at the same time to the body which mass of a solid envelope which contained
it
it.
bounds, and
If,
on
this
hypothesis, any cause whatever regulated at every instant the decrease of the temperatures in the solid envelope, and determined it in such a manner that the condition expressed by the equation
(B)
1
was always
Let
.ZV
satisfied,
be the normal,
dv
-7T7
<LV
dv = m -T- +
q
dx
&c.
[B. L. E.]
118
place of that of the same in either case
air,
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
II.
and the movement of heat would be the we can suppose then that this cause exists,
;
and determine on this hypothesis the variable state of the solid which is what is done in the employment of the two equations (A) and (B). By this it is seen how the interruption of the mass and the
action of the
it
to
diffusion of heat
by submitting
149.
We may We
which relates
:
to the state of the surface under another point of view but we must first derive a remarkable consequence from Theorem in.
retain the construction referred to in the corollary (Art. 140). Let x, y, z be the co-ordinates of the same theorem (Art. 141). of the point p, and
x+Sx, y + %,
those of a point q infinitely near to p, and taken on the straight if we denote by v and w the temperatures of the line in question
:
instant,
we have
dv
,
w = v 4,
bv
dv = v + -j- ox +
,
,
dv
dx
-j- o y
dy
+ -y- oz dz
5,
dv = -j-
8x
-Zbe
dx
+ -Jdx
dv
dy
ce
+ dz j-
dv
z
-F"
ce
thus the quantity of heat which flows across the surface at the point m, perpendicular to the straight line, is
<y
placed
dv
Sx
dv
Sv
dv
Sz
r\
The
The
first
term
is
the product of
K-j~ by dx
dt
and by
CD
-K-.
06
according to the principles of geometry, the area of the projection of co on the plane of y and z ; thus the
latter quantity
is,
product represents the quantity of heat which would flow across the area of the projection, if it were placed at the point p perpen
dicular to the axis of x.
SECT. VII.]
119
K -r-
rs
co
~- dt
made on
the plane of
x and
z,
if this
to itself at the
point p.
Lastly, the third term
of heat
-K
rj
co
-j-
which would flow during the instant dt, across the projec on the plane of so and y, if this projection were placed at tion of
o>
the point p, perpendicular to the co-ordinate z. By this it is seen that the quantity of heat which flows across every infinitely small part of a surface drawn in the interior of the
can always be decomposed into three other quantities of flow, which penetrate the three orthogonal projections of the surface, along
solid,
of the projections.
The
gives rise to properties analogous to those which have been noticed in the theory of forces.
result
of heat which flows across a plane surface given in form and position, being equivalent to that which would cross its three orthogonal projections, it fol lows that, if in the interior of the solid an element be imagined of 150.
ft>,
The quantity
infinitely small,
any form whatever, the quantities of heat which pass into this polyhedron by its different faces, compensate each other recipro cally: or more exactly, the sum of the terms of the first order, which enter into the expression of the quantities of heat received by the molecule, is zero so that the heat which is in fact accumu lated in it, and makes its temperature vary, cannot be expressed
;
except by terms infinitely smaller than those of the first order. This result is distinctly seen when the general equation (A) has been established, by considering the movement of heat in
a prismatic molecule (Articles 127 and 142) the demonstration may be extended to a molecule of any form whatever, by sub stituting for the heat received through each face, that which its
;
three projections would receive. In other respects it is necessary that this should be so
for, if
one of the molecules of the solid acquired during each instant a quantity of heat expressed by a term of the first order, the varia
tion of its temperature
would be
infinitely greater
than that of
120
other molecules, that
its
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
II.
is to say, during each infinitely small instant temperature would increase or decrease by a finite quantity, which is contrary to experience.
151.
We
Through a point a (see fig. 6), taken on the plane of x and y, draw two planes perpendicular, one to the axis of x the other to the axis of y. Through a point b of the same plane, infinitely near to a, draw two other planes parallel to the two preceding
planes the ordinates z, raised at the points a, b, c, d, up to the external surface of the solid, will mark on this surface four points a b c d and will be the edges of a truncated prism, whose base
; ,
,
the rectangle abed. If through the point a which denotes the least elevated of the four points a b c, d a plane be drawn to that of x and y, it will cut off from the truncated prism parallel
is
r
,
a molecule, one of whose faces, that is to say ab c d coincides with the surface of the solid. The values of the four ordinates
,
aa
cc,
dd
aa
z,
bb
77
=z
-f-
-y-
dx
i dx
j
-f-
-j-
d>/.
dy
SECT. VII.]
121
152.
One
and
ch
K -y- we have,
CLOO
dt,
dz
as the expression of the quantity of heat which in one instant passes into the molecule, across the triangle in question. The area of the opposite face is
1 j - ay 2 9 f
[
dz
-j
\dx
ax + -y- ax + -j~ ay y dx j dy
,
dz
dz
CM ?7
K-J-, suppress
ing terms of the second order infinitely smaller than those of the first; subtracting the quantity of heat which escapes by the second
face
first
we
find
-j-
dz j
dx
j dx dy.
This term expresses the quantity of heat the molecule receives through the faces perpendicular to x.
It will
receives,
,
,
equal to
be found, by a similar process, that the same molecule through the faces perpendicular to y, a quantity of heat , vr dv dz ,
-^
dx
dy.
The quantity
rectangular base
face
of heat
is
K-j-dx dy.
a certain quantity of heat is permitted to escape, , to the product of hv into the extent co of that surface. equal The value of is, according to known principles, the same as that
o>
a Vc d
of
dx dy multiplied by the
ratio -
and
fdz\* l-Tj
(-
(dz \dy
122
hence the molecule
THEORY OF HEAT.
loses across its surface
[CHAP.
II.
bc
d a quantity
of
heat equal to hv dx dy - .
of the total quantity of heat acquired by the molecule, each other, in order that the variation of temperature
at each instant a finite quantity
;
must cancel
may
,
not be
the equation
,
dz
dv dz
y
dx dx
or
j-
ax dy
dy dy
-
*\ d*
r dx dy}
*J
hv-dxdy = z
.
0,
he
dv dz
-j-
-==,v
dx -j dx
+ -j
dv dz
-j
dy dy
dv ---jdz
153.
Substituting for -r- and -7- their values derived from &
dx
dy
the equation
+w +p
dv
8 )
,
we have
dv
dv
we know distinctly what is represented by each of the terms of this equation. Taking them all with contrary signs and multiplying them by dx dy, the first expresses how much heat the molecule receives
thus
it
through the two faces perpendicular to x, the second how much receives through its two faces perpendicular to y, the third how much it receives through the face perpendicular to z, and the fourth how much it receives from the medium. The equation
therefore expresses that the sum of all the terms of the first order is zero, and that the heat acquired cannot be represented
To
arrive
at
a vessel which receives or loses heat through its different faces. The equation signifies that all the terms of the first order which
SECT. VIII.]
123
enter into the expression of the heat acquired cancel each other ; so that the gain of heat cannot be expressed except by terms of the second order. may give to the molecule the form,
We
(A), (Art. 142) supposes that all the order cancel each other in the interior of the
The equation
evident for prismatic molecules enclosed in the (B), (Art. 147) expresses the same result
boundaries of bodies.
of view -from
The equation
dv
m (^ + jf+&)
fd*v
<Fv\
d*v
ment
solid
It enables us to ascer
or liquid
from
it
we may
articles
derive
the equation
which
we
shall
make
this application
SECTION
VIII.
all
envelope by r, and suppose, as formerly, in Article 118, that the molecules equally distant from the axis have at each
instant a
common temperature
y,
first
v will be a function of r
2
z
and
is
a function of
evident in the
to
= y + z*. It is z, given by the equation r that the variation of v with respect place
73
is
nul
-j-s
must be omitted.
dx*
We
shall
have
equations
dv_dvdr ~
Ty
dv
~r~
,
J
d*v
d?v_
(dr\*
dr Ty
dv
dz
dv = i dr r
dr dz
aud
d
dv fd*r\
I
+ T~ dr
-i~
\dz*J
124
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
II.
whence
<Pv
dy*
(Fv__d*v + dz* dr
2
(fdr\*
\\cty)
(dr\* \dz)
.dvfd^r + +
dr \dy*
dfr
In the second
member
dr
Ty
dr Tz
d*r
~dtf
d*r
2?
for
which purpose
yT-r dy
z
dr
and
fdr\* 1=^-1 + r -j
d*r
,
\dyj
dy*
-
r-j- and 1
dr
dz
= fdr\* +r-d*r r
\dzj
dz
and consequently
The
first
equation, whose
first
member
is
equal to r
2
,
gives
when we
substitute for
fdr\*
+ /AY
(&)
\dy)
its
value
1,
by equations
d?v
(b)
and
(c)
be now substi
tuted in
(a),
we have
(Fv
dtf
dh
t
dz*~dr
Idv
r dr
of heat
dv_J?i(d^) * ldv\ ~~ 2
dt
as
CD Ur
r dr)
SECT. VIII.]
125
We might also suppose that particles equally distant from the centre have not received a common initial temperature ; in this case we should arrive at a much more general equation.
156.
To determine, by means
We have then
dv d*r
-ydr dx
-=
,
dv
dv dr
jau;
dv
ar dx
-y- -r-
and
dzv
-r-2
dx
z
\dxj
dv dr
v_d
__
v/dr\ 2
dv d~r
dv
_ dv ~
dr
a
d 2v
~ d*v
/dr\ 2
dv d*r
Making
<
have
<Pv
(dr\*
2
dr\*
dz\*
dv (d
The equation
x*
+y +z = r
2
dr
dr
r ~r~ an d i
d-y
dr
= =
\dy]
dr r-^~ and 1 dz
fdr\ -^ \dzj
+ r dz -j-$
z
:
tfr
.
The
first
order give
126
THEORY OF HEAT.
The
three equations of the second order give
:
[CHAP.
II.
_(dr\ +
"
\dx)
fdr\ \dy) dy
dr\*
*V
dxz
dy*
and substituting
for
dx
its
value
1,
we have
ffr
Making these
equation
we have the
~dt^UD
which
is
+
|<F
~<FJ
greater number of terms, if we molecules equally distant from the centre not to have supposed received the same initial temperature.
might also deduce from the definite equation (B), the equations which express the state of the surface in particular cases, in which we suppose solids of given form to communicate their heat to the atmospheric air but in most cases these equa tions present themselves at once, and their form is very simple,
;
We
when
SECTION
IX.
General Remarks.
157.
solids
The investigation of the laws of movement of heat in now consists in the integration of the equations which we
;
have constructed
We
conclude this chapter with general remarks on the nature of the quantities which enter into our analysis.
In order to measure these quantities and express them nume rically, they must be compared with different kinds of units, five
SECT. IX.]
GENERAL REMARKS.
127
in number, namely, the unit of length, the unit of time, that of temperature, that of weight, and finally the unit which serves to
For the
last unit,
we might have
chosen the quantity of heat which raises a given volume of a certain substance from the temperature to the temperature 1.
The
choice
of this unit
respects to that of the quantity of heat required to convert a mass of ice of a given weight, into an equal mass of water at 0, without
have adopted the last unit only raising its temperature. because it had been in a manner fixed beforehand in several works
besides, this supposition into the results of analysis.
;
We
on physics
The specific elements which in every body determine 158. the measurable effects of heat are three in number, namely, the
conducibility proper to the body, the conducibility relative to the atmospheric air, and the capacity for heat. The numbers which
express these quantities are, like the specific gravity, so many natural characters proper to different substances. have already remarked, Art. 36, that the conducibility of
We
the surface would be measured in a more exact manner, if we had sufficient observations on the effects of radiant heat in spaces
deprived of
It
air.
may be
seen, as has
first
section of
h,
Chapter
L, Art. 11,
C,
enter into the investigation they must be determined by obser vation and we shall point out in the sequel the experiments
;
adapted to
159.
precision.
is
The number
C which
always
of
to say,
by the
number
be replaced by the coeffi In this case we must understand by the specific capacity cient c. to for heat, the quantity required to raise from temperature 1 unit of volume of a given substance, and not unit of temperature
volume
CD may
weight of that substance. With the view of not departing from the common definition, we have referred the capacity for heat to the weight and not to
128
the volume
THEORY OF HEAT.
;
[CHAP.
II.
but it would be preferable to employ the coefficient c which we have just denned magnitudes measured by the unit of weight would not then enter into the analytical expressions we should have to consider only, 1st, the linear dimension x, the temperature v, and the time t\ 2nd, the coefficients c, h, and K. The three first quantities are undetermined, and the three others are, for each substance, constant elements which experiment determines. As to the unit of surface and the unit of volume, they are not absolute, but depend on the unit of length.
; :
must now be remarked that every undetermined has one dimension proper to itself, and magnitude that the terms of one and the same equation could not be com We have pared, if they had not the same exponent of dimension.
160.
It
or constant
introduced this consideration into the theory of heat, in order to make our definitions more exact, and to serve to verify the
it is derived from primary notions on quantities; for which reason, in geometry and mechanics, it is the equivalent of the fundamental lemmas which the Greeks have left us with
analysis;
out proof.
In the analytical theory of heat, every equation expresses a necessary relation between the existing magnitudes This relation depends in no respect on the choice x, t, v, c, h, K. of the unit of length, which from its very nature is contingent,
161.
that
is
to say, if
we took a
different unit to
dimensions, the equation (E} would still be the same. Suppose then the unit of length to be changed, and its second value to be equal to the first divided by m. Any quantity whatever x which
in the equation (E) represents a certain line ab, and which, con sequently, denotes a certain number of times the unit of length,
becomes
changed
h,
inx,
of the time,
;
the value t corresponding to the same length ab and the value v of the temperature will not be the same is not the case with the specific elements
;
K,
c\ the first, h,
becomes
,
i(Ylt
heat which escapes, during the unit of time, from the unit of sur face at the temperature 1. If we examine attentively the nature
of the coefficient
K,
as
we have
defined
it
in Articles
68 and 135,
SECT. IX.]
129
we
perceive that
it
becomes
for the
flow
of heat
varies
directly as the area of the surface, and inversely as the distance between two infinite planes (Art. 72). As to the coefficient c which represents the product CD, it also depends on the unit of
mx
same time
m
is
m~
m
If
instead of K,
:
the
number
disappears after
these substitutions
unit of length
.3.
is 1,
that of
attribute to each quantity its own exponent of di mension, the equation will be homogeneous, since every term will
we
Numbers such
as $,
which repre
first
case,
Angles, sines, trigonometrical functions, logarithms or exponents of powers, are, according to the principles of analysis, absolute numbers which do
fore be
and other
not change with the unit of length their dimensions must there taken equal to 0, which is the dimension of all abstract
;
numbers.
If the unit of time,
t
which was at
first 1,
will
become
nt,
The
coefficients
K,
h, c will
become
of x,
K
1
t,
v with respect to
c.
and those of
h, c
are
1,
1, 0.
If the unit of temperature be changed, so that the temperature becomes that which corresponds to an effect other than the boiling of water and if that effect requires a less temperature, which is to that of boiling water in the ratio of 1 to the number pv will become vp, x and t will keep their values, and the coeffi
;
cients
K.
h, c will
become
table
P P P
indicates
The
following
undetermined quantities and the three constants, with respect to each kind of unit.
F. H.
130
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CH.
II.
SECT. IX.
162. If we retained the coefficients C and D, whose product has been represented by c, we should have to consider the unit of weight, and we should find that the exponent of dimension, with
respect to the unit of length, for G.
is
their transformations,
applying the preceding rule to the different equations and it will be found that they are homogeneous with respect to each kind of unit, and that the dimension of every
is
On
nothing.
If this
must have been committed in the case, abridged expressions must have been introduced.
error
If,
some
for
(6)
of Art. 105, V
dv
dt
d*v
hi
~~GD
~da?~
CDS
we
find that, with respect to the unit of length, the dimension of is it is 1 for the unit of temperature, ;
1 for the unit of time.
/ 2/2
and
In the equation v = Ae~x & of Art. 76, the linear dimen sion of each term is 0, and it is evident that the dimension of the
exponent x
A/ ^~
is
CHAPTER
III.
SECTION
I.
the varied
to the
uniform propagation, or to
by the foregoing methods, to problems of pure analysis, and the progress of this part of physics will depend in consequence upon the advance which may be made in the art of analysis.
The
differential
equations which
chief results of the theory ; they express, in the most general and most concise manner, the necessary relations of numerical
analysis to a very extensive class of phenomena; and they connect for ever with mathematical science one of the most
important branches of natural philosophy. It remains now to discover the proper treatment of these
equations in order to derive their complete solutions and an The following problem offers the easy application of them.
it example of analysis which leads to such solutions to us better adapted than any other to indicate the appeared elements of the method which we have followed.
first
164. Suppose a homogeneous solid mass to be contained between two planes B and G vertical, parallel, and infinite, and to be divided into two parts by a plane A perpendicular to the other two (fig. 7) we proceed to consider the temperatures of the mass BAC bounded by the three infinite planes A B, C.
; t
B AC
is
supposed to be a
constant source of heat, that is to say, all its points are main The two at the temperature 1, which cannot alter.
92
132
lateral
solids
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
III.
produced,
the
bounded, one by the plane C and the plane A other by the plane B and the plane A pro-
\c
duced, have at all points the constant temperature 0, some external cause maintaining them always at that temperature; and C have lastly, the molecules of the solid bounded by A,
the initial temperature 0. Heat will pass continually from the source A into the solid BAG, and will be propagated there in the longitudinal direction, which is infinite, and at the same
and
C,
which
will
ab
sorb great part of it. The temperatures of the solid will be raised gradually but will not be able to surpass nor even
:
BAG
to
attain
maximum
of temperature,
It
is
which
is
different
for
different
final
points
of the mass.
state to
and constant
which
approaches.
If this final state were
subsist
it
of itself,
all
and
this
known, and were then formed, it would is the property which distinguishes
problem consists in an infinite rect permanent temperatures solid, bounded by two masses of ice B and G, and a angular mass of boiling water A the consideration of such simple and primary problems is one of the surest modes of discovering the laws of natural phenomena, and we see, by the history of the
determining the
of
;
from
other states.
Thus the
actual
been formed in
this
manner.
briefly the same problem, suppose a rectangular plate BA C, of infinite length, to be heated at its base A, and to preserve at all points of the base a constant
165.
To express more
SECT.
I.]
133
temperature
two
infinite sides
and
C,
perpendicular to the base A, is submitted also at every point to a constant temperature 0; it is required to determine what
at
plate.
supposed that there is no loss of heat at the surface which is the same thing, we consider a solid
:
formed by superposing an infinite number of plates similar to the straight line Ax which divides the plate the preceding into two equal parts is taken as the axis of x, and the co-ordinates
are x and y lastly, the width of the plate represented by 21, or, to abridge the calculation, by IT, the value of the ratio of the diameter to the circumference of a
of any point
is
circle.
are
Imagine a point m of the solid plate B A (7, whose co-ordinates x and y, to have the actual temperature v, and that the quantities v, which correspond to different points, are such that
change can happen in the temperatures, provided that the temperature of every point of the base A is always 1, and that
110
the sides
and
C retain
If at each point a vertical co-ordinate be raised, equal to the temperature v, a curved surface would be formed which would extend above the plate and be prolonged to infinity.
We
endeavour to find the nature of this surface, which drawn above the axis of y at a distance equal to unity, and which cuts the horizontal plane of xy along two infinite straight lines parallel to x.
shall
166.
di
CD
\dx
dy
d
is
we must
made
of the co-ordinate
z,
so that the
term
az
-=,
-y-n
must be omitted
first
member
it
vanishes, since
;
we wish
to
134
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
III.
belongs to the actual problem, and determines the properties of the required curved surface, is the following
:
The function of a? and (x, y), which represents the per manent state of the solid BA G, must, 1st, satisfy the equation J TT or + \ir for y, 2nd, become nothing when we substitute (a) whatever the value of x may be 3rd, must be equal to unity when we suppose x = and y to have any value included between
y>
<f>
TT
and
+ i TT.
<
Further, this function (x, y) ought to become extremely when we give to x a very large value, since all the heat small proceeds from the source A.
167.
the
we shaTT then generalise the y, which satisfy equation (a) value of v in order to satisfy all the stated conditions. By this method the solution will receive all possible extension, and we
and
shall
prove
that
the
solution.
less
complex ex
when we
this is what may be remarked in alge braic functions which, in this particular case, take the form of the product of a function of x by a function of y.
We shall examine first if the value of v can be represented such a product for the function v must represent the state by of the plate throughout its whole extent, and consequently that
;
of the points
whose co-ordinate x
substituting in
is
infinite.
We
(a)
shall
then
write v
= F(x)f(y}\
by
F"
equation
and denoting
(x)
and
(*)
by/
(y\
we
.
shall
have
,/
(y)_
we then suppose
\^
=m
and
r^
=
m>>
being any
SECT.
I.]
135
constant quantity, and as it is proposed only to find a particular mx value of v, we deduce from the preceding equations F(x) = e~
}
168.
We
could not
finitely great.
In
fact,
y
constant source
only
no heat being supplied except from the an extremely small portion can arrive
at those parts of space which are very far removed from the The remainder is diverted more and more towards the source.
infinite
edges
and
C,
and
is
lost
which
bound them.
The exponent
is
lr
e~"
cosmy
unknown, and we may choose for this exponent any positive number: but, in order that v may become nul on making y = | TT or y = + |- TT, whatever x may be, m must be taken
to be
series,
1,
3,
5,
7,
&c.
by
this
be
fulfilled.
more general value of v is easily formed by adding 169. together several terms similar to the preceding, and we have
le~
3x
cos
3j/
-f-
ce~
5x
cos 5y
. .
f.
. .
It
is
(x, y)
(x,
satis!
the equation
-^ +
it
-=-
= 0,
TT)
= 0.
A
<f>
which is expressed thus, remark that this result must (0, y) exist when we give to y any value whatever included between \ TT and -f J TT. Nothing can be inferred as to the values which the function (0, y) would take, if we substituted in place of y a quantity not included between the limits J TT and -f J TT. Equation (b) must therefore be subject to the following condition
third condition remains to be fulfilled,
= 1, and
is
essential to
<f>
The
coefficients, a, b,
c,
d, &c.,
y,
which
is
equal to
136
so long as the variable and + ^ TT. It may be
THEOEY OF HEAT.
y
is
[CHAP.
III.
TT
exists,
but this
170.
difficulty will
Before giving the calculation of the coefficients, we by each one of the terms of
being proportional to the cosine of that distance in this case it will easily be seen what is the nature of the curved surface,
;
whose
temperature v or
fy (x, ?/).
by a plane perpendicular the curve which bounds the section will have
equation v
:
=a
a
cos
be the following
= a,
Z>=0,
= 0, d=
0,
and
so on,
will
be
cos y.
y,
If this surface
the
be a logarithmic spiral whose convexity is turned towards the axis; if it be cut at right angles to the axis of x, the section will be a trigonometric curve whose concavity is turned towards the axis.
section
will
It follows
-7-5-
is
ctx
always positive,
and
d*v
is
-^-3
always negative.
Now
position
between two
is
-^
ctoc
it
from that which precedes it, in the direction of x, more heat than it communicates to that which follows it. But, if the same mole cule be considered as situated between two others in the direction
of y, the function
--a
being negative,
it
SECT.
II.]
TRIGONOMETRIC SERIES.
it
37
more
from that which precedes it. Thus it follows that the excess of the heat which it acquires in the direc
heat than
tion of x,
it
receives
is
exactly compensated
?/.
by that
-^-2
whicn"
it
loses in the
direction
of
as
the
equation
ax
+ -y- =0
2
denotes.
Thus
dy
then the route followed by the heat which escapes from the
A becomes known. It is propagated in the direction and at the same time it is decomposed into two parts, one of which is directed towards one of the edges, whilst the other part continues to separate from the origin, to be decomposed The surface which like the preceding, and so on to infinity. we are considering is generated by the trigonometric curve which
source
of x,
corresponds to the base A, moved with its plane at right angles to the axis of x along that axis, each one of its ordinates de
creasing indefinitely in
same
fraction.
Analogous inferences might be drawn, if the fixed tempera tures of the base A were expressed by the term
b cos
3y or
and in
this
of the
move
be seen by the sequel that the movement is always compounded of a multi tude of elementary movements, each of which is accomplished
ment
of heat in the
for it will
as if
it
alone existed.
SECTION
II.
of heat.
171.
1
=a
cos
+b
cos oy
c cos
oy + d cos 7y
d,
+ &c.,
in
which the
coefficients a,
b,
c,
In
may
exist,
138
THEORY OF HEAT.
by
[CHAP.
III.
sarily satisfy the equations which are obtained differentiations ; whence the following results,
1
successive
= a cos y + b cos 3y + c cos 5y + d cos 1y -f &c., = a sin y + 3b sin 3y + 5c sin 5y + 7d sin 7y + &c., = a cos y + 3 & cos 3# + 5 c cos 5^ + 7 cos 7?/ + &c., = a sin y + 3 6 sin 3y + 5 c sin oy + Td sin 7y + &c.,
2 2 2
and so on to
infinity.
0+...&C.,
&c.,
t>
&c.
of these equations is infinite like that of the The problem consists in eliminating d, e, ... &c.
eliminations, the
number
of the
unknowns
a, b,
c,
d, ...&c., will
be supposed at first definite and equal to m. We shall employ the first equations only, suppressing all the terms containing If in succession m the unknowns which follow the m first. be made equal to 2, 3, 4, 5, and so on, the values of the un
knowns
quantity
of
will
a,
be found on each one of these hypotheses. for example, will receive one value for the
The
case
two unknowns, others for the cases of three, four, or successively a greater number of unknowns. It will be the same with the unknown 6, which will receive as many different values as there have been cases of elimination each one of the other unknowns is in like manner susceptible of an infinity of different values. Now the value of one of the unknowns, for the case in which
;
their
number
it
is
infinite, is
which
by means of the successive eliminations tend. It is required then to examine whether, according as the number of unknowns increases, the value of each one of a, b, c, d ... &c.
receives
it
continually
ap
SECT.
II.]
DETERMINATION
"OF
COEFFICIENTS.
139
:
Suppose the
1
be employed
2
Z>
-I-
10
10
10
10
The
2
five
2
Il =a(ll
-l )+
>
(H -3 )+ c(H -5 )+
2 2
2
J(ll
-7 )+ e(H -9
);
2 6 2 6 2 2 0=a(ll -l )+3 6(ir-3 )+5 c(ll -5 )+7 cZ(ll -7 )+9 e(ll -9 ), 2 2 8 2 2 0=a(ll -r)+3 6(ir-3 )+5 c(ll -5 )+7 ^(ir-7 )+9^(ll -9 ).
2
final
equation
2
.
a (ll
-1
(9
-1)
2
(7
-1
(5
-1
2 )
(3
2 )
ll 2 9
.
2
.
2
.
2
.
2
.
by
we had employed a number of equations greater we should have found, to determine a, an equation analogous to the preceding, having in the first member one 2 2 I and in the second member 13 2 factor more, namely, 13 The law to which these different values of for the new factor.
173.
If
unity,
a are subject
corresponds to
is
evident,
infinite
32
and
it
which
:
an
number
7
is
expressed thus
,
52
92
/Vrp
_ ~
Now
"Wallis*
is
known
and, in
.
accordance with
It is required
then
The
five
of / may be compared with the five simpler equations which would have been employed if there had been only five unknowns.
140
THEORY OF HEAT.
last
[CHAP.
III.
equations differ from the equations of Art. 172, in that in them e, d, c, b, a are found to be multiplied respec tively by the factors
The
n
"
-9
2
*
iv
It
~iY~
-jT
ir- 5
ir-3
ir-r
ir
~~Tr~
this that if we had solved the five linear which must have been employed in the case of five equations unknowns, and had calculated the value of each unknown, it would have been easy to derive from them the value of the unknowns of the same name corresponding to the case in which It would suffice to six equations should have been employed. found in the first case, by the multiply the values of e, d, c, b, a, known factors. It will be easy in general to pass from the value of one of these quantities, taken on the supposition of a certain number of equations and unknowns, to the value of the same quantity, taken in the case in which there should have been one unknown and one equation more. For example, if the value of e, found on the hypothesis of five equations and five unknowns, is represented by E, that of the same quantity, taken in the case
follows from
of one
unknown more,
will
be
E-II
j. JL
The same
for the
value, reason,
same
11*
-9* 13
-9"
and
unknowns
13 2
9* 13* -9*
it
will
2
be
E 11*II
and
from
so
15
"15*
-9"
on.
b,
it
will suffice
to
know
the
value of
it
corresponding to the case of two unknowns, to derive that of the same letter which corresponds to the cases
unknowns, &c.
We
9
2
shall only
have
to multiply
by
5
2 2 2
7 *7
-3
-3
-3
..
&c.
SECT.
II.]
DETERMINATION OF COEFFICIENTS.
141
if we knew the value of c for the case of three we should multiply this value by the successive factors unknowns,
Similarly
_r_
7*-5
2>
9*
ir
2 2
"
-5 ir-5
by
13
2
We
only,
and multiply
this value
II 2
The
is subject to the same rule, be taken for the case of one unknown, and multi
plied successively by
3
3*
5
s "
2 2
2 2
-1
The problem
value of a in the case of one unknown, the value of b in the case of two unknowns, that of c in the case of three unknowns, and so
on
unknowns.
It is easy to conclude,
by inspection only
of the equations
and
without any
nations
must be
It remains only to multiply the preceding quantities by 176. the series of products which ought to complete them, and which we have given (Art. 174). We shall have consequently, for the
142
final
THEORY OF HEAT.
values of the
:
[CHAP.
e,
III.
unknowns
a,
b,
c,
d,
f, &c.,
the following
expressions
6.8
f
_
6
.
4.10
2.12
_
4
.
___
2.16
4.18
11.11
*
1.1
8
.
3.3
12
5.5
14
7.7
2
.
13.13
4
.
10
16
20
22
1.1
10 12
.
3.3
8
.
5.5
6
.
7.7
4
.
9.9
2
.
1313
*
15.15
4 26
.
14
16
18
20
24
The quantity
equiva
Theorem, to
2.2
1
.
4.4
3
.
6.6 577
8.8
77 9
10.10
~97TT
12.12 11713
14.14 137T5
SECT.
If
II.
now
&c.,
we
notice
which must be joined on to numerators and denominators to complete the double series of odd and even numbers, we find that the factors to be supplied are
factors
:
-=V-
whence we conclude
177.
effected,
and the
1
c,
d, &c.,
cos 5y
The
tion
:
7T
- = COS 7/
1 - COS
1
-f
^COS
o
c 5?/
&c.
in value
^TT
The second member is a function of y, which does not change when we give to the variable y a value included between
and
-f |TT.
It
this
series
is
number whatever, and we approach more and more to a fixed value, so that the difference of this value from the sum of the calculated terms becomes less
than any assignable magnitude.
1
to say that writing instead of y any following the calculation of the coefficients,
Without stopping
or,
for a proof,
[E. L. E.]
It is a little better to
of c in
&,
&c.
The
coefficients a,
,
of Section vi.
might be determined, according to the methods by multiplying both sides of the first equation by cos y, cos 3?/,
b, c,
p. 106.
[A. F.]
144
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
III.
which
which the reader may supply, we remark that the fixed value is continually approached is JTT, if the value attributed and J-TT, but that it is to y is included between Jvr, if y is included between \TT and |TT for, in this second interval, each
;
term of the
series
is
series
changes in
sign.
convergence is not sufficiently rapid to produce an easy approxima tion, but it suffices for the truth of the equation.
178.
The equation
cos
3 O
,
ox + O
cos
ox
* cos 7%
/
&c.
belongs to a line which, having x for abscissa and y for ordinate, is composed of separated straight lines, each of which is parallel to
the axis, and equal to the
circumference.
These
parallels
are
situated alternately above and below the axis, at the distance JTT, and joined by perpendiculars which themselves make part of the
To form an exact idea of the nature of this supposed that the number of terms of the function
line.
line, it
must be
cos
7.
cos
3x
+5
cos
5x
&c.
has
first
a definite value.
= cos x
+5
cos
ox
&c.
belongs to a curved line which passes alternately above and below the axis, cutting it every time that the abscissa x becomes equal to one of the quantities
0,
185
7T,
7T,
7T,
&C.
According as the number of terms of the equation increases, the curve in question tends more and more to coincidence with the
preceding
line,
;
dicular lines
composed of parallel straight lines and of perpen so that this line is the limit of the different curves
SECT.
III.]
REMARKS OX THE
SERIES.
145
SECTION
Remarks on
179.
of view,
III.
these series.
We may
and prove
= cos x
case
- cos
- cos
o.x
^ cos 7x
verified
+Q
cos 9#
&c.
The
where x
7T
is
nothing
1
is
by Leibnitz
series,
7 4
11 11 =1 - + ^ - + - &C. o 3 9
7,
;
T=
/
7:
We
shall next
series
cos
+ o cos 5o:
-^
^ cos fa
/
+ &c.
instead of being infinite is finite and equal to m. shall con sider the value of the finite series to be a function of x and m.
We
We
by a
will
negative powers of m; and the function approaches more nearly to being constant and inde becomes greater. pendent of x, as the number
is
= cosxthe
Q o
cos
3.
-cos (2wi 1
l)a?,
7?i,
number
This equation
x gives
-r-
= sin x
sin
3#
+ sin
ox
sin
sin
7x
...
+
multiplying by 2 sin Zx,
2
sin
(2??i
3)
sin (2wi
1)
we have
2 sin
or
cfo
-y-
2# = 2
sin
# sin 2#
(2m
3j? sin
2#
+2
sin
5# sin 2^
...
+ 2 sin
F. H.
- 3)
sin 2,z
2 sin (2w
- 1) x sin 2#.
10
146
THEORY OF HEAT.
Each term
of the
cosines,
[CHAP.
III.
second
member being
that
replaced by the
difference of
two
we conclude
a?)
(-
- cos 3#
cos cos
x + cos 5x 3# - cos 7x
5#
cos
9x
-f
cos
(2i
5)
a?
-f
cos
cos
(2w (2m
-f
1)
cos
(2m
3x)
1) #.
to
1)
a-,
(2m
+ 1) x
cos
(2m
1
*/
or
2 sin 2marsiu
.r
sin %
hence
shall integrate the second member by parts, dis in the integral between the factor smZmxdx which tinguishing
180.
We
must be integrated
successively,
and the
;
factor
COSX
or
sec
which must be differentiated successively denoting the results of these differentiations by sec x, x, sec x, ... &c., we shall have
"
sec"
2y
= const.
2.m
x+
1
-
2m
:,
sin
2mx sec x
I
4-
o~*
cos
2m# sec x
-f
i\>c.
x
is
;r
cos
3x + o
cos
5x
^ cos 7x 7
. . .
2m -
cos
1
(2m
1 ) ;
.r,
which
series
a function of x and m, becomes expressed by an infinite and it is evident that the more the number m increases, the more the value of y tends to become constant. For this
;
reason,
is
infinite,
the function
y has a
definite value
SECT.
III.]
PARTICULAR CASES.
than
J-TT.
1-V7
value of
r, less
Now,
if
we have
1111
equal to
which
1
-
is
7T
= COS X
^ COS 3x 3
111
JTT.
Hence generally we
shall
have
+ - COS OX
o
= COS
7
181.
If in this equation
1
we assume x
=~
we
find
~ -^L_-1
_i_ 1 + 1 + JL lI 9 3~5"7
A
13
J:
15
by giving to the arc x other particular values, we should find other series, which it is useless to set down, several of which If we have been already published in the works of Euler. multiply equation (ft) by dx, and integrate it, we have
7TX
-T4*
= sm x
.
l-o ^ ^ sin 3^ + o sm o
1
1
T^>
sm * + tx
.
&c.
fl
7"
Making
x=
TT,
we
find
to infinity ; but it agrees better with the object of this work to determine, by following the same process, the values of the
different series
arcs.
182.
Let
sin
y=
x - ^ sin 2x +
^
-i
sin
3# - 7 sin 4#
1
- sin 1
. .
-m
We
[m
1)
1 -7?i
sin
mr,
m being any
= cos
-j-
even number.
cos
2# + cos ox
cos 4fx
+ cos (m
1)
cos
mx
102
148
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
III.
term of the second multiplying by 2 sin x, and replacing each the difference of two sines, we shall have member by
2 sin x
-T-
= sin
-
(x
+ x)
+
x)
sin (x
x)
sin (2a?
sin (3#
+ sin
(2x
- a;)
x)
+ a?)
sin (3a?
1)
a?
a;}
sin
{(??? -f
1)
a?
#}
+ #)
-f
sin
- x) (ma?
and, on reduction,
2 sin
a? --,-
dx
= sin x + sin w#
sin
sin (ma?
x}
the quantity
or
is
mx - sin
Ja;)
(?na;
+ a?),
-f
sin (wa?
+J a?
- sin (ma?
(wia;
4# + iar),
;
equal to
therefore
-2
sin
\x cos
Ja;)
we have
dn
sinA-a? 2
cos
mx
.
sin
a?
or
dy
<to
_1
2
cos
(mx 4- i#)
2 cos
whence we conclude
f
1
cos
(mx
2 cos
-}-fa)
fa
If
we
integrate
this
by
parts,
factor
r- or cos^x
factor
sec \x,
and the
times in
of
is
m+^
As
to
the constant
x.
it
SECT.
III.]
SPECIAL SERIES.
149
It follows
from
sin
sin
2# +
sin
3x
- sin 5x
-f-
p sin 7x
the
. . .
-- sin mx
differs
is
very
little
;
from that of
if
\x when
y
very great
and
this
number
is infinite,
equation
^x Zi
sin
^ sin 2x + ^ o
sin
3x
- 7 sin 4# -f
4<
-?
sin
5#
&c.
From
the last series, that which has been given above for
Let now
^
cos
2x
^ cos 4x
+-
cos
6x
. .
2m -2
COS ~
-~-
COS
~"
tx
Differentiating, multiplying by 2 sin 2x} substituting differences of cosines, and reducing, we shall have
the
ax
or
cos
x
(
2
=c-
f, rj \dx tan x
j
\dx
J
r, r^
sm
2??i
+
member, and
If
in
cosx
supposing supposing
equation
infinite,
we have y =
log cos x.
the
^ Z
cos
2x -
-r
T)
cos
x+find
cos
. . .
&c.
we suppose x
nothing,
we
therefore
=-
log 2
+ 5 log cos
ir.
series given
by Euler,
^
cos
= cos x -
- cos 2#
-f
3x -
-j
cos 4^
+ &c.
150
184.
THEORY OF HEAT.
Applying the same process
y = sin #4- O
sin
[CHAP.
III.
to tlie equation
2x 4-
sin
5x
4 - sin 7x 4 &c.,
i
we
TT
4
It
=
7
sin
7x
-,-
sin
9.
4-
&c.
must be observed with respect to all these series, that the equations which are formed by them do not hold except when the variable x is included between certain limits. Thus
the function
cos
-^
cos
%x 4 v
cos 5x
^ cos 7x
i
+ &c.
is
is
not equal to
JTT,
except
when
the variable x
contained
It is the
same
23
- sin 2x
4-
sin
%x
-r
sin
4#
- sin ox
o
&c.
This infinite
series,
which
\x
it is
so long as the arc x is not equal to %x, if the arc exceeds TT;
always convergent, has the value and less than TT. But greater than
is it
\x
it
from x
TT
to
x=
2ir,
sign
all
the function takes with the contrary had in the preceding interval from
x=
This series has been known for a long time, to x TT. the analysis which served to discover it did not indicate but why the result ceases to hold when the variable exceeds TT.
The method which we are about to employ must therefore be examined attentively, and the origin of the limitation to which each of the trigonometrical series is subject must be sought.
185.
To
arrive at
it,
it
is
sufficient to
values
expressed by
infinite
are not
terms which complete them can be assigned it must therefore be supposed that we employ only the first terms of these series,
;
This
may be
to
ir
as in Art. 222.
[R. L. E.]
SECT.
III.]
LIMITS OF
THE REMAINDER.
is
151
included must
We
will
1
-
y = cos x
+o
cos ox
^ cos tx 7
...
~
The number
is
2m - 3
represented by
,
,
2m - 1
of terms
is
even and
sin
is
from
,,
it
infer the
Now the integral fuvdx value of y, by integration by parts. be resolved into a series composed of as many terms as may
may be
desired, u
x.
We may
I
write, for
example,
I
uvdx
c -f u
vdx
=-
dxj
\dx Ivdx
j
+ -j
dx
.,
Idx dxlvdx
J J J
an equation which
is
verified
by
differentiation.
u, it will
Denoting
2//
sin
2mx by
and sec x by
be found that
o sec"o;
=c
-T
sec
sin 2??^
+^
7
cos 2
\
*)<
K*-&?-**
186.
It is required
,
I
sec"
now
between which
series
the integral
is
-^3
[d(sQc"x)
cos 2nix]
To form this integral an infinity of values must included. be given to the arc x, from 0, the limit at which the integral begins, up to oc, which is the final value of the arc for each one of these values of x the value of the differential d x) must
;
(sec"
be determined, and that of the factor cos 2mx, and all the partial now the variable factor cos 2mx is products must be added
:
necessarily a positive
integral
is
or
composed
fZ(scc".r),
of the
differential
152
THEORY OF HEAT.
total value of tlie integral is
[CHAP.
III.
The
then
less
differentials
(sec
a?),
taken from x
:
up
to
the first case we replace the constant quantity 1, and in 1 the second case we replace this factor by now the sum of the differentials d (sec" x), or which is the same thing, the integral
for in
tlie
2mx by
{d
(sec"
x),
taken from x
= 0,
is
sec"
sec
sec"
is
a certain
function of x, and sec"0 is the value of this function, taken on the supposition that the arc x is nothing.
The
that
is
integral required
is
+
negative,
(sec"*e
sec"
and
(sec"
sec"
0)
to say, representing
we have always
/ {d
(sec"
x) cos
=k
x
(sec"
sec"
0).
2m
sec
cos
2mx +
2m
sec
sin
Zmx +
8 2ra3
sec"
x cos Imx
in
^
.-
(sec"
sec"
fib
sum
If we had investigated two terms only we should have 187. had the equation
2t/
= c-~ I
*///
sec
sec
x sin 2mx + -^
^
j c
z
7/&
(sec
x- sec
O).
this it follows that we can develope the value of y in many terms as we wish, and express exactly the remainder the series we thus find the set of equations
From
as
of
*2i/
=c
c
2 in
x
2??^
sec
cos
2mx-^mt %
2
^k
(sec
sec 0),
2y
sec
x cos 2mx+
^m
sec
sec 0),
2y
=c
-^w
sec x cos
%mx+ TT
2w
sec
# sin 2m^ 4-
^m 2
/72-
sec"
cos
2m#
/\\
Hr
n~s
1.
"
(sec
a;
sec
0).
SECT.
III.]
153
The number k which enters into these equations is not the same for all, and it represents in each one a certain quantity 1 which is always included between 1 and m is equal to the number of terms of the series
;
cos
- cos 3# o
is
+5
cos
5x
. . .
~ili
-^
cos
(2m
1)
whose sum
denoted by
y.
188. These equations could be employed if the number m were given, and however great that number might be, we could determine as exactly as we pleased the variable part of the value of y. If the number m be infinite, as is supposed, we consider first equation only; and it is evident that the two terms the which follow the constant become smaller and smaller; so that
is
determined by assuming x
conclude
--
4
It
= COS X
is
= COS Sx
3
easy to see
+ - COS
o
DX
;=
COS
7# +
T:
COS 9.E
&C.
now
arc x
is less
than
value
\ir.
In
that the result necessarily holds if the fact, attributing to this arc a definite
as near to JTT as
we
please,
(sec
we can always
a;
give to in
sec 0),
which completes
;
becomes
less
than any quantity whatever but the is based on the fact that the term
x acquires no value which exceeds all possible limits, whence same reasoning cannot apply to the case in which the arc x is not less than JTT. The same analysis could be applied to the series which express the values of Ja?, log cos x, and by this means we can assign the limits between which the variable must be included, in order
follows that the
that the result of analysis may be free from moreover, the same problems may be treated
all
uncertainty otherwise by a
;
principles
The expression of the law of fixed temperatures in 189. a solid plate supposed the knowledge of the equation
1
Cf.
De Morgan
s Eiff.
and
609.
[A. F.]
154
TT
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
I
III.
= cos x
1
;
cos
3x
-f
-z
cos
5#
= cos / #
+
is
cos 9u;
&c.
g
as follows
:
of two arcs is equal to JTT, a quarter of the the product of their tangent is 1; we have there circumference,
the
sum
fore in general
i
- TT
arc tan
-f
arc tan a
the symbol arc tan u denotes the length of the arc whose tangent is u, and the series which gives the value of that arc is well known whence we have the following result
:
instead of u in equation
(c),
and
in
equa
= arc
=
tan e x ^~ L
arc tan e~ x
^/
~l
j
and j 4
TT
= cos x
cos
ox
o
series of equation
(b)
--
cos ox
o
is
^ cos 7x
/
-}-
-r-
cos 9*i
&c.
The
equation
or
ITT.
(d)
(Art.
180)
is
SECTION
IV.
General solution.
We can now form the complete solution of the problem 190. which we have proposed .for the coefficients of equation (b) but to substitute (Art. 1G9) being determined, nothing remains and we have them,
;
.= e~
cos
-e~"
cos 3y
4-
e~
Bx
cos 5y
7r
e"
cos 7.y
&c....(a).
SECT. IV.]
1,55
This value of v
satisfies
the equation
-j
+ -^ =
it
becomes
;
JTT lastly, nothing when we give to y a value equal to \TT or it is equal to unity when x is nothing and y is included between
Thus all the physical conditions of the problem are exactly fulfilled, and it is certain that, if we give to each
^TT
and
+ |TT.
point of the plate the temperature which equation (a) deter be maintained at the same time at the mines, and if the base
temperature
ture
0, it
and the infinite edges B and C would be impossible for any change
1,
at the
tempera
to occur in the
system of temperatures.
191.
of equation
(a)
of an exceedingly convergent series, it is always easy to deter mine numerically the temperature of a point whose co-ordinates os and y are known. The solution gives rise to various results
which
it
is
general theory. If the point m, whose fixed temperature is considered, is very distant from the origin A, the value of the second member of
the equation
to this
(a)
will
e~
cos
it
reduces
term
if
is infinite.
The equation
solid
e~
cos y represents
also
a state of the
once formed
which would be preserved without any change, if it were the same would be the case with the state repre;
4
sented by the equation v
O7T
3x
cos %y,
term of the
the
same property. All these partial systems exist at once in that which equation (a) represents they are superposed, and with respect to each of them the movement of heat takes place In the state which corresponds to any as if it alone existed.
;
base
one of these terms, the fixed temperatures of the points of the A differ from one point to another, and this is the only con dition of the problem which is not fulfilled ; but the general state
which results from the sum of
all
the terms
condition.
is
considered
is
156
THEORY OF HEAT.
origin, the
is
[CHAP.
of heat
is less
III.
movement
com
for if
the distance x
is very small with respect to that which precedes it, the state of the heated plate is sensibly represented by so that the first three terms, or by the first two, or by the first only, for those parts of the plate which are more and more distant
from the
origin.
whose vertical ordinate measures the formed by adding the ordinates of a temperature multitude of particular surfaces whose equations are
The curved
surface
v,
fixed
is
^=
The
e*
cos y,
~=- K
3*
cos
3#
5*
=^"
cos 5 y
&c.
first
is infinite,
when x
If the difference v
considered to be
the ordinate of a curved surface, this surface will coincide, when x Zx e~ cos 3y. All is infinite, with that whose equation is ^irv 2 = the other terms of the series produce similar results.
The same
results
if
origin, instead of being bounded as in the actual hypothesis by a straight line parallel to the axis of y, had any figure whatever
parts.
le~
cos 3y,
ce~
5x
and have a
Each of them necessary relation to the phenomena of heat. a simple mode according to which heat is established expresses
in a rectangular plate, whose infinite sides retain The general system of temperatures a constant temperature. is compounded always of a multitude of simple systems, and the
and propagated
arbitrary
but the
coeffi
192. Equation (a) may be employed to determine all the circumstances of the permanent movement of heat in a rect angular plate heated at its origin. If it be asked, for example,
what
is
is
to
say,
SECT. IV.]
157
what
is
the base
the quantity which, during a given time, passes across and replaces that which flows into the cold masses
and
(7;
we must
is
axis of
expressed by
K^-.
therefore
amount
of the flow,
is
K-j-dy.
= 4- JTT, in order integrated between the limits y = \-rr and y to ascertain the whole quantity which passes the base, or which is the same thing, must be integrated from y to y = JTT, and
the result doubled.
in
The quantity
-,CLJO
is
a function of x and
y,
which x must be made equal to 0, in order that the calculation may refer to the base A, which coincides with the axis of y. The
expression for the expenditure of the source of heat
fore
is
there
to
2lfKj-dy}.
ITT
;
The
integral
y=
but
if,
in the function
-j-
0,
x = x,
the quantity of heat which flows in unit of time across a trans verse edge at a distance x from the origin.
If we wish to ascertain the quantity of heat which, 193. during unit of time, passes across a line drawn on the plate
parallel to the edges
and
C,
K
;
-j~
and, multiplying
it by the element dx of the line drawn, integrate with respect to x between the given boundaries of the line thus
the integral
A K dy dx)
If
-j-
line
and
if
unit of time, escapes from the plate across the infinite edge C. may next compare the latter quantity with the expenditure
We
158
of the source of heat;
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
III.
for the source must necessarily supply the heat which flows into the masses B and C. If continually this compensation did not exist at each instant, the system of temperatures would be variable.
194.
Equation
(a)
gives
e~
sx
V
-
=
7T
CLJC
(e~
cos y
cos 3y
+ e~
cos
oy
x
e~"
cos
7y
+ &c.);
2/
= 0, we
^
e~
7*
have
sin
( e~
sin y
- e~ 5x sin
3y +
e~
5x
sin oy
7y
-f
&c.
If y be
_ sv
4-^e
fg
as the expression for the quantity of heat which, during unit of time, crosses a line parallel to the base, and at a distance x from
that base.
From
equation
x
(a)
we
derive also
e~
Bx
= --j-
(e~
sin y
sin
Sy + e~
zx
sin
oy
e~
lx
sin
7y +
&c.)
K
(1
-j-
x = 0,
sin
is
{(1
e~")
sin
?/
3:
e"
")
sin 3?/
(1
e"
*)
5y
when x
If this quantity be subtracted from the value which is made infinite, we find
it
assumes
7T
(
e~
\
sin
e~
3x
sin
Sy + ^ O
e~*
sin
oy
&c.
)
have an expression for the whole quantity of heat which crosses the infinite edge C, from the point whose distance from the origin is x up to the end of the
and, on
making
?/
= j7r, we
plate
namely,
SECT. IV.]
159
which is evidently equal to half the quantity which in the same time passes beyond the transverse line drawn on the plate at
a distance x from the origin. We have already remarked that this result is a necessary consequence of the conditions of the
if it did not hold, the part of the ; plate which is situated beyond the transverse line and is prolonged to infinity would not receive through its base a quantity of heat equal to
problem
that which
it
loses
preserve
195.
its state,
through its two edges it could not therefore which is contrary to hypothesis.
;
to the expenditure of the source of heat, it is found in the preceding expression ; hence it assumes by supposing x an infinite value, the reason for which is evident if it be remarked
As
has and
retains the temperature 1 parallel lines which are very near to this base have also a temperature very little different from
unity: hence, the extremities of all these lines contiguous to the cold masses E and C communicate to them a quantity of heat incomparably greater than if the decrease of temperature
In the first part of the were continuous and imperceptible. at the ends near to B or (7, a cataract of heat, or an plate,
infinite flow, exists.
x becomes
196.
appreciable.
of the base has
2^,
The length
it
been denoted by
TT.
If
y,
we
and
X
1
assign to
any value
of
by
~
77"
we must
write JTT
-.-
Denoting by
replace v
(a),
A
-r
.
we must
by
in the equation
v
we have
.
=
7T
e""**
cos
--.
~u
cos 3
4~,
Z.I
J.L
- e~ ~M 3
cos 5 4,7
1
-^6
cos7^ + &c.J
().
This equation represents exactly the system of permanent temperature in an infinite rectangular prism, included between
two masses of
ice
B and
(7,
heat.
160
197.
THEORY OF HEAT.
It is easy to see either
[CHAP.
III.
of this equation, or from Art. 171, that heat is propagated in this solid, by sepa rating more and more from the origin, at the same time that it
is
by means
and
G.
Each
section
parallel to that of the base is traversed by a wave of heat which is renewed at each instant with the same intensity: the intensity
diminishes as the section becomes more distant from the origin. Similar movements are effected with respect to any plane parallel
to the infinite faces; each of these planes .is traversed stant wave which conveys its heat to the lateral masses.
by a con
The developments contained in the preceding articles would be unnecessary, if we had not to explain an entirely new theory, whose principles it is requisite to fix. With that view we add
the following remarks.
Each of the terms of equation (a) corresponds to only 198. one particular system of temperatures, which might exist in a rectangular plate heated at its end, and whose infinite edges are
Thus the equation temperature. the permanent temperatures, when the represents are subject to a fixed temperature, denoted points of the base cos y. now imagine the heated plate to be part of a by may
maintained
at
constant
= e~x cos y
We
plane which is prolonged to infinity in all directions, and denoting the co-ordinates of any point of this plane by x and y, and the
temperature of the same point by v we may apply to the entire x plane the equation v = e~ cos y by this means, the edges B and G receive the constant temperature but it is not the same with contiguous parts BB and CO they receive and keep lower
t ; ; ;
The base has at every point the permanent denoted by cos y, and the contiguous parts AA have temperature higher temperatures. If we construct the curved surface whose
temperatures.
vertical ordinate is equal to the permanent temperature at each point of the plane, and if it be cut by a vertical plane passing
through the line A or parallel to that line, the form of the section will be that of a trigonometrical line whose ordinate represents
surface be cut
the infinite and periodic series of cosines. If the same curved by a vertical plane parallel to the axis of x, the
will
through
its
SECT. IV.]
1G1
199. By this it may be seen how the analysis satisfies the two conditions of the hypothesis, which subjected the base to a temperature equal to cosy, and the two sides B and C to the
temperature
0.
When we
express these t\vo conditions we solve problem If the heated plate formed part of
:
an
infinite plane,
all
the points
of the plane, in order that the system may be self-permanent, and that the fixed temperatures of the infinite rectangle may be those
which are given by the hypothesis ? We have supposed in the foregoing part that some external causes maintained the faces of the rectangular solid, one at the temperature 1, and the two others at the temperature 0. This effect may be represented in different manners; but the hypo
thesis proper to the investigation consists in regarding the prism as part of a solid all of whose dimensions are infinite, and in deter
mining the temperatures of the mass which surrounds it, so that the conditions relative to the surface may be always observed.
200. To ascertain the system of permanent temperatures in a rectangular plate whose extremity A is maintained at the tem perature 1, and the two infinite edges at the temperature 0, we
might consider the changes which the temperatures undergo, from the initial state which is given, to the fixed state which is
the object of the problem.
would be determined
and
it
might then
be supposed that the value was infinite. The method which we have followed
is different,
and conducts
since
it
is
more
to
directly to the expression of the final founded on a distinctive property of that state.
state,
We
now proceed
shew that the problem admits of no other solution than that which we have stated. The proof follows from the following
propositions.
201.
If
we give
an
infinite rectangular
by equation
(2),
and
if
at the
two
edges
end
line
A A
maintain the fixed temperature 0, whilst the is exposed to a source of heat which keeps all points of the at the fixed temperature 1; no change can happen in the
solid.
and
C we
state
F.
of the
H.
In
fact,
the equation
-y-a
-=-$
being
162
satisfied, it is
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
III.
evident (Art. 170) that the quantity of heat which determines the temperature of each molecule can be neither increased nor diminished.
The
= <f*(x,y), suppose temperatures expressed by equation that instead of maintaining the edge A at the temperature 1, the and C be given to it as to the two lines fixed temperature
(a)
same
solid
or v
BAG
that edges A, B, C, and by hypothesis it will not be replaced, so will diminish continually, and their final and the temperatures common value will be zero. This result is evident since the
have a temperature points infinitely distant from the origin infinitely small from the manner in which equation (a) was
formed.
The same effect would take place in the opposite direction, if the system of temperatures were v = (x, y), instead of being v = (j) (x, y) that is to say, all the initial negative temperatures would vary continually, and would tend more and more towards
(f>
A, B,
preserved the
temperature
202.
0.
y) be a given equation which expresses the initial temperature of points in the plate C, whose base is maintained at the temperature 1, whilst the and C edges
Let v
= $ (x,
BA
0.
Let y} be another given equation which expresses the initial temperature of each point of a solid plate exactly the same as the preceding, but whose three edges B, A, G are
BAG
0.
solid the variable state which suc determined by the equation v = y, t\ t denoting the time elapsed, and that the equation v = (x, y, t) determines the variable state of the second solid, for which the
first
is
(f>(x,
<3>
initial
y}.
Lastly, suppose a third solid like each of the two preceding: let v =f(x, y) + F(x y) be the equation which represents its initial state, and let 1 be the constant temperature of the base
t
and
and
C.
SECT. IV.]
SUPERPOSITION OF EFFECTS.
163
is
We proceed to shew that the variable state of the third solid determined by the equation v = y, t} + y, ) In fact, the temperature of a point m of the third solid varies,
(f>(x,
<!>(#,
because that molecule, whose volume is denoted by M, acquires or loses a certain quantity of heat A. The increase of tempera
ture during the instant dt
is
volume.
the
the coefficient c denoting the specific capacity with respect to The variation of the temperature of the same point in
first
solid
is
~^
dt,
and
^dt
in the
second, the
letters
d and
Now
it it
is
easy
to
For proof equal to d + D. receives from another point quantity of heat which the point the interior of the plate, or to the edges which belonging
is
sufficient
"to
temperature is denoted by fv the molecule m, a quantity of heat expressed by qj.f^ f)dt the factor q l representing a certain function of the distance between the two molecules. Thus the
??&,,
whose
initial
dt, to
t
whole quantity of heat acquired by in is S.q^f^f^jdt, the sign 2 expressing the sum of all the terms which would be found by considering the other points m z m 5 ??? 4 &c. which act on m that is to say, writing q 2 ,/ or ^3 ,/3 or q^ /4 and so on, instead of 2
, ,
F)dt will be found to be q v v In the same manner ^q (Fl the expression of the whole quantity of heat acquired by the same point in of the second solid and the factor q l is the same
term 2$\C/i f)dt, since the two solids are formed of the same matter, and the position of the points is the same; we have then
as in the
d=
*?,(./;
-/)*
and
D = Sfc(F, -
F)dt,
it
hence
A=d+D
and
A d T) -^ = ;, -f -j-, cM cM cM
112
164
It follows
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
III.
from this that the molecule m of the third solid acquires, during the instant dt, an increase of temperature equal to the sum of the two increments which the same point would
first
solids.
Hence
at the
end of the
the original hypothesis will again hold, since any molecule whatever of the third solid has a temperature equal
to the
sum
of those
which
it
Thus the
same
relation exists at the beginning of each instant, that is to the variable state of the third solid can always be represented say,
by the equation
203.
The preceding
proposition
is
applicable to
all
relative to the
problems It shews
that the
each of which
effected separately as if it alone existed. This superposition of simple effects is one of the fundamental elements in the theory of heat. It is expressed in the investigation, by
the very nature of the general equations, and derives from the principle of the communication of heat.
<
its
origin
Let now v (x, y] be the equation (a) which expresses the permanent state of the solid plate BAG, heated at its end A, and whose edges B and C preserve the temperature i; the initial state
of the plate
is
have a nul temperature, except those of the base A, whose tem The initial state can then be considered as formed perature is 1. of two others, namely a first, in which the initial temperatures are
:
y), the three edges being maintained at the temperature and a second state, in which the initial temperatures are +
(j>(x,
0,
<j>(x,y),
the two edges and C preserving the temperature 0, and the base the temperature 1; the superposition of these two states produces the initial state which results from the hypothesis. It
remains then only to examine the movement of heat in each one of the two partial states. Now, in the second, the system of tem peratures can undergo no change and in the first, it has been
;
remarked in Article 201 that the temperatures vary continually, and end with being nul. Hence the final state, properly so called, is that which is represented by v = $ (x, y] or equation (a).
SECT. IV.]
If this state
IS
UNIQUE.
165
first it would be self-existent, and which has served to determine it for us. If the solid plate be supposed to be in another initial state, the differ ence between the latter state and the fixed state forms a partial After a considerable time, state, which imperceptibly disappears. and the system of fixed tem the difference has nearly vanished, Thus the variable temper peratures has undergone no change. atures converge more and more to a final state, independent of
it is
this property
if
would form a
partial state,
which ought to be
although the edges A, B, C were maintained at the Now the last effect cannot occur; similarly if we 0. temperature another source of heat independent of that which flows supposed
from the origin A] besides, this hypothesis is not that of the problem we. have treated, in which the initial temperatures are nul. It is evident that parts very distant from the origin can
only acquire an exceedingly small temperature. Since the final state which must be determined
follows that the
is
unique,
it
problem proposed admits no other solution than Another form may be that which results from equation (a). to this result, but the solution can be neither extended nor given restricted without rendering it inexact. The method which we have explained in this chapter consists in formnig fiFst very simple particular values, which agree with the .problem, and in rendering the solution more general, to the
intent that v or
</>
(as,
y)
may
namely
might be followed, and the would necessarily be the same as the foregoing. We shall not stop over the details, which are easily supplied, when once the solution is known. We shall only give in the fol lowing section a remarkable expression for the function (x, y] whose value was developecTm a convergent series in equation (a).
It is clear that the contrary order
solution obtained
</>
166
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
III.
SECTION
V.
205.
+ -3-3 = O, which
1
contains
imaginary
quantities, under the sign of the arbitrary functions. confine ourselves here to the remark that the integral
v=<!>(x+yj
We
shall
= e~x cos y
^ o
e~
Zx
cos
3y
-f
^
5
e~
5x
cos
oy
&c.
In
fact,
we have
- &c.
The
first series is
a function of
of
x
1.
yJ\,
series is the
same function
series
x + yj
Comparing these
with the
known development
of arc tan z
in functions of z its tangent, it is immediately seen that the first ** f3r and the second is if is arc tan e arc tan e thus \
^^
equation
(a)
~ = arc tan
In this mode
v
it
- (x+v e
^+
and
arc tan e
-<*-
v=r
>
+ yj~\) + ^(x-yj~^l)
e~",
.........
(A),
the function
1
(z) is
arc tan
i|r (z).
I.
p. 105.
[A. F.]
SECT. V.]
167
If in equation (B)
ber by
of the second
mem
whence
tan (p
+ g)
N
or
-ftan p
-f
tan a
==
tan
p
1
tan q
x
(
2 cos y
;
-^
e
.f
= arc tan
/2 cos y\ --
\&
_-} ...(..(G). J
This value of v or
c/>
(x,
ends of the
solid,
namely,
(x,
JTT)
70
0,
and
(j>
(0,
y}
=1
72
satisfies also
0,
since
equa
is a transformation of equation (B). Hence it represents the system of permanent temperatures ; and since that exactly state is unique, it is impossible that there should be any other
tion ((7)
solution, either
more general
or
more
restricted.
The equation (C) furnishes, by means of tables, the value of one of the three unknowns v, x, y when two of them are given; it very clearly indicates the nature of the surface whose vertical
}
ordinate
is
solid plate.
the permanent temperature of a given point of the Finally, we deduce from the same equation the values
ax
and
velo-
and
expressed thus,
dx
dv
It
may be remarked
-j-
-j-
and
that of
sums may be
easily
168
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
III.
We
stated.
-3-
and
-r-
which
ace
ay
the
first
we have just
dealt with
is
which
we have solved in the theory of heat, or rather in that part of It the theory which requires the employment of analysis.
furnishes very easy numerical applications, whether we make use of the trigonometrical tables or convergent series, and it
represents
heat.
exactly
all
the circumstances
of
the
movement
of
We
SECTION
VI.
series.
The problem
of
d 2v
-y-g
d v + -=- =
and
if
it
be supposed that all the points of one of the faces of the solid have a common temperature, the coefficients a, b, c, d etc. cf
}
the series
a cos x
b cos
3x +
c cos
5#
4-
cos
7x
...
&c.,
must be determined so that the value of this function may be equal to a constant whenever the arc x is included between JTT and + JTT. The value of these coefficients has just been assigned; but herein we have dealt with a single case only of a more general
;
problem, which consists in developing any function whatever in an infinite series of sines or cosines of multiple arcs. This
problem
is
connected with
the
theory
of
partial
differential
equations, and has been attacked since the origin of that analysis. It was necessary to solve it, in order to integrate suitably the
we proceed
to
explain
We
shall
required, to
examine, in the first place, the case in which it is reduce into a series of sines of multiple arcs, a
function
SECT. VI.]
variable.
160
<
(x),
we arrange the
-f
equation
(j)
(x)
=a
sin
x+
b sin
2x
-f c
sin
3x
+ d sin
4<x
. . .
&c.,
in
which
c,
a, b,
<^(^)
required to determine the value of the coefficients First we write the equation d, &c.
it is
!_
l_
2.
in
which
lv
<
(0),
<"(0),
<
"(0),
(0),
by the
coefficients
(x)
dx
dx*
da?
dx*
in them. when we suppose x Thus, representing the develop ment according to powers of x by the equation
we have
<j>
(0)
0,
and
<f>
(0)
= A,
&c.
If
&c.
<j)(x)
now we compare the preceding equation with the equation = a sin x + b sin 2x + c sin 3# + J sin + e sin 5^ &c.,
4<x
-|-
member with
respect to powers of x,
we
A=a+
3c
3
cZ
These equations serve to find the coefficients a, b, c, d, e, To determine them, we first re &c., whose number is infinite. the number of unknowns as finite and equal to m thus gard we suppress all the equations which follow the first m equations,
;
170
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
III.
and we omit from each equation all the terms of the second member which follow the first m terms which we retain. The whole number m being given, the coefficients a, b, c, d, e, &c. have Different fixed values which may be found by elimination. values would be obtained for the same quantities, if the number of the equations and that of the unknowns were greater by one
the
Thus the value of the coefficients varies as we increase number of the coefficients and of the equations which ought It is required to find what the limits are to determine them. towards which the values of the unknowns converge continually as the number of equations increases. These limits are the true values of the unknowns which satisfy the preceding equations when their number is infinite.
unit.
208.
We
Suppose that we denote as follows different systems of equa tions analogous to those from which the values of the coefficients
must be derived
a^
= A^
aa
+ 26 = A
2
a ,
a3
+ 2& + 3c = A
3 3
3c4
3c5
&c.
&c .........
................ (b).
SECT. VI.] If
five
171
of the
now we
unknown
&)
5
,
e&
by means
A B C D
2
2 )
E.., &c.,
we
find
a. (5
a 5 (5
- I + 2\ (5 - 2 + 3\ (5 - 3 - I ) + 2 (5 - 2 + 3 c (5 - 3
2 2 2
)
)
2
o5
(5
-I +2
2
(5
- 2 + 3V
2
(5
-3
We could have deduced these four equations from the four which form the preceding system, by substituting in the latter
instead of
c4 ,
rf
4f
(5
2
(5
-3 )c -4 )c/
2
2
and instead of
A B C
t ,
A^
5 Jf-C-., 5
(7.
-/>.,
4I
By
similar substitutions
to the number m-f-1. Writing in order all the between the quantities which correspond to one of the cases and those which correspond to the following case, we shall have
= cs (5 - 3 ),
2 2
rf
= rf
(5
-4
),
172
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
III.
We
have also
&c.
From
equations
we conclude
is
infinite,
by
a,
b,
c,
d,
e,
&c.,
un we must
(3*
(4
2 )
(5
(6
-2
2
)
. .
~
(4
(5
-3)
2
(6
- 3 ) (T - 3 )
2
2
. . .
d=
(5*
2
)
(G
(T
-4)
2
(8
2 )
. . .
&c.
&c
(e).
209.
It
;
d4
ee ,
&c.
the
is
remains then to determine the values of a lt 6 2 c 8 first is given by one equation, in which A enters;
,
the second
third
so on.
is
given by two equations into which A 2 BZ enter; the given by three equations, into which A 3 B3 C3 enter ; and
It follows
from
this that if
we knew the
Af^CJ),...,
values of
&c.,
A
we
19
AB
2
ABC
3
3
could easily find a x by solving one equation, a 2 & 2 by solving two equations, a 3 b 3 c 3 by solving three equations, and so on after
:
a, b } c, d, e,
&c.
It is required
then
...,
&c,
1st, we find the value of A 2 in by means of equations (d). terms of A and 52 2nd, by two substitutions we find this value %
;
of
in
terms of
A BC
3 3
3rd,
by three substitutions we
find the
SECT. VI.]
173
successive
same value
values of
in terms of
and
so on.
The
are
A,
A\ 3
2
2
.
- B, (2
2
2
.
+ 22
-
+3
2
2
.
4
-
+
2
2
<7
(2
-
+3 +4 -D
2 2
)
-
^^J^ ^ ^ ^ -^^ 22
2 2
82
^
2
.
22 - 32 5
2
^
6
22 42
2
^
2
32 42 52 )
-
+C -D
the law of which
is
(2
2
(2
+ 2 4 + 2 .5 + 3 .4 + 3 + 3 + 4 + 5 ) + E &c.,
3
2
.5
+4
.5
2 )
readily noticed.
The
which
is
that which
we wish
with an
A, B,
are
C,
D, E,
;
&c.,
known
same
as those
tions (a).
A
2
by the
product
2 .3 .4 .5 .6 ...&c.,
we have
"
D
(.2*.
3".
4"
+
2". 3".
+
3".
+ &C
4".
5"
.S
.^.o 1
^~4\ff
+ &C + &C
)
The numerical coefficients are the sums of the products which could be formed by different combinations of the fractions
1
I
after
2
i
2"
i
3"
i
5
2
i
6*"
Ac
If
having
removed the
first
fraction
p.
we represent
...
lf
Q R^ Slt TI}
x ,
&c.,
and
(e)
and the
first
of equa
we
first coefficient a,
the equation
2 .3 .4 .5
...
CQ l
DR + ES - &c.,
V l
174
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
ITT.
Slt T^... &c. may be easily deter the quantities lt lt Q lf mined, as we shall see lower down hence the first coefficient a
now
;
must pass on now to the investigation of the follow ing coefficients b, c, d, e, &c., which from equations (e) depend on the quantities 6 2 c3 d4 e s &c. For this purpose we take up equations (6), the first has already been employed to find the value of ffj, the two following give the value of 6 2 the three value of d4 and following the value of C 3 the four following the
210.
, ,
, ,
We
so on.
On completing the calculation, we find by simple inspection of the equations the following results for the values of 6 2 c s r74 &c.
,
3c 3 (I
4<Z
-3
2
)
(2
2
-3 =A
2
)
2
.
2
)
2
-B
2
.
2
z
(I
+2 +
)
<7
2 4
(l
-4 )(2 -4 )(3 -4
2 2
2
= .4
2
.
2
.
-^
(I
+2
.3
+ C
(1
-f
2
)
-7>
&c.
It is easy to perceive the
it
remains only
&c.
to
determine
AB
n
A BC
2 3
A$f!v
Now the quantities A.2 B2 can be expressed in terms of 3 B3 C3 B4 C4 D4 For this purpose it suffices to the latter in terms of 4
,
the substitutions indicated by equations (d) the successive changes reduce the second members of the preceding equations so as to contain only the CD, &c. with an infinite suffix,
effect
;
AB
that
is
to say, the
(a)
;
known
quantities
ABCD,
equations
the coefficients
become the
products
which can be made by combining the squares of the numbers It need only be remarked that the first 1*2*3*4*5* to infinity.
of these squares I will not enter into the coefficients of the 2 value of a t that the second 2 will not enter into the coefficients
;
of the value of
that the third square 3 will be omitted only from those which serve to form the coefficients of the value of c3
b.2
;
;
and
We
have then
SECT. VI.]
t>
175
d4 e5 &c, and consequently for those of bcde, c., results entirely analogous to that which we have found above for the value of
2 3
the
211.
If
now we
2
represent by
Q,,
P S
z
,
&c.,
the quantities
1+1+1+1. I 3* 4*
5*
1*.
2
.
2
.
2
.
&c.,
1 1 1
,
...
^5
^ the
,
we
&c.
products which
the sums of the Representing in general by n Q n R n Sn ... can be made by combining all the fractions
>
>
p
d4
,
>
2*
g2
"-
-^2
1
c
only;
es
we have
...,
^-
-T
.,
...
A - P + CQ - DR + ES - &c. = 2i
2
2
"
,-
-^=
l
.2 .3*.5.6..
&c.
176
212.
If
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
III.
of the coefficients a,
2
we consider now equations (e) which give the values 6, c, d, &c., we have the following results
:
(2
2
)
(3
)
2
(4
2
2
)
(5
...
2 .3 .4 .5
...
&c.,
(I
_2)
2
(3
-2
2
2
)
(4
2
-2
2
2
)
(5
-2 )...
2
1 .3*.4 .5
...
= A-BP,+
3
2
)
CQ.
- DR + ES - &c.,
2 2
(2
-3
I
2
.
2
)
(4*
2
2
)
(5*
-3
2
)
. . .
2 .4 .5
...
(1
4)
(2
)
a
(3
2
-4
2
(5
-4
2
)
. . .
I .2 .3 .o
...
= A - BP, +
&c.
D^ + ^^ - &c.,
4 4
Remarking the factors which are wanting to the numerators and denominators to complete the double series of natural numbers, we see that the fraction is reduced, in the first equation
to
11
=.
in the second to
22 m s T
>
^ ne
third to -
33
.
in the
4
fourth to
-r
.
4
^
;
which multiply
a, 2&, 3c,
and
It is only required
3
3
then to
P&E&, P&R&, P Q ^ ^
3
&c.
values depend
To obtain them we may remark that we can make these upon the values of the quantities PQRST, &c.,
^ 1
^>
-&>
T2>
^2>
&c
7&>
without omit-
TT
With
respect to
by the series for the developments of the sine. then the series
We
represent
SECT. VI.]
177
+
2
.
12 02
J.
.
-1
l.T)
A9
92 Zi
2
.
3*
2
.
2
.
4*
2
.
2
.
42
2
.
2
.
42
!&c
1 .2 .3 .4
2*.3 .4 .5
F.22 .32 .5 2
x7
?=
>
by P, Q, 5,
5, &c.
3
The
series
sin#
=#
aj
s 3
+ j^
|o
x5
+ &c.
In
fact,
furnishes the values of the quantities P, Q, E, S, &c. value of the sine being expressed by the equation
the
we have
1
-g |-|
Whence we
+&ft
213.
P Q
w
,
B,
5B
/Sf
n,
&c.,
represent the
sums
of the
2
,
fractions
^ Z
^
,
&c.,
has been removed, n being any integer whatever it is required to determine n Qn n Sn &c., by means of P, Q, E, S, &c. If we denote by
1V
\ H.
178
THEORY OF HEAT.
the factor ( 1
[CHAP.
III.
among which
4)
J^J
it
follows
that on multiplying by
(l
the quantity
we obtain
- qP + (f Q - fR + q*S -
&c.
:
&c.;
&c.
of P, Q, JR, ft and making ?i we shall have the values of equal to 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, &c. successively, &c &c 5 those of &3 &c. ; those of 2
P&RA,
214
of a,
P QA^
From
b, c, d, e,
the foregoing theory it follows that the values &c., derived from the equations
rf
&c.,
SECT. VI.]
179
a- A
[7
1T*
7T
1 7T
1 7T
(7
-lzL + ^!^
[9
|7
l
6
772
^ +
x>
[5""2
|3
2V~
D^-lzL ^!^..!^ + 3
2
Vg
/7r_
|5
[3
3V
6
8
,
F
1-1
_^7r_ 2
ITT*
*
j.
7r
.
"
l^.n -D^.l^ + 4 3 4V l7 4 5
4
,
|3
&c.
215.
of a,
b, c, d, e, &c.,
we can
substitute
them
<
=a
sin
+b
sin
2# +
c sin
3# + d
sin 4;c
+e
C,
sin
ox +
&c.,
and writing
A, B,
D, E,
&c., their
122
180
values
v
THEORY OF HEAT.
vii
[CHAP. HI.
lx
(0),
<J>"
(0),
(0),
<
(0),
<
(0), &c.,
equation
jjf
+ &C.
may make use of the preceding series to reduce into a series of sines of multiple arcs any proposed function whose development contains only odd powers of the variable.
216.
4>
We
(as)
?;
The first case which presents itself is that in which = 0, v () = 0, &c., and so we find then (0) = 1, (0)
<"
<
</>
We
have
n 2
x
4j
on
= sin x
"
2x + ^ o
sin
3x
-r
sin
4# +
&c.,
function to be
x*,
we
shall
0,
have
(0)
= 0, f
=
"(0)
[3,
(0)
= 0,
=
</>
((>)
&o.,
-j= J
\7r
sin
x-
(TT*
- L=
J
s i n 2cc
2
-}-
-^J g
sin 3ic
-f
&c.
^7r
(A).
SECT. VI.]
DEVELOPMENTS IN SERIES OF
SINES.
181
We
ceding equation,
-x =
A
sin
^ sin 2# A
+^ 6
sin
3x -
-r
sin
4#
+ &c.
*f
In
fact,
multiplying each
member by
-f
dx,
and integrating, we
have
-r
cos
~a cos
.Z
2x
^ o
cos
&
-rs
4*
cos
4#
-f
&c.
(7 is
a series whose
sum
is
known
to
be
~ -^
Multiplying by dx the
X*
-T
1 = co - ^2 cos cos
a;
2x
+ -^
cos
3#
&c.,
If
now we
write instead of
its
equation
^ #
= sin a?
TT
sin
2#
+^
sin
3#
-7
sin
4#
+ &c.,
2
we
same equation
as above, namely,
7T
We
every function whose development contains only odd powers of the variable.
5-
Equation (A), (Art. 218), can be put under a simpler which we may now indicate. We remark first, that part of form,
217.
is
the series
(0)
"(0)
#(0)
(0)
+ &c,
182
THEORY OF HEAT.
In
[CHAP.
III.
-(/>(TT).
fact,
we
have,
in
(0)*|*"(0)+|*
&c.
powers,
<f>(x)
<(0)
= 0,
"(0)
= 0,
iv
</>
(0)
= 0,
and
so on.
<f)
= x(j)(Q) + TK
<fi"
(0)
+p
x
W+ ^
<
c<
is
found by multiplying
by
Q the series
3
<T
(0)
+
7T
n>
^(0)
+ IF
vli
</>
(0)
^^
lx
()
+ &c
->
whose value
is
$ r
(TT}.
We
different parts of the coefficient of sin#, and the components of the coefficients of sin 2#, sin 3x, sin &c. may employ for
4<x,
We
this
f (0) +
"(0)
V
<^
(0)
&c.
(0)
^(0) +
&c.
(>
^ &c
7T
SECT. VI.]
DEVELOPMENTS IN SERIES OP
SINES.
183
By means
form
:
sn x
Jf
<"
(TT)
+J
iv
<
(7r)
J ^(TT) + &cj
</>
-i
sin
2*
{</>
(TT)
-I -
(TT)
+1
+
+
lv
4>
(TT)
-1 <^(TT)
+ &c.
J
sin
3*
(/>
(TT)
f
^
(TT)
(TT)
+ &*
sn *
Wsin
(T)
r W - ^W + &
(B);
or this,
a?)
= ^ (TT)
<t>"
sin 2,r
sin
3x
&c.
(TT)
| [
sin
^
x
&c.
[
IV
(/>
(TT)
2x
-jsin
+^ +
^?
sin 3o?
&c.
^
vl
c/)
(TT)
sin
-^
sin
2x
sin 3uC
&c.
[
+ &c.
218.
(C).
We
arcs.
we have
multiple
x e~* example, the proposed function is e whose development contains only odd powers of x, we shall have
(F
TT
Q~*
/
f
sin
-^
sin
2#
sin
3^
&c.
J
*Vu
(sin
a;
*%
*t*3
i
&c.
+ ( sm ^
(
sm
sin
2ic
+
+
i o5 sin
3x
&c.
J
sin
yj
2x
^ sin 3,
&c.
J
184
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
III.
4*x,
&c.,
,
n*
+n -*
x
tf
7+
etc.. its
value -,
ri*
- we
1
(e*
71
e^-e^
~1~11~
_
sin
sin
2x
sin
3#
We
because
of heat.
might multiply these applications and derive from them We have chosen the preceding example
appears in several problems relative to the propagation
219.
Up
to this point
we have supposed
whose development is required in a series of sines of multiple arcs can be developed in a series arranged according to powers of the variable x and that only odd powers enter into that series. We can extend the same results to any functions, even To esta to those which are discontinuous and entirely arbitrary. blish clearly the truth of this proposition, we must follow the analysis which furnishes the foregoing equation (B), and examine
t
what
is
which
multiply sin
a?,
Denoting by
odd, and
mnx
when n
is
we have
a
=
<KT)
J
Hi
*"
+J
Hi
<f
W-i*
It/
+ &C.
Considering s as a function of
TT,
comparing the
results,
we
find s
5
</>
ft
Cv /r
must
satisfy.
Now
is
d zs
T~I
CLtjG
+-5 ft
f
=
</>
(#)>
m which
considered to be a function of
is
a cos nx
+b
4-
sin
nx
nx
\
sin
cos
nx $
(x)
dx
n cos
nx
sin
nx
(x) dx.
SECT. VI.]
If
s
GENERAL FORMULA.
an integer, and the value of x
(x)
is
185
equal to
TT,
n n
is
we have
is
sinnxdx.
The
\(f>
sign
+ must
is
be chosen when n
when that number odd, and the sign x equal to the semi-circumference TT,
dicated;
|
(/>
even.
We
must make
the
result
may
(x) sin
nx dx, by means
<
of integration
by
parts,
remarking
(x)
x=
is
to
x = TT.
We
equal to
If
we
sign sign
+ when
is
of
odd
I
order,
and the
when n
even,
we
shall
have
in general
manner we
arrive at a very
:
=
7T(j>(x)
since
sin
x$(x) dx
in/ic
sin
2x
/sin
J
2#<
(x)
dx+&c.
. "sX
lsini#<
(x)
dx + &c .............. f.
(D), /
the second
member
</>(#),
we
integrate from
x=
pp. 260
1760,
y = 2 (iTV, sin
r=l
Xr
-rr
AX)
sin xir
sin 2xir
+2
(iT Yr sin
sin 3xir
. .
sin nxir
Y^,
Y3 ...Yn corresponding
.
Xlt X2 X3 ...Xn
,
of
where
Xr =
and
AX
Lagrange however abstained from the transition from this summation-formula to the integration-formula given by Fourier. Cf. Riemann s Gcsammclte Mathcmatische Werke, Leipzig, 1876, pp. 218220
of his
historical criticism,
Trigonomctritche Reihe.
[A. F.]
186
THEORY OF HEAT.
coefficients a,
[CHAP.
b, c, d,
III.
We see by this that the 220. which enter into the equation
5
Tr<p
e,f, &c.,
(x)
a sin x + b sin 2x
+c
sin
3x
+d
sin
4#
&c.,
and which we found formerly by way of successive eliminations, by the general term
(x)
dx
is
required.
This remark
important, because
it
may
if
be developed in
<
the function
(x)
be represented
by the variable ordinate of any curve whatever whose abscissa extends from x = to x TT, and if on the same part of the axis sin x, be the known trigonometric curve, whose ordinate is y
constructed, it is easy to represent the value of any integral must suppose that for each abscissa x, to which cor term. one value of $ (a?), and one value of sin x, we multiply responds
We
the latter value by the first, and at the same point of the axis raise an ordinate equal to the product $ (x) sin x. By this con
tinuous operation a third curve is formed, whose ordinates are ~those of the trigonometric curve, reduced in proportion to the This ^ordinates of the arbitary curve which represents <(#).
done, the area of the reduced curve taken from gives the exact value of the coefficient of sin#;
x=
to
X = TT
and whatever the given curve may be which corresponds to $ (#), whether we can assign to it an analytical equation, or whether it depends on
regular law,
it
is
110
evident that
it
in
area of the reduced curve has, in all possible cases, a definite value, which is the value of the coefficient of sin x in the develop ment of the function. The same is the case with the following
coefficient
b,
or
/<
(x) sin
2xdx.
a, b, c, d, &c.,
= sin x,
= sin Zx,
= sin Sx,
= sin 4#,
&c.,
for
SECT. VI.]
187
x=
and then that we have changed these curves by ordinates by the corresponding ordinates of multiplying The equations of the re a curve whose equation is y = duced curves are
to
;
x = TT
all their
<f>(x).
= sin x
cf>
(x),
y=
sin
2x
</>
(x),
= sin 3x
</>
(x),
&c.
to
The
TT,
in the equation
sin
(x)
=a
sin
x+b
sin 2a?
+c
sin
3x + d
4# + &c.
221.
We
by determining
equation
<
can verify the foregoing equation (D), (Art. 220), directly the quantities a lt 2 a3 ... a. &c., in the
, , y
(a?)
=a
sin
a?
+ a2
sin
2#
+a
sin
3x +
. . .
a, sin Jic
+ &e.
by
to
X = TT,
<f)(x)
sin ix
dx
ax sin x sin ix dx +
I
(sin
2# sm ix dx + &c.
+ aj
sinjx sin ix dx
...
&c.
Now it can easily be proved, 1st, that all the integrals, which enter into the second member, have a nul value, except only the
term a
i-TT
;
sin ix sin
ixdx
Ismixsmixdx
is
r
I
(f>
(a?)
sin ix dx.
reduced to considering the value of the integrals which enter into the second member, and to demonThe integral strating the two preceding propositions.
is
-i
2
I
sin jjc
si 11
ixdx,
JL
188
taken from x =
to
THEORY OF HEAT.
x
(*
TT,
[CHAP.
integers,
is
III.
in
which
and j are
(i
jj
sin
- j) x -
^-.
sin
+ j) x + C.
the constant C is Since the integral must begin when x = and the numbers i and j being integers, the value of the nothing,
integral will become nothing of the terms, such as
when
OJ
= TT;
it
at
sin
sin ix da,
a3
(sin
5x
sin
ixdx
&c.,
vanishes,
and that
numbers
i i
are different.
The same
-
and j and j
re-
j)
j
-^
,
and
its
value
is TT.
Consequently we have
== TT
2 sin ix sin ix dx
I
a3)
...
&c.,
namely,
ttj
2 -
f
/(
(#) sin
# dr,
3# &e,
2 a2 = 2 =-
f
l<
(x) sin 2
2 #3 = -
f
I
c/>
(a?)
sin
a,
\$(x) sin
10
Substituting these
(x)
we have
(a?)
sin
I
</>
sin
%7r(f>
# cZic +
sin
2x
l(f)
(x) sin
2# J^? + &c.
+ sin ix
(a?)
sin
ixdx + &c.
222. The simplest case is that in which the given function has a constant value for all values of the variable x included
between
9
?, if
and
TT
sin
ixdx
is
equal to
i
the
number
i is
if
the
number
is
even.
SECT. VI.]
180
= sin x +
sin
3#
4-
sin
5#
-f
= sin 7x
+ &c.,
(N
(x)
has been de
a
is is
sin
-f
& sin
2#
+c
sin
3x
+ d sin kx + &c.
included between
and
IT
but
$ (#)
to hold
TT.
we
shall have,
required to be
x,
sin
sin
x dx
sin
2x
x x
sin
2# dx
+ sin 3#
The
integral
I
sin
3# dx
4-
&c.
x sin
i#cfa? is
equal to
I
,
fT z
the indices
and
TT,
shew the
when
the sign -f must be chosen when i is odd, and the sign i is even. have then the following equation,
We
25
^x =
223.
sin
= sin 2#
+ ^ sin
v
3#
-j
sin
4# + - sin 5^
o
&c.
can develope also in a series of sines of multiple from those in which only odd powers of the variable enter. To instance by an example which leaves no
arcs functions different
We
it
sin
x+
6 sin
2x
+ c sin
3#
+ d sin
4<x
+ e sin
5#
&c.,
*r
190
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
III.
We
- TT
cos
sin
cos
sin
x dx
+
4-
sin
2#
3x
cos
x sin 2# dx x sin 3#
sin
cos
cfce
&c.
The
integral
cos
sin ix
dx
i
is
equal to zero
when
i is
an
_\ when
etc.,
is
an even number.
Supposing
= 2, =
=
4, 6, 8,
seres
T TT cos x 4
or,
s o
m 2# + o ^
? sin 4 ^
K o
sin
"7
is remarkable in this respect, that it exhibits the of the cosine in a series of functions, each one of development which contains only odd powers. If in the preceding equation x to JTT, we find be made
This result
equal
This series
224.
is
known
(Introd.
ad analysin.
of
similar analysis may be employed for the development function whatever in a series of cosines of multiple arcs. any
Let
<(#)
is
required,
we
may
write
<
(x)
aQ cos Ox + a cos x
t
(m).
two members of this equation be multiplied by cosjx, and each of the terms of the second member integrated from x = to x = TT it is easily seen that the value of the integral will be nothing, save only for the term which already contains cosjx. This remark gives immediately the coefficient a,; it is
If the
;
SECT. VI.]
191
taken from x
to
IT,
supposing j and
i to
be integers.
We
have
to
TT,
whenever j and
the case
The
term
sn
becomes
If then
when the
arc
~
,|
and
its
value
is \TT,
is
equal to
77%
we multiply
by
cos ix,
and integrate
from
to
TT,
we have
^TTdi,
</>
(X) COS IX
dx =
coefficient c^.
To
it
may be remarked
that in
the integral
i t
dn
(ji)
^
,
x,
if
and
=
is
of each
term
JTT
cos jx cos ix
dx taken
from x
to
:
are different
but different
equal to zero
2 Jo
;
nothing when the two integers j and i when the two numbers j and i are equal from zero it is equal to TT when j and i are each thus we obtain the following equation,
is it is
= TT
\tr
1 fv
["
fir
Jo
Jo
cos
+ cos 3#
1
I
</>
(a?)
3# d# + &c.
we
J o
(n)\
an analogous result
yet
192
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
III.
This and the preceding theorem suit all possible functions, whether their character can be expressed by known methods of analysis, or whether they correspond to curves traced arbitrarily.
225.
If the proposed function whose is the variable
development
is
itself
we may
required write
=a +
ttj
cos
x + a2
cos
Zx
-f
a 3 cos
ox+
...
+a
cos ix
&c.,
and we have,
tion at
to determine
any
coefficient
x cos
o
ix dx.
when
i is
is
-^
when
i is odd.
We
have at
= 7 ?r
cos
7T
2
.
We
.
series,
A 4
cos
^ 7T
3#
cos
5%
^3 O7T
cos 7x 4 -^ 7T
.
&c.
We may
-x
1
developments for
sin
1111
we have
namely,
sin
2x
+tj
sin
3#
-r
jb
sin
^x
- sin 5x
o
&c.,
12. x =
2
TT
- sin
oj
^X = 2
to
x,
112
jTT 4
TT
(Art. 181),
^ 3V COS
<$X
-^ 5V COS 5x
&C.
It must be remarked that these three values of \x ought not be considered as equal; with reference to all possible values of
the three preceding developments have a common value only when the variable x is included between and JTT. The con struction of the values of these three series, and the comparison of the lines whose ordinates are expressed by them, render sensible the alternate coincidence and divergence of values of these
functions.
To give a second example of the development of a function in a series of cosines of multiple arcs, we choose the function sin a?,
SECT. VI.]
TRIGONOMETRICAL DEVELOPMENTS.
193
which contains only odd powers of the variable, and we may sup pose it to be developed in the form
a
-j-
b cos
-f c
cos
2x
+d
cos
Sx
-f
&c.
we
find,
_&<..
Thus we
arrive at the
tains only odd powers in a series of cosines in which only even powers of the variable enter. If we give to a? the particular value
JTT,
we
find
111111
7r==
rjr375 + o\7- T9
f
we
derive
1
and
also
^ 7T
1111
=
2
3.5
7.9
we
11.13
-&c.
111111
results
have, as above,
7^
^ 1.3
3.o
"^
+~
o.7
-^
pr 7.9
1
TT
9.11
r^
&C.
The foregoing analysis giving the means of developing function whatever in a series of sines or cosines of multiple any arcs, we can easily apply it to the case in which the function to be
developed has definite values when the variable is included between certain limits and has real values, or when the variable is included between other limits. We stop to examine this particular
case, since it is
THEORY OF HEAT.
of multiple arcs.
[CHAP.
III.
Suppose then that we have reduced to a series of form a function whose value is constant, when x is included and a, and all of whose values are nul when x is in between cluded between a and IT. We shall employ the general equation = to x = TT. (D} in which the integrals must be taken from x
this
y
The
values of
<(.x)
nothing from This done, we find, for the series required, denoting by to x = a. h the constant value of the function,
1
~7r<(#)
x=a
which enter under the integral sign being to x = TT, it is sufficient to integrate from x
f
<(I
cos a)
sm x
-\
_j
l-cos2a -- - 2x -- -- sm ^x +
~
sin
cos 3a
&C.
(x]
= versin a sin a; +
versin 2a sin
is
2# +
versin 3 a sin 3#
if
+ &C.
such that
and
a,
the
be ^TT but if we give to x any value whatever greater than a and less than 4?r, the sum of the terms will be nothing.
In the following example, which
values of
is
(x}
x included
between and a, and nul for values of as between a and TT. To find what series satisfies this condition, we shall employ equa
tion
(Z>).
x = to x = IT ; but it is integrals must be taken from in the case in question, to take these integrals from sufficient, x = to x = a, since the values of (x) are supposed nul in the
The
<f>
Hence we
sin
as
find
+~
sin 2a sin
Zx
~sin 3a sin
3x
+ &c
1 In what cases a function, arbitrary between certain limits, can be developed in a series of cosines, and in what cases in a series of sines, has been shewn by Sir W. Thomson, Cainb. Math. Journal, Vol. n. pp. 258262, in an article signed P. Q. K., On Fourier s Expansions of Functions in Trigonometrical Series.
SECT. VI.]
TRIGONOMETRICAL DEVELOPMENTS.
TT,
195
If a be supposed equal to
all
except the
first,
which becomes -
is
sin
we
have then
<#
The same analysis could be extended to the case in 227. which the ordinate represented by $(x) was that of a line com posed of different parts, some of which might be arcs of curves and others straight lines. For example, let the value of the func
tion,
whose development
\^\
}
is
multiple arcs, be
-a? from x =
x=
JTT,
and be nothing
-
from x = JTT to x = TT. We shall employ the general equation (n), and effecting the integrations within the given limits, we find
that the general term 1
is
I
/*
"
U^J
-x
cos
ixdx
is
equal to/3
when
even) to
4-
^ when
?,
i is
when
-^
-I
i is
On
we
3 ?
term 9 fa&y&e.
We have
then
<
cosa;
cos
%x
cos oas
cos
cos 2ic
~J
cos
4#
~*
cos 6#
^2
2^
42
&c
is
and straight
lines.
228.
x=
a,
it
to
x=
a,
equal to
TT
- x,
and
from x
= TT - a
to
x=
lastly
IT.
To reduce
to a series
*^
tf*l>
^n
,,
132
196
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
III.
we employ
ix
/<
(x) sin
dx
is
composed of three
2
and we have,
of sin ix,
when
when
i is
i is an odd number but the coefficient vanishes an even number. Thus we arrive at the equation
-7T(j)(x)
Zi
2\ sin
(^
a.
sin
+^ O
sin 3a sin
3#
4-
sin 5a sin 5x
+
If
5=2
sin 7a sin
7#
4-
&c.
[
(X).
we supposed
= JTT,
isosceles triangle,
7r<f>
(as)
= 2 (sin a?
\
&c.
k2
j
a series which
is always convergent whatever be the value of x. In general, the trigonometric series at which we have arrived, in developing different functions are always convergent, but it
;
has not appeared to us necessary to demonstrate this here for the terms which compose these series are only the coefficients of terms
of series which give the values of the temperature ; and these coefficients are affected by certain exponential quantities which decrease very rapidly, so that the final series are very convergent.
With regard to those in which only the sines and cosines of multiple arcs enter, it is equally easy to prove that they are convergent, although they represent the ordinates of discontinuous
lines.
of the
This does not result solely from the fact that the values terms diminish continually for this condition is not
;
convergence of a series. It is necessary that the values at which we arrive on increasing continually the number of terms, should approach more and more a fixed limit,
1
The accuracy
of this
and other
series given
by Fourier
is
maintained by
Sir
W. Thomson
2
in the article quoted in the note, p. 194. and TT, Expressed in cosines between the limits
ITT<P
()=__{\ cos.2a; + O o
and
cos Gx
+ ^O
cos
Wx + &c.
Cf.
De Morgan
s Diff.
[A. F.]
SECT. VI.]
GEOMETRICAL ILLUSTRATION.
197
and should differ from it only by a quantity which becomes less than any given magnitude: this limit is the value of the series.
Now we may
prove rigorously that the series in question satisfy the last condition.
to
Take the preceding equation (X) in which we can give 229. x any value whatever; we shall consider this quantity as a new ordinate, which gives rise to the following construction.
Having traced on the plane of x and y (see fig. 8) a rectangle whose base OTT is equal to the semi-circumference, and whose height is ?r on the middle point m of the side parallel to the
;
base, let
us raise perpendicularly to the plane of the rectangle a line equal to |TT, and from the upper end of this line draw
Thus will be straight lines to the four corners of the rectangle. If we now measure from the formed a quadrangular pyramid.
point
on the shorter side of the rectangle, any line equal to a, and through the end of this line draw a plane parallel to the base OTT, and perpendicular to the plane of the rectangle, the section common to this plane and to the solid will be the trapezium whose
is
height
this
equal to
is
a.
trapezium
(sin a sin
equal,
of
7T \
^ sm
sm % x +
7z O
sm
^a
sm
It follows
x, y, z
point whatever of the upper surface of the quadrangular pyramid which we have formed, we have for the equation of the surface
of the polyhedron,
-TTZ
-= sin x sin y
j2
sin
3x sin 3^
32
sin
-^2
5x sin oy ^-
198
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
III.
z or the distance of
This convergent series gives always the value of the ordinate any point whatever of the surface from the
plane of x and y.
The
series
therefore adapted to represent, between definite limits, all possible functions, and the ordinates of lines or surfaces whose form is
discontinuous.
the series;
the value of
any
sin
whatever in the
equation
<j)
(x)
=a
sin
x -f
<3
sin
2#
+a
3#
-f
a t sin ix
+ etc.,
is
2 -
\d>
TT J
(as)
sin i dx. ix
Whatever be the function (x), or the form of the curve which it represents, the integral has a definite value which may be introduced into the formula. The values of these definite
<
I
(/>
(x)
dx
in
cluded between the curve and the axis in a given interval, or to the values of mechanical quantities, such as the ordinates of the
centre of gravity of this area or of any solid whatever. It is evident that all these quantities have assignable values, whether the figure of the bodies be regular, or whether we give to them
geometrician assumes that any function whatever may always be developed in a series of sines or cosines of multiple arcs. Now
the most complete of
all
is
that
which
series
with determined
coefficients.
In researches to which partial differential equations are ap plied, it is often easy to find solutions whose sum composes a more general integral but the employment of these integrals
;
requires us to determine
their extent,
and to be able
to dis-
SECT. VI.]
199
clearly the cases in which they represent the general from those in which they include only a part. It is integral necessary above all to assign the values of the constants, and
tinguish
the difficulty of the application consists in the discovery of the coefficients. J^is remarkable that we can express by convergent
series,
and, as
1
we shalPsee Tn
.
by this that we must admit into analysis functionswKich have equal values, whenever the variable receives any values whatever included between two given limits, even though on substituting in these two functions, instead of the variable, a number included in another interval, the results of the two substitutions are not the same. The functions which
continuous law
see
We
lines,
which
coincide in a definite portion only of their course, and offer a These considerations arise singular species of finite osculation.
in the calculus of partial differential equations; they throw a new light on this calculus, and serve to facilitate its employment in
physical theories.
231.
any function whatever, in cosines or sines of multiple arcs, give rise to several remarks which explain the true meaning of these theorems, and direct the application of them.
of
If in the series
ment
e cos
4>x
+ &c.,
same
;
it
t
^
also preserves its value if we augment the variable by any multiple whatever of the circumference 2?r. Thus in the equation
TT<
(x)
=x
I
</>
(x)
dx -f
cos
x
l(f>
(x) cos
xdx
+ cos 2#
Iff)
(x) cos
2xdx
cos
3#
/</>
(x) cos
Sxdx +
&c....(i/),
the function $ is periodic, and is represented by a curve composed of a multitude of equal arcs, each of which corresponds to an
1
Demonstrations have been supplied by Poisson, Deflers, Dirichlet, Dirksen, De Morgan, Stokes. See note, pp. 208, 209. [A. F.]
200
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
IJI.
interval equal to STT on the axis of the abscissae. Further, each of these arcs is composed of two symmetrical branches, which cor respond to the halves of the interval equal to 2?r,
Suppose then that we trace a line of any form whatever (see fig. 9.), which corresponds to an interval equal to TT.
Fig. 9.
</><a
form
b cos
tween
such that, substituting for x any value whatever included be and TT, we find for the value of the series that of the
it is easy to solve the problem the equation (v) are given by
ordinate
X<j>,
if l<f>(x)
2
dx,
2 -
r
l(f>
(x) cos
xdx
&c.
These integrals, which are taken from x = to x TT, having measurable values like that of the area Ofon, and the always series formed by these coefficients being always convergent, there
is
for
is
not
-f
"b
cos
is
-\-
c cos
2# + d cos 3# -f
;
e cos
is
&c.
The
arc
<(/>a
entirely arbitrary
with other parts of the line, they are, on the contrary, determinate; which corresponds to the interval from to thus the arc TT is
<a
is
a<pa
repeated on
is 2?r.
vary the limits of the integrals in equation (v). If = ?r to x = TT the result will be doubled would also be doubled if the limits of the integrals were
:
We may
and
27rr instead of
being
and
TT.
We
SECT. VI.]
ft
GEOMETRICAL ILLUSTRATION.
201
sign
is
equal to
a,
J a
completed when the variable is equal to b equation (n) under the following form
and
is
and we write
i
7T(f)
(x)
i =^
<j>
(x]
dx + cos x
(x) cos
[n
J
xdx -f cos 2x
r*
(f>
(x} cos
2xdx
Jo
cos
3x
(x) cos
%xdx +
Instead of taking the integrals from x to x = 2?r, or from x take them from x =
TT</>
to
IT
x
to
each of these two cases, (x} must be written instead of JTT^ of the equation. in the first member
(a:)
In the equation which gives the development of any 232. function whatever in sines of multiple arcs, the series changes sign and retains the same absolute value when the variable x
becomes negative;
v ariable
is
it retains its value and its sign when the increased or diminished by any multiple whatever of
Fig. 10.
the circumference
2?r.
The
are
^a
(see
fig.
10),
which cor
to TT is arbitrary; all the other responds to the interval from which corresponds parts of the line are determinate. The arc
</>(a,
to the interval
;
has the same form as the given arc but it is in the opposite position. The whole arc OLffxjxfxjxi is (fxfra repeated in the interval from TT to 3?r, and in all similar intervals.
from
to
TT,
We
2
TT<
(a;)
= sin x
I
(f>
Jo
(x) sin
xdx
sin
2x
I
<f>
Jo
(x) sin
(x) sin
Zxdx
sin
3x
I
(j>
3xdx +
&c.
202
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
III.
We
T+T
r-n
or
instead of
it
J _7T
JO
would be necessary
(x).
to substitute
member
TT<
(x) for
JTT<
is
of multiple arcs, (x) developed in cosines a line formed of two equal arcs placed symrepresented by
233.
The function
<
Fig. 11.
metrically on each side of the axis of y, in the interval from this condition is expressed thus, TT to +TT (see fig. 11)
;
The line which represents the function i|r (x) is, on the contrary, formed in the same interval of two opposed arcs, which is what is
expressed by the equation
Any
function whatever
F(x\
TT
<
to
F F mFF represents
I n fact, if the line (V) and ^H[g) the function F(x} and we raise at the point to the right o the ordinate om, we can draw through the point of the given of the axis om the arc mff similar to the arc
}
m mF F
mFF
same axis we may trace the arc mff must then draw through the point m
two equal parts the differ and the corresponding
a line
<^<^
m^ which
SECT. VI.]
GEOMETRICAL DEMONSTRATION.
.
203
ordinate
of or x F
We
must draw
ChJ^ whose
ordinate measures
F F mFF and
lines
that of
FF mFF,
we $
and f
f f mff. This done the ordinate of the f mff being denoted by F (x) and f(x)
= F(
<
respectively, ordinate of
$m$$
(x)
by
(x),
and that
we have
F(x)
hence
<
=
<j,
f (x)
and f(x)
= $(x}-^(x}=F (- x),
*
(x)
= i*
+ lF(-
x)
and
+ (*) =
^(-*),
= $(-x) and
^ (x) = - ^ (-
a?),
(at)
may
(x) and i|r (x), whose sum is equal to be developed, one in cosines of multiple arcs, and the
(/>
other in sines.
If to the first function
the equation
to
X = TT,
we apply equation (v), and to the second - TT taking the integrals in each case from x = and adding the two results, we have
(/x),
/(*)
2a?
/</)
(a;)
cos
2% dx
+ &c. + &c.
x^r(x}
sin
re
dx
sin
2# ^(#)
TT
The
integrals
to
(x)
x = IT.
cos
a?
It
cfo
may now
could,
<>
f +7r
<
we
J -IT
(a?) -^ (a?) instead of to right and left of the being composed, similar parts, and the function ^r (x) being, on the
value, write
(x)
a?
x of two
t
r+Tr
two opposite
ty(x) cos
xdx
J -IT
case
if
a?,
we wrote
i
cos 2a; or
and
204
THEORY OF HEAT.
r+7T
[CHAP.
III.
from
to infinity.
Thus the
integral
<
(x) cos ix
dx
is
the same
J -77
as the integral
r+ir
I
r+n
bfr (%)
+ ^ (X)J
cos
dx,
or
"IT
J -IT
r+T
^(x) smixdx
/*+"
is
equal
J -TT
to the integral
I
</>(#)
swi
J -7T
J -TT
vanishes.
(p),
to develope any function whatever in a series formed of sines cosines of multiple arcs
cos
x F[x] cos x dx
\
+ cos 2#
F(x] cos 2x dx
sin
+ +
&c.
+
234.
sin
x F(x]
\
sin
x dx
+ sin
2x F(x)
I
2x dx
&c.
The function
represented by a line
F F FF,
F(x), which enters into this equation, is of any form whatever. The arc
TT
F F FF,
arbitrary arc
is 27T.
to +TT, is
all
F F FF
We
it
the other parts of the line are determinate, and the is repeated in each consecutive interval whose length
shall
make
and
(i/).
be supposed that the function F(x] in equation (p) is re IT to + TT, by a line composed of presented, in the interval from all the terms which contain two equal arcs symmetrically placed, sines vanish, and we find equation (v). If, on the contrary, the
which represents the given function F(x) is formed of two equal arcs opposed in position, all the terms which do not contain sines disappear, and we find equation (/x). Submitting the func
line
we
we
the quantity
SECT. VI.]
of the
205
j,
which we
may
denote by /(#).
TT.
The
limits
x=
TT
and x =
TT
become
r
=
r
TT
we
<p?
-f
cos
TT
X x -
[
I
7T#
27T.T f
I
,,
277-tf
f(x) cos
dx-\- cos
/(x)
,.
.
cos
c&e
etc.
f
I
.,
sin
TT
/(a?) sin
TTX j
dx
-f
sm
27r#
/*
\f(x)
sm
2?nr
d# +
etc.
All the integrals must be taken like the first from x = r to x = +r. If the same substitution be made in the equations (v)
and
(yu,),
we have
cos
--
f(x) cos
dx
+ cos-
2?ra; /*/./ -
\f(x) cos
--
27ra;
2 ^
/W = sm
/.,
x
.
7T5?
F
\ J
f f(x
In the
first
from x
to
we
1
should have
It
f unction
has been shewn by Mr J. O Kinealy that if the values of the arbitrary /(x) be imagined to recur for every range of x over successive intervals X,
^J
^
,
= 0,
1, 2,
3... cc,
[Turn over.
206
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
III.
x}dx
27T03
-f
(II)
f-,
I
ZTTX
cos
-yrZTTX
JL
TT-
a#
+ cos +
.
4-TnE
=^
f ..
I
47nc
/(a?) cos
-^47r#
a#
,
4-
&c.
-f
sin
/ J
27HB
TT.A-
(a?)
sin
7 a#
4urx
-A-
sin
v JIfw
sin
235.
It follows
this sec
tion, concerning the development of functions in trigonometrical series, that if a function f(x) be proposed, whose value in a de
finite interval
from x
to
of a curved line arbitrarily ; function in a series which contains only sines or only cosines, or the sines and cosines of multiple arcs, or the cosines only of odd
multiples.
To
we must employ
These trigonometric
series,
sines of multiples of arcs, belong to elementary analysis, like the series whose terms contain the successive powers of the variable.
The coefficients of the trigonometric series are definite areas, and those of the series of powers are functions given by differentiation, in which, moreover, we assign to the variable a definite value.
We
could have added several remarks concerning the use and pro perties of trigonometrical series but we shall limit ourselves to
;
enunciating briefly those which have the most direct relation to the theory with which we are concerned.
it
follows that
f(x)
=A + AI cos
+ B^
.
1-
A
2-7TX
^ 2 cos 2
_
A
STTX
h^ 3 cos
+ &c.
sin -r
+ B2 sin 2
- + B%
s
ITTX sin 3 -r
+ &c.
The
sides
coefficients
.
by sin
SECT. VI.]
1st.
REMARKS ON THE
The
series
SERIES.
207
arranged according to sines or cosines of mul that is to say, on giving to the tiple arcs are always convergent variable any value whatever that is not imaginary, the sum of the
;
terms converges more and more to a single fixed the value of the developed function.
2nd.
If
limit,
which
is
we have the
b cos
a+
+ c cos 2x + d cos
</>
3# +
cos
4#
+ &c.,
is
(a?),
3x
+ e cos 4?x -f
of the
1
&c., series
sum
compound
+ ee +
&C.,
and more generally that of the series ax + 6/3 cos x + cy cos 2# + cZS cos 3#
which is formed by comparing term by term the two given This remark applies to any number of series.
3rd.
The
series
of a function
F (x)
(5^)
(Art. 234s)
in a series of sines
may be
+ cos x
F(a) cos
ado.
cos
2#
F (a) cos
2s>cZa
-f
&c.
+ sin
a being a
F (a)
sin acZa
2a dx
+ &c.
new
We
have then
2a
cos
3# cos 3a + &c.
Sx sin 3a
&c.
We
shall
have
fir
f
Jo
t(x)<f>(x)dx=CMT+lT{bp+Cy+...}.
[R. L. E.]
208
or
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
III.
F(x)
=-
F(-J) doi
Ji
+ cos
(x
- a) + cos 2
(x
- a) + &c.
by
series
2
taken from
i = 1
cos i (x
a)
to
i =
GO
we have
(a)
F(x)=- \F 7TJ
The expression ^ + X 2
d* \l
[Z
cos
(a?
a)
represents a function of
and a, such that if it be multiplied by any function whatever F(oi), and integrated with respect to a between the limits a = TT and a = ?r, the proposed function jP(a) becomes changed into a like It will be function of x multiplied by the semi-circumference TT. seen in the sequel what is the nature of the quantities, such as
5 2
+ 2cos*(#
4th.
a),
ciated.
(M), (N), and (P) (Art 234), which on being divided by r give the development of a function f(x), we suppose the interval r to become infinitely large, each term of
If in the equations
element of an integral; the sum of infinitely smal^ then represented by a definite integral. When the bodies have determinate dimensions, the arbitrary functions which
the series
is
an
the series
is
in represent the initial temperatures, and which enter into the of the partial differential equations, ought to be developed tegrals but in series analogous to those of the equations (M), (N), (P)
;
the form of definite integrals, when the dimensTons of the bodies are not determinate, as will be ex plained in the course of this work, in treating of the free diffusion
of heat (Chapter IX.).
Note on Section VI.
On
values are arbitrarily assigned between certain limits, in series of sines and cosines of multiple arcs, and on questions connected with the values of such
series at the limits, on the convergency of the series, and on the discontinuity of their values, the principal authorities are Poisson. Theorie mathematiqiie de la Chaleur, Paris, 1835, Chap. vn. Arts.
92
102,
Sur
la
maniere d exprimcr
les
fonctions arbitraircs
par des
series
de
SECT. VII.]
quantites periodiqucs.
LITERATURE.
209
Poisson
s original
Poll/technique,
Or, more briefly, in his TraiU de Mecanique, Arts. 325328. memoirs on the subject were published in the Journal de VEcole Cahier 18, pp. 417 489, year 1820, and Cahier 19, pp. 404509,
year 1823.
and Integral Calculus. London, 1842, pp. 609 617. developments appear to be original. In the verification of the developments the author follows Poisson s methods. Stokes, Cambridge Philosophical Transactions, 1847, Vol. VIH. pp. 533 556. On the Critical i-alucs of the sums of Periodic Series. Section I. Mode of ascertain ing the nature of the discontinuity of a function which is expanded in a series
Differential
De Morgan,
The proofs
of the
Graphically illustrated.
Thomson and
Tait,
I.
Arts.
7577.
Donkin, Acoustics, Oxford, 1870, Arts. 72 79, and Appendix to Chap. rv. Matthieu, Cours de Physique Mathematique, Paris, 1873, pp. 33 36. Entirely different methods of discussion, not involving the introduction of arbitrary multipliers to the successive terms of the series were originated by
Sur la con 169. Dirichlet, Crelle s Journal, Berlin, 1829, Band iv. pp. 157 vergence des series trigonome triques qui servent a rcpresenter une fonction arbitraire entre les limites donnees. The methods of this memoir thoroughly deserve at
tentive study, but are not yet to be found in English text-books. Another memoir, of greater length, by the same author appeared in Dove s Repertorium der Phyaik,
Ueber. die Darstellung ganz willkuhrlicher 1837, Band i. pp. 152 174. Functioncn durch Sinus- und Cosinusreihen. Von G. Lejeune Dirichlet. Other methods are given by
Berlin,
Ueber die Convergenz Dirksen, Crelle s Journal, 1829, Band iv. pp. 170^178. einer nach den Sinussen imd Cosinussen der Vielfachen eines Winkel* fortachreit enden Eeihe.
Bessel, Astronomische
238.
Ueber den
Amdruck einer Function $ (x) durch Cosinusse und Sinusse der Vielfachen von x. The writings of the last three authors are criticised by Biemann, Gesammelte
Mathematische Werke, Leipzig, 1876, pp. 221 Function durch eine Trigonometrische Eeihe.
Sir 225.
On W.
264
of
Fluctuating Functions and their properties, a memoir was published by K. Hamilton, Transactions of the Royal Irish Academy, 1843, Vol. xix. pp. 321. The introductory and concluding remarks may at this stage be studied.
The writings of Deflers, Boole, and others, on the subject of the expansion an arbitrary function by means of a double integral (Fourier s Theorem) will be alluded to in the notes on Chap. IX. Arts. 361, 362. [A. F.]
SECTION
Application
236.
VII.
problem.
to the actual
solve in a general manner the problem of the propagation of heat in a rectangular plate BAG, whose end
We
can
now
is
its
two
0.
infinite
edges
and
are
210
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
ITT.
Suppose the initial temperature at all points of the slab BAG be nothing, but that the temperature at each point in of the edge A is preserved by some external cause, and that its fixed value is a function f(x) of the distance of the point m from the
to
end whose whole length is 2r; let v be the of the edge constant temperature of the point whose co-ordinates are x and it is required to determine v as a function of x and y, y.
The value
= ae~ mv sin mx
satisfies
the equation
a and
If
we take
m =i-
HT
,
sin
vanishes,
when x = r,
may
-
be.
We
v,
= a,e
sin
-r
\-
a
t>
sin
-+
r
ae
sin
-r
h &c.
y be supposed nothing, the value of v will by hypothesis be equal to the known function f(x). We then have
If
j (x) = a^ sin
/.,
x
.
+
,
& 2 sin
,
--
\-
aa sin
--
f-
&c.
a lt a 2 3 &c. can be determined by means of and on substituting them in the value of v we have equation (M),
coefficients
The
s rv 2
-ITr
sm
TTX ^
/
r-/(a?) sm
7
,,
7TX
r
o"
a^ +
.
-2ir^
sin
%irX C -, f\ i J () r
,
sm
j|
27T#
-- dx
7
+e
237.
solution
r sin
IM/
I
/
f (x)
// A
sin
*V dx
.0 + &c.
the
equation,
we have
- jrv
x\f(x]
sin
#<&
+ e~2y
f(x\ 7
sin
2#
!./(#) sin
Zxdx
/.
+ e~ 5v sin
3^7
J-
sin 3a?c?^
+ &c
(a
SECT. VII.]
or
l
211
-TTV *
rn
4- e~
2v
sin
e~
5v
2x sin 2a
sin
+
a
is
3^
sin 3x
&c.)
new
variable,
which disappears
after integration.
If the
sum
and
if it
be substituted
of v in a finite form.
The
equal to
- a) -
cos (x
+ a)] +
e~
Zy
[cos 2 (x
(a?
- a) -
cos 2 (x
(x
+ a)] +
&c.
;
+
denoting by F (y,p)
e~
v
e~
zv
[cos 3
- a) - cos 3
a)]
the
-f
sum
cosp
e~^ cos 2^
e* v cos
3/>
-f
&a,
we
find
TTl
1
f/W ^
We
have also
,-(v+p\/-i)
g-to-pV-i)
g-(i/+PV-l)
or
F(y
p)
=
e
*Pv
-2cos/?-fe-<" cos^?
whence
cos (# 4- a) -L 2 cos
e"
2 cos
or
(a?
ct)
4- e
^ ^
-j-
"~
-) + e^]
or,
[e
-2
cos
TTU
fit
/()
o
f
-J
-i
^_ 2 cos
~
-*) +
>-"
(a?
^-2cos(^+ a) + ^j
142
212
THEOKY OF HEAT.
[CH.
III.
SECT. VII.
-^ + -=-$
0,
the uniform
its
movement
tions are
general integral, which has two arbitrary functions; these func by the very nature of the problem determinate, and nothing arbitrary remains but the function /(a), considered
and a = ?r. Equation (a) represents, under a simple form, suitable for numerical applications, the same value of v reduced to a convergent series.
between the limits a =
to x = TT, and from y to take the integral fdxfdy v from x y = oo ; the result would be proportianal to the quantity required.
In general there
is
no property of the uniform movement of heat which is not exactly represented by this
problems of this kind from another point
in different
We
of view,
bodies.
CHAPTER
IV.
SECTION
I.
THE
movement
of heat
it is
dv
Kdv
2
hi
,7
dt~Cl)dx*~~CDS
The problem
write
it
is
now
dv
to
integrate
this
equation
we may
simply
d*v
,
wherein k represents
-=
x denotes the
>
of the ring and the length of the arc included between a point and v is the temperature which would be observed at origin 0,
the point
after a given
time
t.
We
first
7
assume v = e~ ht ufx
72 V
this
equation belongs to the case in which the radiation is nul at the surface, since it may be derived from the preceding equa tion by making h = we conclude from it that the different
:
medium, without
law
In fact on integrating the equation -77 = &-TT we should dt (tx find the values of u which to different points of the correspond
>
214
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. IV.
ring at the same instant, and we should ascertain of the solid would be if heat were propagated in
loss at
what the
it
state
the surface
same instant
all
this loss
had occurred,
.
it will
be sufficient to multiply
points, at the
same
is
instant,
by the same
Thus the
effected at the surface does not change the law of the distribution of heat the only result is that the tempera
cooling which
is
less
than
it
this
circumstance, and the temperature diminishes from this cause ht according to the successive powers of the fraction e~
.
239.
to the
integration of the
select the sim-
72
equation -jdt
=k
dx*
we
shall, in
the
first place,
which can be attributed to the variable plest particular values from them we shall then compose a general value, and we ;
shall prove that this value is as extensive as the integral,
which
is
contains an
arbitrary function
of
or,
or
rather that
it
this
arranged under the form which the problem re integral so that there cannot be any different solution. quires,
itself,
It may be remarked first, that the equation is satisfied if we mt and n being subject give to u the particular value ae sin nx, Take then as a particular value of Jen*. to the condition u the function e~ knH sin nx.
may
x
distance
is
Hence
Zirnr
ft
must be a
multiple
which gives n
=-
We may
take
to be
if
it
to always positive, since, the sign of the coefficient a in the value ae~ knH sin nx. change
suffice
it
to
be
The
_ k
n
r*
particular value ae
it
proposed unless
Now
on making
0,
we
find
= a sin
7 or
:
SECT.
I.]
PARTICULAR SOLUTIONS.
215
initial
is
to
Vv
which pass through those points and that which passes through the origin, the movement of heat in the interior of the ring will
Jet
equation u
ae
r*
sin -
and
find
if
we take account
we
ae
-(h + tyt *v
sm r
X
.
In the case in question, which is the simplest of all those which we can imagine, the variable temperatures preserve their primi tive ratios, and the temperature at any point diminishes accord ing to the successive powers of a fraction which is the same for
every point.
The same
initial
/Vl
properties would be noticed if we supposed the temperatures to be proportional to the sines of the double
;
of the arc -
and
in general the
i being
any integer
We
2mrr
nx
= 2V,
and n
u
expresses the
initial
ae
-k% cos r
ix
movement
In
the ratios
established
exist
con
216
be the case
if
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. IV.
function a sin
efficients
b cos
any co
whatever.
Let us pass now to the general case in which the initial temperatures have not the relations which we have just supposed, but are represented by any function whatever F(x). Let us give
240.
(x\
imagine the function
</>(-)
so that
we have
(as)
(
<j>
ic\
j
,
and
of
to be
series
coefficients.
We
write
(O r) ) \
+ a,
X
sin
(l rj ] \
a 2 sin (2 *} rj \
&c.
+&
The numbers a a lt a a ..., 6 ^, 6 2 ... are regarded as known and calculated beforehand. It is evident that the value of u will then be represented by the equation
,
,
a,
sm cos -
fc
r*
sin 2 .
=*
-L
&c.
o,
>
cos
2r
In
since
d/x
-7- j,
the sum of several particular values 2nd, it does not when we increase the distance x by any multiple whatever change
it is
of the circumference of the ring ; 3rd, it satisfies the initial state, since on making t = 0, we find the equation (e). Hence all the
it
remains only to
241. As the time increases, each of the terms which compose the value of u becomes smaller and smaller ; the system of tem peratures tends therefore continually towards the regular and con-
SECT.
I.]
COMPLETE SOLUTION.
217
u from the
sm - +
r
x\
b cos
rj
Thus the particular values which we have previously considered, and from which we have composed the general value, derive their Each of them represents an origin from the problem itself. state which could exist of itself as soon as it is sup elementary posed to be formed these values have a natural and necessary
;
To determine the coefficients a lt a 2 &c., 6 6 1? & 2 must employ equation (II), Art. 234, which was proved
,
&c.,
we
in the
last section of
let
Let the whole abscissa denoted by in this equation be 2?rr, x be the variable abscissa, and let f(x] represent the initial
x=
to
we have then
*)
3 //(
+
b
sin in
(3/
sn si
in
if
Knowing
,
this
manner
the values
of
1,
a2
&c.,
they be substituted in the equation we have the following equation, which contains the complete solution of
b t , b 2 , &c.,
the problem
irrv
x sm .
kt
COS2 -
r /
I (
2t
sin
sin
rj\
cos 2 (
/ (x) a
*
+ &al
/(a?)
(E).
fcoB
dx
J
218
THEORY OF HEAT.
All the integrals must be taken from
[CHAP. IV.
to
x=
2?rr.
The
v, is
first
term
\f(
x ] d x which
>
evidently the mean initial temperature, that is to say, that all the initial heat were distri .which each point would have
it"
We
by the action of a source of heat to its permanent temperatures, the source is suddenly suppressed 2nd, the case in which half the ring, having been equally heated
;
half,
throughout which
k1
We
by the equation
,
= azx + bz~x
the
KS where I is the value of quantity a being e perimeter of the and S the area of that section. generating section,
If
it
is
equation
must
boT = occupied by the source. The condition aoL will therefore be satisfied at this point. For convenience of calcu
that which
is
-yj
to
let
us take the radius r of the ring to be the radius of the trigono x x metrical tables, we shall then have v = ae + be~ hence th<~mitial
;
is
= le*(e*+*+e).
It remains only to apply the general equation (E), and de the mean initial heat (Art. 241), we shall have noting by
its
SECT.
I.]
FURTHER APPLICATION.
219
243.
In order to
equation (E), that half the ring included between x = and x = TT has through out the temperature 1, the other half having the temperature 0.
It
we
shall
make
is required to determine the state of the ring after the lapse of a time t.
The function
case such that
/(#),
its
value
f(x)
and TT. It follows from this that we must suppose to x = TT, the and take the integrals only from x = other parts of the integrals being nothing by hypothesis. We "obtain first the which gives the development following equation, of the function proposed, whose value is 1 from x = Q to X = TT and nothing from x = TT to x = 2w,
between
= 1,
f( x )
=o+
A
7T \
sm x +
o O
si
n %x + ^
O
sin oaj
= sin
/
7-z
+ &c.
If now we substitute in the general equation the values which we have just found for the constant coefficients, we shall have the
equation x
2i
TTV
= e~ ht t-77r +
\4
sin
kt
+^ o
sin
oxe~ 5ZJct
+ &c
which expresses the law according to which the temperature at each point of the ring varies, and indicates its state after any given time we shall limit ourselves to the two preceding applica tions, and add only some observations on the general solution
:
If
is
supposed
infinite,
is
= e~ ht
^lf(x)dx
denoting by
the
initial temperature (Art. 241), v e~ M M. The temperature at every point becomes suddenly equal to the mean temperature, and all the different points retain always equal temperatures,
mean
which admit
is
infinite conducibility.
220
2nd.
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. IV.
if
We
To
were
infinitely small.
3rd.
find the
mean temperature
we must take
divide
the integral
\f(x)dx from x =
x=%7rr, and
by
2?rr.
2?rr, we find the parts of the value of u, and then supposing x total values of the integrals to be nothing except for the first term the value of the mean temperature is therefore, after the
;
the quantity e~ M M. Thus the mean temperature of the ring decreases in the same manner as if its conducibility were in finite the variations occasioned by the propagation of heat in the
time
t,
solid
this temperature.
we have just considered, the tem decreases in proportion to the powers of the fraction e~ h , perature or, which is the same thing, to the ordinate of a logarithmic
In the three cases which
curve, the abscissa being equal to the time
known
but
it
dimensions.
does not generally hold unless the bodies are of small The previous analysis tells us that if the diameter of
a ring is not very small, the cooling at a definite point would not be at first subject to that law the same would not be the case with the mean temperature, which decreases always in proportion For the rest, it must not to the ordinates of a logarithmic curve.
;
be forgotten that the generating section of the ring is supposed to have dimensions so small that different points of the same section
do not
differ sensibly in
temperature.
4th.
If
we wished
escapes in a given
to ascertain the quantity of heat which time through the surface of a given portion of
\
dt
be taken between limits relative to the time. if we took and ZTT to be the limits of x, and
to be the
limits of t\ that is to say, if we wished to determine the whole quantity of heat which escapes from the entire surface, during the
complete course of the cooling, we ought to find after the integra tions a result equal to the whole quantity of the initial heat, or QjrrM, being the mean initial temperature.
SECT.
I.]
221
5th.
we wish
to ascertain
how much heat flows in a given the ring, we must employ the
-ycLx
KS
dt
-=-
dx
writing for
Heat tends to be distributed in the ring according to a law which ought to be noticed. The more the time which has elapsed increases the smaller do the terms which compose the value of v in equation (E) become with respect to those
245.
which precede them. There is therefore a certain value of t for which the movement of heat begins to be represented sensibly
by the equation
/
=a +
n
- 4(a. sin l r \
Z>
cos - ) e rj
x\
_Tct
r.
The same
of the cooling. In this state, if we choose two points of the ring situated at the ends of the same diameter, and represent their
by
their cor
shall
have
= Ja + (^
~ 1a +
f
,
sin^-l-^ cos^-H
~^^~
-
ht
v2
t \
i l
sm
x*
r
+
,
T,
&i
cos
X2\ rj
The
same
is
sines of the
two arcs
and
-f differ only in
or
TT
sign
the
and cos
r
hence
thus the half-sum of the temperatures at opposite points gives a quantity a e~ ht which would remain the same if we chose two
,
points situated at the ends of another diameter. a e~ht, as we have seen above, is the value of the
ture after the time
at
t.
The quantity
mean tempera
Hence the half-sum of the temperature any two opposite points decreases continually with the mean temperature of the ring, and represents its value without sensible Let us error, after the cooling has lasted for a certain time.
222
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. IV.
is
which
-\a Q
/
f
sin
X -
+ 6,
-L
cos
X \ --} e
-j
<*>
e~ ht
If
first
we
we have
\
)
,
the
condition
a, sin
+b
cos r
= 0,
or r
arc tan
\aj
we
the
see that the temperature at this point is at every instant mean temperature of the ring the same is the case with
:
the point diametrically opposite for the abscissa x of the latter point will also satisfy the above equation
;
IT
r)
arc tan
L
I
a^
first
Let us denote by
points
is
X the
of these
situated,
and we
shall
have
sin
X
y;
r
=-a
cos
and substituting
this value of b lt
we have
cos
r
If
we now take
which corre
abscissa
X, and
if
= e~ ht
At
sn - e
.the origin, where the abscissa u is 0, and at the opposite the temperature v is always equal to the mean tempera point, ture these two points divide the circumference of the ring into two parts whose state is similar, but of opposite sign each point
; ;
of one of these parts has a temperature which exceeds the mean temperature, and the amount of that excess is proportional to
SECT.
1.]
223
other part has a temperature less than the mean temperature, is the same as the excess at the opposite point. This symmetrical distribution of heat exists throughout the whole
At the two ends of the heated half, duration of the cooling. two flows of heat are established in direction towards the cooled
half,
and their
effect
is
mean
temperature.
that in the general equation which is of the form
cos
i
x r
+ b.
x\ }
-l
<>
^.
r)
We
can therefore derive, with respect to each term, consequences In fact denoting by the distance
sin i
\-
b.
cos i
r
is
nothing,
we have
the equation
6.
a tan i
t
X
,
and
this sub
It follows
from
by u the new
as the origin of co-ordinates, and denoting abscissa x X, we have, as the expression of the
v,
the function
smi-e
make
If this particular part of the value of v existed alone, so as to the coefficients of all the other parts nul, the state of the
ae~ ht e~
r2
Sin (l \ rj
,
.u\
and the temperature at each point would be proportional to the sine of the multiple i of the distance of this point from the origin. This state is analogous to that which we have already described
224
it differs
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. IV.
from it in that the number of points which have always the same temperature equal to the mean temperature of the ring is not 2 only, but in general equal to 2i. Each of these points or
nodes separates two adjacent portions of the ring which are in a similar state, but opposite in sign. The circumference is thus
is
alter
nately positive and negative. The flow of heat is the greatest possible in the nodes, and is directed towards that portion which is in the negative state, and it is nothing at the points which are The ratios which exist equidistant from two consecutive nodes. then between the temperatures are preserved during the whole of
the cooling, and the temperatures vary together very rapidly in proportion to the successive powers of the fraction
If we give successively to i the values 0, 1, 2, 3, &c., we shall ascertain all the regular and elementary states which heat can
assume whilst it is propagated in a solid ring. When one of these simple modes is once established, it is maintained of itself, and the ratios which exist between the temperatures do not change; but whatever the primitive ratios may be, and in whatever manner the ring may have been heated, the movement of heat can be de composed into several simple movements, similar to those which we have just described, and which are accomplished all together without disturbing each other. In each of these states the tempe
rature
is
tance from a fixed point. The sum of all these partial temperatures, taken for a single point at the same instant, is the actual tempera Now some of the parts which compose this ture of that point.
It follows decrease very much more rapidly than the others. from this that the elementary states of the ring which correspond to different values of i, and whose superposition determines the total movement of heat, disappear in a manner one after the other. They cease soon to have any sensible influence on the
sum
value of the temperature, and leave only the first among them to In this manner we form an exist, in which i is the least of all.
exact idea of the law according to which heat
is
distributed in
a ring, and
is
The
SECT.
II.]
225
it has a natural tendency, and which con that the temperatures of the different points become proportional to the sine of the same multiple of the arc which measures the distance from the origin. The initial distribution
makes no change
in these results.
SECTION
Of the communication of heat
II.
247. We have now to direct attention to the conformity of the foregoing analysis with that which must be employed to de termine the laws of propagation of heat between separate masses ; we shall thus arrive at a second solution of the problem of the
movement
of heat in a ring. Comparison of the two results will indicate the true foundations of the method which we have fol
lowed, in integrating the equations of the propagation of heat in continuous bodies. shall examine, in the first place, an ex
We
is that of the communication of heat between two equal masses. Suppose two cubical masses m and n of equal dimensions and of the same material to be unequally heated; let their respective
temperatures be a and
If
b,
and
let
them be
of infinite conducibility.
these two bodies in contact, the temperature in each would suddenly become equal to the mean temperature \ (a + 6).
we placed
Suppose the two masses to be separated by a very small interval, that an infinitely thin layer of the first is detached so as to be joined to the second, and that it returns to the first immediately after the contact. Continuing thus to be transferred alternately, and at equal infinitely small intervals, the interchanged layer
causes the heat of the hotter body to pass gradually into that which is less heated; the problem is to determine what would be,
after a given time, the heat of each body, if they lost at their sur face no part of the heat which they contained. do not suppose
We
manner
we have
just described:
we wish
only to determine by analysis the result of such an hypothesis. Each of the two masses possessing infinite conducibility, the quantity of heat contained in an infinitely thin layer, is sudF. H.
-
15
226
THEORY OF HEAT.
it is
[CHAP. IV.
in contact;
and a
common temperature results which is equal to the quotient of the sum of the quantities of heat divided by the sum of the masses.
Let be the mass of the infinitely small layer which is separated from the hotter body, whose temperature is a; let a and ft be the variable temperatures which correspond to the time t, and whose
ft)
a and
Z>.
When the
it
&>,
layer
co is
mass
ture
m
a,
has like this mass the tempera which becomes and as soon as it touches the second body affected with the
/3,
temperature
it
temperature equal to
temperature, returns to the
The
first
co
and
temperature
contact
a.
We
a v [m
a))
/w/3
\
+ aftA
&>
m+
co
c:m
m
The
dt,
a.
or
4- G)
variable temperatures
ft}
Tfl>
a.
and
f
;
/3
-f (a
and
ft -f (a
/3)
ITb
co.
We
thus have
the mass which had the initial temperature (3 has received in one instant a quantity of heat equal to md@ or (a ft) co, which has
been
lost in
first
mass.
We
see
by
this
that the quantity of heat which passes in one instant from the most heated body into that which is less heated, is, all other things being equal, proportional to the actual difference of temperature
of the
two bodies. The time being divided into equal intervals, the infinitely small quantity co may be replaced by kdt, k being the number of units of mass whose sum contains co as many times as
the unit of time contains
obtain the equations
dt,
so that
we have - =
co
dt
We
thus
dz
= -(a-j3)~dt
and d&
= (a - 0) - dt.
SECT.
II.]
RECIPROCAL CONDUCIBILITY.
227
248.
serves,
for the
it
If \ve attributed a greater value to the volume w, which may be said, to draw heat from one of the bodies
purpose of carrying it to the other, the transfer would be quicker in order to express this condition it would be necessary to increase in the same ratio the quantity k which
;
enters
of
G)
into
the
equations.
We
might
also
retain
the value
to accomplish in a given
time a
of oscillations, which again would be indicated a greater value of k. Hence this coefficient represents in some by respects the velocity of transmission, or the facility with which
greater
number
heat passes from one of the bodies into the other, that
their reciprocal conducibility.
is
to say,
249.
d/3
0,
and
if
we
we have
d*-d/3+2
(a-/3)
7)1
rft
0,
and,
making
= ;/,
is
a-
b,
we have y =
_1M
(a
b) e
The
differ
=-(a + l) ---(a-b}
250.
_??
e
,
ft
(a
b)
- b}
-***
mass
&>,
In the preceding case, we suppose the infinitely small by means of which the transfer is effected, to be always
the same part of the unit of mass, or, which is the same thing, we suppose the coefficient k which measures the reciprocal con To render the investigation ducibility to be a constant quantity.
in question more general, the as a function of the two actual
temperatures
and
dt,
ft.
We
should
dx.
=-
(a
- ft)
and
152
228
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
IV.
<?=(-)-<#,
in which k would be equal to a function of a and /?, which we It is easy to ascertain the law which denote by (a, /?). the variable temperatures a and /3 follow, when they approach extremely near to their final state. Let y be a new unknown
<f>
is
+ 6)
or
c.
p. 2
;
We
and,
substitute in place of a and /3 their values c as the problem is to find the values of y
small,
y and and z,
we need
of
first
power
y and
We
therefore
and
dz
k
(z
tail
y]
$(c
y, c
z) dt,
and omit
(/>
We
find
dy=(z
y)
$>dt,
and dz
(z
y]
7?2>
<f>dt.
constant,
it
follows that the preceding equations give for the value of the difference z y,& result similar to that which we found above for
the value of a
/3.
From
at
first
this
we conclude
that
if
the coefficient
k,
which was
supposed constant, were represented by any function whatever of the variable temperatures, the final changes which these temperatures would experience, during an infinite time, would still be subject to the same law as if the reciprocal conThe problem is actually to determine ducibility were constant. the laws of the propagation of heat in an indefinite number of equal masses whose actual temperatures are different.
251.
to
m, are
Prismatic masses n in number, each of which is equal supposed to be arranged in the same straight line,
different temperatures a,
b, c, d,
&c.
infinitely
SECT.
II.]
LINE.
229
of which has a mass co, are supposed to be from the different bodies except the last, and are. separated conveyed in the same time from the first to the second, from the second to the third, from the third to the fourth, and so on immediately after contact, these layers return to the masses from which they were separated the double movement taking
place as
is
times as there are infinitely small instants dt\ it to find the law to which the changes of temperature required
many
I
r
-
are subject.
Let a, {$,%$,... co, be the variable values which correspond to the same time t, and which have succeeded to the initial values
a, b,
c,
d, &c.
first
have been separated from the masses, and put in contact with the neighbouring
the layers
co
When
masses,
it is
a(m
ft
(m
co) -f
aco
m
S
o)
m
+ 70)
ma)
7 (m
co)
+ {3co
(m
co)
m
or,
a,
m+
7+ (-7)^,
co
co
/3
(a-/3)^,
... + (78)^,
When
find
the layers
new temperatures we in dividing the sum consists of the masses, and we have
the instant
dt,
have returned to their former places, according to the same rule, which
of the quantities of heat by the sum as the values of a, ft, 7, S, &c., after
7+
The
coefficient of
- 7-
7)
">
>
+ (f -
>)
is
dif-
7,
...
-^,
co.
As
to the first
and
last
coefficients of
they
may be
a,
term
to be
co
230
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. IV.
have then, as formerly, on followed by a term equal to ay. the following equations kdt for substituting
:
&>,
We
252.
the
these equations,
we assume, according
to
Ajjflj,
...
mined.
The
:
substitutions
being constant quantities which must be deter being made, we have the following
equations
ift
k = -(-i)>
A = -{(s-
)-(a8 -a
1 )},
k quantity, we find the expression a2 a v and A, then that of az in a 2 and h ; the same the case with all the other unknowns, a4 a5 &c. The first and
If
t
we regard a
as a
known
for
is
in terms of
last
equations
may be
m
and
^=
(K +1 -
<O
K - Ol-
SECT.
II.]
231
= ax and an = a^, the value Retaining the two conditions a of 2 contains the first power of h, the value of a3 contains the
which contains the h, and so on up to a B+1 This arranged, a a+l becoming equal to an we ih have, to determine h, an equation of the n degree, and a t re mains undetermined.
second power of
,
nth power of
li.
It follows
from
this that
we
shall find
n values
for A,
and in
accordance with the nature of linear equations, the general value of a is composed of n terms, so that the quantities a, /5, 7, ... &c.
are determined
= a/ +
a/e*
<
+ a, +a
V"
= a/* + + 7=
a/<
<e*
V+
V"
&c.,
&c,
&c.
ay + a
"
<
-f
to
=a
+
A",
+ a V* + &c.
The values of h, ti, &c. are n in number, and are equal to the n roots of the algebraical equation of the n ih degree in h, which has, as we shall see further on, all its roots real. The
coefficients of the first
;
arbitrary
as for
th"e
equation a lf a/, a", a" , &c., are coefficients of the lower lines, they are deter
of systems of equations similar to the pre is now to form these equations.
mined by a number n
ceding equations.
The problem
letter
253.
Writing the
q instead of -jA/
we have the
fol-
lowing equations
We
whose
series
two terms
(q
+ 2)
and
1.
We
232
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. IV.
am =
A sin mu + B sin (m
1) u,
determining suitably the quantities A, B, and u. First we find A and by supposing m equal to and then equal to 1, which = B sin w, and a = A sin it, and consequently gives a
am
a
,
sin ?WM
sin
sin M
(m
i\ 1) u.
a
,n>
-!
<W
&C
m -lfe
2 )-<V 2
>
we
find
sin
mu =
(<
2) sin
(m
1)
sin
(m
2) w,
mu
2 cos u sin (m
1)
sin
(w
2) u,
sines of arcs increasing that q -f 2 = cos u, or in arithmetic, progression, we conclude = 2 versin w it remains only to determine the value of the q arcw.
;
of a m being
?m
sin
(m -
1) w],
we must
equation
have, in order to
satisfy the
condition an+l
=^
an9 the
sin (n
-f
1)
sin u
= sin ?m
or
sin (n
TT
1)
whence we deduce
circumference and
i
sin
nu
0,
TT
any
integer, such as 0,
.
1, 2, 3, 4, ...
1)
Thus
}
all
the roots
li
ti,
h",
\ &c.
SECT.
II.]
PARTICULAR TEMPERATURE-VALUES.
233
A==-2-versinfo-V m nj \
/*,
T=
H
o ^ versin 2
7>i
/-i
1 -
^
,
"
n)
\
C\
"*
versin
I Ct
2 -
i 1
1}
=-2
s-\
Z*v
I/
versin
771
(n
- 1)
tv"!
} .
Suppose then that we have divided the semi-circumference TT n equal parts, and that in order to form u, we take i of those parts, i being less than n, we shall satisfy the differential equations by taking a l to be any quantity whatever, and making
into
sin = .- u
sin
=
sin
Qu - ? versin M m e
p
1
Sin 2 It
Sin Iw -^versinu
sin
sin 3i
:
u
sin
= a,
2u -
~
e
versin
sin
w=
As
namely,
A 0there are
also
7T
,
sin
a.
?m
sin (n
^
:
V}u -^ versin w J m
e
sin
there
are
different
arcs
which we
may
-
take
for
u,
-7T ,
2 -
7T
TN"^
71
71
(n
i) X
71
n systems
a,
fS,
7,
&c.,
and the general values of these variables are the sums of the
particular values.
254
.,
We
.
if
the arc u
is
which multiply
to unity, since
the values of
sin Oz
: ,
..
a, j3, 7, &c.,
.
become
all
equal
arc
sin
u
sin
u
is
when the
234
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
IV.
found in the following equations. From this. we conclude that constant terms must enter into the general values of a, 7, ...
&>.
Further, adding
a, /3, 7,
...
all
&c.,
we have
a+
/3+7 + &c. =
nu e
verem u
r ;
smu
an equation whose second member is reduced to provided the arc u does not vanish but in that case we should find n to be
;
the value of
sin
We
a
+ /3 + 7 + &c. = na
now the
initial values of
a, b, c, &c.,
we must
necessarily have
na
it
= a + b + c + &c.
follows that the constant term which must enter into each of
is
(a
+ b + c + &c.),
that
is
to say, the
mean
A 7,
...
G>,
,
1
Sin
U
sin
Sin
Ou
-^ venin
-
u*
u
sin
Ow"
sin
u"
venm
+ &c.,
_
1 (a
+ & + c + &c.) +
sin 2 M
a1
--
sin
M --
-^vewiuu
s
Sill
2M
Sin id
versln
Sin
CI
- 2Z*"
Sin
u"
sin
-^ vemin
r
u"
&c,
SECT.
1
II.]
GENEKAL TEMPERATURE-VALUES.
sin 3it sin
235
2u
-^versm.*
sin sin
u
sin
3w
2w -
^^
sm
+ c,
sin
3*"
sin
&c.,
255.
To determine the
constants
a, b, c,
<#...&c.,
we must
consider the initial state of the system. In fact, when the time is nothing, the values of a, /3, 7, &c. must be equal to a, 6, c, &c.; we have then n similar equations to determine the n constants.
The
sinw
quantities
sinOw, sin2w
sinw, sin3w
sin2w,
...
sin
nu
sin (n
1) u,
may be
A sin ou,
...
A sin
(?i
1)
the equations proper for the determination of the constants are, if the initial mean temperature be represented by C,
a
,
= (7+ a + b + q + &c.
t
sin
A sin
A sin
u"
236
THEORY OF HEAT.
The
quantities a^ b l} q,
[CHAP. IV.
equations,
0, 7,
3, ...co.
We
these
can in general effect the elimination of the unknowns in the values of the quantities equations, and determine
&c. even
;
a, b, c, d,
when
the
number
of equations
is
infinite
we
shall
employ
examining the equations which give the general we see that as the time values of the variables a, j3, 7 ...... in the value of each variable de increases the successive terms
256.
o>,
On
u,
p
u",
u",
&c. being
- 7T
7T
7T
,
&c.,
the
exponents
versin u,
versin u,
versin
u",
versin
u",
&c.
become greater and greater. If we suppose the time t to be infinite, the first term of each value alone exists, and the tempera ture of each of the masses becomes equal to the mean tempera
ture - (a
IV
+ b + c +...&G.).
continually increases,
follows that to ascertain the law which the ultimate changes of temperature follow, we need con sider only the two first terms; all the others becoming incom
u, it
parably smaller according as the time t increases. The ultimate variations of the temperatures a, ft, 7, &c. are therefore expressed
n
1
(a
+ b + c + &c. + a
,
Sin
sin
Sin
Qu
-versinu
f P=-(a + + c + &c.) + n
^
Sill 2lt
:
<LI
- -Sin
U
e
~*~
versin
sin
1, = - (a + b + c + &c.) + n
7
.
S
cfj
sm
SECT.
II.]
CONCLUDING TEMPERATURES.
If
237
we divide the semi-circumference into n equal parts, and, having drawn the sines, take the difference between two consecutive sines, the n differences are proportional to the co257.
_
efficients of e
a,
r
,
versin
or
of
@, 7,...&).
For
this reason
& y...w
are
such that the differences between the final temperatures and the
mean
tional
initial
temperature
differences
(a
+c+
&c.)
are always
propor
to
the
of
first
consecutive
effected
finally
according
a constant
law.
If
we
measured the temperatures in the last stage, when they differ little from the mean temperature, we should observe that the difference between the temperature of any mass whatever and the
mean temperature
sive
and comparing amongst them taken at the same instant, we should see that the differences between the actual temperatures and the mean temperature are proportional to the
selves the temperatures of the different masses
other to be infinite in number, we find for the arc u an infinitely small value ; hence the differences of consecutive sines, taken on
the
circle,
,
sin
mu
sin
:
arcs; for
(m
\JL
l)u.is
sin
equal
to
cos mil,
when the
tem
arc
In this case, the quantities whose infinitely small. peratures taken at the same instant differ from the mean
is
tempera
must
which correspond to different points of the circumference divided into an infinite number of equal parts. If the masses which transmit heat are situated at equal distances from each other on
the perimeter of the semi-circumference TT, the cosine of the arc at the end of which any one mass is placed is the measure of the
quantity by which the temperature of that mass differs yet from the mean temperature. Thus the body placed in the middle of all the others is that which arrives most quickly at that mean
238
THEORY OF HEAT.
;
[CHAP. IV.
temperature those which are situated on one side of the middle, all have an excessive temperature, which surpasses the mean temperature the more, according as they are more distant from the middle the bodies which are placed on the other side, all
;
have a temperature lower than the mean temperature, and they differ from it as much as those on the opposite side, but in con trary sense. Lastly, these differences, whether positive or negative,
decrease at the same time, proportionally to the successive powers of the same fraction so that they do not cease to be repre
all
;
sented at the same instant by the values of the cosines of the same semi-circumference. Such in general, singular cases excepted, is the law to which the ultimate temperatures are subject.
The
initial state of
proceed now
remarks.
the system does not change these results. We problem of the same kind as the
many
useful
\.
Suppose n equal prismatic masses to be placed at equal All these bodies, distances on the circumference of a circle. have known actual temperatures, enjoying perfect conducibility, different for each of them they do not permit any part of the heat which they contain to escape at their surface an infinitely thin layer is separated from the first mass to be united to the second, which is situated towards the right at the same time a parallel layer is separated from the second mass, carried from left to right, and joined to the third; the same is the case with all the
259.
; ;
other masses, from each of which an infinitely thin layer is sepa rated at the same instant, and joined to the following mass. Lastly, the same layers return immediately afterwards, and are
Heat is supposed to be propagated between the masses by means of these alternate movements, which are accomplished
twice during each instant of equal duration; the problem is to find according to what law the temperatures vary that is to say,
:
the initial values of the temperatures being given, it is required to^ ascertain after any given time the new temperature of each of the
masses.
We
shall denote
by a iy a z aJz ,...a ...oJn the initial temperatures arbitrary, and by a v a 2 a s ...a ...& n the values of
,
SECT.
II.]
239
the same temperatures after the time t has elapsed. Each of the quantities a is evidently a function of the time t and of all the
initial
values
a.
a lf a z
a 3 ...a n
it
is
required to
determine the
functions
260.
mass of the layer by a). We may remark, in the first place, that when the layers have been separated from the masses of which they have formed part, and placed re
which
is
We
at
>
a>a
n,
(m
CD)
-f
a>z
(in
o>)
a3
+ coy
2,
. .
.,
(m
a>)
an
+ w^n-i dividing each of these quantities of heat by the mass m, we have for the new values of the temperatures
+
// V
(**-t
Gi)
and a
+
i/V
-l
~a
that
first
is
new
contact,
we must add
to the value
which
it
product of
by the excess
of the
from which the layer has been separated over that of the body to which it has been joined. By the same rule it is found that the
temperatures, after the second contact, are
and suppose
mass as many times as dt is contained in the units of we thus have = kdt. Calling Ja,, da 2 (fa 3 ...da.,...cfa H the time,
a>
240
infinitely small
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. IV.
4
increments which the temperatures a 15 2 ,...a ...an dt, we have the following differential
equations
Ja 2
= -dt
k = -dt
d*i
^-i = -^( a
Illi
-2
- 2 Vi +
<>>
~
<fe.^
<&(<.._,
-2*. 4 a,).
we suppose
in the first place,
261.
To
according to the
known method,
62 &3
...
The
also
is
ff
quantities 6 t
&
It is the exponent li. the differential equations B satisfy 2 cij, the following conditions
,...
:
(6
-26,
7/i
Let
= -v- we
,
6.-, (2
+2 -J
)
SECT.
II.]
PARTICULAR SOLUTION.
241
from this that we may take, instead of b 1 ,b z) b 3 ,... the n consecutive sines which are obtained by dividing the .,...6n whole circumference 2?r into n equal parts. In fact, denoting the
It follows
,
Z>
T7"
arc
2- by iv
u,
the quantities
...
sin
(71
1) u,
whose number is n, belong, as it is said, to a recurring series whose scale of relation has two terms, 2 cos u and 1 so that we always have the condition
:
sin iu
2 cos u sin
2>
(i
l)u
,...
.
sin
,
(i
2) u.
Take
then, instead of b lt b
bB
bn
.
.
the quantities
.(
sin
!) u,
and we have
q
2 cos u,
2 versin
it,
or ^
2 versin
Iv
We
of ^
of b
t
is
2k -- versin
27T
;
and h we have
a
_2A*
.
"
"
2JT
sin
Oue
= sm zue
_
"
verein
"
an
262.
= sm
equations furnish only a very particular solu = we have, as problem proposed ; for if we suppose t the quantities the initial values of a 1? 2 a 3 ...
last
The
tion of the
...
sin (n
1) M,
,
:
differ from the given values a lt a a aa) ...an but the foregoing solution deserves to be noticed because it ex presses, as we shall see presently, a circumstance which belongs to
which in general
all
possible cases,
F. H.
of the
16
242
temperatures.
peratures
j,
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. IV.
We
a2 a2
,
see by this solution that, if the initial were proportional to the sines ... a n
,
-,
tem
sm
27T
2-7T
27T
,
sin 1
sin
...
sin (n
N - 1)
2?T
same they would remain continually proportional to the we should have the equations
sines,
and
where h
2&
versin
2<7T
this reason, if the masses which are situated at equal dis on the circumference of a circle had initial temperatures tances proportional to the perpendiculars let fall on the diameter
For
which passes through the first point, the temperatures would vary with the time, but remain always proportional to those per pendiculars, and the temperatures would diminish simultaneously
as the terms of a geometrical
fraction e
progression
whose
ratio
is
the
-S n
versin
n
.
263.
first
solution,
we may remark
, ,
in the
,
instead of & 15 5 2 b 3
...
bn
the n
cosines corresponding to the points of division of the circumference divided into n equal parts. The quantities cos Ou, cos \u, cos 2w,...
cos (n
series
1) u, in
form
also
a recurring
for
whose scale of relation consists of two terms, 2 cos u and 1, which reason we could satisfy the differential equations by
of the following equations,
versin
7
,
means
otj
= = =
=r
cos
Oue
KM
2
versin
u
,
cos lue
Zkt
cos
2ue m
versin
cos (n
l)ue
SECT.
II.]
OTHER SOLUTIONS.
243
bz
63 ,
...
bn
the quantities
...,
sin(ft-l)2w;
...,
cos(?i
l)2w.
In
terms
;
fact,
is
and
if
we continued the
find
In general,
if
we denote the
2?T
,
2-7T
2-7T
1 ,
2-7T
n
by u lt M S ws
,
...,
(w
1)
&c.,
...,
W B we can take
,
63
...
bn
the w quantities,
sin
Ow
4 ,
sin
lw,.,
sin
2M
4 ,
sin
3w
4 ,
...,
sin (n
1) M,
or else
cos
Qu t) cos
lit.,
cos
2ttj,
cos SM,,
...,
cos
(?i
1)
is
The value
equation
given by the
i
/^
2&
771
versm
w,
We
i,
from
=1
to i
= n.
Substituting these values of b lf b 2 b 3 ... b n) in the equations we have the differential equations of Art. 260 satisfied the following results by
,
of Art. 261,
tfj
-^ versing
sin
*
Ott,
versin MJ
or
=
ofj
-^rn
cos
versinwj
,
sin 2t*4
cos 2u,e
-^
sin (n
1)
~^
versin
M*
,
=
7i
cos (n
1) M4 e
t \
-^
*
versin
162
244
264.
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
IV.
260 could equally be satisfied by ... a constructing the values of each one of the variables a x a a n 8 out of the sum of the several particular values which have been
of Art.
,
,
The equations
of the terms
which enter
into the general value of one of the variables may also be mul It follows from this that, tiplied by any constant coefficient.
may take to express the general value of one of the variables, a^j for example, the equation
of
denoting by whatever, we
Av B A B A B
I}
2,
...*A n)
n)
any
coefficients
==
wi+l
(A
sin
mu 4 B^ cos muj e
r>
^n
vers i n M
i
(A* sin
mu>,
4-
versin
11%
cos
mu)
"
-?**
+
The
(A n sin
versinw,,
7<
J5 X , J5a J5 8 ... n lt 33 quantities into this equation, are arbitrary, and the arcs enter
,
,
A A^A
:
...
Bn
which
,
u it u 2 ,u s
...
un
are given
by the equations
2?r
A ^ = 0-,
^2
- 2?r = 1-,
".
2?r = 2-,
...,
Wn
=(^l)-.
,
27T
The general
cfj,
aa
a8
...
a n are then
(A l sin Ow t
+B
_
5
cos
OuJ
sn
cos
_
versin
* 3
sn w +
&c.;
cos
_m versin
(A^ sin lu^
sin
+ B^ cos IttJ
4-
e
versin w 2
1
4 (A
\u z
lus
cos Iw2 ) e
versin
+ (A sin + &c.;
a
4 B3 cos lnj
SECT.
II.]
GENERAL SOLUTION.
245
a3
(A
cos
zty
versin
?<
4- (^4 2
2w a 4
2?/
1?3 cos
2w 2 )
-^
4 (J. + &c.
an
sin
;
4#
versin
*/
cos
2w a )
= (^
sin (n
1)^4-
^ cos (n
3
1)
t]
m
versin w 2
+
4
[A a
{-4.
sin (n
sin (n
1)
wa
+B
4
cos
(?i
(*i
1)
u9
e
- ?** versin
3
1)
wa
cos
1) iij e
4&c.
265.
If
cr
3,
.
. . .
an
We must become the same as the initial values a lt a2 ,a3 ... a n from this n equations, which serve to determine the coeffi derive It will readily be perceived that cients A v B V-A 2 B2 A y B3 the number of unknowns is always equal to the number of equa In fact, the number of terms which enter into the value tions.
,
of one
of these variables depends on the number of different quantities versin u l} versin w 2 versing, &c., which we find on
,
dividing the
circumference
2?r
2-7T
into
,
n equal
2-7T
parts.
Now
2-7T
the
&c.,
number
is
of quantities versin
versin 1
versin 2
n, if we count only those that are number n by 2^ 4 1 if it is odd, Denoting and by 2i if it is even, i 4 1 always denotes the number On the other hand, when in the of different versed sines.
very
much
less
than
different.
the
....
2?r
series
of
quantities
versin
n versin 1
2-7T
2-7T
versm 2
p
,
&c.,
we come
versin
and versed sine form only one term the two different arcs the same versed sine, have also the same cosine, x-, which, have and the sines differ only in sign. It is easy to see that the arcs Ux and u x which have the same versed sine, are such that
>,
246
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. TV.
the cosine of any multiple whatever of W A is equal to the cosine of the same multiple of w A and that the sine of any multiple
,
of
differs
of UK.
only in sign from the sine of the same multiple It follows from this that when we unite into one the
two corresponding terms of each of the equations, the two un knowns A^ and A A which enter into these equations, are replaced As to the two unknown by a single unknown, namely A^ A^. B^ and BX they also are replaced by a single one, namely J5A + BX it follows from this that the number of unknowns is equal in all for the number of terms is cases to the number of equations We must add that the unknown A disappears of i + 1. always
,
:
itself
from the
arc.
first
terms, since
it is
a nul
Further,
when
the
number n
at the end of each equation a term in which one of the disappears of itself, since it multiplies a nul sine
unknowns
thus the
unknowns which enter into the equations is equal to 2 (i + 1) 2, when the number n is even consequently the is the same in all these cases as the number number of unknowns
number
of
of equations.
266.
To
"
a
i>
a2
>
as
n>
express the general values of the temperatures re g tne g analysis furnishes us with the equa
fc>
tions
a1
= +
2-f
27T\
/
}e
-* m
2 verBinO -?
M
f
A
1 sm0.1
27r
D i +_B 2 cos0.1
2lT\
}e
sin
+B
cos
~ n
&c.,
SECT.
II.]
247
sn
2.1^ n
.
versinl
7?2
cos2.1^)/^ n J
9.ir\
? ^ n
9.TT
+ f^ V + &c,
=
f
sin 2
cos 2
J*M e~ -
v verein 2
JjSin (n-1) j
sin (n
n 27T
+B
cos
A 1)0
27T)
**
-=*<
\e
versin
1) 1
H^
cos (n
1)1
&c
To form these
equations,
we must continue
in each equation
versin 1
versin 2
&c.
until
different versed
sine and we must oniit all the subsequent terms, commencing with that in which a versed sine appears equal to one of the
;
preceding.
The number
of these equations
is n.
If
is
an even number
1 if n equal to 2t, the number of terms of each- equation is i the number of equations is an odd number represented by 2/+ 1,
;
the
number
of terms
,
is still
equal to
+ I.
Lastly,
among the
which enter into these equations, lt 2 I} quantities there are some which must be omitted because they disappear of themselves, being multiplied by nul sines.
&c.,
A B A B^
267.
To determine the
quantities
A V B^A V BV .A^BV
&c.,
which enter into the preceding equations, we must consider the = 0, and instead of initial state which is known suppose t a &c., write the given quantities a x a 2 a 3 &c., which are 2 3 the initial values of the temperatures. We have then to determine
:
lt
A B A B A B
lf lt
9
,
&c.,
248
THEORY OF HEAT.
sin 0.0^"+
[CHAP. IV.
=A
+ B. =A
t
sin
0.1
+ +
A
J5_
sin
0.2
?&
+
+
&c.
cos
+
?i
_
jR,
cos
w
^
.
cos
n
2?r
&c.
2?r
sin 1
A
,
2?r
sin 1
+ A.
+
._ .
sin 1
n
n
+ +
&c.
+ &ooai .0
8
n
2
cos 1
K cos 1
8
&c.
=A
+
sin 2
-+ 4
+
sin 2
+A
sin 2
+ &c.
+
&c.
A cos 2
B.2 cos 2
K cos 2
- 1)
/7T
In these equations, whose number is ??, the unknown quantities are A lt B lt A 2 B2 A 5 Bs &c., and it is required to effect the eliminations and to find the values of these unknowns.
268.
,
, ,
We may
remark,
first,
unknown has a
different
multiplier in each equation, and that the succession of multipliers composes a recurring series. In fact this succession is that of the
sines of arcs increasing in arithmetic progression, or of the cosines of the same arcs it be represented by may
;
sin Qu,
sin lu,
sin 2w,
sin 3w,
...
sin (n
1) u,
or
by
cos Qu,
cos lu,
cos 2w,
/2?r\
cos Su,
...
cos (n
I) u.
The
.
arc
is
equal to
I j
if
the
unknown
in question
is
A.+l
or B. +1 This arranged, to determine the unknown A i+l by means of the preceding equations, we must combine the succession of equations with the series of multipliers, sin Ow, sin lu, sin 2u,
sin Su, ... sin (n l)u and multiply each equation by the cor responding term of the series. If we take the sum of the equat
SECT.
tions
II.]
DETERMINATION OF COEFFICIENTS.
multiplied,
is
249
thus
we
eliminate
all
that which
if
required to be determined.
the value of we must multiply each i+l equation by the multiplier of B i+1 in that equation, and then take the sum of all the equations. It is requisite to prove that by operating in this manner we do in fact make all the unknowns
to find
;
we wish
disappear except one only. For this purpose it is sufficient to shew, firstly, that if we multiply term by term the two following series
sin Qu,
sin Qv,
sin lu,
sin 3u,
sin 3v,
...
sin (n
1) u,
sin lv,
...
sin (n
T)v,
the
sum
of the products
sin
Qu
sin Oy
sin
lu sin lv
&c.
nothing, except when the arcs u and v are the same, each of these arcs being otherwise supposed to be a multiple of a part
is
-;
secondly, that
if
we multiply
series
cos lu,
cos lv,
is
cos 2u,
cos 2v,
...
cos (n
1) u,
1) v,
cos Qv,
...
cos (n
the u
is
sum
of the products
;
nothing, except in
if
equal to v series
thirdly, that
sin Qu,
sin lu,
sin 2u,
...
1) u,
cos Qv,
cos lv,
is
cos 2y,
cos 3v,
...
cos (n
1) v,
the
sum
of the products
always nothing.
269.
by pq the arc
u,
and by
The ft and v being positive integers less than n. two terms corresponding to the two first series will be represented by
vq the arc v
product of
sin
jpq
sin jvq,
or - cos j
(//,
- v) q -
^ cosj
(>
+ v)q,
0, 1, 2, 3...
250
(n
1);
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. IV.
to j its
now
it is
values, from
cos
to (n
if
we give
n successive
(jj,
v)
cos 1
(fL
v)
cos 2 (p
v)
= cos 3
A
(fjL
v)
~ cos (n
1) (p
- v) q
is
+ v)
cos 1 (p
+ v)
.
.
+ +
cos 2 (p
v)
+
In
fact,
cos 3
(/A
+ v) ^ +
cos
g
or,
n~
1) (^
")
v)q by
which
is
consequently
a multiple of
we have the
cos 1#,
recurring series
.
. .
cos Oa,
cos 2z,
cos (w
1) a,
whose sum
is
nothing.
To shew this, we represent the sum by s, and the two terms of the scale of relation being 2 cos a and 1, we multiply successively the two members of the equation
s
cos Oa
+ cos
2a
+ cos
3a
cos (n
1) a
by
2 cos a and by
+1
manner
of re
curring series.
not. being a multiple of the whole cir the quantities cos (n cos (n cumference, 1.) a, 2) a, cos (n 3) a, &c. are respectively the same as those which have been denoted
If
by cos
a),
cos
2a), cos
3a),
...
&c.
;
we conclude
that
2s
25 cos a
thus the
way we
\ cos j (IJL by a is
to say,
The case in which the arc represented q is nothing. must be excepted we then have 1 - cos a = 0; that is the arcs it and v are the same. In this case the term
;
J cos,/
(jj,
+ v)
still
sum
is
nothing
SECT.
II.]
ELIMINATION.
251
but the quantity J cosj (ft q furnishes equal terms, each of value ^ hence the sum of the products term by which has the term of the two first series is i n.
i>)
In the same manner we can find the value of the sum of the products term by term of the two second series, or
S (cosjvq
in fact,
cosjvq)
we can
J cosj
(fj,
v)
% cosj
(fjb
+ v)
q,
and we then conclude, as in the preceding case, that 2 Jcos j(^+v)q is nothing, and that 2,-J cosj (/it v) q is nothing, except in the case = v. It follows from this that the sum of the products where term by term of the two second series, or 2(cosj/j,qcosjvq), is when the arcs u and v are different, and equal to \n always when u = v. It only remains to notice the case in which the arcs have as the value of fiq and vq are both nothing, when we
//,
S
first series.
(sinjfjiq sinjvq),
which denotes the sum of the products term by term of the two
The same is not the case with the sum 2(cosj/^ cosjvq) taken when /j.q and vq are both nothing the sum of the products term
;
by term
of the
two second
As
to the
sum
s
by term
...
of the
two
series
sin Ou,
mlu,
sin 2u,
sin 3u,
cos 3u,
easily
sin (n
1) u,
cos OM,
it is
cos lu,
all cases,
cos 2u,
as
cos (n
1)
nothing in
may
going analysis.
The comparison then of these series furnishes the follow If we divide the circumference 2?r into n equal ing parts, and take an arc u composed of an integral number p of these parts, and mark the ends of the arcs u, 2u, 3u, ... (n l)u, it
270.
results.
known
sin lu,
sin (n
l)u,
252
or indeed
cos Ou,
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
IV.
cos Iw,
cos 2w,
series
cos 3u,
...
cos (n
1) u,
:
composed of n terms
if
we com27T
p.
corresponding
to
another
arc v
or v
and
multiply term by term the two compared series, the sum of the products will be nothing when the arcs u and v are different. If the arcs u and v are equal, the sum of the products is equal to |-/?,
series of sines, or
but the
sum
is
nothing
if
If
we suppose the
u and
v to
be nul,
it is
sum
nothing whenever one of the two both are so formed, but the sum of the products is n bined series both consist of cosines. In general, the
;
products term by term is equal to 0, or \n or n would, moreover, lead directly to the same results. They are pro duced here as evident consequences of elementary theorems in
trigonometry.
271.
By means
of these remarks
it is
nation of the
unknowns
The unknown
we
disappears of itself through having nul coefficients ; to find B^ must multiply the two members of each equation by the co
efficient of
thus multiplied,
and on adding
all
the equations
To determine
we must multiply
the two
members
of each
in that equation,
and denoting
by
4-
q,
we
al
sin
0^
a 2 sin Iq
+a
sin 2q
-f
a n sin (n
l)q
Similarly to determine
rtj
we have
2</
cos 0^
4-
az cos
+a
cos
. .
a n cos (n - 1) q
=^
SECT.
II.]
253
In general we could find each unknown by multiplying the two members of each equation by the coefficient of the unknown in that equation, and adding the products. Thus we arrive at the
following results
:
n
2?r -n
-ftf 2 sin
I-
77
-fasm2-^"
+&c. = 2a sin(i-l)l ^
i
n
2?r
, + GLCOS!
2?r
+a
- 2?r
3
cos2
n
+ &c.= 2
cos(z-l)! J
.2
?i
+a
+a
71
cos2.2
?i
-f
&c.
= 2a,
cos
(i-l)2 }
sinl.3
sin2.3
71
+&c.=Sosin(*-l)3
?i
s^^cos 0.3
+
7i
cosl.3
71
+CLCOS2.3
+ &c. = 2a cos(i-l)3^ J n
i
.
&c .............................................
.....................
(M).
To
find the
development indicated by the symbol %, \ve must and take the sum,
^ ,. 1N/ g^=2asin(t-l)(;-l)
.
.
.,
2?r
and
,->
2?r
.
^B
=s2aodB(i-l)(;-l)
If we give to the integer^ all the successive values 1, 2, 3, 4, &c. which it can take, the two formulae give our equations, and if we develope the term under the sign 2, by giving to i its n values
1, 2, 3, ... n,
A B
3
,
3,
&c.j
we have the values of the unknowns A l9 J$lt and the equations (ra), Art. 267, are completely now substitute &c., in 2 3 ,B S
, ,
:
A ,B
2
solved.
272.
lt
"We
the
known
A B A B A
lt
2,
equations
254
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. IV.
a=^N
=
o
+ JV e
+
sn ^ +
versin
^
e
2
+ JVe + JV
*
cos
versin
+ &c
^
cos
&
+ = N + (M, sin 2q + N
l t
(3/2 sin
qj
<versin
+ &c. + &c.
cos
2^)
z
versin
+ (M
.
sin
2g 2
^ cos 2g
e
2)
<
vershl *
= JV +
{,, sin ( j
- 1) ^ + + M sin - 1
71
^
,
cos (j
- 1) grj
cos
+
cos
^"
Sl
e
versin
&c.
=i +
o
sn
q,
+ {M
In these equations
e
sin
+ -
1) q z
+ JV; cos
- 1)
27T
2}
versin
&c.
= e_
^y
,
27T
,
22
= 2 27T
>
3 ^= Q
&c.,
273.
just set
;
down
contain the
problem
it is
represented by
o,= -2a,+
-sin(j-l)~Sasin(i-l)-^+ n cos 2
.xSTT^
( i
1)
2a
cos
-.N^Tr"!
-^
(i
1)
n\
n
(e),
SECT.
in
II.]
255
,
which only known quantities enter, namely, a v a 2 a- 3 ... a n which are the initial temperatures, k the measure of the conducibility, m the value of the mass, n the number of masses heated, and t the time elapsed.
,
From
it
equal
bodies n in
are arranged in a circle, and, having received initial temperatures, begin to communicate heat to each other any in the manner we have supposed ; the mass, of each body being
number
denoted by m, the time by t, and a certain constant coefficient by k, the variable temperature of each mass, which must be a function of the quantities t, m, and k, and of all the initial temperatures,
is
(e).
We
first
substitute instead
indicates the place of the body whose ascertain, that is to say, 1 for the first
body, 2 for the second, &c.; then with respect to the letter i which enters under the sign 2, we give to it the n successive values As to the 1, 2, 3, ... n, and take the sum of all the terms.
number
as
of terms
must be
as there are different versed sines belonging to many the successive arcs
of
them
0^,1^,2^3^ n n n n
that
is
&
to say, whether the number n be equal to (2\ + 1) or 2\, according as it is odd or even, the number of terms which enter
is
always \
1.
To give an example of the application of this formula, us suppose that the first mass is the only one which at first was heated, so that the initial temperatures a v a2 a3 an are all
274.
let
,
. . .
first.
quantity of heat
mass is distributed gradually among all the Hence the law of the communication of heat is expressed
first
by the equation
.
a*
t
-r
2 -
n
2
a. l
cos
( j
1) J
+-a +
2 tv
2?T
t
cos (j
.
1) 2 2?T
cos (j
1)3
e
7&
-^ m
+ &c.
THEORY OF HEAT.
If the second
[CHAP.
IV.
tures
,,
a3
mass alone had been heated and the tempera we should have ... a n were nul,
-a
jsin (j
1)
sin
2vr
2?r)
"
+ cos
(/I)
Vl/
7
cos
^e
I
Bin2
+ cos
4-&C.,
(7 Vi/
-1)2
cos 2
and if all the initial temperatures were supposed nul, except and a 2 we should find for the value of aj the sum of the values t found in each of the two preceding hypotheses. In general it is in easy to conclude from the general equation (e), Art. 273, that to which the initial quantities of order to find the law according heat are distributed between the masses, we may consider sepa are mil, one only rately the cases in which the initial temperatures
,
The quantity of heat contained in one of the masses be supposed to communicate itself to all the others, regarding may the latter as affected with nul temperatures; and having made this hypothesis for each particular mass with respect to the initial
excepted.
it has received, we can ascertain the temperature of one of the bodies, after a given time, by adding all the any temperatures which the same body ought to have received on each of the foregoing hypotheses.
heat which
275.
(e)
ajt
we suppose
is
we
=-2a
i}
so that
acquired the
mean temperature
first
a result
which
self-evident.
As
the value
of
term -
&i
becomes greater and greater relatively to the following terms, or The same is the case with the second with respect to the terms which follow it; and, when the time has become
to their sum.
SECT.
II.]
LATER TEMPERATURES.
a,-
257
is
by the equation,
a,-
1 = - 2ta
4-
2 n
-tain (j
{
-1) n 2a
2?r
2?r
-
sin (i
1)
n
1)
??
4
Denoting by a and
cos (j
1)
7i
,
cos ( j
1)
ft
2a,-
cos
(i
1)
and of
m
"*"
e~~>*
by
G>,
we have 9^ ~ n
o;
1 =- 2
4-
2-7T
1)
4 6 cos (j -
1)
The quantities a and b are constant, that is to say, independent of the time and of the letter j which indicates the order of the
mass whose variable temperature is a,-. These quantities are the same for all the masses. The difference of the variable tempera
ture
a.j
2a
decreases therefore
for
fraction
each of the masses, in proportion to the successive powers of the Each of the bodies tends more and more to acquire
&>.
2a
it
and the variable temperature of the same body ends always by decreasing according to the successive powers of a This fraction is the same, whatever be the fraction. body whose the coefficient of co* or changes of temperature are considered
;
(a sin Uj
denoting by
KJ
the arc
1)
may
be put
under the form A sin (uj 4- B), taking A and B so as to have a = A cos B, and b = A sin B. If we wish to determine the
coefficient of
to*
with
temperature
-
is
aj+l)
so
successive
bodies whose
to
HJ the arc
must add
or 2
and
on
so that
we have
to*
the equations
% - n 20; = A
OLJ
.
sin
(B 4 %)
+ &c.
n /
J
- - 2a = A
-
sin
[B 4
\
Uj
41
at
4-
&c.
F. H.
17
258
THEOEY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. IV.
^ +2
2 a = A sm
.
B + Uj + 2
(j3
co*
+ &c.
+ &c.
2a = A
.
sin
+ Uj +
CD*
by these equations, that the later differences between the actual temperatures and the final temperatures are
276.
see,
We
represented by the preceding equations, preserving only the first term of the second member of each equation. These later differ
ences vary then according to the following law if we consider only one body, the variable difference in question, that is to say the excess of the actual temperature of the body over the final
:
and common temperature, diminishes according to the successive powers of a fraction, as the time increases by equal parts and, if we compare at the same instant the temperatures of all the
;
bodies, the difference in question varies proportionally to the suc The cessive sines of the circumference divided into equal parts. temperature of the same body, taken at different successive equal
instants, is represented
whose axis
by the ordinates of a logarithmic curve, divided into equal parts, and the temperature of each of these bodies, taken at the same instant for all, is repre
is
is
divided
before,
easy to see, as
we have remarked
the initial temperatures are such, that the differences of these temperatures from the mean or final temperature are pro
that
if
portional to the successive sines of multiple arcs, these differences will all diminish at the same time without ceasing to be propor
tional to the
same
sines.
initial
temperatures, will not be disturbed by the reciprocal action of the bodies, and will be maintained until they have all acquired a
temperature. The difference will diminish for each body according to the successive powers of the same fraction. Such is
the simplest law to which the communication of heat between a succession of equal masses can be submitted. When this law has
common
and when
it
differences of these temperatures from the mean temperature are not proportional to successive sines of multiple arcs, the law in question tends always to be set
to say,
when the
SECT.
II.]
259
and the system of variable temperatures ends soon by coin ciding sensibly with that which depends on the ordinates of a circle and those of a logarithmic curve.
up,
we regard two bodies situated at the ends of the same diameter, the temperature of the first will surpass the mean and constant temperature as much as that constant temperature
follows that if
we take
this
For this reason, if surpasses the temperature of the second body. at each instant the sum of the temperatures of two
is
opposite,
we
find a constant
sum, and
the same value for any two masses situated at the ends of the same diameter.
sum has
The formulae which represent the variable temperatures 277. of separate masses are easily applied to the propagation of heat in continuous bodies. To give a remarkable example, we will determine the movement of heat in a ring, by means of the
general equation which has been already set down.
be supposed that n the number of masses increases suc cessively, and that at the same time the length of each mass decreases in the same ratio, so that the length of the system has a constant value equal to 2?r. Thus if n the number of masses be successively 2, 4, 8, 16, to infinity, each of the masses will
it
Let
be
- &c. It must also be assumed that the 4 O facility with which heat is transmitted increases in the same ratio as the number of masses in\ thus the quantity which k
TT,
-^,
t
-r,
represents when there are only two masses becomes double when there are four, quadruple when there are eight, and so on.
by g, we see that the number k must be &c. K we pass now to the successively replaced by g, 2g, of a continuous body, we must write instead of m, the hypothesis value of each infinitely small mass, the element dx instead of n,
Denoting
this quantity
4<g,
the
number
of masses,
we must
write
2_
^
;
instead of k write
172
260
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. IV.
,
a lt a 2 a 3 ...an they depend on and regarding these temperatures as the x, successive states of the same variable, the general value a repre sents an arbitrary function of x. The index i must then be
to the initial temperatures
,
As
x
replaced by
-y.
With
a3
...,
x and t
index
these are variable temperatures depending on two quantities Denoting the variable by v, we have v = $ (x, t). The
j which marks
t
should be replaced by
-y-.
number
body in the form of a ring, we must substitute for the quanti ties n, m, Ic, a it i, aj} /, their corresponding quantities, namely,
-ydx
,
dx,
ff f(x\ -jdx J ^ J) dx
.
4>
^ Y (x. t\
"
-7dx
made
in equation
(e)
Art. 273,
and
let
i
and j instead of
and j
1.
The
first
~ \f(x) J %Tr)
dx taken from
=
;
to
sm(j-l)^
n
cos x
;
becomes smjdx or
sin
x the value
-\ f(x]
sin
(/I)
-y- is
dx
that of ft
2a
sin
(i
1)
n
:
is
JPC&P,
irj
=
cos
to
x=2jr
cZx,
(i
1)
is
-If ()
the
limits.
Thus we obtain
the equation
-f
\j /
sin
(x) sin
xdx -f
cos
}e-
ffnt
4-
sin
2# lf(x)sinZ
cos
(E)
SECT.
II.]
REMARKS.
gir
261
by
k,
we have
/(a;) cos #cta
xdx + cos x
e J
w
e~^kt
+
+
(sin 20ma)
&c.
sin
dxj
This solution is the same as that which was given in the 278. preceding section, Art. 241 it gives rise to several remarks. 1st. It is not necessary to resort to the analysis of partial differential
;
equations in order to obtain the general equation which expresses the movement of heat in a ring. The problem may be solved for
a definite number of bodies, and that number may then be supposed infinite. This method has a clearness peculiar to itself, and
guides our
first
researches.
It is
eas^afterwards to pass to a
naturally.
We
see
that the discrimination of the particular values, which, satisfying the partial differential equation, compose the general value, is
known
ential equations whose coefficients are constant. The discrimina tion is moreover founded, as we have seen above, on the physical
conditions of the problem. 2nd. To pass from the case of separate masses to that of a continuous body, we supposed the coefficient Jc
to be increased in proportion to n, the number of masses. continual change of the number k follows from what we
This have
formerly proved, namely, that the quantity of heat which flows between two layers of the same prism is proportional to the value
of
y-
to the section,
and v the temperature. If, indeed, we did not suppose the co efficient k to increase in proportion to the number of masses, but were to retain a constant value for that coefficient, we should find, on making n infinite, a result contrary to that which is observed in continuous bodies. The diffusion of heat would be infinitely slow, and in whatever manner the mass was heated, the temperature at a point would suffer no sensible change during a finite time, which is contrary to fact. Whenever we resort to
the consideration of an infinite
number
of separate masses
which
262
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. IV.
we must
transmit heat, and wish to pass to the case of continuous bodies, attribute to the coefficient k, which measures the yj^ocity
number
of infinitely
value of v or
(#, i),
which we obtained to express the we suppose t = 0, the equation necessarily state, we have therefore in this way the
equation
(p),
+ sin
(*)<fo
as
+ &c.
+ cos x
+ &c.
the
gives,
between assigned
limits,
of sines or cosines development of an arbitrary function in a series of multiple arcs is deduced from elementary rules of analysis.
Here we
all
process which
we employed
to
the coefficients except one disappear by successive in make tegrations from the equation
-f
~~
*
a^ sin b t cos
x+ x+
a^ sin 2# 5 a cos 2x
These integrations correspond to the elimination of the different unknowns in equations (m), Arts. 267 and 271, and we see clearly by the comparison of the two methods, that equation (B), Art. 279, and 2?r, without its holds for all values of x included between
of x which exceed those being established so as to apply to values
limits.
which satisfies the conditions of the problem, and whose value is determined by equation (E), Art. 277, may be expressed as follows
279.
The
function
(x, t)
32
{2sin3ic |^a/(a)sin3a4-2cos3^pa/(a)cos3a}e"
^-f-
&c.
SECT.
II.]
FUNCTIONAL EXPRESSION.
2G3
or 27T$ (x,
t}
= Idxfty
{I
+ (2 sin 2x sin 2a + 2
cos
(2 sin
^ + &c.}
fda/(a) [1
+ 22 cos i (a - a?) e
**^.
The sign 2 affects the number i, and indicates that the sum We can also include the must be taken from 4 = 1 to i = oo first term under the sign 2, and we have
.
a?,
cfa/(a)
cos / (a
- a?)
<r
X
;
We must then give to i all integral values from co to + oc oo and + oo next to the which is indicated by writing the limits one of these values of i being 0. This is the most concise sign 2,
expression of the solution. To develope the second member of the = 0, and then i= 1, 2, 3, &c., and double equation, we- suppose 4
When each result except the first, which corresponds to i = 0. the initial t is nothing, the function (x, t) necessarily represents state in which the temperatures are equal to / (x), we have there
<
We
and 2 the
limits
between
This theorem holds which the integral sum must be taken. whatever be the form of the function / (x) in the in generally to x = 2?r the same is the case with that which terval from x = is expressed by the equations which give the development of F (x\ Art. 235; and we shall see in the sequel that we can prove directly
;
280.
different
</>
It is easy to see that the problem admits of no solution from that given by equation (E), Art. 277. The function
(x, t)
=k
-,
dt
da?
no
264
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. IV.
other function can enjoy the same property. selves of this we must consider that when the
solid is represented
1
To convince our
first
state of the
is
known, since
1
it is
equivalent to k
Thus denoting by
of the
# 2 or v 1
-\-Jc
-j-
dt,
commencement
second instant,
state
we can deduce the value and from the differential equation. the same manner the values va v 4 ... v n
,
We
could ascertain in
of the temperature at
any point whatever of the solid at the beginning of each instant. Now the function (x, i) satisfies the initial state, since we have
<
<f)
(x, 0)
=/(#).
Further,
it satisfies
consequently
values for
-
if it
were
,
differentiated,
,
at
-=f at
-=/
at
&c., as
would
from successive
Hence, if in the applications of the differential equation (a). function $ (x, t) we give to t successively the values 0, ft), we shall find the same 3ft), &c., ft) denoting an element of time,
2o>,
values v lt vzi v s
state
&c, as
initial
=k
at
-j doo
Hence
every function ^r (x, f) which satisfies the differential equation and the initial state necessarily coincides with the function (x, t) for such functions each give the same function of x, when in them
<f>
we suppose
successively equal to 0,
co,
2&>,
3&)
...
iw, &c.
by this that there can be only one solution of the and that if we discover in any manner a function ^ (x, t) problem, which satisfies the differential equation and the initial state, we are certain that it is the same as the former function given by
see
We
equation (E).
281.
object
is
the varied
all
it
=k
In
fact,
when a
SECT.
II.]
GENERAL INTEGRAL.
26o
value of v as a function of
the time
t,
is
it
is
evident that
all
any time whatever are determinate. We may therefore select arbitrarily the function of x, which corresponds to a certain state, and the general function of the two variables x and t then becomes determined. The same is not the case
correspond
to
-^ + -7-5
0,
which
was
employed in the
of heat
preceding chapter, and which belongs to the constant movement its integral contains two arbitrary functions of x and ; y
but we
may reduce this investigation to that of the varied move ment, by regarding the final and permanent state as derived from the states which precede it, and consequently from the initial
state,
which
is
given.
The
integral which
we have given
(a)
~ (dzf
;
2e
m cos
* (a
- a?)
contains one arbitrary function f(x), and has the same extent as the general integral, which also contains only one arbitrary func tion of x or rather, it is this integral itself arranged in a form
In fact, the equation v 1 =f (x} represent the initial state, and v = (x, t) representing the variable ing state which succeeds it, we see from the very form of the heated solid that the value of v does not change when x i%7r is written
suitable to the problem.
<f>
instead of
x, i
The
(a
function
^ e -i kt cosl
satisfies this condition; it represents also
t = 0,
#)
initial state
the
when
we suppose
since
we then have
(a)
cos i (a
x),
an equation which was proved above, Arts. 235 and 279, and is also easily verified. Lastly, the same function satisfies the differ
ential equation
-=-
-5-5
of
t,
the
temperature v is given by a very convergent series, and the different terms represent all the partial movements which combine to form
266
the total movement.
[CHAP. IV.
higher orders alter rapidly, but their influence becomes inappre ciable; so that the number of values which ought to be given to
the exponent
i
diminishes continually.
system of temperatures is represented sensibly by the terms which are found on giving to i the values 0, + 1 and 2, or only
and
there
1, is
or lastly,
by the
first
da/ (at)
To arrive at the solution we considered first the simple 282. values of the function v which satisfy the differential equation we then formed a value which agrees with the initial state, and
has consequently
all the generality which belongs to the problem. might follow a different course, and derive the same solution from another expression of the integral when once the solution
We
is
If we suppose the results are easily transformed. diameter of the mean section of the ring to increase infinitely, the
known, the
function
<
(a?,
t),
as
we
form, and coincides with an integral which contains a single The arbitrary function under the sign of the definite integral.
latter integral
be applied to the actual problem; but, if we were limited to this application, we should have but a very imperfect knowledge of the phenomenon; for the values of the
might
also
and temperatures would not be expressed by convergent series, we could not discriminate between the states which succeed each other as the time increases. The periodic form which the problem
function which re supposes must therefore be attributed to the the initial state; but on modifying that integral in this presents
= IT-
ATTJ
{<**/
() 2e-** cos i
(OL
- x).
question, as
the last equation we pass easily to the integral in was proved in the memoir which preceded this work. less easy to obtain the equation from the integral itself. It is not These transformations make the agreement of the analytical
results
From
more
clearly evident
SECT.
II.]
2G7
and constitute no different analysis. In oneofthe following we shall examine the different forms whicfT may be chapters
assumed by the integral of the equation -r ^-r^^ the relations dv dx which they have to each other, and the cases in which they ought
to be employed.
integral which expresses the movement of heat in was necessary to resolve an arbitrary function into a series of sines and cosines of multiple arcs; the numbers which affect the variable under the symbols sine and cosine are the natural numbers 1, 2, 3, 4, &c. In the following problem the function is again reduced to a series of sines; but the arbitrary coefficients of the variable under the symbol sine are no longer the numbers 1, 2, 3, 4, &c.: these coefficients satisfy a definite equation whose roots are all incommensurable and infinite in number.
To form the
it
a ring,
Note on
Sect. I,
Chap. IV.
first
to
investigate the problem of the movement of heat in a ring on the hypothesis of the law of cooling established by Dulong and Petit. See his Memoire sur la
theorie de la chaleur, Crelle s Journal,
Band
VII., pp.
116131,
Berlin, 1831.
(Read before the French Academy of Sciences, 1825. ) M. Libri made the solution depend upon a series of partial differential equations, treating them as if they were linear. The equations have been discussed in a different manner by
Mr
The principal Kelland, in his Theory of Heat, pp. 69 75, Cambridge, 1837. mean of the temperatures at opposite ends of any diameter of the ring is the same at the same instant. [A. F.]
CHAPTER
V.
SECTION
General
283.
I.
solution.
of the propagation of heat in a sphere has been explained in Chapter II., Section 2, Article 117; it consists in integrating the equation
THE problem
dv
fd*v
2 dv\
so that
when x
k denoting the
ducibilities
;
ratio
and h the
ratio
of the
two con-
-^
v is the temperature which is observed after has elapsed in a spherical layer whose radius is a?; the time t v is a function of x and t, which is is the radius of the sphere
equal to
given,
If
F (x)
when we suppose
initial
0.
The
function F(x)
is
and
we make y =
vx,
^f
= ^T^
tnus
we must
in t e gr ate the
last
We
sc
first place,
to
if,
what are the simplest values which can be attributed and then form a general value which will satisfy at the same
CHAP.
V.
SECT.
I.]
PARTICULAR SOLUTIONS.
equation,
state.
269
relative
time
three
the
differential
initial
the
condition
to
the
surface,
and the
when
these
complete, and no
Let y
emtu,
u being a function
of x,
we have
First,
we
notice that
when
the value of
becomes
infinite,
the
value of v must be nothing at all points, since the body is com pletely cooled. Negative values only can therefore be taken for
m.
Now
k has a positive numerical value, hence we conclude is a circular function, which follows from the
of the equation
known nature
mu = k -j-s
dx
Let u
<Fu
=A
cos
nx
+ B sin nx
we have the
of v
condition
m=
kw
2
.
=e
-knH
so
by the equation
(A
cos
nx -f
B sin nx\
A A
and
where n
is
B are
constants.
We
may remark, first, ought to be nothing ; for the value of v which expresses the temperature at the centre, when we make x 0, cannot be infinite ; hence the term cos nx
should be omitted.
Further, the
if
arbitrarily.
In
fact,
+ hv
we
of
we
find
nx cos nx +
(hoc
1) sin
nx =
0.
we
shall
x=
suppose
hX>
and
e,
we have
tan
= X.
We
must therefore
find
an arc
6,
which divided by
its
tangent
270
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. V.
gives a
known
quotient X,
= -^
JL
It is
evident that there are an infinity of such arcs, which have a given ratio to their tangent so that the equation of condition
;
,
tan
nX - I _ XT m.\. nX
-vr-
-L
is
u = - be the equation to a straight line, whose co-ordinates A If we eliminate u from these two are also denoted by e and u.
and
let
equations,
e.
The un-
known e is therefore the abscissa of the point of intersection of the curve and the straight line. This curved line is composed of an infinity of arcs ; all the ordinates corresponding to abscissae
1357
"
"
"
"
71
71
71
71
2
are infinite,
27T,
STT,
and
are
all
&c.
.
those which correspond to the points 0, TT, To trace the straight line whose nothing.
equation
is
A,
=
1
ilJL
j-^
oi
coi,
and
hX
from
utsm e
has for
SECT.
I.]
271
tangent at the origin a line which divides the right angle into two equal parts, since the ultimate ratio of the arc to the tangent is 1.
if X or is a quantity less than the straight line mom passes from the origin above the unity, curve non, and there is a point of intersection of the straight line with the first branch. It is equally clear that the same straight
We
1TiX
H^TTH, &c.
Hence the
The
TT
equation
first
is
tan
=X
e
included between
and
STT
^,
and
and
2t
-^*2*
and
so on.
These roots
approach very near to their upper limits when they are of a very advanced order.
286.
If
we wish
following rule
write
= arc
tan u and u
,
A<
arc tan
u de*
noting the length of the arc whose tangent is u. Then taking any number for u, deduce from the first equation the value of e ;
value of u
substitute this value in the second equation, and deduce another substitute the second value of u in the first equation ; ;
thence we deduce a value of 6, which, by means of the second Substituting it in the first equation, gives a third value of u.
equation we have a new value of e. Continue thus to determine u by the second equation, and e by the first. The operation gives
values more and more nearly approaching to the evident from the following construction.
unknown
e,
as is
In
fact, if
value which
is
the point u correspond (see fig. 13) to the arbitrary assigned to the ordinate u and if we substitute
;
equation
= arc
will
correspond to the abscissa which we have calculated by means If this abscissa e be substituted in the second of this equation.
equation u
= - we
,
shall find
to the point u. Substituting u in the first equation, we find an abscissa e which corresponds to the point e ; this abscissa being
272
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. V.
then substituted in the second equation gives rise to an ordinate w which when substituted in the first, gives rise to a third
,
abscissa
e",
and
so on
to infinity.
That
Fig. 14.
ceding equations, we must draw through the point u a horizontal line up to the curve, and through e the point of intersection draw
a vertical as far as the straight line, through the point of inter section u draw a horizontal up to the curve, through the point of
intersection e
draw a
to infinity, descending
The foregoing figure (13) represents the case in which 287. the ordinate arbitrarily chosen for u is greater than that which corresponds to the point of intersection. If, on the other hand, we
chose for the initial value of u a smaller quantity, and employed
in the
= arc tan u,
we
value.
should again arrive at values successively closer to the unknown Figure 14 shews that in this case we rise continually
towards the point of intersection by passing through the points ueu e &c. which terminate the horizontal and vertical lines.
u"
e",
is
too small,
we
obtain quantities
which converge towards the unknown value, and are smaller than it and starting from a value of u which is too great, we obtain quantities which also converge to the unknown value, and each of which is greater than it. We therefore ascertain
e
",
&c.
SECT.
I.]
MODE OF APPROXIMATION.
273
successively closer limits between the which magnitude sought is Either approximation is represented by the always included.
formula
. . .
arc tan
- arc tan
j
\.
When several of the operations indicated have been effected, the successive results differ less and less, and we have arrived at
an approximate value of
288.
e.
We
might attempt
e
to apply the
two equations
A.
u=e
= \n.
should then take an arbitrary value of e, and, substituting it in the first equation, we should find a value of u, which being substituted in the second equation would give a second value of
e; this
We
new
value of
first.
could then be
manner
as the
But
in
it is easy to following this course of operations we from the point of intersection instead of
The
successive values of e
which we should obtain would diminish continually to zero, or would increase without limit. We should pass successively from from to e from e to u from u to e, and so on to to
e"
u",
u"
infinity.
The rule which we have just explained being applicable to the calculation of each of the roots of the equation
tan
e
limits,
we must
regard
all
these roots
to be as
known numbers.
it
number
of real roots.
We have explained this process of approximation because it is founded on a reinarkable construction, which may be usefully employed in several cases, and which exhibits immediately the
nature and limits of the roots
but the actual application of the process to the equation in question would be tedious it would be easy to resort in practice to some other mode of approximation.
;
;
F. H.
18
274
THEOKY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. V.
We now know a particular form which may be given to 289. the function v so as to satisfy the two conditions of the problem. This solution is represented by the equation
v
or v
, -Kn2 t sin nx
.
nx
is
The
coefficient
such that
initial
Tr=lhX.
-
follows
from
this
that
if
the
the quotient
fix
they would
all
between themselves throughout the whole duration of the cooling the ratios which had been set up and the temperature at each point would decrease as the ordinate of a logarithmic curve whose abscissa would denote the time passed. Suppose, then, the arc e divided into equal parts and taken as abscissa, we raise at being each point of division an ordinate equal to the ratio of the sine to
;
the
arc.
The system of ordinates will indicate the initial tem which must be assigned to the different layers, from the
represents the parts. radius X, cannot be taken arbitrarily; it is necessary that the As there are arc and its tangent should be in a given ratio.
construction,
The
arc e which, on
this
an
infinite
number
we might
thus form an infinite number of systems of initial temperatures, which could exist of themselves in the sphere, without the ratios
of the temperatures changing during the cooling.
290.
It
initial state
by means
of
a certain number, or of an infinite number of partial states, each of which represents one of the systems of temperatures which we have recently considered, in which the ordinate varies with the
proportional to the quotient of the sine by the The general movement of heat in the interior of a sphere arc. will then be decomposed into so many particular movements, each
is
distance x, and
of which
is
accomplished
,
freely, as if it
alone existed.
Denoting by nlt na
equation
-
n3
&c.,
^=1
SECT.
I.]
275
general equa
order,
we form the
tion
vx
If
t
= a~
ltn? i
sin njc
be made equal to
temperatures
0,
we have
sin
as the expression
of the
initial state of
vx
=a
sin
n tx
+a
n2x
+a
sin
n3 x
-f
&c.
,
The problem
&c.,
whatever be the
we have
F(x)
= - (a
sin n^x
sin njc
+a
sin
n s x + a4 sin n^x
+ &C.)
1
. . .
(e).
2.91.
of the equation
To determine the coefficient a lt multiply both members by x sin nx dx, and integrate from x = to x = X.
The
integral
these limits
is
m
If
&c.,
n2
w1
w
2>
w3
which
tan
TL^\.
^= 1
hX, we have
mX
tanmX
or
nX
t&
m cos mX sin w X
We
n sin
w X cos w JT = 0.
see by this that the whole value of the integral is nothing; but a single case exists in which the integral does not vanish,
namely,
when
m = n.
It then
becomes
and,
by application of
known
rules, is
reduced to
-2
4sn
1 Of the possibility of representing an arbitrary function by a series of this form a demonstration has been given by Sir W. Thomson, Camb. Math. Journal,
Vol.
m.
pp.
2527.
[A, F.]
182
276
It follows
coefficient
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. V.
from this that in order to obtain the value of the a lt in equation (e), we must write
2 \x sin UjX F(x) dx
a^\X
x=
to
so
-^~
sin
Zn^X]
= X.
sn si
Similarly
we have
2 \x sin n zx F(x)
dx=aAX^
all
may
be deter
F (x) dx
always has a determinate value, whatever the arbitrary function If the function F(x) be represented by the (x) may be.
any manner, the function xF(x) sin nx corresponds to the ordinate of a second line which can easily be constructed by means of the first. The area bounded and determines by the latter line between the abscissae x
xX
n.
The arbitrary function F(x) enters each coefficient under the sign of integration, and gives to the value of v all the generality which the problem requires; thus we arrive at the following
equation
sin n^xlx sin n % x
J
F (x} dx
-
sin
n zx Ix
J
sin n z x
F (x) dx
e-**
&c.
This
is
of the equation
in order that
it
may
all
sphere.
In
fact,
represent the movement of heat in a solid the conditions of the problem are obeyed.
SECT.
I.]
277
1st,
The
which escapes at the surface accords at the same time with the mutual action of the last layers and with the action of the air
of heat
on the surface
that
is
-?-
+ hx = 0,
which
each part of the value of v satisfies when x X, holds also when we take for v the sum of all these parts ; 3rd, the given solution agrees with the initial state when we suppose the time nothing.
292.
The
roots n lt n 2
7?
nX
7
tan n X.
V"
_, 1
,_
/&-A.
are very unequal; whence we conclude that if the value of the time is considerable, each term of the value of v is very small, As the time of cooling relatively to that which precedes it. increases, the latter parts of the value of v cease to have any
at first
and those partial and elementary states, which compose the general movement, in order that the initial state may be represented by them, disappear almost entirely, one only excepted. In the ultimate state the temperatures of the
sensible influence
;
same manner
as in a circle
When
it
begins to
exist,
through the whole duration of the cooling. Whatever the function (x) may be which represents the initial state, the
law in question tends continually to be established ; and when the cooling has lasted some time, we may without sensible error
suppose
293.
it
to exist.
apply the general solution to the case in which the sphere^ having been for a long time immersed in a In fluid, has acquired at all its points the same temperature.
shall
this case the function
coefficients
is
We
F(x)
is
1,
x=X
the integral
sin
nX nX cos n X
278
THEORY OF HEAT.
of each coefficient
is
[CHAP. V.
:
expressed thus
2 sin n
X nX cos n X
sin
nX
nX cos n X
n,
is
nX cos nX = 1 TF sin nX
.,
:
hX.
We
therefore find
a
It
is
JiX
nn
X cosec nX
cos
nX
is
easy
now
e~*
to
given by the
equation
vx
Wl2<
shifts
Denoting by
e t , e2 , e3 , &c.
tan
and supposing them arranged in order beginning with the least &c. by e^ e2 63 &c., and writing instead replacing n^X, n 2 X, n Q
;
TT
of
the variations of temperature during the cooling of a solid sphere, which was once uniformly heated, the equation
C-w
xV
(.
Ci
KX
sm-^F I* e x
e cosec e 1 x
cos
e^
nn-fe
ea)
6
cosec
cos e
&c.
Note.
The problem
of the
discussed
by
Biemann,
Partielle Differentialglelchungen,
6169.
[A. F.]
SECT.
II.]
279
SECTION
II.
We
of the sphere is to have a very small value, or that the radius the least value of e becomes very small ; so that the very small,
,
equation
=1
h -^
v X
is
reduced to
-=
=1
-273
^.
63
or,
e,
= ohX
On
the other
-.
cos e becomes,
27
^ K
Sm
ex
And
the term
X
is
reduced to
1.
ex
On making
_
8fr
these
X
t
Ci)X -f &c. substitutions in the general equation we have v = e remark that the succeeding terms decrease very rapidly may with the first, since the second root n9 is very much in
We
comparison
we may
the
has so that if either of the quantities h or as the expression of the variations take,
Sht
67>j:
=e Thus the different equation v spherical envelopes of which the solid is composed retain a common temperature during the whole of the cooling. The of a logarithmic curve, the temperature diminishes as the ordinate the initial temperature 1 is retime being taken for abscissa
of temperature,
.
duced
after the
time
to e
CDX
.
*h A.
In
initial
t
temperature
may be
the value of
must be ^y
CD log m.
Thus
in spheres of the
280
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. V.
of different diameters, the times occupied in losing half or the same defined part of their actual heat, when the exterior conducibility
is
The
;
Ka
~y
is
generally
when the
quantity
-^
vejy small.
We may regard
is
the quantity
cooled
is
as
very small
being
a spherical vessel of small thickness. The hypothesis is in some measure the same as that of perfect conducibility; the tem
perature decreases then according to the law expressed by the
Sht
equation v
295.
C1JX
.
the preceding remarks we see that in a solid sphere for a long time, the temperature de centre to the surface as the quotient of the sine creases from the
By
arc decreases from the origin where it is 1 to the end of a given arc e, the radius of each layer being represented by the variable length of that arc. If the sphere has a small diameter, or if its interior conducibility is very much greater
by the
than the exterior conducibility, the temperatures of the successive layers differ very little from each other, since the whole arc e
which represents the radius of the sphere is of small length. The variation of the temperature v common to all its points
Sht
then given by the equation v e Thus, on comparing the times which two small spheres occupy in losing half respective or any aliquot part of their actual heat, we find those times to be proportional to the diameters.
is
.
cux
result expressed by the equation v = e belongs to masses of similar form and small dimension. It has been only
_ 3M
296.
The
CDX
known
a long time by physicists, and it offers itself as it were spontaneously. In fact, if any body is sufficiently small for the
for
its different points to be regarded as equal, it easy to ascertain the law of cooling. Let 1 be the initial
temperatures at
is
SECT.
II.]
281
temperature common to all points it is evident that the quantity of heat which flows during the instant dt into the medium
is hSvdt, denoting supposed to be maintained at temperature On the other hand, of the body. by 8 the external surface if C is the heat required to raise unit of weight from the tem to the temperature 1, we shall have CDV for the perature
of the
to
is
Hence
is
TT/TTT-
temperature v
diminished
We
~
hSvdt
or v
= egp
is
If the
is
-M
DX
.
X, we
shall
=e
297. Assuming that we observe during the cooling of the body in question two temperatures v l and v z corresponding to the times t t and t z we have
,
hS _
log
0j
t
log v2
"
CDV~
We
If the
-t t
v 7
Cf
,.
different bodies,
and
if
,
we know in advance the ratio of their specific heats G and C we can find that of their exterior conducibilities h and h Reciprocally, if we have reason to regard as equal the values
.
we can
conducibilities of two different bodies, ascertain the ratio of their specific heats. see by this that, by observing the times of cooling for different liquids and other substances enclosed successively in the same vessel
We
whose thickness
is
small,
we can determine
K which measures
282
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. V.
depend on the interior conducibility ; and the observation of these times can teach us nothing about the latter property but it could be determined by measuring the times of cooling in vessels
;
of different thicknesses. 298. What we have said above on the cooling of a sphere of small dimension, applies to the movement of heat in a thermo meter surrounded by air or fluid. shall add the following
We
filled
Suppose a mercurial thermometer to be dipped into a vessel with hot water, and that the vessel is being cooled freely
law
in air at constant temperature. It is required to find the of the successive falls of temperature of the thermometer.
If the temperature of the fluid were constant, and the thermo meter dipped in it, its temperature would change, approaching very quickly that of the fluid. Let v be the variable temperature indicated by the thermometer, that is to say, its elevation above the temperature of the air let u be the elevation of temperature of the fluid above that of the air, and t the time corresponding At the beginning of the instant to these two values v and u. dt which is about to elapse, the difference of the temperature
;
of the thermometer from that of the fluid being v u, the variable v tends to diminish and will lose in the instant dt a quantity proportional to v
so that
we have
li
the equation
dv
(v
u) dt.
During the same instant dt the variable u tends to diminish, and it loses a quantity proportional to u, so that we have the
equation
du =
Hudt.
The
coefficient
air,
H expresses
a quantity which may easily be discovered by ex and the coefficient h expresses the velocity with which periment, the thermometer cools in the liquid. The latter velocity is very much greater than H. Similarly we may from experiment
liquid in
find the coefficient
fluid
du
Hudt and dv =
(v
u) dt,
SECT.
II.]
ERROR OF A THERMOMETER.
u
283
or
Ae~ m and
-j-
hv
+ hAe~ Ht
= le~ ht + aHe~ m
being arbitrary constants. Suppose now the initial value u to be A, that is, that the height of the thermometer exceeds by A the true temperature of the fluid at the beginning of the immersion; and that the initial value of u is E. We can determine a and b, and we shall have
a and
of v
Z>
is the error of the thermometer, that is which is found between the temperature indicated by the thermometer and the real temperature of the fluid at the same instant. This difference is variable, and the informs us according to what law it tends preceding equation
The quantity v
to decrease.
We
its
see
terms containing e~ u diminish very rapidly, with the velocity which would be observed in the thermometer if it were dipped into fluid at constant temperature. With respect
that two of
to the
by the expression
vu
and
term which contains e~ , its decrease is much slower, effected with the velocity of cooling of the vessel in air. It follows from this, that after a time of no great length the error of the thermometer is represented by the single term
is
Ht
HE -Ht h-H e
299.
or
H
h-H
teaches as to the values
Consider
of and h. Into water at 8 5 (octogesimal scale) we dipped a thermometer which had first been heated, and it descended in the water from 40 to 20 degrees in six seconds. This ex
From this we periment was repeated carefully several times. if the time is reckoned find that the value of e~h is Q 000042 in minutes, that is to say, if the height of the thermometer be
1
it
will
be #(0-000042) at the
ftlog l0 e
1
4-376127l.
[A. F.]
0-00004206, strictly.
284
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. V.
was allowed to cool in air at 12. The value of e~H in this case was found to be 0*98514, hence that of Hlog i0 e is O006500. We see by this how small the value of the fraction h a single minute each term multiplied by e~ is, and that after
e~
is not half the ten-thousandth part of what it was at the beginning of the minute. We need not therefore take account of those terms in the value of v The equation becomes u.
- u= Hu
Hu
"
h^n
IIu
-"r+a^T-
From
and A, we see that the h is more than 673 times greater than H, that quantity say, the thermometer cools in air more than 600 times
the values found for
latter
is
to
faster
air.
-j fi
is
certainly less
and
as the
term
-H ^
-y
fi
is
less
than
the 600th part of the preceding term, which is already very small, it follows that the equation which we may employ to represent very exactly the error of the thermometer is
V
= Hu T
fl
Ji,
we
= Hu -=
/I
The investigation which we have just made furnishes useful results for the comparison of thermometers. very
300.
into
which
cooling always a little greater than that of the This excess or error of the thermometer differs with the
is
is
height of the thermometer. The amount of the correction will be found by multiplying u the actual height of the thermometer by the ratio of H, the velocity of cooling of the vessel in air,
We to h the velocity of cooling of the thermometer in the fluid. might suppose that the thermometer, when it was dipped into
SECT.
II.]
COMPARISON OF THERMOMETERS.
285
This is what almost but this state cannot last, the thermometer always happens, begins to approach to the temperature of the fluid at the same time the fluid cools, so that the thermometer passes first to the
the
fluid,
same temperature
as the fluid,
and
it
300*.
"We
see
by these
results that if
filled
we dip
different
is
thermo
cooling
slowly, they must all indicate very nearly the same temperature at the same instant. the velocities of cooling Calling h, h ,
h",
of the
thermometers in the
fluid,
we
shall
have
Hu
r
as
their
Hu Hu IT* T~
If
two thermometers are equally h and Ti are the same, their temperatures will differ equally from those of the fluid. The values of the coefficients h, h are very great, so that the errors of the thermometers are extremely small and often in appreciable quantities. We conclude from this that if a thermo meter is constructed with care and can be regarded as exact, it will be easy to construct several other thermometers of equal It will be sufficient to place all the thermometers exactness. wish to graduate in a vessel filled with a fluid which which we cools slowly, and to place in it at the same time the thermometer which ought to serve as a model we shall only have to observe all from degree to degree, or at greater intervals, and we must mark the points where the mercury is found at the same time These points will be at the in the different thermometers. We have applied this process to the con divisions required. struction of the thermometers employed in our experiments,
respective
errors.
h"
so
similar circum
stances.
This comparison of thermometers during the time of cooling not only establishes a perfect coincidence among them, and renders them all similar to a single model but from it we derive also the
;
means by
of exactly dividing the tube of the principal thermometer, which all the others ought to be regulated. In this way we
286
satisfy the
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. V.
fundamental condition of the instrument, which is, that any two intervals on the scale which include the same number of degrees should contain the same quantity of mercury. For the
rest
we omit here
several details
We
articles the
tem
perature v received after the lapse of a time t spherical layer at a distance x from the centre.
by an interior
It is required of the sphere,
now
mean temperature
which
mass.
it
would have if the whole quantity of heat contains were equally distributed throughout the whole
of a sphere
The volume
whose radius
is
x being
Q o
temperature
is v,
and radius x
is
will
be
vdl-^-J.
Hence the
mean temperature
PrS
n
or
to
x = X.
Substitute for v
X
and we
e~ kn * H sin njx
e~ kn ** sin njc
-f
etc.
shall
We found
a.=
-- 2 sin n
t
SECT.
II.]
287
z,
We
have, therefore,
f
-
.4
= (sm 6, ^ cos 3
e
26
- sin 2e
(sm ej -fitx* * 3
,
- 6 cos e N2 2e - sin 2e
e,
2 g)
-^P
all
Kcft
Let us consider the case in which, all other conditions of the radius of the remaining the same, the value sphere becomes infinitely great 1 Taking up the construction described
302.
r
"F"
in Art. 285,
we
^- becomes
infinite,
the straight line drawn through the origin cutting the different branches of the curve coincides with the axis of x. We find then
for the different values of e the quantities
TT,
Since the term in the value of z which contains e CD x * becomes, as the time increases, very much greater than the following terms, the value of z after a certain time is expressed
J--T
_A
!i!<
first
term
only.
KTTZ
being equal to
in spheres
7
^y
we
very slow
of great diameter,
of e
which
From
of the variations to
the foregoing remarks we can form an exact idea which the temperatures are subject during the
The initial values of the temperatures cooling of a solid sphere. change successively as the heat is dissipated through the surface. If the temperatures of the different layers are at first equal, or
they diminish from the surface to the centre, they do not maintain their first ratios, and in all cases the system tends more
if
and more towards a lasting state, which after no long delay is In this final state the temperatures decrease sensibly attained.
Biemann has shewn, Part. Diff. gleich. 69, that in the case of a very large sphere, uniformly heated initially, the surface temperature varies ultimately as the square root of the time inversely. [A. F.]
1
288
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. V.
from the centre to the surface. If we represent the whole radius of the sphere by a certain arc e less than a quarter of the
for each point the quotient of the sine
circumference, and, after dividing this arc into equal parts, take by the arc, this system of
that which
is
of itself set
From
these ultimate ratios occur they continue to exist throughout the whole of the cooling. Each of the temperatures then diminishes
as the ordinate of a logarithmic curve, the time being taken for can ascertain that this law is established by ob abscissa.
We
z, z
z",
"
etc.,
which denote
etc.
;
the
mean temperature
t,
+ 2, t + 3,
/
-77-,
the body begins to cool. The duration of the cooling for a given interval, that is to say the time required for the mean tem
perature z to be reduced to a definite part of
as the diameter of the sphere 304. If
is
itself
increases
enlarged.
different
in
we must
durations
and
sphere
is
and are in the ratio of the squares of the and if the diameters of the spheres are included diameters; between these two limits, the ratios of the times will be greater than that of the diameters, and less than that of their squares.
durations
SECT.
II.]
289
1
.
The exact value of the ratio has been already determined The problem of the movement of heat in a sphere includes that
of the terrestrial temperatures.
at greater length,
8
we have made
chapter
305.
of the equation
is
=X
very
The con well adapted to explain the nature of these equations. struction indeed shows clearly that all the roots are real at the
;
same time
it
for
The analytical determining the numerical value of each root. investigation of equations of this kind would give the same results. X tan e = 0, in First, we might ascertain that the equation e
which X
is
known number
less
m + njl.
It
quantity for e ; and we see after the transformations that the first member cannot vanish when we give to and n real values, It may be proved moreover that there can unless n is nothing.
X sin
cose
or
0.
In
fact, 1st,
=
cose
do not
X tan e = 0,
m + nj
- cos
has
when X
is less
than unity.
To prove
we must
of factors
:
number
9
:
It is
&=i*X*
e^Y
z,
2
,
as
may
first
The
for
Art. 301.
du mouvement de
la chaleur
dans
les
page 10.
solides, is that
memoir, entitled Theorie du mouvf.ment de la chaleur dans les corps which formed the basis of the Theorie analytique du mouvement de la chaleur published in 1822, but was considerably altered and enlarged in that work now translated. [A. F.]
first
The
F. H.
19
290
THEORY OF HEAT.
{CHAP. V.
and consider
by
differentiation.
Suppose that instead of forming sin e from the product of an infinite number of factors, we employ only the m first, and denote
the product by we take
</>
( )*
To
*.
This done,
or
().
we have
the equation
*.W-*.
Now, giving
from 1 to
to the
infinity,
()
= o.
1, 2, 3, 4,
&a
of
principles
Algebra, the nature of the functions of e which correspond to these different values of m. We see that, whatever m the number
of factors may be, the equations in e which proceed from them have the distinctive character of equations all of whose roots
are real.
Hence we conclude
in
which X is less than unity, cannot have an imaginary root 1 The same proposition could also be deduced by a different analysis which we shall employ in one of the following chapters.
.
Moreover the solution we have given is not founded on the property which the equation possesses of having all its roots real. It would not therefore have been necessary to prove It this proposition by the principles of algebraical analysis.
is
can be
it
the accuracy of the solution that the integral coincide with any initial state whatever; for follows rigorously that it must then also represent all the
sufficient
for
made
to
subsequent
states.
1 The proof given by Eiemann, Part. Diff. Gleich. 67, is more simple. The method of proof is in part claimed by Poisson, Bulletin de la Societe Philomatique,
[A. F.].
^w
*
^<e
rv,
CHAPTER
VI.
306.
length,
is
THE movement
dv
dt
_ ~
K
CD
(d*v
(dtf
ldv\
x
d~x)
A. T/_L V h
^- n
~dx
To
inte
give to v the simple particular value = ue~ mt ; expressed by the equation v being any number, and
we
u a function of
enters the
first
x.
We
which
equation, and
by h the
coefficient
-^
which enters
v,
the second equation. Substituting the value assigned to find the following condition
we
m
7fc
d zu
-j-j
axr
1 ~ du -jx ctx
satisfies this
Next we choose
differential equation.
for
u a function of x which
It is easy to
^3
I
may
gx*
2
__
X-rn
qy*
-r
We
shall
192
292
is
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. VI.
we have
The
derived; here we consider the function u to be known, and ue~ 01ct as the particular value of v.
state
to a condition expressed
is
subject
which must be satisfied when the radius x has whence we obtain the definite equation
its total
value
X\
oa
9 2
4 V
9 *
4, Tl
fi U
thus the
which enters into the particular value ue~ u The number must necessarily satisfy the is not arbitrary. which contains g and X. preceding equation,
number
$r
We
shall
are given quantities has an infinite number of roots, and that It follows that we can give to the all these roots are real. variable v an infinity of particular values of the form ue~ aM,
which
differ
g.
We
a more general value, by adding all these particular values multiplied by arbitrary coefficients. This integral which serves to resolve the proposed equation in all its extent is given by the following equation
v
ffi>
= a^e
, ,
4-
a 2 w 2e~^w
4-
w 3e~^
3<
&c.,
&Ct denote all the values of g which satisfy the definite u v u z u s &c. denote the values of u which correspond equation aa &c. are arbitrary coeffi to these different roots; a l9 a z cients which can only be determined by the initial state of the
9v
9a>
solid,
must now examine the nature of the definite equation which gives the values of g, and prove that all the roots of this equation are real, an investigation which requires attentive
307.
We
examination.
CHAP.
VI.]
293
In the series
l-*
|^ -^+&c.
0,
by the quantity
and denoting
s
/9
this function of
by
/ (0)
or y,
we have
(0)
=/
=1- +
ffi
"
0*
2*.
4a
O
~^~
6*
""
~^~
JiX
*
2*
ff*
32
3*
2*
3*
fj*
4*
*
^
1
~^ +
ia
~~
2
&C
/ (0)
Each value of ^
equation
^r 2 ,
gz
number
The problem
must have
all its
roots real.
We
shall
J>rove
in fact that
the
equation f(&)
has
all
its
same
it
is
the
(0)
follows
~)
has also
all its
roots real,
representing the
known number
hX
2
294
308.
THEORY OF HEAT.
The equation
~*-
[CHAP. VI.
m
2 92 *
m
^
~^~
We
and
all
those which
may
be derived from
by
differentiation,
&c.,
and
in general
Now if we write in the following order the JT = 0, and all those which may be derived from
algebraic equation
it
by
differentiation,
dX
and
if
d*X
that every real root of any one of these equa tions on being substituted in that which precedes and in that which follows it gives two results of opposite sign it is certain that the
;
we suppose
X=
v
has
all
its
roots real,
all
~"
dx
t>
dx*
dx*
-0
"~~"
V/j
&c
CX<V/
tions,
These propositions are founded on the theory of algebraic equa and have been proved long since. It is sufficient to prove
fulfil
Now
this follows
equation
CHAP.
VI.]
295
w+v+v &+*%&-*
for if
dy
l
i+l
i,d
^d
i+
*u
we
give to
d i+l v
-~ and
-^~ receive
values of opposite
With respect to the negative values of 6 it is"evident, from the nature of the function /(#), that no negative value substituted for 6 can reduce to nothing, either that function, or any of the
others which are derived from
stitution of
it by differentiation: for the sub any negative quantity gives the same sign to all the
terms.
has
all its
roots real
309.
It follows
from
principles of algebra.
cessive values
to 6 values
or y = (0) which is a known consequence from the Let us examine now what are the suc
this that the equation
receives
when we
give
If a
=
7J
to
= GO
value of 6 makes y
also
;
becomes nothing
7
it
becomes
infinite
when 6 makes y
nothing.
Now
it
follows from the theory of equations that in the case in question, lies between two consecutive roots of 0, y every root of y
Hence denoting by # t and 3 two consecu reciprocally. roots of the equation y = 0, and by # 2 that root of the tive = which lies between l and 3 every value of 6 in equation y cluded between l and 2 gives to y a sign different from that which the function y would receive if 6 had a value included be
and
,
tween
and
is
nothing when
.
0=0^
it
is infinite
when
The quantity
from
to in
to Z and must also take all possible the interval from of the opposite sign, from infinity to zero, in the interval values
from
to #3
A=
i/
296
real root
THEORY OF HEAT.
between
X
[CHAP. VI.
and
has
all its
number,
Q~
\j
has the same property. In this manner proof that the definite equation
2
we have achieved
the
-&c
2
2
in
2 .4
2 .4 .6
is #,
has
and
positive.
We
proceed to continue the investigation of the function \ differential equation which it satisfies.
310.
u and
of the
From the
-~ equation y -f ^| -f 6
1)
equation -jji
(i+
J^TI
we suppose
= we
dB i+l
d^y_
y
terms of
+ ldOif
the development of the function/ (0), since these coefficients depend on the values which the differential coefficients receive when the
variable in
them
is
made
to vanish.
1,
Supposing the
the series
first
term to
we have
_
If
_^ __ ____ _..
+ -r- +--r = Q dor dx
,
,
now
d*u
z
du
gu
we make
x*
g^
= 0,
and seek
0,
for the
new equation
in
u and
0,
re
garding u as a function of
we
du
find
d?u
CHAP.
VI.]
SUM OF A CERTAIN
conclude
SERIES.
297
Whence we
_ &c
It is easy to
ex^es^^e^lim
of this series.
To obtain the
multiple arcs.
We
x
~l
^\
l
o \ 2 cos i sin x) (a
iw*^
*
o>,
-ae-* V= l
e
+e
,
-^ae^~
e^
fcie-*^
,
and denoting
by
aw
cut)"
aw
aw"
2 cos (a sin #)
=e
e~
+ e~
2
.
we Developing the second member according to powers of find the term which does not contain w in the development of 2 cos (a sin x) to be
&>,
&c. are nothing, the same 1 the coefficients of the terms which contain of , with
The
coefficients of
a)
a>
is
3
,
the case
5
o>~
o>~
&c.
4
o>
the coefficient of aT
is
2
o>
the coefficient of
is
4.6.8
the coefficient of of
4
2 2 4. 6. 8. 10
.
&>
^
4
.
It is easy to express the law according to which the coefficients succeed ; but without 2 + 2), or 2 cos 4# in stating it, let us write 2 cos 2a? instead of
is
o>~
(o>
stead of
4
(ft)
&)~ ),
and
so
on
(a sin x} is
.*;.!.
l<f)(x)dx
+ cos #
|<^(a;)
cos
a?(?ic
+ &c,
X
j - 1 4
f
(
298
with the equation
2 cos (a sin x)
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
VI.
=A
4-
we
expressed by
definite integrals.
coefficient
A.
We
have then
-
A=-
from x
T*
to
= TT.
c>
Hence the
^+^
w~4?
6*
+^
*s
^iat
tne
dx
Jo
We
manner by comparison of two equations the values of the successive coefficients B, G, &c.; we have indicated these results because they are useful in other researches which depend on the same theory. It follows from this that the particular value of u which satisfies
the equation
d*u
9U
+j +~
Idu =
c
1S
.If cos
-J
^ sm
/.
*) fo*
to r
TT.
Denoting by q
[dx
2
>
this
= qS, we
find
S=a+&
gu + ^
/cos
j
an d we have
-r-
#2
2
==
|
a 4-6
| j
T?
a?
-=
I
= 0,
>2
>
(a;
^
6
sin r) Jr.
a and
we suppose
= 0, we
have,
as formerly,
cos (x
Jg
sin r) dr.
this expression
we add the
following remarks.
The equation
If"
cos (^ sin w)
c?
M=
/9
/9*
/9
CHAP.
VI.]
299
verifies itself.
We have
11)
in fact
Icos (0 sin
du
Idu (l
^
to
\-
^
TT,
&c.J
2,
denoting by
S#
^6
&c.
Isirfudu, lsm*udu,
sin
u du,
&c.,
we have
f
(COS (0 Sin
j
tt)
<?M
=
2,
7T
- W $ + rj S - w S
2
4 4,
,
fl*
fi*
6 f)
4- &C.,
it
remains to determine
$ ^ S6
&c.
The term
sin
n
u,
n being
an even number,
sin
n
may
u
be developed thus
= TT, we
the
have simply
sin
u du
= A n7r,
From
powers of
A
sines,
for the
-~~
2
-!
~~
LL*
1
A
6
-L ~
2
&c.,
4 5 6
*
2
S^,
2
find
S&
we
cos (0 sin u)
6*
We
cos
(t
can
it),
make
this result
taking, instead of
sin
sin u.
(z)
have a function
<j>
which
may be
* 00 =
we
shall
<
f+
w
f+
f -
f + &c.
"
have
3
(f>
(t
sin u)
=$+ =
sin
(/>
$
25
sin
w+
-5
sin
c^"
w + &c.
X
and - |dw
7TJ
<f>
(*
sin w)
<f>
A6
/S! 2
<f>"
+S# o
"
-f
<#>
&c. ,|
(e).
300
THEORY OF HEAT.
Now,
it is
[CHAP. VI.
8 $ $5
lt
3,
&c. are
nothing.
With
2,
$4 S
,
R)
previously denoted by A# A# this reason, substituting these values in the equation may be, generally, whatever the function
quantities which
</>
we
R,
&c.
(e)
For have we
u)
du
represents cos
so on.
$ (z)
and
z,
and we
have
(j>
= 1,
=
</>"
iv
1,
<
= 1,
=
</>*
1,
312.
To
/ (0),
and of the equation which gives the values of g, it would be necessary to consider the form of the line whose equation is
which forms with the axis of abscissae areas alternately positive and negative which cancel each other the preceding remarks, also, on the expression of the values of series by means of definite When a function of the integrals, might be made more general. variable x is developed according to powers of x, it is easy to deduce the function which would represent the same series, if the 3 powers x, x*, x &c. were replaced by cos x, cos 2aj, cos 3x, &c. By
;
,
making use
,
of this reduction
in the
we
;
series
object.
It
is
sufficient
to
We will add
continued fraction.
313.
satisfies
the equation
CHAP.
VI.]
301
whence we
%
dO
by y\
y">
tfy
W
=
tfy
dO"
o,
">
&c.,
-y =y +
0y"
or g.
&c.;
whence we conclude
1-2-3-4-5- &c/
Thus the value of the function
definite
-
__
7W)
equation,
>
when
_0_
expressed
as
an
6
infinite
continued
fraction, is
1-2-3-4now
_ _0_
_0_
5-&C."
314.
We
shall
which we have up to
If the variable radius of the cylindrical layer be denoted by x, and the temperature of the layer by v, a function of a? and the
time
equation
dv
(d?v
1 dv
for v
following value
v
= ue~mt
1
is
a function of
a?,
which
satisfies
the equation
mw
T + -r-a-h- ax = 0. ax K x j-
d?u
du
302
[CHAP. VI.
If
7)1
X*
,
K u
and consider u
as a function of x,
we have
du
d~e
+ Q de^4
d*u
The
following value
2
u _i 1
satisfies
a u
^2
J*02 ~r J* _
2
2
&
42
0,
We
~m
2
of
in terms of
-
x
~
to
be
mo?
m*
a?
2
x3
2*"
F2
.1
,77& *
:c
the
sum
of this series
is
This value of v in the integral being taken from r = to r = TT. terms of x and satisfies the differential equation, and retains a
finite
value
when x
is
nothing.
+ -j- =0
must be
satisfied
when x =
if
value whatever
we must
2
"1-2-3-4-
5- &c.
in
which Vj denotes
i>
m
-j-
X* -^
is
fi^ ~ +
2
*
~"
+*
>
^V ^ +
*~
""
Xr
"
by
Z,
3,
&c.
the
V2
>
Y
is
f
I
JT 2
<
"
expressed by
/
Atf?i
Trv-e
x
2
-y,
i-
~x*~
cos
v^ sin
CHAP.
VI.]
303
We
the equation
=a
Z-kf9i
l
r
I
/
f
e~ x*
x
2
-^
cos
Ju
sin
qjdq
g%# 3
A-a
r
/
cos
2^7^ sin
coefficients
:
+ &c.
q dis
!,
a2
a3
&c.
are
arbitrary
the variable
= TT.
To prove that WfJWM
"
315.
f oi
-,
the problem and contains the general solution, it remains only to determine -the coefficients a a z &c. from the initial state. lf 2
,
IT-
.^Sf^SJ*^
****M>*iB-
= af m ^u^ +
,
a 2 e~ mit u 2
+ a/r m ^ u3 +
&c.,
in
which w 1? w2
w3
assumed by the
function u, or
-
xz
m*
x*
~
&c. are successively sub-
77?
when, instead of
stituted.
-y-,
the values ^,
it t
^ 2 ^3
,
Making
in
= 0,
V =* a^fj -f a u +
2 2
w3
+ &c.,
<
in which
if
F is
a given function of
i
x.
Let
(x)
be this function
we
whose index
is i
by
>/r
(xtjff^
we
have
(x)
= a^
(a?
V^) + a.^
first
(x
Jg} + a3 ^
(a;
v/^3 )
&c.
multiply each member of a function of x, and integrate from the equation by c^ dx, cr^ being x = to x = X. We then determine the function cr^ so that after the integrations the second member may reduce to the first tenn
To determine the
coefficient,
only,
and the
coefficient a l
may be
304
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. VI.
coefficient
having nul values. Similarly to determine the second a a we multiply both terms of the equation
,
<f>
(x)
= a u^ +
z
w2
+ou
3
-f
&c.
-
to x X. The by another factor 2 dx, and integrate from x = must be such that all the integrals of the second member 2 vanish, except one, namely that which is affected by the coefficient a2 In general, we employ a series of functions of x denoted by ^ a wn i cn correspond to the functions u iy u# u s &c. s
<r
factor
<r
"i>
"2
cr
all
the terms
which contain definite integrals disappear in integration except one in this manner we obtain the value of each of the coefficients We must now examine what functions enjoy the a,, GL, a 3 &c. a J 1 2
;
,
.^..I^IMB^B^^^^^^^
:..,
-...
property in question.
316.
is
Each
member
of the equation
of
u being a function
which
the equation
~j~ A;
mU
d?u
~T"
~7
n *l
da?
1 du _ ~7~ ^ x dx
we have
therefore alcrudx
J
= -a
|(--7^-fo m]\xdx
-T~).
dx
du
/V du , \- -^-dx Jicau;
f
I
<7
d*u
we have
and
,
~ = C + u (T
|wa)
/<r\
\xj
cZcr
c
7
w
o
dx
V}
-p.
<&*
c?V
ad?
-^a,^
u-^
dx
= and integrals must be taken between the limits x x = X, by this condition we determine the quantities which enter into the development, and are not under the integral signs. To in
The
we suppose x in any expression in x, we shall affect that expression with the suffix a; and we shall give it the suffix co to indicate the value which the function of x takes, when we
dicate that
its last
value X.
CHAP.
VI.]
AUXILIARY MULTIPLIERS.
305
Supposing x
n
=
,
in the
a\ n = C + / u -}
[
in and
xj a
\fc
thus
we determine the
to
constants
C and
D.
Making then x = X in
x=
x = X, we have
du,
d?u
and
cr -y-.
^
C
ax
fdu - a 7 \dx
da\
dxj a
-j-\
fdu a 7 \dx
da\ -ydx] a
lu -=-5 2
J
d cr . cZa7, dx
-m
-j-
-.
lo-udx
j
d?(r
i
-
\u dx r {
T dx )\dx
\xj]
+
-
fdu
[-r0-
da
dcr
<T-u-j-
\dx
fdu
(-
U-J-+U-) dx x/
dx
a\
\dx
o-\ + u-}
xj a
p d 2 cr
317.
If the quantity
-^
2
*(-- \x
-r
sign of integration in the second member were equal to the pro duct of cr by a constant coefficient, the terms
u ^f-?
dx
dx [ and
j
audx
for the required
value to zero.
in the
same manner
as the
the equation
m
F. H.
du
2
du
20
306
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. VI.
m and n being constant coefficients, we have don m[ fdu fdu -T-O\ffudx =-7-0u-j- +u-}
,
<r\
do-
\dx
dx
W-7-
x/v
\dx
dx
o\ + M-) x/ a
relation exists,
which
is
dis-
covered
cr
when
in the equation
7;"
+ :^ --T~~ =
we
su PP ose
= xs
n d*s S k *~da?
which shews that the function
s
Ids _
xdx~">
by the equation
1 m u + d*u ~ du = 0+ T~ T cZ^
-7~2 2
A;
cc rfa?
To
find s
it is
sufficient to
change
into
in the value of
the value of
^ (#A/
T; J
that of
cr
will
therefore be xty (x A/ -^ J
We
cZ?^
have then
do-
-j- (7
dx
U-j-
dx
+ Ux
)
a-
-Vf * (Vf
t(
VS - V^ K/l^ Vf
(
the two last terms destroy each other, it follows that on making x 0, which corresponds to the suffix a, the second member
vanishes completely.
tion
We
CHAP.
VI.]
VANISHING FORM.
307
It is easy to see that the second member of this equation is and n are selected from always nothing when the quantities those which we formerly denoted by v m^ 3 &c.
m m
We
have in
fact
W
and
hX=
comparing the values of /UT we see that the second member of the
equation (/) vanishes.
from this that after we have multiplied by adx the two terms of the equation
It follows
<#>
(*0
= CW + a
from
a?
w-
+ o,w + &c.,
8
side
to
a;
= X,
member may
vanish,
suffices to
take
a the quantity xu
or x^r
[A-r-J V V K J
We
of
case in which n
is
= m, when
the value
and
determined by known
rules.
318.
If A
V/
=
-JA/
/j,
and A/ T V A/
= v, we
have
If the numerator
We
du A+.-+-P
d*u
1
or
^4-T
it
202
308
THEORY OF HEAT.
also
lix
[CHAP.
VI.
and
or,
^ + ^x^ = 0,
f
hty
+ pfy =
hence we have
we can
integral which
required to
putting for
/JL
its
value,
and denoting by
)
when we suppose x =
The
index
or
It follows
b=
the
first
and
x
2
-J~
f-, I
fhX\*}X*U*
i
second
when
different,
and the
(x) =a u l + a 2 ii 2 + a 8ua + &c., in Taking then the equation which the coefficients a v a 2 a 3 &c. are to be determined, we shall find the coefficient denoted by a. by multiplying the two members to x of the equation by xu dx, and integrating from x = the second member is reduced by this integration to one term only, and we have the equation
1
,
CHAP.
VI.]
COMPLETE SOLUTION.
.
309
, , . . .
The coefficients a l9 a 2 a 3 which gives the value of a a p being thus determined, the condition relative to the initial state expressed = + a 2u2 + a3 us + &c., is fulfilled. (x) by the equation
t
it is
+ &C.
The
function of
a?
is
expressed by
the integrals with respect to # must be taken from a? = to X, and to. find the function u wer must integrate from q = to = 7r; (a?) is the initial value of the temperature, taken in the interior of the cylinder at a distance # from the axis, which
all
x
<2
real
and positive
"2
X~ -JL JL JL _L F^ ^ 3 - 4^
5-&c.
320.
If
an
infinite
we suppose the cylinder to have been immersed for time in a liquid maintained at a constant temperature,
(/>
the whole mass becomes equally heated, and the function (x) which represents the initial state is represented by unity. After
this substitution, the general equation gradual progress of the cooling.
represents
exactly the
If
is infinite,
the second
member
contains
all
the
for this reason, supposing the roots to be to be the least, the arranged according to their magnitude, and final state of the solid is expressed by the equation
2,
310
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. VI.
general solution we might deduce consequences similar to those offered by the movement of heat in a spherical
From
the
mass.
We
notice
first
that there
are
an
infinite
number
of
particular states, in each of which the ratios established between the initial temperatures are preserved up to the end of the cooling.
I When
I
the initial state does not coincide with one of these simple states, it is always composed of several of them, and the ratios of the temperatures change continually, according as the time increases.
In general the solid arrives very soon at the state in which the temperatures of the different layers decrease continually preserving
the same ratios.
When
the radius
is
1 very small ,
we
find that
2ft
e"
CDX.
e in the
2 is very on the contrary the radius large the exponent of term which represents the final system of temperatures contains the square of the whole radius. We see by this what
,
upon the final velocity of 3 If the temperature of the cylinder whose radius is y cooling. from the value to the lesser value B, in the time T, the passes
will pass temperature of a second cylinder of radius equal to from A to B in a different time T If the two sides are thin, the ratio of the times T and T will be that of the diameters. If, on
.
I
1
the contrary, the diameters of the cylinders are very great, the ratio of the times T and T will be that of the squares of the diameters.
1
When
X is very small, Q = -%
_ &kte
e
from
>
tlie
^
B
2hM
becomes
e,
In the
2
text,
is
"When
is
quadratic equation
1=
B
i
_
O
fi
will make
assume
its
proper magnitude.
Hence 0=1-446
_?2to0
and
e,
becomes
*
.
The
3
is 1-4467,
is
4
.
the
mean
temperature, which
is
equal to
[A. P.]
CHAPTER
VII.
321.
THE equation
^ + ^4 + j^ =
0,
ment
in Chapter II., Section iv., Article 125, expresses the uniform move of heat in the interior of a prism of infinite length, sub
mitted at one end to a constant temperature, its initial tempera tures being supposed nul. To integrate this equation we shall, in the first place, investigate a particular value of v, remarking that this function v must remain the same, when y changes
sign
when z changes sign an.d that its value must become infinitely From this it is small, when the distance x is infinitely great. to see that we can select as a particular value of v the easy mx function ae~ cos ny cos pz and making the substitution we find z z m n p 0. Substituting for n and p any quantities what = Jtf+p*. The value of v must also satisfy the ever, we have m
or
;
;
definite equation
I v + 2~
= ^ when ~
l (
or ~Z,
+ ~dz =
Wll6n Z
=l
Article 125).
If
we
we have
n
or
sin
ny
+ 7 cos ny = Q
hi
-j-
and
hi -r
sin pz
+ 7 cospz = 0,
= pi tan pi,
we
find
= nl tan nl.
e,
We
see
by
this that if
an arc
I,
is
equal
to the whole
known quantity
we can take
n or p the quan-
312
THEORY OF HEAT.
Now,
[CHAP. VII.
tity y.
it
is
number
by
same
for
definite product
-j-,
whence
it
follows
that
we can
find
or
p an
If
infinite
number
e
of different values.
322.
arcs
for
we denote by
lt
ea ,
number
of
which
satisfy
tan
=
^,
we can take
gave
n and p other
The same would be the by we must then take w2 = n 2 + p 2 If we values, we could satisfy the differential
I.
.
can equation, but not the condition relative to the surface. infinite number of particular values
We
the equation,
and as the sum of any collection of these values we can form a more general value of v.
successively for n and
3
,
still satisfies
Take
^,
-j,
all
^
:
&c.
Denoting by a lf a2
a3
&c.,
7>
1?
6 2 , 6 8 , &c.,
con
may be
a
e"
equation
v
=
4-
(a l e~
% +%
2
cos njj
-f
aa
?+^
cos njj
(a^e~
+ n ** cos
2 3
n$
n
-f
+ (a^-* V ^2+W
+ &c.
323.
If
cos
4-
n3z
distance
must preserve a constant temperature. It is there fore necessary that, on making x 0, the value of v should be the same, whatever value we may give to y or to z pro always vided these values are included between and Now, on making
the section
;
I.
0,
we
find
(a t cos n^y
+a
4>
cos
n z y + a3 cos n 3 y + &c.)
-f
x (^ cos n^z
cos n z y
& 3 cos
nz y
+ &c.).
CHAP.
VII.]
313
Denoting by
=a
cos njj
cos
nzy
+
+
a 3 cos
??
+ &c
= \ cos n$ + b
cos v 2 y
+ &c.
,
then to determine the coefficients a lf a a a- 3 &c., whose number is infinite, so that the second member of the equa This problem has already tion may be always equal to unity.
It is sufficient
,
been solved in the case where the numbers n lt n 3 n s &c. form the Here series of odd numbers (Chap. III., Sec. IL, Art. 177). n n 3 &c. are incommensurable quantities given by an equa ?ij,
,
2>
324.
= dj cos n^y + a
cos
n$ +
a 3 cos
n.A y
+ &c.,
multiply the "two members of the equation by cos n^y dy, and take We thus determine the first l. the integral from y = to y
coefficient a r
The remaining
coefficients
may be determined
in a
similar manner.
In general, if we multiply the two members of the equation by cos vy, and integrate it, we have corresponding to a single term of the second member, represented by a cos ny the integral
t
a Icos ny cos vy
dij
or
^al
cos (n
v)
y dy
+ -^ a
/cos (n
+ v) ydy,
sin (n
"
")*
^TV
sin (n
+v]
4-
ii)
sin (n
v)l+(n
v) sin (n
-f-
v)J.\
-~tf~?~
of
v,
y
= T;
the
satisfies
we have
n tan
vl
therefore
v tan
i/
z^Z
or
n sin w cos
vl
v sin
cos
?z
= 0.
314
THEORY OF HEAT.
Thus the foregoing
-2
[CHAP. VII.
a
2
integral,
which reduces to
vl),
2 (
is
integral
jsin (n
[
v)
I] J
n-v
it is
we
see that if
we have n = v,
It follows 1
if
in the equation
=a
cos 71$
cos
n 2y
+a
cos n z y
+ &c.
we wish to determine the coefficient of a term of the second member denoted by a cos ny we must multiply the two members
y
by
cos
ny
dy,
to
We
.
have the
resulting equation
f
cos
Jo
* A * nydy = 2 -^a\l H y J
V
sin2nZ\
1
1 - sin nl,
fi
whence we deduce
cients
2nl
sin 2nl
=4
a.
coeffi-
a^ a 2
,
a3
,
&c.
with b lt 6 2 63
coefficients.
&c.,
may be determined the same is the case which are respectively the same as the former
325.
satisfies
It is easy
now
d?v
to
v.
1st, it
d zv
dx
dy
+ -T^ = O; dz
+ hv
d?v
2nd.
it satisfies
the two
conditions
k-j-
hv
= 0,
and
Jc-j-
value to v
z
when we make x
between
0,
may
be, included
We have
1
_ ~
sin
n cos n^y n
in 2
CHAP.
VII.]
6
THE SOLUTION.
by
1}
315
n t l, n 3 l, &c.
.
or denoting
nj.,
sin 1
e,
cos
e.y -~
2e x
+ sin e
2e a
+ sin
+
e2
_
sin e3 cos
ey
+ &c
3
.
-y-
2e 3
+ sin e
an equation which holds for all values of y included between and I, and consequently for all those which are included between x = 0. and I, when
Substituting the known values of a l9 b lt a a &2 a a b 3 &c. in the general value of v, we have the following equation, which contains the solution of the proposed problem,
, ,
,
smnjcosnf
2
sin
4.4
fsmnjcoan.y
/ sin
y^~^
v^TT^
,
*
j sin
3
njcosnjs
in 2?i 2 Z
__+
2/i
^
_ __
V 2^? \ZriJ
,
&c
+ sin 2/i^
denoted by n lt n^ n B
&c.
are
,
infinite
3
,
in
&c. ;
arcs,
e
e1
e2
&c.,
equation
tan
hi
-=.
The solution expressed by the foregoing equation 326. is the only solution which belongs to the problem it represents the
;
-^ +
-^
+ y- = 0,
2
in which the
tions.
arbitrary functions have been determined from the given condi It is easy to see that there can be no different solution.
In
us denote by -fy (as, y, z] the value of v derived from the equation (E), it is evident that if we gave to the solid initial tem peratures expressed by ty(x, y, z), no change could happen in the
fact, let
system of temperatures, provided that the section at the origin were retained at the constant temperature 1: for the equation
j-a dx
+ -5-5 +
dy
~J~>
being
satisfied,
dz"
31 G
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
VII.
The same would not be the temperature is necessarily nothing. if after having given to each point within the solid whose the case, co-ordinates are x, y z the initial temperature ty(x, y, z), we gave
t
to all points of the section at the origin the temperature 0. see clearly, and without calculation, that in the latter case the
state of the solid
We
heat which
air,
would change continually, and that the original contains would be dissipated little by little into the and into the cold mass which maintains the end at the tem
it 0.
perature
ty(x, y, z),
This result depends on the form of the function which becomes nothing when x has an infinite value as
.
similar effect
(x, y, z)
;
would exist if the initial temperatures instead were -^ (#, y, z] at all the internal points
always at the
provided the section at the origin be maintained temperature 0. In each case, the initial tempera
tures would continually approach the constant temperature of the and the final temperatures would all be nul. medium, which is
;
These preliminaries arranged, consider the movement of 327. heat in two prisms exactly equal to that which was the subject of the problem. For the first solid suppose the initial temperatures is maintained to be + ^(a?, y, s), and that the section at origin
For the second solid suppose the temperature initial temperatures to be ^ (x, y, z), and that at the origin A It all points of the section are maintained at the temperature 0.
at the fixed
1.
prism the system of temperatures can not change, and that in the second this system varies continually up to that at which all the temperatures become nul.
is
first
If
solid,
the
same
alone existed.
initial
systems, each point of the solid has zero temperature, except the Now points of the section A, in accordance with the hypothesis.
the temperatures of the second system change more and more, and vanish entirely, whilst those of the first remain unchanged.
Hence after an infinite time, the permanent system of tempera tures becomes that represented by equation E, or v = ^r(#, y, z]. It must be remarked that this result depends on the condition
relative to the initial state
;
it
CHAP.
VII.]
GEOMETRICAL CONSTRUCTION.
31
contained in the prism is so distributed, that it would vanish entirely, if the end A were maintained at the temperature 0.
328.
1st, it is
We may
tan
=
-j-
we
u = e tan e,
15) that
the arc
The curve
357
"
The
o
abscissa?
which correspond
->
to
"
"
71
77
9
TT,
71
&c
tion are
2?r,
3?r,
now we
~r
K.
,
an ordinate
equal to the
known quantity
and through
extremity draw
abscissa?,
tan
=
-j-
The con
Researches of
2nd.
We
easily conclude
In
fact,
n l9 n z
w3
2nr
is
318
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. VII.
into the greater than any of the analogous fractions which enter terms. subsequent
Suppose now that we can observe the temperature of a point on the axis of the prism situated at a very great distance x, and the temperature of a point on this axis situated at the distance x + 1, 1 being the unit of measure we have then y 0, z = 0,
;
and the
ratio of the
first is
sensibly
^2ni\ e~
if
we mark on
which
at a distance equal to the unit of measure from the pre the ratio of the temperature of a point to that of the point ceding,
is
which precedes
it,
e~^2ni
thus the temperatures of points situated at equal distances end by decreasing in geometrical progression. This law always holds,
whatever be the thickness of the bar, provided we consider points situated at a great distance from the source of heat.
It
is
easy to
quantity called
small,
n{
of the construction, that if the half the thickness of the prism, is very I, has a value very much smaller than nz or ?? 3 &c. ; it
see,
by means
is
which
very much than any of the analogous fractions. Thus, in the case in greater which the thickness of the bar is very small, it is unnecessary to be very far distant from the source of heat, in order that the tem
follows
from
e~
^2ni
is
in geometrical peratures of points equally distant may decrease The law holds through the whole extent of the bar. progression.
330.
general value of v
e -x\/zn^^
a very small quantity, the reduced to the first term which contains
Z
is
which expresses the temperature of a point whose co-ordinates are x, y, and z, is given in this case by
the equation
2nl (4+ sm 2nlJ
.
=,
sin nl
.
\
7
cos
ny cos nz
-x-Jzn?
the arc
or nl
e
becomes very
tan
e
small, as
we
e
see
2
by the
;
construction.
first
The equation
=
j-
reduces then to
= -r
the
value of
CHAP.
VII.]
319
e,
or e lf
is
\J j- by
;
we know the
,
values of
e lt e 2
e8 , e 4
e6,
A/ -j-
&c.
The
values of n v n v n3 n^
,
ny
&c.
are, therefore,
!_
/h
&
as
7T
J
27T
i
3?T
~i
v^v
whence we conclude,
was said above, that if I is a very small quantity, the first value n is incomparably greater than all the others, and that we must omit from the general value of v all the terms which follow the first. If now we substitute in the first term the value found for n, remarking that the arcs nl and 2nl are equal to their sines, we have
hl\
x
/?
the factor
small,
it
A/ -j- which
follows
the temperature varies very little, for different points of the same section, when the half thickness I is very small. This result is so to speak self-evident, but it is useful
that
remark how it is explained by analysis. The general solution reduces in fact to a single term, by reason of the thinness of the bar, and we have on replacing by unity the cosines of very small
to
arcs v
= e~ x *
A*
kl
,
We found the same equation formerly in Article 76 obtained here by an entirely different analysis.
331.
it
is
The foregoing solution indicates the character of the movement of heat in the interior of the solid. It is easy to see that when the prism has acquired at all its points the stationary temperatures which we are considering, a constant flow of heat
passes through each section perpendicular to the axis towards the end which was not heated. To determine the quantity of flow
which corresponds to an abscissa x, we must consider that the quantity which flows during unit of time, across one element of
320
the section,
is
THEORY OF HEAT.
equal to the product of the coefficient
/75
[CHAP. VII.
k, of
the area
dt,
and of the
ratio -=-
We
to z
I.
integral
k dy dz
I I
-=
,
from z
y=
to
y=
We
the half thickness of the bar, and then from thus have the fourth part of the whole flow.
The
law according to
which the quantity of heat which crosses a section of the bar decreases and we see that the distant parts receive very little heat from the source, since that which emanates directly from it is directed partly towards the surface to be dissipated into the air. That which crosses any section whatever of the prism forms, if we may so say, a sheet of heat whose density varies from one point
;
of the section to another. It is continually employed to replace the heat which escapes at the surface, through the whole end of the prism situated to the right of the section it follows therefore
:
that the whole heat which escapes during a certain time from this part of the prism is exactly compensated by that which penetrates
it
by virtue of the
must calculate the produce of the flow The element of surface is dxdy, and v its temperature, being hvdxdy is the quantity of heat which from this element during the unit of time. Hence the escapes
integral
h\dx\dyv
finite
from a
We
1,
known
value of v in y supposing z
l,
y = QiQy =
;
We and a second time from x = x up to x = oo thus find half the heat which escapes from the upper surface of the prism and taking four times the result, we have the heat lost through the upper and lower surfaces.
If
dz
v,
and give to
to z = l, and a and integrate once from z = second time from x = to x = oo we have one quarter of the heat which escapes at the lateral surfaces. in v its value
;
The
integral
/?
dx \dy
v,
CHAP.
VII.]
321
ml cos
nl e~ x ^mi+n *,
dx Idz v gives
a
cos
vm + n
2
ml sin
Hence the quantity of heat which the prism loses at its surface, throughout the part situated to the right of the section whose abscissa is x, is composed of terms all analogous to
sin
ml cos nl + -
cos
ml
in sin nl\
}
On the other hand the quantity of heat which during the same time penetrates the section whose abscissa is x is composed of terms analoous to
mn
sin mlsiD.nl
ml
sin nl
=
H
sin
ml cos nl
cos
ml sin nl,
;
or
k (mz
nl
+ hn sin ml cos wZ
now we have
separately,
km?
or
sin
ml
cos wZ
m sin ml = h
cos
imZ
also
2
we have
A;?i
sin nl sin
mZ = hn
??Z
or
n sin
cos
?iZ
r=7 k
is satisfied.
is
in
cessantly established between the heat dissipated and the heat and transmitted, is a manifest consequence of the hypothesis
;
H.
322
pressed; but
it
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. VII.
was useful to notice this conformity in a new problem, which had not yet been submitted to analysis.
332. Suppose the half side I of the. square which serves as the base of the prism to be very long, and that we wish to ascertain the law according to which the temperatures at the different points of
we must give
to
I
to
y and
Now
e is
the construc
-^
,
value of
the second
-x-
the third
2i
&c. Let us
n^
--, ~
t-r
f>
and
e"
1 *
;
we then
find
-&C.
see by this result that the temperature at different points of the axis decreases rapidly according as their distance from the If then we placed on a support heated and origin increases.
We
maintained at a permanent temperature, a prism of infinite height, having as base a square whose half side I is very great; heat would be propagated through the interior of the prism, and would be dis
sipated at the surface into the surrounding air which is supposed When the solid had arrived at a fixed to be at temperature 0.
the points of the axis would have very unequal temperatares, and at a height equal to half the side of the base the temperature of the hottest point would be less than one fifth part of the temperature of the base.
state,
CHAPTER
VIII.
333.
IT
still
remains for us to
dv
make
d*v
/d?v
solid
v.).
cube exposed
Section
Assuming, in
v the very simple value e~ mt cosnx cospycosqz, if we substitute it in the proposed equation, we have the equa tion of condition m = k (n* + p* + q*), the letter k denoting the
the
TT-
coefficient
n, p,
z
It follows
from
this that if
we
substitute for
k(n
+ p* + q ),
*
q any quantities whatever, and take for 2 the preceding value of v will
We
requires also that if x changes sign, and if y and z remain the same, the function should not change ; and that this should also
now the
To express the
:
we must employ
the
following equations
.(6).
212
324*
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
VIII.
a, These ought to be satisfied when x a, or g a, or y centre of the cube is taken to be the origin of co-ordinates and the side is denoted by a.
The
The
+
or
first
of the equations
(6)
gives
mt
e"
sin
nx cospy cos qz
+ n tan nx
a.
value what
ever for n t but that this quantity must satisfy the condition
nata>una
J\.
-^a.
We
must
tan
= -^a,
J\.
=&
Now
the
equation in
n an
has an infinity of real roots hence we can find for We can ascertain in the same
;
manner the values which may be given to p and to q they are all represented by the construction which was employed in the preceding problem (Art. 321). Denoting these roots by n^n^n^ &c.;
we can then
equation
select
provided we substitute for n one of the roots n v n z p and q in the same manner.
335.
n3
&c.,
and
We
v,
and
it
sum
satisfy the differential equation (a), and the definite equations (). In order to give to v the general form which the problem requires, we may unite an indefinite number of terms similar to the term
cos
nx
The
v =
value of v
may be
(a t cos n^x
(b l cos
(Cj
e~ kn
&+a
n zx
n
e~
kn
^+a
_j_
cos n 3 x e~ CO s
*"
& + &c.),
+ &c.),
+ &c.).
H
n^y
Q-IM + ^ cos
e~ kn
e-kn?t
er*"**
n$ e~
n s y e~
kn *H
kn
cos n^z
^+
c 2 cos
n2 z
c 8 cos
CHAP.
VIII.]
GENERAL VALUE OF
is
V.
325
3,
&c. are
if t
unknown
be made
= 0,
a2 a 3
,
&c.,
and z, provided that each of these values is included between a and a. Denoting by 1 the initial temperature at all points of
solid,
the
we
1
shall write
(Art. 323)
s
=a
cos n^x
cos
+a +
cos n zx
+ aa cos n x + &c.,
+
b3 cos n^y
ca cos n B z
, ,
1
1
=&
=c
ny
t
6 a cos
c a cos
n2 y
n zz
+ &c., + &c.,
cos n^z
in
which
it
is
plying each
member
X
CL-.
required to determine a lt at a s &c. After multi of the first equation by cosnx, integrate
it
from # =
to
employed
1
we have
:
the equation
=i
^T?
-f i
^-s
sin
,
n z a cos njc
:
gin
tn^\
nja,
+ &c.
Denoting by
_
.
^ the
quantity ^
sin n.a
-\
1 H
we have
j,
^
sin n.a
cos n^x H
cos n sx
-f
&c.
when we
give to
x a value included
between a and
a,
From
it
we conclude the
general value of
v,
which
is
given by
/sin n. a
(
,.
2/ t
sin
-f
na
cos njc e~ kn *
,. f
+ &c.
\
)
s
(
cos
n$
e~ ina^
+ &c.J,
/sin
CL
ros M z
~
fi
, f kn *,,
sin
-I
n na si
cos n^z e
326
336.
THEORY OF HEAT.
The expression
x,
[CHAP. VIII.
for v is therefore
functions, one of
In
fact, if in
the equation
dt~ we suppose
by Y
a function of x and t, denoting by a function of z and t, we have a function of y and t, and by
v
XYZ\
ax
"
x"^
rW + ^^
~
d^
dY
dz _
"
*W
.
**-z&)
dz
~dt
dy"
dt~
^ +^
dx
whence we deduce
K
from
=,=,.
dy
dz
It follows
it is
enough
-^
=k
0,
-^ and
,
to
add to
it
the
equation of condition -p
+ ^u
We must
value of
v.
either
T/
or
#,
and we
shall
X Y
}
Z,
whose product
is
the general
is
solved as follows
,
cos
CHAP.
VIII.]
327
n l} w 2
?i
ha
in which e represents
is
2n^a
(yy
t),
(z, t)
are found.
337.
We may
blem
differential
be assured that this value of v solves the pro and that the complete integral of the partial equation (a) must necessarily take this form in order
In fact, the expression for v satisfies the equation (a) and the conditions relative to the surface. Hence the variations of tempe
rature which result in one instant from the action of the molecules
which we
should find by differentiating the value of v with respect to the time t. It follows that if, at the beginning of any instant, the function v represents the system of temperatures, it will still
represent those which hold at the commencement of the following instant, and it may be proved in the same manner that the vari
able state of the solid
is
v,
in
this function continually increases. with the initial state: hence it represents all the later agrees Thus it is certain that any solution which states of the solid.
t
Now
must be wrong.
If we suppose the time t, which has elapsed, to have 338. become very great, we no longer have to consider any but the for the values n v n^ n3 &c. are first term of the expression for v
;
,
This term
is
given
by the equation
v
this
/sin
(
??
1
a\
the principal state towards which the system of tem peratures continually tends, and with which it coincides without In this state the tempesensible error after a certain value of t.
then
is
328
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. VIII.
rature at every point decreases proportionally to the powers of the fraction e~ skn ^- the successive states are then all similar, or }
rather they differ only in the magnitudes of the temperatures which all diminish as the terms of a geometrical progression, pre may easily find, by means of the pre serving their ratios.
We
ceding equation, the law by which the temperatures decrease from one point to another in direction of the diagonals or the edges of
tain also
the cube, or lastly of a line given in position. might ascer what is the nature of the surfaces which determine the
We
same temperature. We see that in the final and which we are here considering, points of the same layer preserve always equal temperatures, which would not hold in the initial state and in those which immediately follow it.
During the
infinite
is
mon
temperature.
It is easy to
determine for a given instant the mean temperature of the mass, that is to say, that which is obtained by taking the sum of the products of the volume of each molecule
339.
by
its
sum by
3
We
which
that of the
mean temperature
The
z,
}
X YZ
we have
thus the
mean temperature
is
fl-gpl
s i nce
>
integrals have a
common
value, hence
nfl
J PI
is
nta
e-^+ Ac.
e
The quantity na
and
//,
equal to
e,
tan
-~
is
equal to x (l
We
6 1} e a e 8
, ,
by
CHAP.
VIII.]
329
6,
is
between
the roots
and e2
6
TT,
e2 is
between
TT
and
between
2?r
and
TT,
g,
e4 ,
&c. approach
3-7T,
to the
inferior limits
TT,
2-Tr,
&c.,
i is
very great.
The double
between
2?r
and
TT,
and
.
3?r,
between
all
4?r
:
positive
.
the quantities 1 H
16 1
1 H
sin 2e2
-
^ ^
and included
between
and
2.
It follows
^V
are positive.
We propose now to compare the velocity of cooling in 340. the cube, with that which we have found for a spherical mass. We have seen that for either of these bodies, the system of tem
peratures converges to a permanent state which is sensibly attained time the temperatures at the different points of the cube then diminish all together preserving the same ratios,
after a certain
;
and the temperatures of one of these points decrease as the terms of a geometric progression whose ratio is not the same in the two It follows from the two solutions that the ratio for the bodies.
.
n3
and
for
the cube e
Je
2
.
The quantity n
h
is
given by
cos na na sm na
^,<7,
e is
given
by the equation
tan
This arranged, let us consider two different cases; that in which the radius of the sphere and the half side of the cube are each equal to a, a very small quantity and that in which the value of a is very great. Suppose then that the two bodies are of
;
330
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. VIII.
is
the
we have
therefore
-^
=e
2
,
-3-Jfe
<*<*
is
equal to
cva
Thus the ultimate temperatures which we observe are expressed in na cos na h _!^ ,, TP the form Ae CDa. If now in the equation -j^a, we K. sin na
. .
:
=1
member
-
^
JK.
na
-^-,
-^=
-W
is
-e
cva.
conclude from this that if the radius of the sphere is verythe final velocities of cooling are the same in that solid and small, in the circumscribed cube, and that each is in inverse ratio of the
that is to say, if the temperature of a cube whose half side a passes from the value A to the value B in the time t, a sphere whose semi-diameter is a will also pass from the temperature A If the quantity a were to the temperature B in the same time.
radius
is
;
We
changed
for
each body so as to become a, the time required for A to would have another value t and the
ratio of the times t and t would be that of the half sides a and a. The same would not be the case when the radius a is very great for 6 is then equal to JTT, and the values of na are the quantities
:
TT,
27T,
3-7T,
4?r,
&c.
easily find, in this case, the values of the frac
;
they are
e~^
and
e~~"* .
From this we may derive two remarkable consequences: 1st, when two cubes are of great dimensions, and a and a are their halfsides if the first occupies a time t in passing from the temperature A to the temperature B, and the second the time t for the same 2 interval the times t and t will be proportional to the squares a z and a of the half-sides. We found a similar result for spheres of 2nd, If the length a of the half-side of a cube great dimensions. is considerable, and a sphere has the same magnitude a for radius, and during the time t the temperature of the cube falls from A to
; ;
a different time
temperature of the
CHAP.
sphere
VIII.]
REMARKS.
from
331
t
is
falling
3.
to JB,
and
are in the
ratio of
4 to
when
Thus the cube and the inscribed sphere cool equally quickly their dimension is small and in this case the duration of
;
the cooling
each body proportional to its thickness. If the dimension of the cube and the inscribed sphere is great, the final
is
for
duration of the cooling is not the same for the two solids. This duration is greater for the cube than for the sphere, in the ratio of
for each of the two bodies severally the duration of the increases as the square of the diameter. cooling
4 to
3,
and
341. We have supposed the body to be cooling slowly in at mospheric air whose temperature is constant. We might submit the surface to any other condition, and imagine, for example, that
all its points preserve,
0.
by
virtue of
some external
temperature quantities n, p, q, which enter into the value of v under the symbol cosine, must in this case be such that cos nx becomes nothing when x has its complete value a, and that the
The
same
cube
is
qz.
represented by TT, 2?r being the length of the circumference whose radius is 1 ; we can express a particular value of v by the
is
following equation, which satisfies at the same time the general equation of movement of heat, and the state of the surface,
v
= e .. cb
cos
x cos y cos z.
. .
This function
is
tt
when x or y or z
for the
+2i
or
2*
temperature cannot have this simple form until after a consider able time has elapsed, unless the given initial state is itself represented by cos x cos y cos z. This is what we have supposed
in Art. 100, Sect. Yin. Chap. I. The foregoing analysis proves the truth of the equation employed in the Article we have j ust cited.
Up
to this point
we have
in the theory of heat, and have considered the action of that element in the principal bodies. Problems of such kind and order have been chosen, that each presents a new difficulty of a
degree.
We
higher
332
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
VIII.
intermediate problems, such as the problem of the linear movement of heat in a prism whose ends are maintained at fixed temperatures,
movement
state
The expression for the varied or exposed to the atmospheric air. of heat in a cube or rectangular prism which is cooling in an aeriform medium might be generalised, and any initial
whatever supposed. These investigations require no other principles than those which have been explained in this work,
was published by M. Fourier in the Memoir es de VAcademic des vii. Paris, 1827, pp. 605 624, entitled, Memoire sur la distinction des racines imaginaires, et sur Vapplication des theoremes d analyse algebrique aux
Sciences,
A memoir
Tome
equations transcendantes qui dependent de la theorie de la chaleur. It contains a proof of two propositions in the theory of heat. If there be two solid bodies of similar convex forms, such that corresponding elements have the same density, specific capacity for heat, and conductivity, and the same initial distribution of
temperature, the condition of the two bodies will always be the same after times which are as the squares of the dimensions, when, 1st, corresponding elements of the surfaces are maintained at constant temperatures, or 2nd, when the tem
peratures of the exterior constant.
medium
remain
For the velocities of flow along lines of flow across the terminal areas *, s of corresponding prismatic elements are as u-v u -v , where (u, v), (i/, 1/) are tem A on opposite sides of s and s peratures at pairs of points at the same distance and if n n is the ratio of the dimensions, u-v u -v =n :n. If then, dt, dt be
:
corresponding times, the quantities of heat received by the prismatic elements are as sk (u -v) dt s k (u - i/) dtf, or as n^n dt : itf ndt But the volumes being as n 3 : n 3, if the corresponding changes of temperature are always equal we must have
: .
n?n dt
ri*
_n :;
ndt
3
dt__<n?_
<^"
ra
~^*
n.
H H =ri:
:
[A. F.]
CHAPTER
IX.
FIRST SECTION.
Of
342.
the
line.
HERE we
consider the
all
movement
of heat in a solid
infinite. The homogeneous mass, solid is divided by planes infinitely near and perpendicular to a common axis and it is first supposed that one part only of the solid has been heated, that, namely, which is enclosed between two parallel planes A and B, whose distance is g all other parts but any plane included between have the initial temperature A and B has a given initial temperature, regarded as arbitrary, and common to every point of the plane the temperature is dif The initial state of the mass being ferent for different planes.
of whose
dimensions are
thus defined,
it is
all
the suc
ceeding
states.
The movement
is
in direction of the axis of the plane for it is evident that there can be no transfer of heat in any plane perpendicular to the axis,
since the initial temperature at every point in the plane
is
the
same.
Instead of the infinite solid we may suppose a prism of very small thickness, whose lateral surface is wholly impenetrable to heat. The movement is then considered only in the infinite line which is the common axis of all the sectional planes of the prism.
more general, when we attribute temperatures to all points of the part of the solid which has entirely arbitrary
is
The problem
334
been heated,
perature
solid
0.
THEORY OF HEAT.
all
[CHAP. IX.
The laws
to
other points of the solid having the initial tem of the distribution of heat in an infinite
mass ought
since
or
the movement
is
have a simple and remarkable character not disturbed by the obstacle of surfaces,
The
angular axes, on which we measure the co-ordinates x, y, z, the temperature sought is a function of the variables x, y, z, and of This function v or the time (x, y, z, t) satisfies the general
t.
<
equation
Further,
it
must
which
is
moment when
<(*,
we must have
(5).
y, z, 0)
= F(x,
y, z)
Hence we must
which
tion
satisfies
(&).
find a function v of the four variables x, y, z, t, (a) and the definite equa
In the problems which we previously discussed, the integral is subject to a third condition which depends on the state of the surface for which reason the analysis is more complex, and the
:
solution
requires
The
very
much more
it
and
when
But
in order to
explain this part of the theory, and to ascertain according to what law the diffusion is effected, it is preferable to consider first the linear movement, we it into the two
resolving
shall see in the sequel
how they
dimensions.
a part a b of an infinite line is raised at temperature 1 the other points of the line are at the actual temperature it is assumed that the heat cannot be
First
344.
problem
all
points to the
medium; we have
to determine
SECT.
I.]
TWO PROBLEMS.
the state of the line after a given time.
general,
335
This problem that the initial
what
is
by supposing,
1st,
temperatures of the points included between a and b are unequal and represented by the ordinates of any line whatever, which we
shall regard first as
(see
fig.
16);
2nd, that part of the heat is dispersed through the surface of the solid, which is a prism of very small thickness, and of infinite
length.
consists in determining the successive states of a prismatic bar, infinite in length, one extremity of which is submitted to a constant temperature. The solution of
-.JO* 6
second
problem
dv
tfv
z
HL
CDS
dt~CDdx
v is (Article 105), which expresses the linear movement of heat, the temperature which the point at distance x from the origin must have after the lapse of the time t K, H, C, D, L, S, denote the internal and surface conducibilities, the specific capacity for
;
heat, the density, the contour of the perpendicular section, the area of this section.
and
345.
Consider in the
first
is
propagated freely in an infinite line, one part of which ab has received any initial temperatures; all other points having the initial temperature 0. If at each point of the bar we raise the
ordinate of a plane curve so as to represent the actual tempera ture at that point, we see that after a certain value of the time t,
the
state of the solid is expressed by the form of the curve. Denote by v = F(x) the equation which corresponds to the given initial state, and first, for the sake of making the investigation
336
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. IX.
more simple, suppose the initial form of the curve to be composed of two symmetrical parts, so that we have the condition
F(x)=F(-x}. JL-i. HL -
CD~
2
CDS~
in
the equation
~rr
dt^
k-j
hv,
make
-,
= e~ ht u, and we
v
have
du
dt
d*u dz* \
Jc
1 particular value of u, namely, a cos qx e"^ ; a and q being arbitrary constants. Let q v q 2 q 3 &c. be a series of any values whatever, and a l9 a 2 , a 3 &c. a series of corresponding
Assume a
we have
cos faai) e~kq ^
,
+ aa cos fax) e-^* + &c. &c. increase by infinitely Suppose first that the values q lt q^, q s small degrees, as the abscissa q of a certain curve ; so that they &c. become equal to dq, 2dq, dq being the constant differen
l
u=a
cos fax)
2<
e~*<zi
+a
3dq>
the abscissa; next that the values a^ a 2 a 3 &c. are pro that they portional to the ordinates Q of the same curve, and become equal to Q^dq, Q^dq, Q3 dq, &c., Q being a certain function
tial of
,
>
of
q.
:
It follows
may be
expressed
thus
is
from q
an arbitrary function f(q), and the integral may be taken Q to q=vo. The difficulty is reduced to determining
346.
for u,
To determine
to
Q,
we must suppose
in the expression
and equate u
(x).
We
condition
If
we
substituted for
integration from q
it is
Q any
function of
q,
to q
oo,
we should
find a function of
required to solve the inverse problem, that is to say, to ascertain whatranctioii of q, after being substituted for Q, gives as the result the function F(x) a remarkable problem whose
t
solution
demands
attentive examination.
SECT.
I.]
AN INVERSE PROBLEM.
337
Developing the sign of the integral, we write as follows, the equation from which the value of Q must be derived
:
F(x)
= dq Q
cos qjc
cos q z x
+ &c.
member
dis
In order to
make
all
integrate with respect to x from x = infinite number, and r represents a magnitude equal to any one of q lf q z q 3 &c., or which is the same thing dq, 2dq, 3dq, &c. Let
,
,
q be any value whatever of the variable qf and q^ another value, namely, that which we have taken for r; we shall have r =jdq,
i
and q = idq.
number n
to express
many
how we
have n
-r-
dq
value of the integral Idx cos qx cos rx
nothing, whenever r and
is
its
value
UTT,
when q =
r.
This follows from the fact that integration eliminates from the member all the terms, except one namely, that which contains qj or r. The function which affects the same term
second
;
is
Qj,
we have
therefore
dx F (x) cos qx
and substituting
for
=
1,
dq
nir,
ndq
its
value
we have
cos qx.
We
-^ = Jo dxF(x)cosqx. 2
(*>
Thus, to
Q which
to
satisfies
function
infinite,
x nothing
2 ;
that
is
to say,
we deduce
the
f(q}=-ld,jcF(x)cosqx,
F.
ii.
function
F(f)
representing
22
338
initial
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. IX.
temperatures of an infinite prism, of which an intermediate part only is heated. Substituting the value of/(^) in the expres sion for (x} y we obtain the general equation
A
347.
If
(e).
we
we have found for the function Q, we have the following integral, which contains the complete solution of the proposed problem,
-v
^a
I
7I
= e~ u
dq cos
qx
e~ kqH
dx F (x)
.
cos qx.
fcy*
The integral, with respect to #, being taken from x nothing to x infinite, the result is a function of q\ and taking then the to q = oo we obtain for v a integral with respect to q from q = function of x and t, which represents the successive states of the solid. Since the integration with respect to x makes this variable
,
disappear, it may be replaced in the expression of v by any varia ble a, the integral being taken between the same limits, namely
from a =
to a
oo
We have
I
then
I
!L_ _. e -u
fa cos g X e -kq*t
Jo
or
Jo
= e~ ht
a
dx F(a.)
Jo
Jo
dq e~
kqZf
cos
qx cos
qy.
integration with respect to q will give a function of x and taking the integral with respect to a we find a funca, tion of x and t only. In the last equation it would be easy to effect the integration with respect to q, and thus the expression of v would be changed. We can in general give different forms
The
and
dv
dt
=k
d*v
dJ?~
hv
<$"
they
all
t.
348. Suppose in the first place that all the initial tempera tures of points included between a and b, from x = 1, to x 1, have the common value 1, and that the temperatures of all the
SECT.
I.]
339
other points are nothing, the function F(x) will be given by this condition. It will then be necessary to integrate, with respect to
x,
from x
to
x=
1,
for the
rest of the
integral
is
nothing
We
,
2 sin * = ----q * 1
and
irv
-TT
-
= e~ M
easily
C^dg
I
cos
qx sm
a.
JO 1
be seen presently ; it represents exactly the state of the solid at a given instant, and if we make in it t = 0, it ex
series, as will
sin
q cos qx
is
equivalent to unity,
:
if
\
we give to x any value included between 1 and 1 but this function is nothing if to x any other value be given not included between 1 and 1. see by this that discontinuous functions
/
/ /
We
also
may be
In order to give a second application of the preceding us suppose the bar to have been heated at one of its points by the constant action of the same source of heat, and that it has arrived at its permanent state which is known to be
349.
formula, let
of heat
by
F (x)
we
shall
have
/HL
F(x)
= Ae
TTT
^;
most heated.
To
the initial temperature of the point = l, simplify the investigation let us make
is
and -^7=1.
Ao
We
have
then
F(x\e~
x
,
whence we deduce
innnite;;<
=^j
x and
is
given by
222
34-0
THEORY OF HEAT.
350.
If
[CHAP. IX.
~=
Jo
+ 2 JM
which
cor-
equal to
e-
x
.
It
value accord
when x becomes
before
by the
source
the
was formed,
is
propagated equally to the right and the left of the point 0, which directly receives it: it follows that the line whose equation is
2 f^dqcoaqx
I
1S
2"
composed
f ot
are formed by repeating to right and left of the axis of y the part which is on the right of the axis of y, and
is
whose equation
function it is e x
y = e~
discontinuous function
C S
I
We
^
is
f^- is
equivalent to e~
1
.
when x
is positive,
but
when x
negative
of the propagation of heat in an infinite bar, one end of which is subject to a constant temperature, is reducible, as we shall see presently, to that of the diffusion of heat 351.
The problem
in
an
infinite line;
but
it
initial heat,
instead of affecting equally the two contiguous halves of the solid, is distributed in it in contrary manner; that is to say that repre
senting by F(x) the temperature of a point whose distance from the middle of the line is x, the initial temperature of the opposite &, has for value (x). point for which the distance is
This second problem differs very little from the preceding, and might be solved by a similar method: but the solution may
also
for us the
be derived from the analysis which has served to determine movement of heat in solids of finite dimensions.
Suppose that a part ab of the infinite prismatic bar has been heated in any manner, see fig. (16*), and that the opposite part
but of contrary sign all the rest of the solid the initial temperature 0. Suppose also that the surroundhaving
a/3 is in like state,
;
Of.
Biemann, Part.
Diff. Glcich.
16, p. 34.
[A. F.]
SECT.
I.]
HEATED FINITE
is
BAR.
841
ing
it
medium
what
origin
will
It is required to find, after a given time be the temperature v of a point whose distance from the
t>
is x.
We
then
shall
consider
first
the
heated bar as
having a
finite
length 2JT, and as being submitted to some external cause which maintains its two ends at the constant temperature 0; we shall
make JT=
oc.
352.
We
first
and makin
v = e~ hf u
we have
_ ~
dt
dx*>
may be
expressed as follows
&
Making then x = X, which ought to make the value of v nothing, we have, to determine the series of exponents g, the
condition sin
gX= 0,
=.
or
gX=i7r,
being an integer.
Hence
.
a^e
sin
-^
+ae
2
sin
=-
&c. +^
&c.
Making =
t
we have
.
.
sin
-.+ a
sin
-- + a
sin
-- +
xc.
342
THEORY OF HEAT.
Let
[CHAP. IX.
~Y
r,
and denote
F (x)
2
or
F(2 =-
by f(r)
we have
f(r)
sin r
sin
2r
+ a a sin 3r -f &c.
r
to r
= TT.
Hence
The
x
= X Making these
to
substitutions,
we form
the equation
sin
353.
Such would be the solution if the prism had a finite It is an evident consequence of the
principles which we have laid down up to this point; it remains Let infinite. UTT, n being only to suppose the dimension
X=
an
infinite
number;
dgr
also let
q be a variable whose
infinitely small
increments
we
write
-7-
instead of n.
(a)
The general
term of the
series
being
jpi
ITTX (
..
-,
we
represent
by
3- the
which
is
variable
and becomes
infinite.
Thus we have
JL
-v
IT = -T-,
1 = -7-
q
dqr
fc=-j-.
dy
dq
Making these
e~ kqH sin
we
find
gx\dxF (x)
*7T
Each
of these terms
must be divided
and
by
X or v-,
becoming thereby an
SECT.
I.]
GENERAL SOLUTION.
of the series
is
343
the
sum
to q
= oo
qx
Hence
e~ M
\dqe-W*
sin
the integral with respect to x must be taken from We may also write
TTl)
x=
oo.
*
7TV
_ Q-U
Q
~
f
\
30
Jo
dqe-Wt sm qx
f
30
f
I
sm
Jo
or
~^ * Equation
f
\
30
Jo
(a)
d^F(^]\
Jo
dq e-
contains the general solution of the problem; and, substituting for F(x] any function whatever, subject or not to a continuous law, we shall always be able to express the value
of the temperature in terms of x and t only it must be remarked that the function F(x) corresponds to a line formed of two equal
:
1
.
is
FFFF
(fig.
initial
Fig. 17.
state, is formed of two equal ares situated right and left of the fixed point 0, the variable movement of the heat is expressed by the equation
TTV
-_
= e~ u
f
I
30
00
f
I
-d&F(a)
dq
Fig. 18.
(fig.
18),
initial state, is
That
is to say,
344
THEORY OF HEAT.
arcs,
[df AP.
IX.
= e~ u
Too
\
Jo
If
dxf(a)
Jo
da e~ kqH s m qx sin
qa..
initial heat to be distributed in any manner, be easy to derive the expression for v from the two preced ing solutions. In fact, whatever the function $ (x) may be, which represents the given initial temperature, it can always be decom (x) +/(#), one of which corresponds to the posed into two others line FFFF, and the other to the \iueffff, so that we have these
it
we suppose the
will
three conditions
F(x)
<}>
()
= F(x) +f(x).
234.
We have already made use of this remark in Articles 233 and We know also that each initial state gives rise to a variable
which
is
The composi no change into the tem peratures which would have occurred separately from each of them. It follows from this that denoting by v the variable tem perature produced by the initial state which represents the total function (x), we must have
partial state
formed as
if it
alone existed.
cf>
-.
/ _ e -u Mr
WO
fa g-*a^ CO s qx
dot.
(a)
cos
qy.
Jo
+
If
oo
Jo
dq e-**** sin. qx
Jo
we took the
and
+ oo
it
is
evident that
we
We may
member
the denominator
a=
toa = +
oo.
We
r+oo
I
da $
00
(a)
J -
F(a) cos
is
qy.
00
sub
we must have
J -oo
daf(ot) cosqy.
SECT.
I.]
ANY
INITIAL DISTRIBUTION.
345
We
r+oo
dj.
<f>
? f**^
instead of
J -oo
J -oo
dif(o.}
ee*s qx,
for
we
evidently have
0=
"diFtynnqx, [ oo
We
TTV
= e~ ht
r+oo
I
JO
dq Q-W-t
da.
oo
VJ -
(a)
cos
qy.
cos
qx
da<
+
or,
J -00
(ajsin^sinja;) /
(
7rv
= e- M
/oo
l
/+
JO
dqe~
k<
H
J -oo
Too
I
dx
(a)
cos ^
a),
r + oo
or,
7rv=e~ ht
\
dz<l>(oL)
J -oo
Jo
dqe-
k * 2t
cosq (x
a).
355.
what
solution of this second problem indicates clearly the relation is between the definite integrals which we have
The
just employed,
and the
results of the
analysis
which we have
series which this analysis furnishes, which denote the dimensions infinite values each of the terms becomes infinitely small, and the sum of the series is nothing but an integral. We might pass directly in the same
;
manner and without any physical considerations from the different trigonometrical series which we have employed in Chapter ill. to it will be sufficient to give some definite integrals examples of
;
In the equation
7 4
TT
= sin u +
^ sin 3
3z*
~ +o
sin
ou + &c.
we
u the quantity to
-=;
/yi
is
a new variable,
and n
is
an
infinite
number equal
is
a quantity formed by
We
34G
THEORY OF HEAT.
number
i i
[CHAP. IX.
by
-J-
If in the general
term
2^
sin (2*
-we + 1) n
put for
and n their
values, the
term
becomes
^sin2<7#.
of the series to q
is
2q
the integral being taken from q the equation \
IT
~sm2qx,
$
therefore
=
is
oo
we have
=J
sin
Jo
2qx which
Let 2qx
%
x.
= r,
;
new
varia
we have
I
and J
TT
sin r
nite integral
sin r
has been
known
for
some time.
If on
supposing r negative we took the same integral from r oo we should evidently have a result of contrary sign r=
,
=
-J
to
TT.
357.
just
made on
serves to
the value of
the integral
sin r,
which
is
J TT or
TT,
make known
f^dqsi]
*h~^l
cos qxy
whose value we have already found (Article 348) to be equal to 1. 1 or according as x is or is not included between 1 and
"We
have in
cos
fact
qx sin q
is
=J
sin ^ (x 4- 1)
TT
sin q (x
1)
the
first
term
equal to J
or
TT
according as x
+1
is
sin q (x
1) is
equal
TT,
according as x
integral
is
other.
But
at
if
to say if
we have
-f
>
and x
<
0,
SECT.
I.]
347
J
TT.
the two terms add together and the value of the integral
Hence the
equal to 1
1
;
definite integral
vrJo
sin a cos
qx
is
a function of x
if the variable x has any value included between 1 and and the same function is nothing for every other value of x not included between the limits 1 and 1.
358.
We
might deduce
2
also
series
dq cos qx
1
is
vJt
the
x
FC
<f
W
x
qdq sin qx
1
equivalent to e~ when x is positive, and to x e when x is negative. The second is equivalent to e~ if x is positive, x and to e if x is negative, so that the two integrals have the
first (Art.
350)
same
value,
is
when x
is
positive,
is
when x
negative.
One
and have values of contrary sign represented by the line eeee (fig. 19),
20).
Fig. 20.
(fig.
The equation
1
>
olLL
sin 2a sin
"T"
2#
"
sin 3 a sin
2
O52
3x
2
~1
O^Cij
which we have arrived at (Art. 226), gives immediately the integral 2 f dqsinqTTsmqx ,., .. 3 which expression is equivalent to sin x, if x 2
.
.
is
included between
7T.
and
TT,
and
its
value
is
whenever x ex
ceeds
1
is
Eiemann,
15.
Eiemann,
16.
The
for
dq for -, q for
-.
We
then have sin x equal to a series equivalent to the above integral for values of x between and TT, the original equation being true for values of x between and a.
[A.F.]
348
359.
TT
cf>
THEORY OF HEAT.
The same transformation
(w)
[CHAP. IX.
= sin u
/y
,
Idu
<f>(u)smu+
2w Idu $
(u) sin
2w
&c.
Making w = ft denote $
/*\
(w)
or
ments equal
to dq, n will
be equal to
-j-
and
i to
substituting
sin
ix [dx
I
.
d>
n r \nj
(
fx\ -
ix
sin
we
is
find
dq
sin qx.
TT,
The
taken from u
to
u=
We
J
for
/(*)"*
^o
djnnpj dxf(x)smqx ^o
is
(e),
f(u)=ldqQsmqu an
we
shall
a given function,
have
to
Q=-
u nothing
(Art.
u infinite. We have already solved a similar problem and proved the general equation 346)
Too
/<*>
^irF(x}
which
is
*o
dqcosqxl dxF(x)cosqx
Jo
(e),
360.
To give an
r
,
f(x)=x
the second
sin
application of these theorems, let us suppose member of equation (e) by this substitution
becomes Idq
The
integral
sin
jdx
qx x* or
SECT.
I.]
349
is
equivalent to
-^ldusmuu
nothing to u
infinite.
Let
fjL
be the integral
00
du
o
sin u
r
;
it
* Lq sin qx -^ a
LL,
or LLXrfj sin du
\
ui
denoting the
we have
xr fjiv.
We
last integral by v, taken from u nothing to u infinite, as the result of two successive integrations the term must then have, according to the condition expressed
(e),
by the equation
| 7T Of
fJLV
Xf
Or
JJLV
7T
/*, r aww
smw and
Jo
Jo
sm w
is ^TT.
For example,
if
= - ^ we
,
find the
known
result
in the
same manner we
I
find
Jo
2
1
,
and from these two equations we might also conclude the following
f
I
dqe~
361.
-S/TT,
for
some time.
By means
(e)
and
to
(e)
we may
solve the
following
analysis.
1
problem, which
belongs
also
partial
differential
What
is
function
of the variable q
The way
407.
[R. I
E.]
350
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. IX.
dqQe~ qx may be
equal to a given function, the integral being taken from q nothing 1 But without stopping for different consequences, ? the examination of which would remove us from our chief object,
to q infinite
we
which
is
obtained
and
(e).
=
=
Jo
dq sin qx
Jo
dzf
/-co
roo
and
1 ~
TrF
(x)
Jo
dq
cos qx
"Jo
daF
(a)
cos qx.
oo
is
If we took the integrals with respect to a. from the result of each integration would be doubled, which sary consequence of the two conditions
to
-f oo,
a neces
We
,00
7rf(x)
Jo
dq
,00
sin
qx
JI
dxf(<x)
sin qx,
-00
and
TrF (x)
JO
dq cos qx
J-oo
have remarked previously that any function $ (x) can always be decomposed into two others, one of which F (x) satisfies the condition F(x) F(x], and the other f(x) satisfies the We have thus the two equations condition /(#) = /( x).
/H-oo
We
dzF (a)
-oo /+oo
1
sin ^a,
and
J -oo
To do
this write
x*J
2 JQ,
1 in f(x)
cos qx dq =f (x
for x,
dx.
Again we may subtract and use the sine hut the imaginary quantities recurs continually. [R. L. E.]
difficulty of
dealing with
SECT,
i.]
FOURIER S THEOREM.
351
whence we conclude
/-
-+00
TT
[F(x) +/(#)]
=
TT<J>
(x)
dq sin qx
JO"
/.
J -oo
4-
JO
dq
cos
J -
dzF (a)
oo
cos
^or,
and
TT<
(a?)
JO
d^
gin
%%
dx(j>
J-oo
(a)
sin qa.
.00
-+W
I
<?#
+
Jo or
dg cos
/ -*
dz<j)
(a) cos
x,
w$(#)
1
,
J -
di<f>(a)l
00
/t
dq(8mqx6
"*
or lastly
f (*)
->~
TTj-oo
*4>
W JO c!qcosq(x-a)
f
"
a,
The integration with respect to q gives a function of x and and the second integration makes the variable a disappear.
definite integral Idqcosq (x
a)
if
it
(a)
and by
is
dx,
and integrate
is
limits,
the result
to
gration
362.
1
we multiply it by any function with respect to a between infinite so that the effect of the inte (x)
number
IT.
dcs Sciences,
Poisson, in his Memoire sur la Theorie des Ondes, in iheMemoires de V Academic Tome i. Paris, 1818, pp. 85 87, first gave a direct proof of the theorem
f(x)
=-
00
-(-so
r dq r da e~ k ^
in which k
is
made
equal to
Boole,
On
fioyal Irish
Academy, Vol.
126130,
s
introduces
some ana
Theorem
as unproved
unless equivalent to the above proposition. Deners, at the end of a Note sur quelques integrates definies &c., in the Bulletin des Sciences, Societe Philomatique, Paris, 1819, pp. 161 166, indicates a proof of Fourier s Theorem, which Poisson repeats in a modified form in the Journal Pobj-
The special difficulties of this proof have been technique, Cahier 19, p. 454. noticed by De Morgan, Differential and Integral Calculus, pp. 619, 628.
An
Mr
Ser.
J.
i.,
class
of proofs
here alluded to
,
is
given by
W.
L. Glaisher in an article
v.,
On
sinac
and
cos oo
Messenger of Mathematics,
Vol.
pp.
232244, Cambridge,
1871.
[A. F.]
352
stated in Article 2:34,
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP.
IX.
tion
which gives the development of any func and cosines of multiple arcs. We F(x) the last proposition to those which we have just demon pass from Each term strated, by giving an infinite value to the dimensions. 1 Trans of the series becomes in this case a differential quantity formations of functions into trigonometrical series are some of the
in a series of sines
.
make
elements of the analytical theory of heat; it is indispensable to use of them to solve the problems which depend on this
theory.
The reduction
of arbitrary functions
such as are expressed by equation (E), and the two elementary equations from which it is derived, give rise to different conse
We shall only remark that the same equations present themselves sometimes in analysis under other forms. We obtain for example this result
1
<j>(x)=-
r
f
TfJ
drf
(a)
JO
dqcosq(x
a)
(E )
which
from equation (E) in that the limits taken with and oo instead of being oo and + oo respect to a are
differs
.
In this case it must be remarked that the two equations (E) and (E ) give equal values for the second member when the
variable
If this variable is negative, equation (E ) a nul value for the second member. The same is always gives
is
positive.
not the case with equation (E), whose second member is equiva lent to 7T(j) (x), whether we give to x a positive or negative value. As to equation (E ) it solves the following problem. To find a
function of x such that
if
is
is
may
be
</>
(x),
and
if
.
may
be always nothing 2
363.
line
The problem
besides be solved by giving to the integral of the partial differential equation a different form which we shall indicate in
may
Eiemann, Part.
Diff. Gleich.
F (x) =
- x).
(E) and
These remarks are essential to clearness of view. The equations from which its cognate form may be derived will be found in Todhunter s Integral Calculus, Cambridge, 1862, 316, Equations (3) and (4). [A. F.]
SECT.
I.]
VARYING TEMPERATURE IX
IX FINITE BAR.
333
We
first
Suppose that, the initial heat being distributed in any manner throughout the infinite bar, we maintain the section A at a constant temperature, whilst part of the heat communicated is dis persed through the external surface. It is required to determine
the state of the prism after a given time, which is the object of the second problem that we have proposed to ourselves. Denoting by 1 the constant temperature of the end A, by that of the medium,
S as the expression of the final temperature of a point situated at the distance x from this extremity, or simply
we have
x
j
W^
TTJ-
e~
assuming
- to be equal to unity.
y
Denoting by v the variable temperature of the same point the time t has elapsed, we have, to determine v, the equation
after
dvct*v
let
HL
now
= e~
du
Ks
+u,
d*a
vehftve
K
,
HL
dit
-
= k (TV
TT T
rr
replacing
by k and
by
h.
If
-,-
Jc
dt
jdxa
the value of u or
final
temperatures
this difference u,
final
to vanish,
and whose
value
is
nothing,
equivalent at
first
to
-W^
F(x)r-e
denoting by
distance x.
F.
*,
at the
temperature over
!:}
H.
354
the final temperature,
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. IX.
satisfies
we must
hu,
find for
u a function which
initial
the equation
and whose
value
is
f(x), and
T
final
value
0.
the point A, or
x=
-x>J
0,
the quantity
v-e
see by this has, by hypothesis, a constant value equal to 0. that u represents an excess of heat which is at first accumulated in the prism, and which then escapes, either by being propagated to
into the medium. Thus to represent infinity, or by being scattered of the effect which results from the uniform heating of the end a line infinitely prolonged, we must imagine, 1st, that the line is
We
also prolonged to the left of the point A, and that each point situated to the right is now affected with the initial excess of 2nd, that the other half of the line to the left of ;
in a contrary state so that a point situated at the from the point A has the initial temperature /(#) : the heat then begins to move freely through the interior of the bar, and to be scattered at the surface.
is
;
-x
preserves the temperature 0, and all the other In this manner we are arrive insensibly at the same state. points able to refer the case in which the external source incessantly com
The point
municates new heat, to that in which the primitive heat is propa gated through the interior of the solid. We might therefore solve
the proposed problem in the same manner as that of the diffusion of heat, Articles 347 and 353; but in order to multiply methods of solution in a matter thus new, we shall employ the integral under
we have
considered
up
to this
364.
to e~ e
x
kt
.
is satisfied
by supposing u equal
of a definite integral,
which
is
put under the form deduced from the known very easily
fact
q
may also be
value of ldqe~ q \
is
We
have in
*j7r=]dqe~
*,
when
the integral
taken from
= -coto
= +oo. We
JT
\dqe~
SECT.
I.]
355
b being any constant whatever and the limits of the integral the same as before. From the equation
we
conclude, by
making
= kt
e~* e
kt
is
equivalent to
we might
also suppose
and we should
find in the
same
way
is
equivalent to
sum
of an
number
of such values,
and we
have
+ &c.)
The constants a lt a2 a3
,
the series
therefore
&c.,
s>
Zg_>Jkt ;
u=
ldqe~
qi
^>
(x
fyjkfy
The
from
the equation
=k
-j-
-y-j
trary function was not known when we had undertaken our re searches on the theory of heat, which were transmitted to the
Institute of France in the
month
of December, 1807:
it
has been
232
356
given by M. Laplace of the Me moires de
conclude
+0
,,
1
,
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. IX.
in a work which forms part of volume vui Ecole Polytechnique we apply it simply to the determination of the linear movement of heat. From it we
1
;
g-hti
2JL/
dqe-V([>(x
+
e
J -00
when t =
hence
the value of u
is
F(x)
=r
J _
and
<>
= =
Thus the arbitrary function which enters into the integral, is deter mined by means of the given function /(a?), and we have the following equation, which contains the solution of the problem,
v
= -^e
/WL
e~ M
+0
f
/
,
,
.
-7=7T
it is
365.
all
having the initial temperature 0, the end points of the line A. is heated so as to be maintained continually at the tempera
ture 1.
differs
AB
It follows
from
this that
F (x)
when x
-x
whenever x differs from 0. Thus f(x} is equal to e and to x is nothing. On the other hand it is when from 0, necessary that on making x negative, the value off(x) should change
sign, so that
L !^~ KS
we have the
condition
/(
-
x)
f(x)
it
We
thus
know
e
becomes
than
0.
when x exceeds
r +co
0,
and
of
+e
KS
when x
is less
We
x the quantity x
+ 2q^kt.
To
find
vi
dqe-*
-.
u orl
from
f(x+
%VAtf),
we must
first
=
1
to
Tome vm.
pp.
235244,
Paris,
1809.
Laplace shews also that the complete integral of the equation contains only one arbitrary function, but in this respect he had been anticipated by Poisson. [A. F.J
SECT.
I.]
357
+ IqJkt = - oo
we have
to
x + 2q*/ki = 0.
first part,
*>
and replacing
lc
by
its
value
-^ we
have
VTT
/S
-^-<
or
_ Ji
TT T r
becomes
Xl e~ v^s ffu r ecus \dre- r\ 7= VTT J
+
=
2y
9
= 00,
oo
,
or from
-7=
-
to a
or from
__
a;
to r
iKi
VCD
The second
part of the integral
is
358
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. IX.
or
VTT
or
A/
-oo
or from
to
from
>
I jf+ / XI- 6
VCD
The two
last limits
r<i
be
replaced by these:
~HU
x
r
Kt
and r
oo
CD
It follows
is
expressed thus :
iTLt
u=
the
first
* KS
/ffi
PU
e CDS
r
dre"
e~
wIHL e ^
ona
idre-^j
integral
,^- to r =
oo
to r
= co
SECT.
I.]
FORM OF SOLUTION
IN CASE CONSIDERED.
359
= Idre
JfJ
x
^ from
=R
to r
oo
by
T/T
(R],
and we
shall
have
HLt
cDs
+
_,
^jm CD
hence u, which
y_ is
equivalent
to"
_HLt eTcDS
is
expressed by
and
has been known for some time, i/r (7?) can easily calculate, either by means of convergent series, or by continued fractions, the values which this function receives, when we substitute for given quantities; thus the numerical
and we
is
subject to no difficulty
1
.
The
Kramp.
An.
following references are given by Riemann: Analyse des refractions astronomiques et terrestres.
vii. 4to.
Table
fc
I.
at the
of the integral /
from k = 0-00 to
= 3 -00.
et des integrates
Euleriennes.
Tomen.
360
366.
If
THEORY OF HEAT,
[CHAP. IX.
This equation represents the propagation of heat in an infinite which were first at temperature 0, except those at the extremity which is maintained at the constant temperature 1. We suppose that heat cannot escape through the external surface of the bar or, which is the same thing, that the thickness of the bar is infinitely great. This value of v indicates therefore the law
bar, all points of
;
is propagated in a solid, terminated by supposing that this infinitely thick wall has first at all parts a constant initial temperature 0, and that the surface is submitted to a constant temperature 1. It will not be quite
an
infinite plane,
Denoting by
r
(7?)
the integral
\dre~
taken from r
to
JTTJ
7?,
we
have,
when
is
a positive quantity,
hence
(- 5)
(JR)
^>
= 20
CR) and
t?
= l-20/
~
~CD,
(R)
we have
Paris, 1826.
4to. pp.
5201.
The
of x
first
Hog - j from
from 0-80 to
Astronomisches Jahrbuchfvr 1834. Berlin, 1832, 8vo. Table 2 ft end gives the values of / e~ tz dt from f = 0-00 to t = 2 QO. [A. F.]
Encke.
I.
at the
SECT.
I.]
361
hence
1st,
"being
we suppose x nothing, we find v = 1 2nd, if x not = 0, the sum of the terms which nothing, we suppose t
if
;
contain
x represents the
is
to r
= oo
#3
t
&
and consequently
equal to \J-jr; therefore v
is
nothing; 3rd,
,
different points of the solid situated at different depths cc x v lt &c. arrive at the same temperature after different times tlt tit
,
&c. which are proportional to the squares of the lengths x lt a?2 xz &c.; 4th, in order to compare the quantities of heat which during an infinitely small instant cross a section S situated in the interior
,
of the solid
"at
a distance
x from
we must take
KS
r and we have
-T- is
/Hf/}
T7"
at the surface varies with the quantities C, D, K, t ; to find how much heat the source communicates to the solid during the lapse of the time t, we must take the integral
362
THEORY OF HEAT.
=or
[CHAP. IX.
thus the heat acquired increases proportionally to the square root of the time elapsed.
367.
By
a similar analysis
diffusion of heat,
we may treat the problem of the which also depends on the integration of the
hv.
equation
~r:
=k
j-^
initial
tem
perature of a point in the line situated at a distance x from the origin, we proceed to determine what ought to be the temperature
of the
same point
Ut
,
after a
time
z
I
t.
Making
dq e~
qt
^>
= e~ ht z, we
2q Jkt).
have
(it
-y-
= k -Tg0,
and consequently
(x
When
J -oo
we must have
GO
9 (x)
or
hence
e~ty
To apply this general expression to the case in which a part of ato# = ais uniformly heated, all the rest of the line from x the solid being at the temperature 0, we must consider that the
factor
thesis,
which multiplies e~ qZ has, according to hypo 1, when the quantity which is under the of the function is included between a and a, and that all sign
f(x+ 2q Jfo)
a constant value
Hence the
a to x
integral
x+2q Jkt =
.
+ 2q JTt = a,
-^ &
VTT
(It)
q=
--j^.~
**jkt
toq=
*>Jkt
Denoting as above by
=R
to r
oo
we have
2jktn
SECT.
I.]
363
368.
We
7T J
to the
case
in
which the
infinite bar,
heated by a source of
1, has arrived at fixed temperatures and is then cooling freely in a medium maintained at the temperature For this purpose it is sufficient to remark that the initial 0.
constant intensity
function denoted
variable
by f(x)
is
x which
_X
J*
and that the same function is equivalent to e^* when the variable which is affected by the symbol /is less than 0. Hence
the
first
integral
+ 2q-Jkt =
to
x + fy-Jkt
= oo
x+
The
first
ZqjTtt
--
oo
to
is
x + 207^ =
0.
fie
_
^Q
^fl^Jht
Jv
or
Q-X\
jfc"
{(JqQ
J
or
^
."[dre-**
,
making r =
g 4- ^/Ai.
The
2
from
=
=
^r
to 2
=
>
or from
to r
364
THEORY OF HEAT.
The second
part of the value of v
./
[CHAP. IX.
is
,-/
n~-Tlt
-T^e x \f^ldq
e-<?
&&*
or e V* dr
e~*
making
=q
JTti.
The
oo
tor =
.
Jfa
--7=
=
co
,
or from
= Jht
/%
-f
>_
^y/
j=. Kit
to r
3C9.
We have
to express the law of diffusion of heat in a bar of small thickness, heated uniformly at its middle point between the given limits
x=
a,
+ a.
We
different
had previously solved the same problem by following a method, and we had arrived, on supposing a = 1, at
the equation
results
we
x=
^{R}
taken from r =
= R, we
have
1 1
/o
\"
~i
1 /
l;y -
&ft
SECT.
I.]
365
~ e~ M
TT
sin q e~ q
kf
,
or
=
[8
w2
Icfo<e~
Now
a
the integral
value,
Q to u
oo
has
known
We
V*
=
I ,
have in
general
Jo o
-2222
gives then, on
[2 u /,
1
making
u*
1
q*kt
\
if,
\due~
15 Ti
3/.-
+ fr 7T3-- &C. o^
5
[2
13
This equation
is
v + ii/_j_y
,/fc
1
:C
the same as the preceding when we suppose a. = 1. see by this that integrals which we have obtained by different processes, lead to the same convergent series, and we arrive thus at two identical results, whatever be the value
We
of x.
might, in this problem as in the preceding, compare the quantities of heat which, in a given instant, cross different sections of the heated prism, and the general expression of these contains no sign of integration ; but passing by these quantities
remarks, we shall terminate this section by the comparison of the different forms which we have given to the integral of the equation which represents the
line.
We
diffusion of heat in
an
infinite
3/0.
r>>-n
m lo
satisfy the
.,
,.
dll
equation
~r
e n kt,
d*ll
Z)
we may assume
easily
= e~
ff
e kt,
or in general
e~ n ?
whence we deduce
Cf.
Rieinann,
18.
3G6
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. IX.
From
the
known equation
we conclude
-+00
N/7r
dqe~(
q+a)\
i,
or
a.
We may
*
de-
shall
known
This
value
is
nothing when n
odd,
and we
find
when n
is
an even
number 2w,
L
371.
2.2.2.2...
We
du
-rr
equation
d?u
k^ the expression
n ** kt cos n^x
,,
u
or this,
+ a e~ n
a
**kt
cos n Bx
+ &c.
u
a,,
,
a^e"
a 2 a s)
&c,,
and
Wj,
wa n B
,
&c.,
constants.
q (dq e~ sin n (x
+ 2q *Jkt),
In
fact, to
dq e~^ sin
J
06
SECT.
I.]
IDENTITY OF SOLUTIONS.
form
367
we
or else,
4-
,P/ e~i da
/ ./-*
cos
-t _ 2V_ V2V-1
fe-M
ft
.
I/
which
e-** sin
is
equivalent to
e -(9-
v-*0
(jdq
e-* cos
/^ e
-(</+
V-w>A
4-
a?
***=**
for
taken from ?
=-x
to ^
=x
is
V^
we have therefore
and
in general
*<
sin
w^ =
we
c?2 e-3
(x
+ 2^ ^S)
is
V? e
cos
?i#.
We
see
by
ki
(a, sin
(aa sin
63 cos
up)
-f
&c.
equivalent to
1
-i Cdq 9 ~*
v/7rj.
Sin Wl
(iC
I*
(^
cos Wl
+ 2 2 V ^) + a (a: + 2j V^) + 6
sin w,
4-
2^
22
cos
7i
(x 4-
368
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. IX.
The
we have
seen previously,
+ 2q? *Jkt
=
The
-^.
&^
may
besides be pre
SECTION
Of
372.
the free
II.
movement of heat in an
infinite solid.
The
,,
-^
-j-9
(a)
furnishes
.........
,
as
we have
pagation of heat in a solid cube. For which reason it is sufficient in general to consider the effect of the diffusion in the linear
case.
When
infinite,
the distri
bution of heat
solid
medium
continually disturbed by the passage from the to the elastic medium; or, to employ the expres
proper to analysis, the function which determines the temperature must not only satisfy the partial differential equa tion and the initial state, but is further subjected to conditions which depend on the form of the surface. In this case the integral
sions
difficult to ascertain,
problem with very much more care in order to pass from the case of one linear co-ordinate to that of three orthogonal co-ordinates
:
not interrupted, no accidental condition Its movement is the to the free diffusion of heat.
solid
mass
is
same
in all directions.
"
1 See an article by Sir \V. Thomson, On the Linear Motion of Camb. Math. Journal, Vol. in. pp. 170174. [A. F.]
Heat,"
Part
I,
SECT. IL]
LINEAR MOVEMENT.
369
is
The
TT
a?
whose temperature
denotes the distance between a fixed point 0, and the point m, is equal to v after the lapse of a time t.
We
suppose that the heat cannot be dissipated through the external surface of the infinite bar, and that the initial state of the bar is
expressed by the equation v=f(x). which the value of v must satisfy, is
The
differential
equation,
~
dt
CD
dx*
But
we
write
dv
d*v
another
unknown
^
if,
Kt
in/ (oj),
and
we
substitute
2
,
X+%n*/t
after
having multiplied by
-_
VTT
g-*
we
integrate with
^1
satisfies, as
d?ie~ na
we have proved
(b)
that
to say the expression has the property of giving the same value for the second fluxion with respect to x } and for the first
is
fluxion with respect to t. From this it is evident that a function of three variables (x, y, z) will enjoy a like property, if we substi
tute for
x, y, z
the quantities
provided
we
by
dn
H.
-n* e j= P
&L ,-* ,- e *
VTT
*3L f - q * ._ e *
VTT
F.
VTT
24
370
In
fact,
THEORY OF HEAT.
the function which
[CHAP. IX.
we thus
form,
gives three terms for the fluxion with respect to t, and these three terms are those which would be found by taking the second fluxion
so,
y, z.
= TT fdn
3
jdpjdq
y+
dv _ d*v
d*v
2
~dt~dx^d^
+ ^"
d*v
373. Suppose now that a formless solid mass (that is to say one which fills infinite space) contains a quantity of heat whose
Let v =F(x, y, z) be the equation which expresses this initial and arbitrary state, so that the molecule whose co-ordinates are x, y, z has an initial temperature
actual distribution
is
known.
equal to the value of the given function F(x,y,z). We can initial heat is contained in a certain part of
first state
is
F(x
y, z),
and that
all
given by means of the equation other points have a nul initial tem
perature.
It is required to ascertain what the system of temperatures be after a given time. The variable temperature v must
<j>
will
consequently be expressed by a function (x, y, z, t) which ought to satisfy the general equation (A) and the condition (x, y, z, 0) = F(x y, z}. Now the value of this function is given by the
</>
integral
v
= 7r
fact, this
t
In
make
= 0, we
IT9
if in it
we
y, z),
or,
F (x,
y, z).
SECT.
II.]
371
represents the
it
374.
(x, y,
z,
t]
initial state
when
in
it
we make
= 0,
and since
satisfies
the
differential equation of the propagation of heat, it represents also that state of the solid which exists at the commencement of the
second instant, and making the second state vary, we conclude that the same function represents the third state of the solid, and all the subsequent states. Thus the value of v, which we have
just determined, containing an entirely arbitrary function of three variables x, y, z, gives the solution of the problem ; and we cannot suppose that there is a more general expression, although other
we might
-77
ctt
-j-g dx
and
it
the
integral
result
which belongs to the case of three dimensions. The which we should obtain would necessarily be the same as
the preceding.
To give an example of this investigation we shall make use of the particular value which has aided us in forming the exponential
integral.
=
-^-
^-j
... (b),
let
us give to v the
satisfies
it
-j-
which
evidently
the
rfv
differential
equation
ri*v.
(6).
In
also,
fact,
we
derive from
and -y-g
CUD
d*v
Hence
the integral
r
V
dn e~ nZt cosnx
for this value of v is
m
;
(6)
formed of the
sum
Now,
the integral
nx
242
372
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. IX
f3
is
Fri
known, and
is
known
to
be equivalent to /-
/^
function of x and t agrees also with ing article). Hence this last the differential equation (b). It is besides very easy to verify
_1
P
4
-TF
satisfies
the equation in
The same
we
by
a,
We may
,
-j=
in
whatever.
dzf (a) -
p
t>
also satisfies
for this sum is composed of an the differential equation (6) of the same form, multiplied by infinity of particular values Hence we can take as a value of v in the constants.
arbitrary
//7)
equation
-j-
dt
= -3-- the
dx
CM
7J
following,
A
^
being a constant
,
coefficient.
we suppose
= j2 making
also
A ~r=
we
shall
have
00
f*
V/^-oo
We
see
by
this
SECT.
II.]
EVALUATION OF AN INTEGRAL.
373
375.
The
is
relation in
each other
integral
dn
^t cos nx.
To effect the integration, we might develope the factor cos nx and integrate with respect to n. We thus obtain a series which represents a known development; but the result may be derived
more
is
easily
transformed to
thus have
/foo
I
dp e~^
cos 2pu,
We
dn e~ nH cos nx =
/+>
-J.
J -oo
*JtJ
e~& cos ^l - dp
2pu.
/r
A
^S
~S
We
shall
now
write
1
Idpe~^cos2pu =
Idpe-^+fyu^-
e--p
f<#p
V
Idpe^-
~ u*
--
u*
(dp e
Now
equal to
is
We have
in fact in general
and consequently
=
I J -00
b.
We
I
find then on
9
making
tt
= T M s/^T,
I
^
cos
e"
cos 2#w
= e~
,
V^
hence
1
dn e~ nH
nx =
j -oo
*y^
The value
[A. F.]
is
Integral Calcuhu,
375.
374
THEORY OF HEAT.
u
value 2 V
[CHAP. IX.
and putting
for
its
=>
we have
_ e *t
2
dn ff~*** cos nx
,~ VTT.
pt
Moreover the particular value
itself directly
is
j=-
without
its
from the
the
the
value
e~
nH cosnx.
However
may
be, it is
certain that
-&
function
j=-
dv
satisfies
-j-
= d*v
-^
it is
6~~
^t
*Jt
may
be.
376.
To
it is sufficient
_&M?
to multiply the function of
functions, one of
x and
t,
ijt
y and
t,
dv
_ dt~d^ + dy + d?
z
d*v
d?v
d?v
We
shall take
then
member by den, d$, dy, and by of the quantities a, /6, 7, we find, any function whatever/ (a, /3, 7) on indicating the integration, a value of v formed of the sum of an
If
now we multiply
the second
by arbitrary constants.
It follows
may be
2
thus ex
pressed
M-oo
,.+00
^3
J-oo
J-oo
J -OP
This equation contains the general integral of the proposed equation (A): the process which has led us to this integral oug^t^
SECT.
to be
is
II.]
375
(
\
it is applicable to a great variety of cases ; useful chiefly when the integral must satisfy conditions If we examine it attentively we perceive relative to the surface.
it
remarked since
I
f
it
We
we
member by
a constant co
efficient A,
=2A
3
f>f
(x
+ 2n Jt, y + 2pji,
+ 2$ Ji).
and
-f oo,
Taking the three integrals between the limits and making t = in order to ascertain the initial
v
oo
state,
we
find
=2
-s
3
3
^7r~2/(#, y,
z).
Thus,
z),
if
we
temperatures
_.
by F (x, y,
and give
TT
2,
we
r+ x
r+
J
= 7r~2
J
dn\ J oo
dpi
oo
which
is
integral of equation (A) may be put under several other forms, from which that is to be chosen which suits best the
The
problem which
It
it is
proposed to solve.
in general, in these researches, that
must be observed
two
functions
(as,
y, z, t)
are the
satisfy the
differential equation (A), and when they are equal for a definite value of the time. It follows from this principle that integrals, which are reduced, when in them we make t = 0, to the same arbitrary function F(x, y, z), all have the same degree of generality;
of the
differential
(6)
equation
(a)
was
jr
and in equation
we supposed
it
this coefficient
equal to unity.
To
is
sufficient to write
376
THEORY OF HEAT.
of in the integral
[CHAP. IX.
Kt
TYT, instead
\jJLJ
t,
(i)
We
shall
now
indicate
some
of the results
equations.
377.
serves
as
number
e* can only represent an absolute number, which follows from the general principles of analysis, as we have proved ex
plicitly in
Chapter
t
II.,
Tfj.
section IX.
If in this
exponent we replace
of
the
unknown
K D and
}
C,
t,
0,
3,
and
0,
the
Kt
-^ is
term of the numerator, so that the whole dimension of the expo nent is 0. Let us consider the case in which the value of t increases more and more; and to simplify this examination let us employ
first
the equation
which represents the diffusion of heat in an infinite line. Suppose initial heat to be contained in a given portion of the line, from x = htox = +g, and that we assign to a? a definite value
the
which
time
t
a certain point
m of
4<t
that line.
-
If the
which
the product e & e *t e & we can omit numbers, the two last factors which sensibly coincide with unity. We thus
that
in
find
,, N
_*
_ 2_o?
_ ft2
daf(a)
the expression of the variable state of the line after a very long time it applies to all parts of the line which are less distant from the origin than the point m. The definite integral
This
is
*2
* In such quantities as e~
[A. F.]
SECT.
+ff
II.]
INITIAL
377
-h
contained in the
solid,
on the temperatures after a very long time. They depend only on the sum B, and not on the law according to which the heat has been distributed.
378.
If
we suppose a
single element
co
to have received the initial temperature/ and that all the others had initially the temperature 0, the product cof will be equal to
r+ff
the integral
since
<fa/(a)
or B.
co
we suppose
the line
very small.
X*
The equation
=
2
if
._
..
J TT *Jt
cof represents
the
movement which
a single element situated at the origin had fact, if we give to x any value a, not infinitely
X2
will
0.
The
same would
not
be
_nothing.
0. We can ascertain distinctly the nature of this function, if we apply the general principles of the theory of curved surfaces to the surface whose equation is
an
infinite
when
e~ty
The equation
._
._
a)f expresses
perature at any point of the prism, when we suppose the whole initial heat collected into a single element situated at the origin. This hypothesis, although special, belongs to a general problem,
since after a sufficiently long time, the variable state of the solid is always the same as if the initial heat had been collected at the
origin.
The law
378
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. IX.
;
much
this effect
insensible.
but becomes weaker and weaker, and ends with being quite
It is necessary to remark that the reduced equation (i/) 379. does not apply to that part of the line which lies beyond the point whose distance has been denoted by X.
In
fact,
be,
we might
would differ sensibly from unity, so that this factor could not then be suppressed. We must therefore imagine that we have marked on either side of the two points, m and m situated at a certain distance or origin and that we increase more and more the value of the time, X,
e
,
4*
observing the successive states of the part of the line which is and m. These variable states converge more included between
is
to
X, we
shall always
be able to
find a value of the time so great that the state of the line
mom
does not differ sensibly from that which the preceding equation (y)
expresses.
require that the same equation should apply to other parts more distant from the origin, it will be necessary to suppose a value of the time greater than the preceding.
If
we
The equation
(?/)
which expresses in
all cases
any line, shews that after an exceedingly long time, the different points acquire temperatures almost equal, and that the temperatures of the same point end by varying in inverse ratio of the square
root of the times elapsed since the commencement of the diffusion. The decrements of the temperature of any point whatever
always
become proportional
380.
If
we made use
of the interal
SECT.
II.]
ADMISSIBLE SIMPLIFICATIONS.
379
to ascertain the variable state of the points of the line situated at a great distance from the heated portion, and in order to express
the ultimate condition suppressed also the factor e results which we should obtain would not be exact.
4Jit
,
the
fact,
In
supposing that the heated portion extends only from a = to a=g and that the limit g is very small with respect to the distance x of
the point whose temperature
~~
we wish
to determine
the quantity
jy;
4kf
is
w hi cn
fact to
that
_ xf
,
and
^-
approaches
more nearly
we can replace respect to that of a but it one of these quantities by the other in the exponent of e. In general the omission of the subordinate terms cannot thus take
does not follow that
The quanti place in exponential or trigonometrical expressions. ties arranged under the symbols of sine or cosine, or under the
exponential symbol e are always absolute numbers, and we can omit only the parts of those numbers whose value is extremely
y
small
if
no importance.
To decide
expression
(a-*) 2
&/(*)* Jo
**
_^_
toe
eZa/(a),
J o
ratio of
to a is very great,
-TTI are
t
This
;
when
extremely great
but
it
381.
ought to elapse in order that the temperatures of the part of the and x X, may be represented very solid included between x
380
THEORY OF HEAT.
and g may be the
[CHAP. IX.
and that
heated.
The exact
solution
is
1}
= r^a/(a)eZirkt Jo
i
,
/ ,
is
(y),
(y)
may be
it
which
;
is
we omit, should differ very little from unity for we might apprehend an error equal to the value
the half of that value.
fraction, as
if it
calculated or to
to
Let then
&*
w,
being a small
^^ or LOO
77:7:7,;
LOOO
=
and
if
or
co
J
is
we have
O3C = - ^y
co ^i/2
We
see
by
more
the points are whose temperatures we wish to determine by means of the reduced equation, the more necessary it is for the value of the time elapsed to be great. Thus the heat tends more and more
to be distributed according to a law independent of the primitive After a certain time, the diffusion is sensibly effected, heating. that is to say the state of the solid depends on nothing more than
was made of
the quantity of the initial heat, and not on the distribution which The temperatures of points sufficiently near to it.
the origin are soon represented without error by the reduced equation (y}\ but it is not the same with points very distant from
SECT.
II.]
NUMERICAL APPLICATION.
381
the source.*
We
extremely long.
Suppose that the substance of which the prism is formed is iron, and that the portion of the solid which has been heated is If we wish to ascertain a decimetre in length, so that g = O l. what will be, after a given time, the temperature of a point whose distance from the origin is a metre, and if we employ for
this investigation the approximate integral (y), we shall commit an error greater as the value of the time is smaller. This error
will be less than the hundredth part of the quantity sought, if the time elapsed exceeds three days and a half. In this case the distance included between the origin and the point in, whose temperature we are determining, is only ten times
If this ratio is one hundred greater than the portion heated. instead of being ten, the reduced integral (y) will give the tem
perature nearly to less than one hundredth part, when the value of the time elapsed exceeds one month. In order that the ap proximation may be admissible, it is necessary in general, 1st that
2 2ft
2
ft
TAAA or
^ ess
should have an absolute value very much less than the small quantities which we observe with the most sensitive thermometers.
portion of the solid
we consider are very distant from the which was originally heated, the temperatures which it is required to determine are extremely small thus the error which we should commit in employing the reduced equation would have a very small absolute value; but it does not follow
the points which
;
When
that
use of that equation. For if the error committed, although very small, exceeds or is equal to the quantity sought or even if it is the half or the fourth, or an
to
;
we should be authorized
make
It is appreciable part, the approximation ought to be rejected. evident that in this case the approximate equation (y) would not
express the state of the solid, and that we could not avail ourselves of it to determine the ratios of the simultaneous temperatures of
two
or
more
points.
3~82
THEORY OF HEAT.
383.
It follows
[CHAP. IX.
from
this
W
<fe/(a)
_(a-ff)
"
7=
~4*
that the
law of the primitive distribution has no influence on the tempera The resultant effect ture of points very distant from the origin. of this distribution soon ceases to have influence on the points
near to the heated portion; that is to say their temperature depends on nothing more than the quantity of the initial heat, and not on the distribution which was made of it but greatness
:
preserves
it
diffusion of heat.
only after an immense time represents the temperatures of points extremely remote from the heated part. If we applied it without
this condition,
we
results, or even incomparably greater or smaller; and this would not only occur for very small values of the time, but for great
Lastly this expression values, such as an hour, a day, a year. much the less exact, all other things being equal, as would be so
the points were more distant from the part originally heated.
384.
When
is
represented as
we have
seen by the
is
we know the
limits
contained in a definite portion of the solid which comprise this heated part, and
which vary under the integral sign, cannot Suppose then that we mark on the three axes six points whose distances are + X, + Y +Z, and X, Y, Z, and that we consider the successive states of the solid included within the six planes which cross the axes at these distances; we see that the exponent of e under the sign of
a, /3, 7,
f
SECT.
II.]
APPROXIMATE FORMULA.
/g? J_
2
7/
_|_
383
2 2 \
integration, reduces to
^fact,
when
tlie
J,
In
^,-
and
^r-
receive in this case very small absolute values, since the numera tors are included between fixed limits, and the denominators
increase
to
infinity.
extremely
solid, after
little
from unity.
omit
differ
state of the
expressed by
The
of heat
/9,
7) represents the
whole quantity
of tempera
which the
solid contains.
on
its
quantity.
We
upon the initial distribution of heat, but only might suppose that all the initial heat was
&>
contained in a single prismatic element situated at the origin, whose extremely small orthogonal dimensions were a) lt 2 3 The
,
o>
initial
temperature of this element would be denoted by an exceedingly great number /, and all the other molecules of the
solid
G)
i
ft)
would
Ct)
have
nul
initial
temperature.
The product
3/
ig
Whatever be the
initial heating,
corresponds to a very great value of the time, is the same as if all the heat had been collected into a single element situated at the
Suppose now that we consider only the points of the whose distance from the origin is very great with respect to the dimensions of the heated part we might first imagine that this condition is sufficient to reduce the exponent of e in The exponent is in fact the general integral.
385.
solid
;
384
THEORY OF HEAT.
a, /3,
[CHAP. IX.
by hypothesis, included between values are always extremely small with respect to the greater co-ordinate of a point very remote from the origin. It follows from this that the exponent of e
and the variables
so
are,
finite limits,
that their
M+ p,
one of which
is
we cannot conclude
,
that the
ex
H+ * becomes equal to e M or differs only from it by ponential e must a quantity very small with respect to its actual value.
We
M and
m
In order that we
to the. equation
may
(j)
=jB
necessary that the quantity
2ao;
it is
+ 2ffy +
fyz
- a* - ft - 7*
2
should always be a very small number. If we suppose that the distance from the origin to the point m, whose temperature we wish to determine, is very great with
whose dimension
is
0,
the extent of the part which was at first heated, should examine whether the preceding quantity is always This condition must be satisfied to a very small fraction
respect to
we
but this equation does not represent the variable state of that part of the mass which is very remote from the source of heat.
It
gives on the contrary a result so much the less exact, other things being equal, as the points whose temperature are determining are more distant from the source.
all
we
The
initial
mass penetrates successively the neighbouring parts, and spreads itself in all directions; only an exceedingly small quantity of it arrives at points whose distance from the origin is very great.
SECT.
III.]
385
When we
express analytically the temperature of these point?, the object of the investigation is not to determine numerically these temperatures, which are not measurable, but to ascertain their ratios. Now these quantities depend certainly on the law
according to which the initial heat has been distributed, and the effect of this initial distribution lasts so much the longer as the
parts of the prism are
more
But
4*kt
if
the
and
4kt
-7-7-,
have
approximate
integrals.
This condition occurs in problems where it is proposed to determine the highest temperatures of points very distant from the origin. We can demonstrate in fact that in this case the
values of the times increase in a greater ratio than the distances, and are proportional to the squares of these distances, when the
we are considering are very remote from the origin. It is only after having established this proposition that we can effect the reduction under the exponent. Problems of this kind are the object of the following section.
points
SECTION
Of
386.
III.
an
infinite solid.
We
move
an infinite bar, a portion of which has been uniformly and we shall investigate the value of the time which must heated,
in
ment
elapse in
may
attain
its
highest temperature.
Let us denote by 2g the extent of the part heated, the middle which corresponds with the origin All the of the distances x. points whose distance from the axis of y is less than g and greater than g, have by hypothesis a common initial temperature f, and
of
all
0.
We
suppose
that no loss of heat occurs at the external surface of the prism, or, which is the same thing, we assign to the section perpendicular to
It
is
H.
25
386
be the time
t
THEORY OF HEAT.
which corresponds to the whose distance is x.
[CHAP. IX.
of temperature
maximum
at a given point
We
-FT-
The
coefficient
^ being
Jc
ducibility,
C the
Tpi
D the density.
= 1,
and in the
becomes
result
for v
To
make
write kt or -
instead of
t.
The expression
72
J7
.
This
is
-=cfa
= -y-
The
function
oar
-ycfo;
measures the velocity with which the heat flows along the axis of
the prism.
Now
this value of
-y--
is
We
have in
a
_!
or,
^=_/_
dx
2
387.
The function
may
also
sign of integration:
now
it is
first
order^-;
we have
We
2
- 2 (* +
ff~)
-^
~ (
SECT.
III.]
387
which gives
(%+g}6~
whence we conclude
(x+V)* ~v
= (x-g}e~
C*j^)
;
We
have supposed
rrf^
= \.
To
we
must write
-^ instead of
Kt
t,
and we have
__ ff
CD
~K~r
The highest temperatures follow each other according to the law expressed by this equation. If we suppose it to represent the varying motion of a body which describes a straight line, x being
the space passed over, and t the time elapsed, the velocity of the moving body will be that of the maximum of temperature.
When
initial
the quantity
is
is
when the
the
heat
collected
t is
reduced to find
,
and by
.
differentiation or
development in
series
we
-^ = (jD
Kt
x*
2>
We
have
left
T escapes at the surface of the prism ; w e now proceed to take account of that loss, and we shall suppose the initial heat to be contained
in a single
element of the
388.
have
determined the
variable state of an infinite prism a definite portion of which was affected throughout with an initial temperature f. suppose
We
that the initial heat was distributed through a finite space from
x=
in
to
x=
b.
We
an
now suppose
that the
252
388
THEORY OF HEAT.
and from
[CHAP. IX.
this follows
solid
is
what was
state
of the
e^t
~~ ht
(a)
;
when the
-=-
coefficient
-^ L/JJ
differential equation
-^=
/
-^
hv, is
denoted by
As
to the
777
coefficient h,
it
is
equal to
^ rtc/ ;
section of the prism, I the contour of that section, conducibility of the external surface.
and
the
we have
represents the
mean
initial
temperature, that
is
to
say, that
which a single point would have if the initial heat were distributed equally between the points of a portion of the bar whose length It is required to determine is /, or more simply, unit of measure. t of the time the value elapsed, which corresponds to a maximum
of temperature at a given point.
To
(a)
it
is
sufficient to derive
it
from equation
the value of
and equate
x*
to zero
we have
dv
lv
must elapse in order that the x may attain its highest temperature,
0,
SECT.
III.]
389
To
exponent of
2
e~ 1
in equation (a)
is
ht
+ -jy1
Now
equation
for
1 I
(&)
gives fa
= jf-
# -
"rA-C
hence ht
Zfff
and putting
its
known
value,
1
e"
we have
ht
l\ + TT~ = \/ T + 7 ^ y T
/p2
,
2
;
j^rCv
/(J
ponent of
in equation (a),
we have
its
known
value,
we
find, as
the expression
maximum
V,
4/i 1
_1
X*
The equations
let
(c)
and
(d)
let us also
write 5
g instead
of
-=-
is
a square.
We
have to determine
Fand
6,
w
which
is
e-
V^^+i
We
I*B
,l
These equations are applicable to the movement of heat in a thin bar, whose length is very great. suppose the middle of this prism to have been affected by a certain quantity of heat bf
surface.
propagated to the ends, and scattered through the convex V denotes the maximum of temperature for the point
whose distance from the primitive source is a?; is the time which has elapsed since the beginning of the diffusion up to the instant at which the highest temperature V occurs. The coeffi-
300
cients C,
THEORY OF HEAT.
H, K,
[CHAP. IX.
denote the same specific properties as in the preceding problems, and g is the half-side of the square formed by a section of the prism.
In order to make these results more intelligible by a 389. numerical application, we may suppose that the substance of which the prism is formed is iron, and that the side 2g of the square is the twenty-fifth part of a metre.
and
measured formerly, by our experiments, the values of those of C and D were already known. Taking the metre as the unit of length, and the sexagesimal minute as the unit of
We
time,
and employing the approximate values of H, C, D, we 6 corresponding to a given shall determine the values of V and distance. For the examination of the results which we have in view,
}
it is
not necessary to
see at
first
know
We
is
Kg
has a large value with reference to the second term of these terms increases as the distance increases.
The
ratio
Thus the law of the highest temperatures becomes more and more simple, according as the heat removes from the origin. To determine the regular law which is established through the whole extent of the bar, we must suppose the distance x to be very great, and we find
Kg
390.
We
see
sponds to the maximum of temperature increases proportionally with the distance. Thus the velocity of the wave (if however we
may
or rather
apply this expression to the movement in question) is constant, it more and more tends to become so, and preserves this
its
property in
movement
to infinity
SECT.
III.]
391
We may
JJH fe~* K9
expresses
the
may be
seen in Chapter
I.,
In order to represent to ourselves the value of V, we must therefore imagine that all the initial heat which the source con tains is equally distributed through a portion of the bar whose
The temperature /, which each point of this portion, is in a manner the would mean temperature. If we supposed the layer situated at the
length
is
b,
result for
origin to be retained at a constant temperature /during an infinite time, all the layers would acquire fixed temperatures whose
K& denoting by x the distance of the general expression is fe These, fixed temperatures represented by the ordinates of layer.
,
Jw
when
the distance
is
they decrease, as
origin.
is
known, very
rapidly, according
Now the equation (8) shews that these fixed temperatures, which are the highest each point can acquire, much exceed the highest temperatures which follow each other during the diffusion To determine the latter maximum, we must calculate of heat.
the value of the fixed
maximum, multiply
it
by the constant
dis-
number
tance x.
W
^is
/2jy\i
)
j=V^TT
line, as the ordinates of a logarithmic curve the square roots of the abscissae, and the movement of
the wave
uniform.
If we regarded the conducibility of the external surface 391. or the thickness of the prism as nothing, or if the conducibility were supposed infinite, we should obtain very different results. 2g
302
THEORY OF HEAT.
could then omit the term
[CHAP. IX.
1
We
-=?-
K9 x~
maximum
is
inversely propor
not be uniform.
purely theoretical,
It
Thus the movement of the wave would must be remarked that this hypothesis is
if the conducibility is not nothing, but an extremely small quantity, the velocity of the wave is not only variable in the parts of the prism which are very distant from the if this value is given, In fact, whatever be the value of origin. as also those of and g, and if we suppose that the distance x 211 z increases without limit, the term -~r x will always become much
and
H
t
&9
greater than J.
The
2
distances
may
at first be small
radical.
enough
for
the term
2H -=- #
A#
to
The times
are
then proportional to the squares of the distances but as the heat flows in direction of the infinite length, the law of propagation The alters, and the times become proportional to the distances.
;
that is to say, that which relates to points extremely to the source, differs very much from the final law which is near. established in the very distant parts, and up to infinity but, in the intermediate portions, the highest temperatures follow each
initial law,
:
((7),
remains
for
which heat
we have
established,
presents
no
When
and
heat
all
is
a definite portion of an infinite solid has been heated, other parts of the mass have the same initial temperature 0, propagated in all directions, and after a certain time the
is
the same as
if
The time
= 1.
[A. F.]
SECT.
III.]
GENERAL INVESTIGATION.
this last effect is set
393
up
is
exceedingly
when the
Each
points of the mass are very distant from the origin. is of these points which had at first the temperature
imperceptibly heated; its temperature then acquires the greatest value which it can receive; and it ends by diminishing more and
more, until there remains no sensible heat in the mass. variable state is in general represented by the equation
e
The
=fdajdbfdo
The
integrals
^
,
b lt + b 2 a lt + a 2 The limits c1 + c2 are given; they include the whole portion of the solid which was originally heated. The function f(a, b, c) is also given. It expresses the initial temperature of a point whose co-ordinates are a, b, c. The defi
, ,
nite integrations make the variables a, b, c disappear, and there remains for v a function of x, y, z, t and constants. To determine
the time
ra,
which corresponds
to a
maximum
of
v,
at a given point
we must
at
-57:
we
thus form an equation which contains 6 and the co-ordinates of From this we can then deduce the value of 6. If ra. then we substitute this value of 6 instead of t in equation (E), we
the point
find the value of the highest and constants.
temperature
V expressed
in
x y z
} }
(da
fdb jdc
Pf(a,
b, c),
b, c),
denoting by
P the
multiplier of
f (a,
we have
=
dt
~2 t+j
da db
)
dc
gs
last expression to points of the
393.
solid
We
which are very distant from the origin. Any point what ever of the portion which contains the initial heat, having for co ordinates the variables a, b, c, and the co-ordinates of the point
394
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. IX.
whose temperature we wish to determine being x, y, z, the square of 2 the distance between these two points is (a xf + (6 y)*+ (c z} ;
and
term of
-7-
Now the point being very distant from the origin, it is evident that the distance A from any point whatever of the heated
portion coincides with the distance origin that is to say, as the point
;
from the primitive source, which contains the origin of co-ordinates, and A becomes 1. the final ratio of the distances
It follows
from
(e)
of
^ the dt
factor
(a
- xf +
(b
- yf +
(c
zf-
may be
replaced by
$ 4. y* +
the origin.
or r
2
,
We
from
dv
or
= V /r^__3A
"
ai dt
P \ti
2 1) ziy
If
we put
and replace
by -^.
in order to
K
re-establish the coefficient fTn
w^i ca we
we have
dv
GD
394.
This result belongs only to the points of the solid whose is very great with respect to the greatest It must always be carefully noticed that
we can omit
the varia
bles a,
b, c under the exponential symbol. They ought only to be omitted outside this symbol. In fact, the term which enters under the signs of integration, and which multiplies / (a, 6, c), is the
SECT.
III.]
395
product of several
such as
2
-a 2
ax
-x*
Now
great
If, for
it
is
number
we may suppress the two first factors. we suppose a equal to a decimetre, and x equal to example,
ten metres, and if the substance in which the heat is propagated is iron, we see that after nine or ten hours have elapsed, the factor
2
ax
.
7CD
is still
greater than 2
hence by suppressing
its
it
we
should
of
-r-
value.
dt
it belongs to points very distant from the origin, and for any time whatever, ought to be expressed by equation (a). But it is not the same if we consider only extremely large values of the
time, which increase in proportion to the squares of the distances in accordance with this condition we must omit, even under the
exponential symbol, the terms which contain a, b, or c. Now this condition holds when we wish to determine the highest tempera ture which a distant point can acquire, as we proceed to prove.
395.
The value
;
of
^-
must in
fact
question
we have
therefore
acquire highest temperature is proportional to the square of the distance of this point from the origin.
may
its
we
l
by
its
value
2
,
396
THEOKY OF HEAT.
reduced to
~ L
[CHAP. IX.
may be
unity.
Consequently we find V
V
=
b, c)
The
the volume of the sphere whose radius is r is 4 s K 7rr so that denoting by / the temperature which each molecule o the initial heat
,
of this sphere
all
would receive,
if
we
distributed amongst
its
parts
we
shall
have v
= A/
$f.
The results which we have developed in this chapter indicate the law according to which the heat contained in a definite portion of an infinite solid progressively penetrates all the other parts
whose initial temperature was nothing. This problem more simply than that of the preceding Chapters,
is
solved
since
by
attributing to the solid infinite dimensions, we make the con ditions relative to the surface disappear, and the chief difficulty
consists
in
results of the
the employment of those conditions. The general movement of heat in a boundless solid mass are
is
It is accomplished freely
This investigation is, properly properties of heat. speaking, that of the irradiation of heat within the material
natural
solid.
SECTION
Comparison of
396.
IV.
the integrals.
integral of the equation of the propagation of heat presents itself under different forms, which it is necessary to com It is easy, as we have seen in the second section of this pare.
The
Chapter, Articles 372 and 376, to refer the case of three dimen
sions to that of the linear
movement
**
dt~~
it
is
sufficient therefore to
JL &*
CDdx*
SECT. IV.]
RING.
397
or the equation
dv
d?v
To deduce from
this differential equation the laws of the propa body of definite form, in a ring for example,
know the integral, and to obtain it under a certain form suitable to the problem, a condition which could be This integral was given for the first fulfilled by no other form.
time in our Memoir sent to the Institute of France on the
21st of December, 1807 (page 124, Art. 84) : it consists in the following equation, which expresses the variable system of tem
/.
(a).
R is the radius
with respect to gives the same
of the
a.
mean circumference
i is any integer, must be taken from oo to i= + x v denotes the temperature which would be observed after the lapse of a time t, at each point of a section separated by the arc x from that which is at the origin. We represent by v = F (x) the initial tem
result,
irR to a
i =
= TrR
2)
We
must give
to i the succes
&c.,
-3
&c.,
M
ix
write
ix
IOL
la.
We thus obtain all the terms of the value of v. Such is the form under which the integral of equation (a) must be placed, in
order to express the variable movement of heat in a ring (Chap. IV., Art. 241). consider the case in which the form and extent of the generating section of the ring are such, that the points of the
We
same
also that
section sustain temperatures sensibly equal. no loss of heat occurs at the surface of the ring.
We
suppose
398
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. IX.
The equation (a) being applicable to all values of R, we 397. can suppose in it R infinite in which case it gives the solution of the following problem. The initial state of a solid prism of
;
small thickness and of infinite length, being known and expressed by v F(x) to determine all the subsequent states. Consider the
t
radius
to contain numerically
tables.
n times the
Denoting by q a variable which successively trigonometrical becomes dq, 2dq, 3dq, ... idq, &c., the infinite number n may
be expressed by
-y,
by
-|-
Making
these substitutions
we
= ^-
dq
dy.
a).
are differential
definite integral
becomes that of a
M-ao
quan and
;
we have
f
+ao
= xJ->7T
-j
doL
J -oo
F (a)
J -
qz)
(@).
This equation is a second form of the integral of the equation it expresses the linear movement of heat in a prism of infinite (QL) It is an evident consequence of the length (Chap. VII., Art. 354).
;
first
integral
(a).
We can in equation (/3) effect the definite integration 398. with respect to q- for we have, according to a known lemma, which we have already proved (Art. 375),
}
/.
+00
dz e~ z cos 2hz
= e~ h
J -00
Making then
r
z*
= (ft, we
find
J J-
Jt
(/S)
Hence the
integral
becomes
SECT, iv.]
If
399
ft
we employ
%Jt
of a
another
unknown quantity
making
= ft we
(8).
This form
(8)
of the integral
of equation
(a)
was given in
Volume VIII. of the Memoires de VEcole Poly technique, by M.Laplace, who arrived at this result by considering the infinite series which
represents the integral.
Each
of the equations
three forms of the same integral, and that not one can be con Each of them is contained sidered more general than the others.
in the integral (a) from which infm infinite value.
it
is
derived,
by giving
to
R an
It is easy to develope the value of v deduced from 3 s 99. equation (a) in series arranged according to the increasing powers These developments are self-evident, of one or other variable.
and we might dispense with referring to them; but they give rise to remarks useful in the investigation of integrals. Denoting by
<",
<j>,
(f>",
&c.,
the functions
-7-
<(#),
-j
$(#")>
~T~3
$( x
i
& c we
->
}>
have
dv
-77
=v
/,
,
and v
= c + rat v
7
1
//
;
T~"*
\^
forms
t
tt
has been given by
F<f>
(x
+ 2/3^) and
dic2
(x),
Mr
p. 30.
Expanding
<(>(x+2pJt)
by Taylor
>Jt
Theorem, integrate each term separately: vanish, and we have the second form ;
]_
da
[3
I
Jo
We
have thus a
slightly
Theorem,
p. 351.
[A. F.]
400
THEORY OF HEAT.
x.
[CHAP. IX.
Putting for
v"
its
ldtv
iv
,
substitutions,
we
= c+
v"
jdt
iv
\c"
+jdt
v
(c
+jdt vJ]
or
= c + tc"+~d +
^G
^c
+ &c ............. (I
).
In this series, c denotes an arbitrary function of x. If we wish to arrange the development of the value of v, according to ascend ing powers of #, we employ
d*v
_ dv
dx*~dt
and, denoting by
<
<
<
/y ,
//y
d,
we have
first
d*
a* a?* df^
v
&c
->
=a+
t.
bx
\dx \dx vt
two functions of
We
a,
value
l>p
Idx Idx
v /f
and
a tl
+ b^x +
By continued
substitutions
v= a + bx +
\dx Idx v
= a + lx+
\dx\dx \a
\dx
+ Ix 4+ bx +
Idx Idx v
J
+b x
t
= a + bx+ldx
a
t
Idx Idx (a u
-f
\dx \dx
v\
|
SECT, IV.]
401
or
t;
= a + -^ a + r-r a
-
4-
a
6
&c.
|2
|4
.................. (Z).
In this
If
in,
series,
t.
we
put, instead of
a and
b, (t) -^ (f), to ascending powers of t, we find only a single arbitrary function owe this remark to of x, instead of two functions a and b.
</>
two functions
and
We
vi.
of the
Memoires de
result with respect to the same powers of x, the coefficients of these powers are formed of two entirely arbitrary functions of t ;
which can be
400.
easily verified
The value
of
v,
ought in
function
fact to contain only one arbitrary function of x ; for the differential equation (a) shews clearly that, if we knew, as a
of #, the value of v which corresponds to t = 0, the other values of the function v which correspond to subsequent values of t, would be determined by this value.
It
is
no
less
v,
when developed
powers of x, ought to contain jwo com functions of the variable t. In fact the dISerential pletely arbitrary
according to ascending
equation
-7-3
= -7-
shews
that, if
we knew
as a function of
the
value of v which corresponds to a definite value of x, we could not conclude from it the values of v which correspond to all the other values of x. It would be necessary in addition, to give as
a function of
of
for
the value of v which corresponds to a second value example, to that which is infinitely near to the first. All
t
v,
spond
v,
H.
402
THEORY OF HEAT.
t.
[CHAP. IX.
this equation (a) that the form of the surface is determined, when we give the form of the vertical section in the plane which passes through the axis of x
x and and
It follows evidently
from
and
it is
evident that,
from the physical nature of the problem for the initial state of the prism being given, all the
;
subsequent states are determined. But we could not construct the surface, if it were only subject tcT passing through a curve traced on the first vertical plane of i and v. It would be necessary
to
know
traced on
it
a second
vertical
plane
parallel to the
to
which
The same remarks apply to all we see that the order of the equation does not determine cases the number of the arbitrary functions.
401.
The
which
is
equation
dv
d?v
the form v
=e
tD<i
<f>
(x).
instead of
D\
we have
(Art. 399),
Following the same notation, the first part of the series (X) which contains only even powers of x, may be expressed
,J
D)
of
<j>
(t).
and write
^ instead
D\
differentiation.
from the
function
therefore
first
<
(t)
We
have
= cos (tf^I
!>)</>()+
and
-W =
*dx cos (x
J^
SECT. IV.]
SYMBOLICAL METHODS.
403
This
known abridged
is
notation
is
which
of
it
exists
and
to verify
them
without any development. It is sufficient to differentiate under the signs which the notation employs. For example, from the = etl} * (a?), we deduce, by differentiation with respect equation v
<f)
to
only,
series
satisfies
first
the differential
Similarly, if
we
consider the
(X), writing
we
only,
Hence
We
equation
(x).
We must
D
:
y,
and write
^-
instead of
fact,
= --D
COS
satisfies also
is
= cos (yD)
<
(x)
+ W,
where
W= sin (yD) ty
(x).
262
404
402.
THEORY OF HEAT.
If the proposed differential equation is
[CHAP. IX.
ifv
dh
dt*-dtf
and
if
efo
z
"
d?/
according to
S?* + ^*
fPv
= Dv, we
<J
have
= cos (t
D) $
(x, y).
From
this
we
infer that
-Ta
at
-5-5
dx*
-7-5
df
of
t,
We must develope the preceding value of v according to powers instead of D and then regard i as the order write (n + -rni
of differentiation.
The following
(t
J- D) ^
(a?,
#) satisfies the
same
is
and
jdt
v
is
cos
(*
7^5) ^
x y]
,
a function f(x
0)
y>
f)
of three variables.
y)
;
If
we make
0,
we
<),
have/= (a?, y,
we have/
(a?,
<
(a?,
and denoting
^/fe y,
by/ (, y,
y, 0)
=^
(x, y}.
will
SECT. IV.]
A DIFFERENTIAL EQUATION.
405
be v
= cos
(tD*)
<j>
(#,#), denoting
by D;
for
we deduce from
this value
572
dt
-V = - -j-4 V. dy?
arbitrary
d*
The general value of v, which can contain only two functions of x and y, is therefore
v
= cos (ZD )
2
(a?,
y)
+ W,
and
TF
Jo
f dt cos
2
(*Z>
-^ (#, y).
Denoting u by
/(a?, y, 0,
and
by
(a;,
y,
),
we have
to
*
403.
& y) =/ (^
tfv
y*
and
)>
^ (^ y) =/ te
y>
o).
d*v
_ -
we may denote by D$
or Z)
2
^>
the function
-y
+ -gj
so that
+ -p j
2
to the
Equation
(e)
then becomes
z = -^ + D v 0; and
d?v
the value
(x, y)
;
of
v,
t,
is cos
(tD)
for
<f>
from
we
7
derive
ar
/,
or
^^ + cfo
cfar
4 -y-
dx2 dy2
+ -7-4 =
dy
0.
The most general value of v being able to contain only two arbitrary functions of x and ?/, which is an evident consequence of
the form of the equation,
v
may be
(x,
expressed thus
dt cos (tD}
= cos
(tD)
</>
y)
f (#,
y).
406
THEOKY OF HEAT.
functions
</>
[CHAP. IX.
The
and
i/r
function v by /(a?, y,
t),
and
^/
o),
(x, y, t)
by/
(x, y,
t),
(*,
y}
=f (*,
y>
t fa y) =/x fa y.
be
o).
dv _dt
=a
dot?
1-2
-y~4
dx*
c :r~6 6
dx
the coefficients
equation
a, b,
c>
are
is indefinite.
function of
The most general value of v can only contain one arbitrary x for it is evident, from the very form of the equa tion, that if we knew, as a function of x, the value of v which
;
corresponds to
0, all
tt
v,
which correspond to
successive values of
would be determined.
To
express
v,
we
(x).
We
denote by
D(f>
the expression
that
v,
we must develop
-^dx
of differentiation.
In
fact, this
with respect to dv
-T:
c?^
only,
,
we have
,
tD
-j
fic
It
would be useless to multiply applications of the same process. For very simple equations we can dispense with abridged expres but in general they supply the place of very complex in sions
;
vestigations.
We
all relate to
have chosen, as examples, the preceding equa physical phenomena whose analytical
expression
first,
is
(a)
and
analogous to that of the movement of heat. The two and the three (b), belong to the theory of heat
;
SECT. IV.]
407
following
presses
what
to dynamical problems; the last (/) ex the movement of heat would be in solid bodies, if
(d),
(e),
the instantaneous transmission were not limited to an extremely have an example of this kind of problem in small distance.
We
the
movement
of luminous heat
media.
404.
We
:
we shall indicate in the first place that which results equations from the use of the theorem enunciated in Art. 361, which we
now proceed
If
to recal.
p
d<
dy.
J -
(a)
cos
oo
J -co
we
represents a function of #; for the two definite integrations with respect to a and p make these variables dis appear, and a function of x remains. Thgjiataiir of the function will evidently depend on that which we shall have chosen for
see that
it
(j)
(a).
We may
tffSTafter
ask what the function (a), ought to be, in order two definite integrations we may obtain a given function
<f)
f(x^. In general the investigation of the integrals suitable for the expression of different physical phenomena, is reducible to problems similar to the preceding. The object of these problems
to determine the arbitrary functions under the signs of the definite integration, so that the result of this integration may be a given function. It is easy to see, for example, that the general
is
dv
d*v
d4v
de v
d*v
would be known
determine
of
<
if,
we
could
(a),
eq^kion might be a
given function f
v,
In
fact,
we form
expressed thus,
v
= e~ mt cospx,
6
and we
m=
op*
-f
lp*
rp
+ &c.
408
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. IX.
We
might then
also take
_ e -mt cos
We
)
have similarly
It is evident that this value of v satisfies the differential equation (/) ; it is merely the sum of particular values.
Further, supposing t = 0, we ought to find for v an arbitrary function of x. Denoting this function by/(#), we have
/ (x) =
Now
it
dz
(f>
(a)
dp cos (px
p%).
follows from the form of the equation (/), that the most value of v can contain only one arbitrary function of x. general In fact, this equation shews clearly that if we know as a function of v for a given value of the time t, all the other which correspond to other values of the time, are It follows rigorously that if we know, necessarily determined. as a function of t and x, a value of v which satisfies the differential = 0, this function of x and t equation; and if further, on making t becomes an entirely arbitrary function of x, the function of x and t in question is the general integral of equation (/). The whole of
x the value
of v
values
problem
is
therefore
<
above, the function may be a given function /(#). It the solution may be general, that
reduced to determining, in the equation (a), so that the result of two integrations
is
we should be
f(x) an entirely arbitrary and even discontinuous function. It is merely required therefore to know the relation which must always exist between the given function f(x) and the unknown function Now this very simple relation is expressed by the theorem (a).
<j>
of which
we
are speaking.
when the
<
between
(a) is
/ (a)
that
is
to say, that
I
r+oo
we have
/+
the equation
~fc.-l - oo ^?r j
& /(a )|
j -
SECT. IV.]
409
From
we conclude
equation (/),
u
= -L
If
^7T J -oo
efe/(
405.
which expresses the transverse vibratory movement of an elastic 1 plate we must consider that, from the form of this equation, the most general value of v can contain only two arbitrary functions of x: for, denoting this value of v by f(x,t), and the function
,
cit
-rf(x,
t)
by
/
is
(a?, t),
it
is
evident that
if
we knew f(x,
-
0)
and
f
all
(x, 0),
that
and
- at
the
first
at
instant,
fact,
This follows also from the very nature of the phenomenon. In consider a rectilinear elastic lamina in its state of rest: x is
the distance of any point of this plate from the origin of co ordinates; the form of the lamina is very slightly changed, by drawing it from its position of equilibrium, in which it coincided
with the axis of x on the horizontal plane; it its own forces excited by the change of form.
is
then abandoned to
is
The displacement
supposed to be arbitrary, but very small, and such that the initial form given to the lamina is that of a curve drawn on a vertical
plane which passes through the axis of x. The system will suc cessively change its form, and will continue to move in the vertical
plane on one side or other of the line of equilibrium. The most general condition of this motion is expressed by the equation
d*v
a?+-
d4 v
,,
........................
w
.
Any
distance
1
x from the
point m, situated in the position of equilibrium at a origin 0, and on the horizontal plane, has, at
An
elastic
rod,
investigation of the general equation for the lateral vibration of a thin of which (d) is a particular case corresponding to no permanent
internal tension, the angular motions of a section of the rod being also neglected, 169177. [A.F.] will be found in Donkiu s Acoustics, Chap. ix.
410
the end of the time
,
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. IX.
perpendicular height
v.
been removed from its place through the This variable flight v is a function of
x and
is arbitrary; it is expressed by any the equation (d) deduced from the funda function Now, (x). mental principles of dynamics shews that the second fluxion
t.
The
initial
value of v
(/>
of
v,
,-or
~
z
(Jut
d*v
which
differ
only in sign.
We
question relative to the discontinuity of these functions; in view only the analytical expression of the integral.
may suppose also, that after having arbitrarily displaced the different points of the lamina, we impress upon them very small initial velocities, in the vertical plane in which the vibrations
ought to be accomplished. The point m has an arbitrary value.
ty (x} of the distance x. It is evident that if
initial
We
velocity given
to
any
It is
we have given
initial
impulses or ty (x), all the subse quent states of the system are determinate. Thus the function v oif(x,t), which represents, after anytime t, the corresponding
system or
</>
(x)
and the
form
of
(x).
the
lamina,
contains two
arbitrary functions
<
(x)
and
ijr
t),
we can
u
or else
cos
ft cos (qx
<?a)
t.
We
doL
ft cos (qx
q *),
SECT. IV.]
F(OL) being
411
may
be.
This value of v
merely a sum
= Supposing now that t 0, the value of v must denoted by/(#, 0) or be that which we have (x).
<f>
necessarily
We
have
therefore
(f)
(x)
IdoL
F (a)
qx).
The function
F (a)
must be determined
so that,
effected, the result shall be the arbitrary Now the theorem expressed by equation (.6) shews function (x). oo and + GO that when the limits of both integrals are we
,
have
of
is
= ^I
/+
dy.
</>
Air J -so
(a)
J -oo
qa).
t,
the
<
in
to
^Jr,
it is
satisfy the
(d),
x
(<l
- 2*)if
This value
expression
= 0;
and
we take the
dw =
"^
2^rJ
we
see that
is
on making
in
it,
it
becomes equal to
-j;
-^ (x).
-
The same
it
becomes
nothing when
It follows
0,
to
<
(x)
when t = 0.
(d) is
1
^7T
r +x
I
J -oo
qz)
W= u + TF,
and
"
Tr= g-
1
r"
00
+ao
rfaA|r (a)
dq
Sin
Q"t
COS (QX
412
In
also
fact, this
THEORY OF HEAT.
value of v
t
[CHAP. IX.
when we make
fy
0, it
function
it
(x)
in the expression
-7cLii
of v
reduces to a second arbitrary function ^r (as). Hence the value is the complete integral of the proposed equation, and there cannot be a more general integral.
406.
The value of v may be reduced to a simpler form by the integration with respect to q. This reduction, and effecting that of other expressions of the same kind, depends on the two
results expressed
by equations
(1)
and
(2),
which
will
be proved
/:
dq cos * *
^ cos * = qz
-^
p-sin I-T
+ T)
-TAiT
) /
(1). v
.-= /.
sin f-r ZL
(k/
**/
(2). \ /
From
this
we conclude
Denoting
j-
by another unknown
a
p,
we have
= x + 2/,6 Jt,
+A
fc2
da.
=
value
i ts
v
we have
u = -TT= f V ^7T J -oo
(sin
^ + cos fS)
<j>
(OL
).
have proved in a special memoir that (5) or (8 ), the integrals of equation (d), represent clearly and completely the motion of the different parts of an infinite elastic lamina. They
contain the distinct expression of the phenomenon, and readily It is from this point of view chiefly that we explain all its laws.
We
SECT. IV.]
413
have proposed them to the attention of geometers. They shew oscillations are propagated and set up through the whole extent of the lamina, and how the effect of the initial displace
how
ment, which is arbitrary and fortuitous, alters more and more as it recedes from the origin, soon becoming insensible, and leaving
only the existence of the action of forces proper to the system, the
forces
namely
of elasticity.
results expressed
407.
The
by equations
(1)
and
(2)
depend
upon the
definite integrals
dx
cos
ce
an d dx sin x*
I
let
f-f-oo
I
r-f-oo
dx
ao
cos
cc
and h
dx
ao
sin
a;
J -
and regard g and h as known numbers. It is evident that in the two preceding equations we may put y + b instead of x, denoting by b any constant whatever, and the limits of the integral will be the same. Thus we have
g = JP*dy cos 00
(y*
+ Zby +
),
^
(
J
2
00
dy sin (y
s*
2by
),
cos
f di I
sin
- sin y
it is easy to see that all the integrals factor sin 2by are nothing, if the limits are sin 2by changes sign at the same time as y.
Now
o>
g=
cos 6
a
I
The equation
h
in h also gives
S^n
*
= id
J
i \
y
2
cos 2
cos
sin
sin
26y sin
we have
cos &
dy
sin
y cos 2by
sin
2
Z>
414
[CHAP. IX.
and
(b)
two integrals
z \dy sin y cos 2&# and
\dy cos
2
?/
cos
2%
We may
now
which we
by
and B.
make
z
=p
z
t,
and Zby = pz
or
we have
therefore
cosp*t cos)2
1
fj"t\dp
= A,
*Jt\dp
sn
si]
cos
>2
=
known
The values
result
of
g and
/&
VTT
dx e~ x
*.
J -00
The last equation is in fact an identity, and consequently does not cease to be so, when we substitute for # the quantity
The
substitution gives
r1 \
dy
"^
f1 \
cos
dy
equation conclude
last
Thus the
is N/TT
=
-j=
(\dy
y*+jdy
y*)
More
readily
360, viz.
x/w fdusinu
e?2sins2
~~r~ = \/ v
/^
o 2
Let u
=z
>
Ju
I
1= =dz
I
du
..
>
then
Jo
=i \/ J. and V 2
dzsinz*=2
dzsiuz"*=
J-oo
Jo
\/ J. V 2
p**^ ^/* w
/
[B.L.B.]
SECT. IV.]
415
and
\dy cos y*
\dy siny
or
It
and
(6),
remains only to determine, by means of the equations the values of the two integrals
I
(a)
and
:
dy sin y* sin
2by.
A=
B=
sin 6
+g
cos 5
2
,
dy sin
2
i/
cos 26^
= h cos 6 2 - ^ sin b 2
whence we conclude
writing
sin
or cos
instead of
i/
we have
=
and
^ ing4-|)
s
.................. (1)
7
I
/-
,..(2)
proposition expressed by equation (B) Article 404, by equation (E) Article 361, which has served to discover the integral (8) and the preceding integrals, is evidently applicable to
or
408.
The
In
fact, in
or
/ 0) =
J
A-
/+*>
-+QO
9V<
OO
d P\
J ~
3D
d* cos (px -
p*)f (a),
41 G
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. IX.
we can regard f(x) as a function of the two variables x and y. The function /(a) will then be a function of a and y. We shall now regard this function f (a, y) as a function of the variable y, and we then conclude from the same theorem (B), Article 404,
"
that
f(a,
=
;?/)
1
f"
00
J^
/ (a,
jdq
cos (qy
We have therefore, for the purpose of expressing any function whatever of the two variables x and ?/, the following equation
y)
**&f( $
cos
/+oo
(P*-
J -00
We
*, y, *)
**
|>a)
A 7)
(^ - 0/9)
I?r cos (r
ry)
.....
jd/p
cos (_p#
/Jg cos
(BBF),
oo
between
the
limits
and
It is evident that the same proposition extends to functions which include any number whatever of variables. It remains to show how this proportion is applicable to the discovery of the integrals of equations which contain more than two variables.
409.
we wish
that
;
1st,
to ascertain the value of v as a function of (x, y, t), such on supposing t 0, v or f(x, y, t) becomes an arbitrary
function
of -S/ IJ
y
<
(a?,
y) of
y
in the value
or
f (x,y
t),
we
SECT. IV.]
417
the form of the differential equation (c) we can infer that the value of v which satisfies this equation and the two pre
From
ceding conditions
this integral,
is
we
first
To
discover
The
It is
m = Jp* +
q*.
no
less
evident that
(x
we may
q (y
write
ft)
= cosp
a) cos
cos
J$ -f
(f,
or
v
dx
d/3
(a, /3)
dp
cos
(px
- pot)
neither x,
F
t
(a,
which contain
is
particular values.
If
we suppose
= 0,
v necessarily
becomes $
(x} y).
"We
have
therefore
x
>
y)
=
jdzldP
( a , /3)
J
is
dp cos (px
- POL)
jdq
cos (qy
- q/3).
so that
reduced to determining
<
F
we
(a, /3),
the result of the indicated integrations may be comparing the last equation with equation (BB),
+
*>
(x, y).
Now, on
find
y}
kf
+
</>
a>
/S)
J-x>
f J -
cos
Hence the
integral
may be
expressed thus
We
by
function
thus obtain a
first
part
other arbitrary
(x, y),
we have
v
= u+ W,
27
F.
H.
418
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. IX.
W to
be the integral
ludt,
changing only
<>
In
fact,
= 0;
tion,
and
at the
when t is made u becomes equal to (a?, y), becomes nothing, since the integra same time
(f>
with respect to
if
t,
sine.
Further,
part,
we take
and make
0,
the
first
second
v
which then contains a sine, becomes nothing, and the Thus the equation part becomes equal to ty (x, y).
the complete integral of the proposed equation.
integral
of the
= u + Wis
We
equation
<Fv
c?v
d?v
cFv
It
would be
sufficient to introduce a
new
factor
2^
and
cos (rz
ry)
and
7.
410.
+ -7-2 + -7-* $
cLy
ctz
it is
express v as a function f(x,y,z), such that, 1st, f(x,y,Q) may be an arbitrary function $(#,#); 2nd, that on
required to
making
in the function
-7ctz
f(x,y,z) we
may
find a second
It evidently follows, from the form of (#, y). arbitrary function the differential equation, that the function thus determined will be the complete integral of the proposed equation.
To
tion
is
we may remark
first
the exponents by cos^>#cos and q being any numbers whatever, and the value of m being
writing v
mz , qij e
We
might then
v
also write
= cos
(px-p*}
cos (qy
- q(3}
<v
(e
^+
-f
SECT. IV.]
419
or
=
t,
ft)
jdpjdq
cos
(px -pi)
cos (qy
qft)
If 2 be
made equal
to 0,
we
/3),
the
following condition
y)
=
jdzldft
(a, /3)
jdpjdq
cos
we
see that
we have
first
^)
4P
(P x -P*)
(^ ~ 2#)
The value
substitution
of
w reduces to
</>
(x, y)
-j-
when
= 0,
of
dx
nothing.
We
might
IF=
^)
da.
|
jd/3
^r (a,
ft)
cos
Jdp
The value
substitution
of TF
= 0,
dW
j~ equal to -^
is v
Hence
= u + W.
f
dt
*
*-~*^dy*~
272
420
it is
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. IX.
the
required to determine v as a function/ (#, y, t), which satisfies proposed equation (e) and the two following conditions
:
namely,
arbitrary
1st,
the
substitution
<jf>
function
t)
(x,
y)
2nd,
an
in
ctt
(x-,
y,
It evidently follows from the form of equation (e), and from the principles which we have explained above, that the function v, when determined so as to satisfy the preceding conditions, will be
To
discover this
whence we derive
d*v
= -. m v
* 2
d*v
= tf v
4
d*
dt
dx*
dor dy*
= * 22v p*g*
dv
dy*
^
can write
We
or
(p*
),
q/3)
cos (p*t
-1-
q*t),
or
ldz \dpF(z,
j3)
pot) cos
(qy
q/5)
z t
cos (p
+ q*t).
have v
(a.,
/9).
we
find that,
which serves If we compare this with the when the integrals are taken
<f>(x,y)\
between
/ 1 \
F(a,
ft) is
\
(f>
(a, /8).
We
first
part u of the
a
J
cos
cos
Integrating the value of w with respect to t, the second arbi trary function being denoted by -\|r, we shall find the other part of the integral to be expressed thus
SECT. IV.]
421
W = (^) fa fa ^
If
(*, ft)
fa fa
- 2/3)
(jp
l
+ g*t)
we make
equal to $(&,y),
in u and in IF, the first function becomes and the second nothing; and if we also make
-=-
in -j-u
and in
W, the
first
hence v
= u +W
is
the
412.
We may give to
ing the two integrations with respect to p and q. For this purpose we use the two equations (1) and (2) which we have proved in Art. 407, and we obtain the following integral,
the Denoting by u the first part of the integral, and by which ought to contain another arbitrary function, we second, have
TF =
If
rt
dtu and
Jo
= u+ W.
we denote by
/-t
and
have
a-x_
;*
and
if
ft-y_
I7T
d@
t
we
substitute for
a, /?,
dz,
their values
#4-2^7^,
y + 2vji
2d
we have
this other
could not multiply further these applications of our The preceding formulae without diverging from our chief subject.
We
known and
examples relate to physical phenomena, whose laws were un difficult to discover; and we have chosen them because
422
the
integrals
of
THEORY OF HEAT.
these
for,
[CHAP. IX.
fruitlessly
sought
equations, which have hitherto been have a remarkable analogy with those which
of heat.
express the
413.
movement
might
We
also,
consider
first series
and sum
developed according to powers of one variable, these series by means of the theorems expressed by the
theory
heat
itself,
worthy of
notice.
We
have
u derived
dv
d*v
...................... ......
dt=dj
(a)>
developed in series, according to increasing powers of the variable contains one arbitrary function only of x and that when de t,
;
powers of
x, it contains
The
first series is
expressed thus
= t(*) +
--. .....
(T).
The
integral denoted
or
^-
dy.
(a)
pZ * cos dp e~ (px
^?a),
sum
of
of this series,
The value
v,
There is therefore, independently of equation (/3), another form of the integral which represents the sum of the last series, and which contains two arbitrary functions, f(t) and F(f).
SECT. IV.]
423
It is required
equation,
which
discover this second integral of the proposed cannot be more general than the preceding,
We
can arrive at
it
by summing each
it
t,
of the
two
if
series
which
in
is
evident that
we knew,
the
sum
which
contains f(t), it would be necessary, after having multiplied it by into dx, to take the integral with respect to x, and to change (t) should thus find the second series. Further, it would (t).
We
be enough to ascertain the sum of the odd terms which enter into the first series for, denoting this sum by /i, and the sum of all the other terms by v, we have evidently
:
[*ax [*dx
\
dp
-j.
Jo
Jo
Now
the function
f(t)
may
It is easy to
the second
member
of equation
2
,
(5),
dp, the
respective factors
+p*,
6
,
&c.
once the
common
factor cos
(ptpz),
Thus the problem consists in finding the sum of the series which enters into the second member, which presents no difficulty. In fact, if y be the value of this series, we conclude
<?y
^=-/+2
,
p^
4
6 8 p^
<2*y
or
s?
= ~ py
5
424
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. IX.
when x
is
nothing, y
may be
1,
and
dij
tx>
fry
d?i/
dx2
d?
of the series,
may be
nothing,
we
find, as
the
sum
It
it is
would be useless to
which
gives,
as the integral
sought,
2<?
(t
a)
(e^
e~v x ) cos qx
- sin
The term
2^
(t
- a)
(&*
- e~ qx
sin
gx }
+ W. .....
it is
is
formed by
integrating the
first
and by changing / two completely arbitrary functions f(t) and of v, we suppose x nothing, the term
hypothesis, and the
first
to x = x, part with respect to x, from Under this form the integral contains into F.
x=
If,
(t).
in the value
we make
x=
ax
it
is
first
part
-j-
dx
will
dW
second, -j
,
which
differs
by the function
be reduced to
(t).
Thus the
integral expressed
by equation (00)
member
This
it is
;
necessary to select
in several
we see that it is very problems of the theory of heat different from that which is expressed by equation (/3), Art. 897.
1
W. Thomson,
"On
Heat,"
Part
II.
Art.
III. pp.
2068.
SECT. IV.]
425
to express,
employ very different processes of investigation definite integrals, the sums of series which repre by The form of these sent the integrals of differential equations.
414.
We may
We
expressions depends also on the limits of the definite integrals. will cite a single example of this investigation, recalling the
of Art.
result
311.
If in the equation
Article
we
write x
+ 1 sin u
we have
1
l"du
..
7T
<j>(x
sin u)
- + (*);+ a
4
</>"
(x)
+ =Ai ^ (.r)
.*
Denoting by v the sum of the series which forms the second 2 2 2 member, we see that, to make one of the factors 2 4 6 &c.
,
, ,
disappear in each term, we must differentiate once with respect to t, multiply the result by t, and differentiate a second time with
respect to
t.
We
d~v
satisfies
the partial
differential equation
_l ~
dx*
We
du
(j>
(x
+ 1 sin
11)
+ W.
new
arbitrary
W of the
first,
integral contains a
The form
much from
and may also be expressed by definite The results, which are obtained by means of definite integrals. integrals, vary according to the processes of investigation by which they are derived, and according to the limits of the integrals.
that of the
415.
It is necessary to
general propositions which serve to transform arbitrary functions for the use of these theorems is very extensive, and w e derive from them directly the solution of several important physical problems, which could be treated by no other method. The
r
426
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. IX.
following proofs, which we gave in our first researches, are very suitable to exhibit the truth of these propositions.
f(x)
which
is
=I
"
cfaf (a)
oo
JO
dp cos
(py.
-px)
we may
effect the in
we
find
a-x
ought then to give to p, in the last expression, an infinite value; and, this being done, the second member will express the
value of f(&). We shall perceive the truth of this result by means of the following construction. Examine first the definite C m vi dx which we know to be equal to JTT, Art. 356. integral x Jo If we construct above the axis of x the curve whose ordinate is
/
We
y*
sin x,
is -,
M>
we
may
whose form
become alternately positive at the points where x = TT, and nearer to this axis.
approaches nearer
A second branch
first, is
situated
The
integral
dx
sin
x
is
the area
af Jo included between the curve and the axis of x, and reckoned from
up
in which p is supposed to be & any positive number, has the same value as the preceding. In
definite integral
/
,
The
dx
Jo
fact, let
px = z
dz
z
is
and,
true,
Jo
consequently,
it
also
equal to
^TT.
This proposition
SECT. IV.]
427
whatever positive number p may be. If we suppose, for example, ,. .sn , 1A ,, T has sinuosities very p = 10, the curve whose ordmate is J
-
much
x
;
closer
sinuosities
whose ordinate
is
up
to
x=
is
the same.
Suppose now that the number p becomes greater and and that it increases without limit, that is to say, becomes
greater,
infinite.
The
near.
whose ordinate
is
ss
are infinitely
Their base
so,
is
an
That
being
if
we compare
--
of these intervals
following interval, and if we denote by JTthe finite and sufficiently large abscissa which answers to the beginning of the first arc,
we
a?,
the same as
sum
of the
nothing.
is
The same
is
infinitely
finite ratio to
r
01
the
1
P
p
*
value of x.
We
T?*/
know from
dx
in
Jo
which we suppose^? to be an infinite number, is wholly formed out of the sum of its first terms which correspond to extremely small values of x. When the abscissa has a finite value X, the area does not vary, since the parts which compose it destroy each other two by two alternately. We express this result by writing
428
,
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. IX.
which denotes the limit of the second integral, The quantity has an infinitely small value and the value of the integral is the same when the limit is co and when it is oo
;
.
416.
+
f
/,
sin
(a.
-x) ^
is
*)-]
Having
that
axis
this curve
laid
down
a,
construct above
/ (a).
The form
of
entirely arbitrary;
it
being nothing.
Construct also above the same axis of abscissae a curved line ss
whose ordinate
is
a very
The centre of this curve, or the point great positive number. to the greatest ordinate p, may be placed at the which corresponds of the abscissae a, or at the end of any abscissa whatever. origin
We
transferred to
suppose this centre to be successively displaced, and to be all points of the axis of or, towards the right, depart
ing from the point 0. Consider what occurs in a certain position of the second curve, when the centre has arrived at the point x, which terminates an abscissa x of the first curve.
as constant,
p
VL
(a
oc)
If then
we
link together the two curves, for the purpose of is to say, if we multiply each ordinate of the
and represent the product by an ordinate of a third curve drawn above the axis of a, this product is
,
**
, .
sinp
a
(a
a?)
x
between
may then be
x)
expressed by
sin;? (a
a-x
SECT. IV.]
EXAMINATION OF AX INTEGRAL.
the
429
has
Now
number p being
finite
near
which are at a
integral, or the
distance
easily see that for all points from the point x, the definite
we
whole area of the third curve, is formed of equal parts alternately positive or negative, which destroy each other two by two. In fact, for one of these points situated at a certain dis
tance from the point #, the value of /(a) varies infinitely
little
when we
same
is
by a quantity
x,
less
than
The
distance.
fore the
to the interval
there-
P
and a
a;
were not
variables.
Consequently
x is a finite magnitude. nothing when a be taken between limits as near integral may
gives,
between those
limits,
infinite limits.
reduced then to
taking the integral between points infinitely near, one to the left, the other to the right of that where a x is nothing, that is to say from OL = X co to a = x+ co, denoting by co a quantity infinitely
In this interval the function /(a) does not vary, it is equal to/ (a?), and may be placed outside the symbol of integra
small.
tion.
of the expression [
J
is
x
co,
x=
and a
x=
co.
Now
we
TT,
as
we have seen
is
in the pre
t
article
equal to irf(x)
whence
*/
/<*)
1 = 5z r* j
/
O
s/
^ sin p
(a.
x}
<**/<)
"irjr
<***)
J -co
417.
that notion
of infinite
It quantities which has always been admitted by geometers. would be easy to offer the same proof under another form, examin ing the changes which result from the continual increase of the
430
THEORY OF HEAT.
sin/>
[CHAP. IX.
(OL
X).
known
all, it
to
make
it
Above
must be remarked that the function /(a?), to which and not subject to a con
We might therefore imagine that the enquiry is a function such that the ordinate which represents it concerning has no existing value except when the abscissa is included between
tinuous law.
two given
nothing
all
;
limits a
and
to
b,
all
the other ordinates being supposed no form or trace except above the
axis of a in
interval from
x=a
b,
other parts of
its course.
The same proof shews that we are not considering here infinite values of x, but definite actual values. might also examine on the same principles the cases in which the function f(x) becomes
We
values of x included between the given limits; but these have no relation to the chief object which we have in view, which is to introduce into the integrals arbitrary functions
infinite, for singular
impossible that any problem in nature should lead to the supposition that the function f(x) becomes infinite, when we
it
is
give to
a;
or ordinates each of
In general the function f(x) represents a succession of values which is arbitrary. An infinity of values being
given to the abscissa x, there are an equal number of ordinates / (x). All have actual numerical values, either positive or negative
or nul.
We do not suppose these ordinates to be subject to a common law; they succeed each other in any manner whatever, and each of them is given as if it were a single quantity.
It may follow from the very nature of the problem, and from the analysis which is applicable to it, that the passage from one ordinate to the following is effected in a continuous manner. But
(B),
considered by
itself,
is
independent
It is
SECT. IV.]
431
the values of f(x] are nothing when x is not included between a and 6; the limits of integration with respect to a, in the preceding equation (B\ become then a = a, a = 6; since the result is the same
as for the limits a
=
a
oc is
by hypothesis,
when
oo a every value of (a) being nothing not included between a and b. We have
,
</>
of this equation (B
is
a function of the
a.
make
the variables
andp
dis
appear, and x only remains with the constants a and b. Now the function equivalent to the second member is such, that on substitut
ing for
a and
<f>
b,
;
we
find the
same
result as on substituting this value of x in (x) and we find a nul result if, in the second member, we substitute for x any value not
b. If then, keeping all the other quantities which form the second member, we replaced the limits a and b by nearer limits a and & each of which is included between a and 6, we should change the function of x which is equal to the second member, and the effect of the change would be such that the second member would become nothing whenever we gave to # a value not included between d and 6 and, if the value of x were included between a and 6 we should have the same result as
, ;
,
on substituting
this value of
in
<j>(x).
can therefore vary at will the limits of the integral in the This equation exists always for second member of equation
(B").
We
values of x included between any limits a and b, which we may have chosen; and, if we assign any other value to x, the second
member becomes
nothing.
the second member, whose value is /(a?), will represent the variable ordinate of a second curve whose form will depend on the limits a and b. If these
;
ordinate of a curve of
<t>(x)
by the variable
limits are
oc
and
20
for
<j>(x)
ordinate, and the other f(x], coincide exactly through the whole extent of their course. But, if we give other values a and b to these
two curves coincide exactly through every part of their course which corresponds to the interval from x = a to x = b. To and left of this interval, the second curve coincides precisely right
limits, the
432
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. IX.
This result is very remarkable, at every point with the axis of x. and determines the true sense of the proposition expressed by
equation (B).
418.
(II)
Art. 234
must
of view.
This equation
serves to develope an arbitrary function (x) in a series of sines or The function f(x) denotes a function cosines of multiple arcs. completely arbitrary, that is to say a succession of given values,
subject or not to a
common
x included between
The
equation,
value
of this
function
is
*?y(*-lO
The
integral,
(A).
limits a
with respect to a, must be taken between the = 6 each of these limits a and I is any quantity and X. The sign 2 affects the whatever included between
= a,
and a
integer
number
it
every
0,
and must take the sum of the terms arranged under the sign 2. After these integrations the second member becomes a function of The general the variable x only, and of the constants a and b.
proposition
consists in this
:
1st,
member, which would be found on substituting for x a quantity included between a and &, is equal to that which would be obtained on substituting the same quantity for x in the function /(a?); 2nd, and X, but not included every other value of x included between between a and b, being substituted in the second member, gives a
mil result.
Thus there is no function f(x), or part of a function, which cannot be expressed by a trigonometric series.
The value
of the period
of the second
is
X, that
is
when
member is periodic, and the interval to say, the value of the second member All its x is written instead of x.
+X
SECT. IV.]
TRANSFORMATION OF FUNCTIONS.
433
The trigonometrical series equal to the second member is convergent; the meaning of this statement is, that if we give to the variable x any value whatever, the sum of the terms of the
series
limit.
approaches more and more, and infinitely near to, a definite This limit is 0, if we have substituted for x a quantity
included between
ft;
the quantity substituted for x is included between a and b, the limit of the series has the same value as f(x). The last function is subject to no condition, and the line whose ordinate it
but
if
represents
formed of a
of the function being arbitrary, the proposition has a very exten sive signification ; and, as it not only expresses an analytical property, but leads also to the solution of several important
problems in nature,
it
w as necessary
r
to consider it
under different
have points of view, and to indicate its chief applications. several proofs of this theorem in the course of this work. given
We
That which we
shall refer to in
X infinite, the
;
terms of the
series
become differential quantities the sum indicated by the sign 2 becomes a definite integral, as was seen in Arts. 353 and 355, and equation (A) is transformed into equation (B). Thus the latter equation (B) is contained in the former, and belongs to the case is infinite: the limits a and b are then in which the interval
The theorem expressed by equation (B) presents also 419. divers analytical applications, which we could not unfold without will enunciate the quitting the object of this work; but we
principle from
We
member
of the equation
the function f(x) is so transformed, that the symbol of the function / affects no longer the variable &, but an auxiliary
F.
H.
28
434
variable
a.
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP, IX.
The
from
variable
It follows
this,
x is only affected by the symbol cosine. that in order to differentiate the function / (x)
with respect to x, as many times as we wish, it is sufficient to differentiate the second member with respect to a under the
symbol
cosine.
We
whatever,
We
when
of sign
when
i is even,
i is
can also integrate the second member of equation (Z?) several times in succession, with respect to x\ it is sufficient to
write
of p.
We
in front of the
and
to
summa
which may be effected upon trigonometrical quantities. The chief characteristic of the theorem in question, is to transfer the general sign of the function to an auxiliary variable, and to place the variable x under the trigonometrical sign. The function f(x)
by this transformation, all the properties of trigonometrical quantities differentiations, integrations, and sum mations of series thus apply to functions in general in the same
;
acquires in a manner,
manner
as to exponential trigonometrical functions. For which reason the use of this proposition gives directly the integrals of partial differential equations with constant coefficients. In
ticular exponential values
satisfy these equations by par and since the theorems of which we are speaking give to the general and arbitrary functions the
fact, it is
;
evident that
we could
character of exponential quantities, they lead easily to the expres sion of the complete integrals.
The same transformation gives also, as we have seen in Art. 413, an easy means of summing infinite series, when these
series contain successive differentials, or successive integrals of the
SECT. IV.]
43.")
for the
summation
of the series
is
reduced, by
employ the theorem in question for the purpose of substituting under the general form of the function a binomial formed of a real part and an imaginary part. This
analytical
We may also
of
it
and we point it out here since partial differential equations has a direct relation to our chief object.
If in the function f(x)
result consists
we
write
\L
1 instead of #, the
of
two parts
(b+Jlty. The
and
</>
problem
//.
is
to
v.
ty in terms of
and
We
we
expression
for the
instead of
real
I problem is then reduced to the substitution of /A + v x under the symbol cosine, and to the calculation of the
coefficient of
1.
We
thus have
=/(/*
+ v J~l) = ~jdz
)
I
(*)
fdp
e pv
cos [p (p
- a) +pv
4~
p a /(a
$=
cos
~*
+e
sn
pv
hence
Thus all the functions f(x) which can be imagined, even those which are not subject to any law of continuity, are reduced to the form -f1, when we replace the variable x in them by the
Nj
binomial
yu,+
v*J-
1.
282
436
421.
let
THEOEY OF HEAT.
To
[CHAP. IX.
-^ +
-,
= 0,
which
relates to the
The general
integral of this equation evidently contains two arbitrary func tions. Suppose then that we know in terms of x the value of v
when y = 0, and
value of
-7-
that
we
also
x,
the
which has long been known; but we find imaginary quantities under the functional signs the integral is
:
=
</>
(x
+ y^l) +
<
(x
- 2/7=3) + W.
first
of the integral is derived from the The second part into ^r. integrating with respect to y, and changing
<f>
by
$(x + y J
1)
and
order to separate the real parts from the ima ginary parts. Following the process of the preceding Article we find for the first part u of the integral,
$ (#
~~
yj~
i)>
u =
/+
I
r+ 30
^-
da/(a)
00
dp
GO
cos (px
-pa)
(e
and consequently
W=
The complete
real
& F(a)
cos (p
- iw)
(e-
- e-)-
terms
in
1st, that it
integral of the proposed equation expressed in and we perceive in fact, therefore v = u + ; satisfies the differential equation ; 2nd, that on making
is
it,
it
gives v
=f(x)
is
3rd, that on
making y
in the
function
-7-
the result
F(x).
SECT. IV.]
DIFFERENTIATION OF FUNCTIONS.
437
We may also remark that we can deduce from equation 422. (B) a very simple expression of the differential coefficient of the
i
th
[*
I
dx f(x).
is
may
not enter
it
as
quantity, in order to include, in the same formula, every case in which we assign to i any positive or negative value. To obtain it
we
shall
^7^
ITT
-=-
or
cos r cos
-^
sin r sin
becomes successively
sin
r,
- cos r,
+ sin
r,
cos
r,
sin r,
&c.,
if the respective values of i are 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, &c. The same results recur in the same order, when we increase the value of i. In the
second
member
of the equation
cos
we must now
add under
this
-f-
i-
We
shall thus
have
The number
i,
shall not press these applica any positive or negative integer. tions to general analysis ; it is sufficient to have shewn the use of
We
The equations
of the fourth
and
dynamical problems.
yet
as we have said to (e), Art. 411, belong The integrals of these equations were not
in a
Memoir on
the Vibrations
of
438
THEOKY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. IX.
Academy
of Sciences
1
,
13 and 14). 10 and 11, and Art. vii. Gth June, 1816 (Art. VI. consist in the two formulae S and 8 Art. 40G, and in the two They
,
equation of Art. 412, the other then gave several the last equation of the same Article. by This memoir contained also the of the same results. other proofs
first
We
integral of equation (c), Art. 409, under the form referred to in "With that Article. regard to the integral (/3/3) of equation (a), Art. 413, it is here published for the first time.
Arts.
of
The propositions expressed by equations (A) and (B ), 418 and 417, may be considered under a more general point view. The construction indicated in Arts. 415 and 41 G applies
423.
Sill
f
?)j
oc
^-^
77 7
1
)
but
suits
oc
becomes
a,
other functions, and supposes only that when the number p infinite, we find the value of the integral with respect to by taking this integral between extremely near limits. Now
this condition belongs not only to trigonometrical functions, but is thus arrive at applicable to an infinity of other functions. the expression of an arbitrary function f(x) under different very
We
remarkable forms
which occupy
us.
With
Art. 418,
structions,
respect to the proposition expressed by equation (A), it is equally easy to make its truth evident by con
and
this
for
at
first.
It will
be
The memoir was read on June 8th, 1818, as appears given in the Bulletin dcs Sciences par la Societe Philomatique, September 1818, pp. 129 136, entitled, Note relative mix vibrations des surfaces The reading of the memoir elastiques et au mouvement des ondes, par M. Fourier.
1
The date
is
inaccurate.
of
it
from an abstract
further appears from the Analyse des travaux de V Academic des Sciences pendant Vannee 1818, p. xiv, and its not having been published except in abstract, from a remark of Poissoii at pp. 150 1 of his memoir Sur les Equations aux differences
partielles, printed in
Paris,
1820.
The
is
title,
the Memoires de VAcademie des Sciences, Tome in. (year 1818), Memoire sur les vibrations des surfaces glastiques, par
M. Fourier,
physical
p. ISO.
The
object,
"to
integrate several
phenomena
1
and to deduce from the integrals the knowledge of the which these equations refer," is stated in the Bulletin,
LA. I
.]
SECT. IV.]
EXAMINATION OF AN INTEGRAL.
439
we can
sign
replace
its
the
sum
of
the
is
2 by
value, which
have seen different examples of this calculation previously, It gives as the result if we Section III., Chap. in. suppose, in order to simplify the expression, 2?r = X, and denote a-#
We
by
r,
_-+.;
.
2j
-j
cos ir
cos
?r+
sin J ir
versmr
sin r
-.
We
by
a
cZx/(a),
= - TT
must then multiply the second member of this equation suppose the number j infinite, and integrate from The curved line, whose abscissa is a and to a = + TT.
ordinate cos^V, being conjoined with the line whose abscissa is a. and ordinate /(a), that is to say, when the corresponding ordinates are multiplied together, it is evident that the area of
the curve produced, taken between any limits, becomes nothing when the number j increases without limit. Thus the first term
cosjr gives a nul result.
it
were
common
abscissa
and as ordinates
sm
r
,
versin r
we
becomes
?*
;
infinite.
This will
x is nothing and in the interval in which take place if r or a a differs infinitely little from x, the value of /(a) coincides with Hence the integral becomes f(x).
r sin
Jr
>
or 4/(.r)
~ sin
j
jr,
44-0
THEORY OF HEAT.
is
[CHAP. IX.
which
equal to 2irf(x)
Arts.
Whence we con
When
the variable x
struction shews
what
is
TT or + TT, the con is exactly equal to the value of the second member of the
- TT
and
of
+ TT,
x
but other
TT
numbers a and
b,
each of
which
is
included between
are, for
+ TT, we
see
by the same
figure
and which
the second
member
of equation (A)
nothing.
If we imagine that between the limits of integration certain values of /(a) become infinite, the construction indicates in what sense the general proposition must be understood. But we do
not here consider cases of this kind, since they do not belong
to physical problems.
TT and + TT, we of restricting the limits give extent to the integral, selecting more distant limits a greater and b we know from the same figure that the second member
If instead
of equation (A) is formed of several terms and makes the result of integration finite, whatever the function /(#) may be.
We
we
write 2?r
instead of
r,
the
results
at which
we
It is
an
alternately positive and negative, so that the area may become may also vary nothing, when j increases without limit.
We
the factor
versm r
-,
and we
may
this
Expressions of
We
to
kind are very general, and susceptible of very different forms. cannot delay over these developments, but it was necessary
;
for the employment of geometrical constructions without any doubt questions which may arise on the they solve extreme values, and on singular values; they would not have served to discover these theorems, but they prove them and guide
exhibit
all
their applications.
SECT. IV.]
441
We have yet to regard the same propositions under 424. another aspect. If we compare with each other the solutions relative to the varied movement of heat in a ring, a sphere, a
rectangular prism, a cylinder, we see that we had to develope an arbitrary function f(x) in a series of terms, such as
i</>
OvO +
(,
<v
(/v*0
3<!>
(/vO
+ &c
The function
(A)
is
a cosine or a sine,
may be very different from a sine. instead of being integers, are given
all
The numbers
are real
fi lt
//, 2 ,
//, 3 ,
&c.
by a transcendental equation,
of
whose roots
infinite in
number
The problem
a
\>
av as
- - -
consisted in finding the values of the coefficients they nav e been arrived at by means of definite
integrations which
make
all
examine specially the nature of the exact consequences which flow from it.
proceed to
We
and
we
In order to give to this examination a more definite object, will take as example one of the most important problems, namely, that of the varied movement of heat in a solid sphere.
\Ve have seen, Art. 290, that, in order to satisfy the initial dis tribution of the heat, we must determine the coefficients a l} a a ... a i? in the equation s
r/-
ocF(x)
=a
sin
(^x)
+a
is
sin
(JLL^X)
-4-
a 3 sin (p 3 x)
;
entirely arbitrary
it
radius
is
x.
temperature of the spherical shell whose The numbers /^, a ... p. are the roots /^, of the
/z-
transcendental equation
is
is
efficient
We
the values of
This demonstration
is
1 The Mfrnoircs de V Academic des Sciences, Toine x, Paris 1831, pp. 119 146, contain Rcmarqiifs fjcncralc* sur V application des principes dc Vanalyse algebriquc
442
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. IX.
general theory of equations, and requires only that we should suppose known the form of the imaginary roots which every equa
have not referred to it in this work, since its place is supplied by constructions which make the proposition more evident. Moreover, we have treated a similar problem analytically,
tion
may
have.
We
movement
of heat in a cylindrical
body
This arranged, the problem consists in discovering numerical values for a lt # 2 a g ,...a &c., such that the second
,
f ,
member of equation (e) necessarily becomes equal to xF(x), when and the we substitute in it for x any value included between
whole length X.
To find the coefficient we have multiplied equation (e) by dx sin fi a;, and then integrated between the limits x 0, x = X, and we have proved (Art. 291) that the integral
.,
t
rX
I
dx
Jo
^x
i
to say
/*,
It follows
from
this,
gration
making
all
member
disappear,
coefficient,
we have
to
determine this
x
dx \x
Jo o
ix
dx
sin
Jo
pp sin pp.
t
Substituting this value of the coefficient a derive from it the identical equation (e),
r
I
in equation
(e),
we
x
dot.
a,F(a) s
Jo
,
d@ sin
& sin a B
do not satisfy the equation tance=0, since for them, tan# = JN/ - 1. The equation tan x = is satisfied only by the roots of sin x 0, which are all real. It may be shewn also that the imaginary roots of sec # = do not satisfy the equation
x=Q
x-mtsinx-Q, where
roots of the
fr+1 (x), fr (x], of x which make
m is less than 1, but this equation is satisfied only by the = 0, which are all real. For if equation f(x) = x cos x - m s fr -i(x), are three successive differential coefficients of f(x), the values
mx
by Fourier
fr ()=0, make the signs of /r+1 (x) and /r-1 (x) different. Hence Theorem relative to the number of changes of sign of f(x) and its
/(.r)
successive derivatives,
[A. F.j
SECT. IV.]
443
^, all the roots p, of the The integral must be taken for a from a = to equation (/). a = X, which makes the unknown a disappear. The same is the case with /3, which enters into the denominator in such a manner
successively substitute for
depends only on
that after
is multiplied by a coefficient a. whose value and on the index i. The symbol S denotes having given to i its different values, we must write
The integration then offers a very simple means of determining the coefficients directly; but we must examine attentively the
origin of this process,
1st.
which gives
(e)
rise to
If in equation
we had omitted
down
is
part of
the
terms, for
example,
all
an even
number, we should still find, on multiplying the equation by dx sin fj,.x, and integrating from x = to x = X, the same value of a n which has been already determined, and we should thus form
an equation which would not be true for it would contain only part of the terms of the general equation, namely, those whose
;
index
is
odd.
The complete equation (e) which we obtain, after having determined the coefficients, and which does not differ from the equation referred to (Art. 291) in which we might make =0 and v =/(#), is such that if we give to x any value included between and X, the two members are necessarily equal; but we cannot conclude, as we have remarked, that this equality would hold, if
2nd.
(x) a function subject to a con choosing for the first member tinuous law, such as sin x or cos x, we were to give to x a value and X. In general the resulting equation not included between
xF
and ^Y. ought to be applied to values of x, included between coefficient a does not Now the process which determines the into equation (e), nor explain why all the roots ^ must enter this equation refers solely to values of a:, included between why
(e)
t
and X.
To answer these questions clearly, it is sufficient to revert to the principles which serve as the foundation of our analysis.
We
into an infinite
number n
of parts
444
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. IX.
= X, and writing (x) instead of equal to dx, so that we have ndx xF(x),wQ denote by /^/^jf. .../;.../, the values of /(#), which
idx ndx, assigned to correspond to the values dx, 2dx, Sdx, we make up the general equation (e) out of a number n of ... terms; so that n unknown coefficients enter into it, a v a 2 3
. . .
.
. .
This arranged, the equation (e) represents n equations of the first degree, which we should form by substituting succes
^...a^
n values dx, 2dx, 3dx,...ndx. This system of n equations contains yj in the first equation, 2 in the second, /3 in ih To determine the first coefficient a lt we the third, fn in the n
equation by a-lt the second by cr2 the third by and add together the equations thus multiplied. 3 The factors 1} cr 2 o-g ...o- must be determined by the condition, that the sum of all the terms of the second members which contain aa must be nothing, and that the same shall be the case with the All the equations being then following coefficients aa c& 4 ...a n
multiply the
<7
first
and
so on,
<7
tt
we have
an equation
all
for
determining this
coefficient.
,
We
then multiply
p 2 p 3 ,...p n respectively, on adding the n equations, all the coefficients may be eliminated, except a 2 We have then an to determine a 2 Similar operations are continued, and equation
,
the equations
anew by other
factors p l
factors so that
choosing always
new
factors,
we
evident that this process of elimi nation is exactly that which results from integration between the and X. The series l cr2 limits 3 n of the first factors is
coefficients.
it is
<r
unknown
Now
<r
,...<r
dx
dx
dx sin (pfidx) ...dx sin (^ndx). In which serves to eliminate all the co
. .
efficients except a it is dx sin (^dx), dx sin 2dr), dx sin (^ 3dx) dx sin (pjridx) it is represented by the general term dx sin (^x), in which we give successively to x all the values
.
(>.
dx,
2f&,
%dx,
ndx.
which serves to determine these no respect from the ordinary process of elimi nation in equations of the first degree. The number n of equations is equal to that of the unknown quantities a lf 2 a a ...a n and is
We
see
by
coefficients, differs in
of given quantities The /,,/,,/,... /^ values found for the coefficients are those which must exist in
number
SECT. IV.]
CONDITIONS OF DEVELOPMENT.
445
to say one of
n
is
is infinite, it
included between
member f (x) necessarily coin when the value of x substituted in each and X.
The
form
a sin
it
jLs
sin
+a
<
sin
z# +
. . .
+a
sin
(frx)
integral f Jo
dx $ (pp) $
when
and j are
different numbers.
If
it
a, + O +.-.+ / b cos ix sm x +7 sm 2x 6
cos 2j?
a.cosix
&C.,
the quantities
dition
p lf
/z 2 ,
^3 ...^,
ec
cos f2wt
.]
sin
2?rj
-^J
= 0,
we always holding when the indices i and j are different numbers, the coefficients a b iy the general equation obtain, by determining not differ from equation (A) Art. 418. (II), page 206, which does
t,
425.
or
If in the second
member
of equation
(e)
we omitted one
equation (/), equation and a, not to be prove this, let us suppose a term containing /^ written in the second member of equation (e), we might multiply
roots /^ of the correspond to one or more To in general be true. (e) would not
dxsmfajZdx), dx sin
(//_.
3dar)
. .
dx sin fondx)
and adding them, the sum of all the terms of the second members would be nothing, so that not one of the unknown coefficients would remain. The result, formed of the sum of the first members,
446
that
is
THEORY OF HEAT.
to
{CHAP.
IX.
/,
/ / .../,
2
,
multiplied
dx
sin
(fjLjdx),
dx sin
(fjifidx],
dx sin
(pfidx)
dx sin (^ndx),
This relation would then necessarily exist between the given quantities/, / /3 2 /; and they could not If these be considered entirely arbitrary, contrary to hypothesis.
would be reduced to
zero.
quantities
ditions
question cannot
/, f2 ,fs ---fn have any values whatever, the relation in exist, and we cannot satisfy the proposed con
or
by omitting one
(e).
as
a3
sin (fijX) in
equation
Hence the function f(x) remaining undetermined, that is to system of an infinite number of arbitrary constants which correspond to the values of x included between
say, representing the
and X,
equation
it is
(e)
all
necessary to introduce into the second member of the terms such as a. sinter), which satisfy the
condition
x
dx sin /Aft sin fifx
o
0,
j being different; but if it happen that the such that the n magnitudes /,/2 ,/3 -/ are
-x
dx
o
sin fj,jxf(x)
0,
it is
tion
(x) whose develop the second member of the equation (e), does ment, represented by not contain certain terms corresponding to some of the roots JJL.
Thus there
There are for example cases in which we omit all the terms whose index is even; and we have seen different examples of this
in the course of this work. But this would not hold, if the func tion /(a?) had all the In all these cases, we generality possible. ought to suppose the second member of equation (e) to be com
plete,
and the investigation shews what terms ought to be omitted, since their coefficients become nothing.
SECT. IV.]
426.
447
represents, in our analysis, the system of a number n of separate and quantities, corresponding to n values of x included between
X, and that these n quantities have values actual, and consequently not infinite, chosen at will. All might be nothing, except one, whose value would be given.
It might happen that the series of the n values flt f2 ,fs .../ was expressed by a function subject to a continuous law. such as x or x 3 sin#, or cos a-, or in general (x) the curve line 0(70, whose ordinates represent the values corresponding to the abscissa to x = X, x, and which is situated above the interval from x =
,
<j>
(x),
and the
coefficients
a lt a 8 a 3
,
...
by the preceding rule always satisfy the condition, that any value of x included between and X, gives the same result when substi tuted in and in the second member of equation (e). (x)-,
<p
initial
"We
might suppose,
F(x)
= bx,
to say, that the initial heat increases proportionally to the distance, from the centre, where it is nothing, to the surface
where
In this case xF(x) or f(x) is equal to bx 2 and applying to this function the rule which determines the coeffi cients, bx* would be developed in a series of terms, such as
it is
bX.
al
sin
fax)
+a
sin
fax)
+a
sin
fax)
...
+ an sin fax).
Now each term sinQ^oj), when developed according to powers of x, contains only powers of odd order, and the function bx* is a power of even order. It is very remarkable that this function
denoting a series of values given for the interval from to X, can be developed in a series of terms, such as a sin fax).
, t
bx
have already proved the rigorous exactness of these which had not yet been presented in analysis, and we have shewn the true meaning of the propositions which express them. We have seen, for example, in Article 223, that the function cos# is developed in a series of sines of multiple arcs, so that in the equation which gives this development, the first member contains only even powers of the variable, and the second
results,
We
448
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. IX.
series
which only odd powers enter, is resolved, Art. 225, into a of cosines which contain only even powers.
developed by means of equation
xF(x)
as
is
we
which contains
which
is
a function of
x
dxsin
sin
(fai) aF(ca)
.. ......
(E).
(/i 4
0) sin fo/3)
The general solution which gives this equation (E} is wholly independent of the nature of the function F(x) since this function represents here only an infinite multitude of arbitrary constants,
which correspond to as many values of x included between and X.
If
we supposed the
of the
solid
= to x = $X, only sphere, for example, from x and that the initial temperatures of the upper layers were nothing, it would be sufficient to take the integral
sin
(^a )/(),
and x = ^X.
In general, the solution expressed by equation (E) suits all cases, and the form of the development does not vary according to
the nature of the function.
Suppose now that having written sin x instead of F(x) we have determined by integration the coefficients a and that we have
t)
sin
=a
sin
JJL^X
sin
JJL Z
+ a3
sin
JJL^X -f
&c.
It is certain that
between
equal to
a;
on giving to x any value whatever included and X, the second member of this equation becomes
since; this is a necessary
But it nowise follows that on giving to a; a value not included between and X, the same equality would exist. We see the
contrary very distinctly in the examples which
we have
cited, and,
SECT. IV.]
449
particular cases excepted, we may say that a function subject to a continuous law, which forms the first member of equations of this kind, does not coincide with the function expressed by the second and X. member, except for values of x included between
values which
may
member
which
variable
of this equation representing a certain analytical function coincides with a known function f(x) if we give to the
With respect to the w hich coincide for all values of the variable included between certain limits and differ for other values, it is proved by all that precedes, and considerations of this kind are a
values included between
T
and
".
existence of functions,
evident that equations (e) and (E) apply not whose radius is X, but represent, one the initial state, the other the variable state of an infinitely extended and when in these solid, of which the spherical body forms part
Moreover,
it
is
equations
give to the variable x values greater than X, they refer to the parts of the infinite solid which envelops the
we
sphere.
all
means
To apply the solution given by equation (E) to the case 427. which a single spherical layer has been originally heated, all the other layers having nul initial temperature, it is sufficient to
in
\dj.
sin (/^a)
= r, and a = r + u, r being the radius of the inner surface of the heated layer, and u the thickness of this layer.
We
initial
can also consider separately the resulting effect of the heating of another layer included between the limits r + u
the variable temperature due to this second cause, to the temperature which we found when the first layer alone was heated, the sum of the two temperatures is that
and r
2u
and
if
we add
which would arise, if the two layers were heated at the same time. In order to take account of the two joint causes, it is sufficient to F. H. 29
450
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. IX.
(/i 4 ot)
r and
= r + 2w. More =
xj
ay.
sm
x
\
si d/3 sn uj
sn
Jo
we
the
see that the whole effect of the heating of different layers is sum of the partial effects, which would be determined separately,
by supposing each of the layers to have been alone heated. The same consequence extends to all other problems of the theory of
it is derived from the very nature of equations, and the form ; of the integrals makes it evident. see that the heat con tained in each element of a solid body produces its distinct effect, as if that element had alone been heated, all the others having
heat
We
nul
temperature. These separate states are in a manner superposed, and unite to form the general system of temperatures.
initial
For
initial state
must be regarded
The
definite
integral
ture,
which enters into the expression of the variable tempera having the same limits as the heated solid, shows expressly that we unite all the partial effects due to the initial heating of
each element.
which is devoted which we have obtained almost entirely to analysis. integrals are not only general expressions which satisfy the differential equa tions they represent in the most distinct manner the natural effect
428.
shall terminate this section,
Here we
The
which is the object of the problem. This is the chief condition which we have always had in view, and without which the results of in vestigation would appear to us to be only useless transformations.
When
is,
properly speaking,
the equation of the phenomenon; it expresses clearly the character and progress of it, in the same manner as the finite equation of a
line or curved surface
forms.
makes known all the properties of those exhibit the solutions, we do not consider one form only of the integral we seek to obtain directly that which is suitable
To
to the problem.
Thus
it is
SECT. IV.]
451
movement
from that which expresses the movement in a cylindrical body, or even in a sphere whose radius is supposed infinite. Now each of these integrals has a definite form which cannot be replaced by
another.
It is necessary to
make
use of
it, if
we wish
to ascertain
the distribution of heat in the body in question. In general, we could not introduce any change in the form of our solutions, with
is
the repre
The different integrals might be derived from each other, But these transformations require since they are co-extensive. and almost always suppose that the form of the long calculations,
result
is
known
in advance.
We may
finite,
consider in the
this
first place,
problem to
unbounded
Thus
it is
referred to at the beginning of this The first becomes the second, section, depend upon each other. when we suppose the radius infinite. Reciprocally we may
derive
(ft)
In general, we have sought to obtain each result by the shortest way. The chief elements of the method we have followed are
these
:
1st. consider at the same time the general condition given the partial differential equation, and all the special conditions by which determine the problem completely, and we proceed to form
We
satisfies all
these conditions.
We first perceive
of terms, into
number
it is
equal to
is
which unknown constants enter, or that an integral which includes one or more arbitrary
first
functions.
In the
instance, that
is
to say,
derive from the special con ditions a definite transcendental equation, whose roots give the
term
affected
by the symbol
S,
we
values of an infinite
number
of constants.
The second
instance obtains
;
the
when the general term becomes an sum of the series is then changed
292
452
3rd.
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. IX.
can prove by the fundamental theorems of algebra, the physical nature of the problem, that the transcen by dental equation has all its roots real, in number infinite.
or even
4th.
We
of a sine or cosine
whole numbers, or real or irrational quantities, each of them in cluded between two definite limits.
In more complex problems, the general term takes the form of a function given implicitly by means of a differential equation However it may be, the roots of the definite integrable or not.
equation
exist,
they are
it
real, infinite in
integral
important, since
necessary relation
number. This distinction must be composed, is very the form of the solution, and the
5th. It remains only to determine the constants which depend on the initial state; which is done by elimination of the unknowns We from an infinite number of equations of the first degree.
multiply the equation which relates to the initial state by a differential factor, and integrate it between defined limits, which
are most
effected.
commonly those
of the solid in
is
There are problems in which we have determined the co by successive integrations, as may be seen in the memoir In this case we whose object is the temperature of dwellings.
efficients
consider the exponential integrals, which belong to the initial 1 state of the infinite solid it is easy to obtain these integrals
:
.
from the integrations that all the terms of the second member disappear, except only that whose coefficient we wish to determine. In the value of this coefficient, the denominator be
It follows
comes nul, and we always obtain a definite integral whose limits are those of the solid, and one of whose factors is the arbitrary function which belongs to the initial state. This form of the result
is
the problem,
necessary, since the variable movement, which is the object of is compounded of all those which would have existed
separately, if each point of the solid had alone been heated, the temperature of every other point had been nothing.
1
and
See section 11 of the sketch of this memoir, given by the author in the
111.
[A. F.]
SECT. IV.]
453
When \ve examine carefully the process of integration which serves to determine the coefficients, we see that it contains a
complete proof, and shews distinctly the nature of the results, so that it is in no way necessary to verify them by other investi
gations.
we have
hitherto
movement
In other researches, the determination of the coefficients would require processes of investigation which we do not yet know. But
it
must be remarked,
that,
coefficients,
we can always
problem, and of the natural course of the phenomenon which its object; the chief consideration is that of simple movements.
6th.
When
the
unknown
the expression sought contains a definite integral, functions arranged under the symbol of integration
are determined, either by the theorems which we have given for the expression of arbitrary functions in definite integrals, or by a more complex process, several examples of which will be found
in the Second Part.
These theorems can be extended to any number of variables. They belong in some respects to an inverse method of definite since they serve to determine under the symbols integration
;
result of
integration
a given function.
The same principles are applicable to different other problems of geometry, of general physics, or of analysis, whether the equa tions contain finite or infinitely small differences, or whether they
contain both.
The
and
solutions
No
are devoid of
all
foundation
it
them.
7th.
tion
We
proper
the plisnomenon,
since
it
represents
it
distinctly
454
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. IX.
throughout the whole extent of its course, and serves to determine with facility all its results numerically.
The
by these
composed of a multitude of terms, either finite or infinitely small but the form of these expressions is in no degree arbitrary; it is
determined by the physical character of the phenomenon.
this reason,
For
of the function
is
expressed by a series
which exponentials relative to the time enter, it is of natural effect whose necessity that this should be so, since the
into
seek, is really decomposed into distinct parts, corre The parts express to the different terms of the series. sponding so many simple movements compatible with the special conditions ;
laws
we
for
all the temperatures decrease, In this composition we ought due to the linear form of the
but an actual
effect
dynamical problems in which we consider the causes which destroy motion but it belongs
in experiments.
It appears also in
;
necessarily to all problems of the theory of heat, and determines the nature of the method which we have followed for the solution
of them.
8th.
of heat includes
;
first,
the exact
equations;
problems.
integrals can also be obtained, or other problems solved, by introducing certain changes in the course of the investigation.
same
We
method
different
its results.
9th. It has been objected, to the subject of our analysis, that the transcendental equations which determine the exponents having imaginary roots, it would be necessary to employ the terms which
proceed from them, and which would indicate a periodic character in part of the phenomenon; but this objection has no foundation,
since the equations in question have in fact no part of the phenomenon can be periodic.
all
and
It has been alleged that in order to solve with certainty of this kind, it is necessary to resort in all cases to a problems
10th.
SECT. IV.]
SEPARATE FUNCTIONS.
455
certain form of the integral which was denoted as general ; and equation (7) of Art. 398 was propounded under this designa
tion
but this distinction has no foundation, and the use of a single integral would only have the effect, in most cases, of com It is moreover evident plicating the investigation unnecessarily.
;
that this integral (7) is derivable from that which we gave in 1807 to determine the movement of heat in a ring of definite radius ; it is sufficient to give to an infinite value.
llth.
It has
consists in
expressing the integral by a succession of exponential terms, and in determining their coefficients by means of the initial state,
does not solve the problem of a prism which loses heat unequally
two ends ; or that, at least, it would be very difficult to in this manner the solution derivable from the integral (7) verify shall perceive, by a new examination, by long calculations.
at its
We
that our method applies directly to this problem, and that a single
integration even
12th.
is sufficient
1
.
We have developed in series of sines of multiple arcs functions which appear to contain only even powers of the variable, cos a; for example. We have expressed by convergent series or
by
definite integrals separate parts of different functions, or func tions discontinuous between certain limits, for example that which
Our
13th.
We find
in the works of
many geometers
results
and pro
cesses of calculation analogous to those which we have employed. These are particular cases of a general method, which had not yet
became necessary to establish in order most simple problems the mathematical laws of the distribution of heat. This theory required an analysis appropriate to it, one principal element of which is the analytical
been formed, and which
it
By
function
a separate function, or part of a function, we understand a / (x) which has values existing when the variable x is
included between given limits, and whose value is always nothing, This func if the variable is not included between those limits.
tion measures the ordinate of a line
1
which includes a
1, p. 12.
finite arc of
[A. F.]
456
THEORY OF HEAT.
[cHAP. IX.
in all the arbitrary form, and coincides with the axis of abscissas rest of its course.
This motion
is
we might even
It had always been Bernouilli, of Cauchy, of Lagrapge and Euler. as manifestly impossible to express in a series of sines regarded
of multiple arcs, or at least in a trigonometric convergent series, a function which has no existing values unless the values of the
variable are included between certain limits, all the other values
But this point of analysis is fully mil. cleared up, and it remains incontestable that separate functions, or parts of functions, are exactly expressed by trigonometric con
of the function being
vergent
by definite integrals. We have insisted on this from the origin of our researches up to the present consequence time, since we are not concerned here with an abstract and isolated problem, but with a primary consideration intimately connected
series, or
Nothing has
appeared to us more suitable than geometrical constructions to demonstrate the truth of these new results, and to render intelli
gible the forms
principles which have served to establish for us the analytical theory of heat, apply directly to the investigation of the movement of waves in fluids, a part of which has been agitated.
14th.
The
They
aid also the investigation of the vibrations of elastic laminae, of stretched flexible surfaces, of plane elastic surfaces of very great
dimensions, and apply in general to problems which depend upon the theory of elasticity. The property of the solutions which we derive from these principles is to render the numerical applications
easy,
and to
offer
distinct
and
intelligible results,
which really
determine the object of the problem, without making that know ledge depend upon integrations or eliminations which cannot be
effected.
We
1st.
results of analysis
regard as superfluous every transformation of the which does not satisfy this primary condition.
429.
tial
We
shall
equations of the
the differen
If two
molecules of the
SECT. IV.]
457
a certain quantity of heat; proportional extremely small difference of the temperatures: that is to say, if that difference became double, triple, quadruple, and all other conditions remained the same, the heat communicated would be double, triple, quadruple.
directly to the other during one instant
is
to the
which quantity
is sufficient
This proposition expresses a general and constant fact, which to serve as the foundation of the mathematical theory. The mode of transmission is then known with certainty, inde
pendently of every hypothesis on the nature of the cause, and cannot be looked at from two different points of view. It is
evident that the direct transfer
that
it
is
and
has no existence in fluids or liquids which are not diathermanous, except between extremely near molecules.
of
the
movement
of
heat,
in
the
bodies, are necessary consequences of the foregoing proposition. They are rigorously derived from it, as we have proved in our
first Memoirs in 1807, and we easily obtain these equations by means of lemmas, whose proof is not less exact than that of the
These equations are again derived from the same proposition, by determining by means of integrations the whole quantity of heat which one molecule receives from those which surround it. This investigation is subject to no difficulty. The lemmas in
question take the place of the integrations, since they give directly the expression of the flow, that is to say of the quantity of heat,
which crosses any section. Both calculations ought evidently to lead to the same result; and since there is no difference in the be any difference in the consequences. principle, there cannot
2nd.
surface.
We
It
gave in 1811 the general equation relative to the has not been deduced from particular cases, as has
been supposed without any foundation, and it could not be; the proposition which it expresses is not of a nature to be discovered
by way
ignore
of induction;
it
we cannot
ascertain
it for
certain bodies
and
of the surface may not suffer in a definite time an infinite change. In our Memoir we have omitted the details of the proof, since
458
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. IX.
they consist solely in the application of known propositions. It was sufficient in this work to give the principle and the result, as
we have done
in Article 15 of the
Memoir
cited.
From
the same
condition also the general equation in question is derived by deter mining the whole quantity of heat which each molecule situated
at the surface receives calculations
and communicates.
make no change
ment
and
In the investigation of the differential equation of the move of heat, the mass may be supposed to be not homogeneous,
it is
very easy to derive the equation from the analytical expression of the flow; it is sufficient to leave the coefficient which
Newton was the first to consider the law of cooling of 3rd. bodies in air; that which he has adopted for the case in which the air is carried away with constant velocity accords more closely
with observation as the difference of temperatures becomes less; it would exactly hold if that difference were infinitely small.
Amontons has made a remarkable experiment on the establish ment of heat in a prism whose extremity is submitted to a definite temperature. The logarithmic law of the decrease of the tempera
tures in the prism was given for the first time by Lambert, of the Academy of Berlin. Biot and Rumford have confirmed this law
1
by experiment
1
Newton, at the end of his Scala graduum caloris et frigoris, Philosophical Transactions, April 1701, or Opuscula ed. Castillioneus, Vol. n. implies that when a plate of iron cools in a current of air flowing uniformly at constant temperature, equal quantities of air come in contact with the metal in equal times and carry off quantities of heat proportional to the excess of the temperature of the iron
over that of the air whence it may be inferred that the excess temperatures of the iron form a geometrical progression at times which are in arithmetic progres sion, as he has stated. By placing various substances on the heated iron, he
;
obtained their melting points as the metal cooled. Amontons, Memoires de VAcademie [1703], Paris, 1705, pp. 205 6, in his Remarques sur la Table de degres de Chaleur extraite des Transactions Philosophiques 1701, states that he obtained the melting points of the substances experimented
on by Newton by placing them at appropriate points along an iron bar, heated to whiteness at one end but he has made an erroneous assumption as to the law
;
Lambert, Pyrometrie, Berlin, 1779, pp. 185 6, combining Newton s calculated temperatures with Amontons measured distances, detected the exponential law
SECT. IV.]
459
To
movement
prism of very small radius, it was necessary to know the mathe matical expression of the quantity of heat which traverses an extremely short part of the prism. This quantity is not simply
sections
proportional to the difference of the temperatures of the two which bound the layer. It is proved in the most rigorous manner that it is also in the inverse ratio of the thickness of the
layer, that is to say, that if tivo layers of the same prism were un equally thick, and if in the first the difference of the temperatures of the two bases was the same as in the second, the quantities of heat
traversing the layers during the same instant would be in the inverse The preceding lemma applies not only to ratio of the thicknesses.
layers
whose thickness
is
infinitely small;
is
it
applies to prisms of
;
fundamental in so far as any length. we have not acquired it, we cannot form an exact idea of the phenomenon and of the equation which expresses it.
It is evident that the instantaneous increase of the temperaof temperatures in
a long bar heated at one end. Lambert s work contains a of the progress of thermal measurement up to that time.
224. Eumford, Jlemoires Biot, Journal des Mines, Paris, 1804, xvn. pp. 203 de VInstitut, Sciences Math, et Phys. Tome vi. Paris, 1805, pp. 106 122. Ericsson, Nature, Vol. vi. pp. 106 8, describes some experiments on cooling
in vacuo which for a limited range of excess temperature, 10 to 100 a very close approach to Newton s law of cooling in a current of
air.
M. M. Dulong and
de Ph. 1817,
of
experiments are insufficient to discredit the law of cooling in vacuo derived by Petit (Journal Poll/technique, Tome xi. or Ann. de Ch. et
Tome vn.) from their carefully devised and more extensive range But other experiments made by Ericsson with an ingeniously experiments. contrived calorimeter (Nature, Vol. v. pp. 505 7) on the emissive power of molten iron, seem to shew that the law of Dulong and Petit, for cooling in vacuo, is
very far from being applicable to masses at exceedingly high temperatures giving off heat in free air, though their law for such conditions is reducible to the former
law.
Fourier has published some remarks on Newton s law of cooling in his Questions sur la theorie physique de la Chaleur rayonnante, Ann. de Chimie et de Physique, 1817, Tome vi. p. 298. He distinguishes between the surface conduction
and radiation to free air. Calor quern ferrum Newton s original statement in the Scala graduum is calefactum corporibus frigidis sibi contiguis dato tempore communicat, hoc est This supposes Calor, quern ferrum dato tempore amittit, est ut Calor totus fern." the iron to be perfectly conducible, and the surrounding masses to be at zero
"
temperature.
It
4GO
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. IX.
ture of a point is proportional to the excess of the quantity of heat which that point receives over the quantity which it has lost, and that a partial differential equation must express this result but
:
does not consist in enunciating this proposition which fact; it consists in actually forming the differential
equation, which requires that we should consider the fact in its If instead of employing the exact expression of the elements. flow of heat, we omit the denominator of this expression, we
thereby introduce a difficulty which is nowise inherent in the problem; there is no mathematical theory which would not offer
similar difficulties, if Not only are proofs.
tion; but there
is
we began by altering the principle of the we thus unable to form a differential equa
proposition of this kind, in Avhich we should be expressing the To avoid equality of quantities which could not be compared.
this error,
stration
66,
it is sufficient to give some attention to the demon and the consequences of the foregoing lemma (Art. 65, 67, and Art. 75). 4th. With respect to the ideas from which we have deduced
time the differential equations, they are those which have always admitted. We do not know that anyone physicists has been able to imagine the movement of heat as being produced in the interior of bodies by the simple contact of the surfaces which separate the different parts. For ourselves such a proposition
for the first
would appear
meaning.
A surface
of
contact cannot be the subject of any physical quality; it is neither It is evident that when one heated, nor coloured, nor heavy.
part of a body gives its heat to another there are an infinity of material points of the first which act on an infinity of points of the second. It need only be added that in the interior of opaque
material, points whose distance is not very small cannot commu nicate their heat directly; that which they send out is intercepted
by the intermediate molecules. The layers in contact are the only ones which communicate their heat directly, when the thickness
of the layers equals or exceeds the distance which the heat sent from a point passes over before being entirely absorbed. There is no direct action except between material points extremely near, and it is for this reason that the expression for the flow has the
it.
The
SECT. IV.]
461
it
is
added
but
not from
value during unit of time is a finite and measurable magnitude, even although it be determined only by
cause
that
its
When
its
a space free from air bounded by a solid envelope, the value of the outward flow is assuredly an integral; it again is due to the action of an infinity of material points, very near to the surface, and we
have proved formerly that this concourse determines the law of the external radiation 1 But the quantity of heat emitted during the unit of time would be infinitely small, if the difference of the
.
finite value.
is
In the interior of masses the conductive power greater than that which is exerted at the surface.
it, is most distinctly perceived by us, has arrived at its constant state, the since, prism quantity of heat which crosses a section during the unit of time exactly balances that which is lost through the whole part of the
when
the
heated surface, situated beyond that section, whose temperatures exceed that of the medium by a finite magnitude. When we take no account of this primary fact, and omit the divisor in the
expression for the flow,
tial
it is
Farther,
it is
acquired temperatures. Even although the problem is only that of the linear movement, and all points of a section are regarded
as having the
same temperature, it does not follow that we can the dimensions of the section, and extend to other prisms disregard the consequences which belong to one prism only. The exact
equation cannot be formed without expressing the relation between the extent of the section and the effect produced at the
We shall not develope further the examination of the principles which have led us to the knowledge of the differential equations Memoires de VAcadcmie des Sciences, Tome v. pp. 2048. Communicated
1
in 1811.
[A. F.]
482
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. IX.
we need
difficult
only add that to obtain a profound conviction of the use it is necessary to consider also various
dicate,
problems; for example, that which we are about to in is wanting to our theory, as we have
This problem consists in forming the differ ential equations, which express the distribution of heat in fluids in motion, when all the molecules are displaced by any forces,
long since remarked.
combined with the changes of temperature. The equations which we gave in the course of the year 1820 belong to general hydro 1 dynamics; they complete this branch of analytical mechanics
.
Different bodies enjoy very unequally the property which physicists have called conductibility or conducibility that is to say, the faculty of admitting heat, or of propagating it in the interior
430.
of their masses.
We
1 See Memoires de V Academic des Sciences, Tome xn. Paris, 1833, pp. 515530. In addition to the three ordinary equations of motion of an incompressible fluid, and the equation of continuity referred to rectangular axes in direction of which the velocities of a molecule passing the point x, y, z at time t are u, v, w,
its
temperature being
6,
in which
follows.
is
Into the parallelepiped whose opposite corners are (x, y, z), (x + Ax,y + Ay, z + Az), the quantity of heat which would flow by conduction across the lower face AxAy,
if
-K-j- AxAy At
in time At,
convection
+ Cw Ax Ay At
is,
there
is
that
is to say,
the gain
is
equal to
K -^ - C
(w0)
;
Ax Ay Az At.
Two
three
and
the
sum
of the
equal to
:
(7
At Ax Ay Az, which
is
Ax Ay Az
whence the above equation. and C vary with the temperature and pressure but are usually treated as constant. The density, even for fluids denominated incom
in time At
The
coefficients
temperature variation.
the velocities u, v, w are nul, the equation reduces to the equation for flow of heat in a solid. It may also be remarked that when is so small as to be negligible, the equation has the same form as the equation of continuity. [A. F.j
may
be noticed that
when
SECT. IV.]
463
do not appear to us to be exact. Each of them, the first especially, would rather express, according to all analogy, the faculty of being conducted than that of conducting.
more
it
unequally permeable to this element, that is to say, it is propagated them with more or less facility, in passing from one interior molecule to another. We think these two distinct properties
1 might be denoted by the names penetrability and permeability
.
must not be lost sight of that the penetrability of a surface depends upon two different qualities one relative to the external medium, which expresses the facility of communication by
all it
:
Above
the other consists in the property of emitting or admit radiant heat. With regard to the specific permeability, it is ting to each substance and independent of the state of the proper
contact
;
For the rest, precise definitions are the true foundation surface. of theory, but names have not, in the matter of our subject, the same degree of importance.
431.
The
last
contribute very
much
These ought only to be proposed with reserve, and not admitted but after long examination. That which we have employed re
duces
itself to
limits.
have availed ourselves also of the sign S to express the an indefinite number of terms derived from one general term in which the index i is made to vary. We attach this index if necessary to the sign, and write the first value of i below, and
We
of
sum
The
coefficients of penetrability
\vere (h, K],
and
interior
conduction
determined in the first instance by Fourier, for the case of cast iron, by experiments on the permanent temperatures of a ring and on the
The value
of
by the method of
de
I
Art.
v.
110,
of
Mem.
Acad.
d.
Se.
Tome
pp.
[A. F.]
464
the usefulness of
finite integrals,
it,
THEORY OF HEAT.
[CHAP. IX.
and
of de especially when the analysis consists the limits of the integrals are themselves the
object of investigation.
432.
tions of
The truth of these general equation which relates to the surface. of the effects equations is not founded on any physical explanation
In whatever manner we please to imagine the nature of whether we regard it as a distinct material thing from one part of space to another, or whether we which passes
of heat.
this element,
make
heat consist simply in the transfer of motion, we shall always arrive at the same equations, since the hypothesis which we form
facts
The quantity
of heat transmitted
temperatures are unequal, depends on the difference of these If the difference is infinitely small it is certain temperatures. all that the heat communicated is proportional to that difference
;
experiment concurs in rigorously proving this proposition. Now in order to establish the differential equations in question, we
consider only the reciprocal action of molecules infinitely near. There is therefore no uncertainty about the form of the equations which relate to the interior of the mass.
we have said, normal at the that the flow of the heat, in the direction of the boundary of the solid, must have the same value, whether we cal culate the mutual action of the molecules of the solid, or whether
relative to the surface expresses, as
The equation
we consider the action which the medium exerts upon the envelope. The analytical expression of the former value is very simple and as to the latter value, it is sensibly proportional is exactly known to the temperature of the surface, when the excess of this tempera ture over that of the medium is a sufficiently small quantity. In other cases the second value must be regarded as given by a series
;
of observations;
it depends on the surface, on the pressure and on the nature of the medium this observed value ought to form
;
the second
member
named
is
re-
SECT. IV.]
465
of the
placed by a given condition, which expresses the state surface, whether constant, variable or periodic.
433.
The
movement
of heat are
mathematical consequences analogous to the general equations of and of motion, and are derived like them from the equilibrium most constant natural facts.
The
coefficients
c,
h, k,
be considered, in general, as variable magnitudes, which depend on the temperature or on the state of the body. But in the appli cation to the natural problems which interest us most, we
assign to these coefficients values sensibly constant. The first coefficient c varies very slowly, according as the
may
tem
perature
rises.
series of about thirty degrees. Professors Dulong and Petit, indicates that the value of the specific capacity increases very slowly with the temperature.
The
face
is
coefficient
most
variable,
h which measures the penetrability of the sur and relates to a very composite state. It
expresses the quantity of heat communicated to the medium, whether by radiation, or by contact. The rigorous calculation of this quantity would depend therefore on the problem of the move
of heat in liquid or aeriform media. But when the excess of temperature is a sufficiently small quantity, the observations prove that the value of the coefficient may be regarded as constant.
ment
In other
cases, it is easy to
derive from
known experiments a
correction which
result sufficiently exact. It cannot be doubted that the coefficient k, the measure of the
makes the
permeability, is subject to sensible variations; but on this impor tant subject no series of experiments has yet been made suitable
informing us how the facility of conduction of heat changes with 1 the temperature and with the pressure. see, from the obser as constant throughout vations, that this quality may be regarded
for
We
But the same obser a very great part of the thermometric scale. vations would lead us to believe that the value of the coefficient
in question, is very
of tempera
ture than the value of the specific capacity. Lastly, the dilatability of solids, or their tendency to increase
1
Reference
is
[A. F.j
F.
H.
30
466
in volume,
THEORY OF HEAT.
:
[CHAP. IX.
is not the same at all temperatures but in the problems which we have discussed, these changes cannot sensibly alter the In general, in the study of the grand precision of the results. natural phenomena which depend on the distribution of heat, we
It is rely on regarding the values of the coefficients as constant. to consider the consequences of the theory from necessary, first, this point of view. Careful comparison of the results with those
of very exact experiments will then shew what corrections must be employed, and to the theoretical researches will be given a further
extension, according as the observations become more numerous and more exact. shall then ascertain what are the causes
We
which modify the movement of heat in the interior of bodies, and the theory will acquire a perfection which it would be im
possible to give to
Luminous
liquids,
emitted by incandescent bodies, penetrates transparent solids and and is gradually absorbed within them after traversing an
interval of sensible magnitude. It could not therefore be supposed in the examination of these problems, that the direct impressions of heat are conveyed only to an extremely small distance. When
this distance has
different
form
the differential equations take a but this part of the theory would offer no useful
finite value,
applications unless
it were based upon experimental knowledge which we have not yet acquired. The experiments indicate that, at moderate temperatures, a
very feeble portion of the obscure heat enjoys the same property as the luminous heat ; it is very likely that the distance, to which is
conveyed the impression of heat which penetrates solids, is not wholly insensible, and that it is only very small but this occasions no appreciable difference in the results of theory or at least the
:
CAMBRIDGE: PRINTED BY
C.
J.
Volume
I.
LL.D., D.C.L., F.R.S., Professor of Natural Philosophy in the University of Glasgow, Fellow of St Peter s College, Cambridge, and P. G. TAIT, M.A., Professor of Natural Philosophy in the University of Edin burgh; formerly Fellow of St Peter s College, Cambridge.
W. THOMSON,
[New Edition
in the Prest.
By
Professors
W. THOMSON and
P. G.
TAIT.
Part
I.
By
Edin
burgh
Demy
College, Cambridge.
Second Edition.
Hontron:
CAMBRIDGE WAREHOUSE,
:
17
PATERNOSTER ROW.
CO.
STATISTICS LIBRARY
This book
due on the last date stamped below, or on the date to which renewed. Renewed books are sub jectto immediate recall.
is
LD
21-50m-12, (C4796slO)476
brary
niversity of California
Berkeley
U.C.
111
BERKELEY LIBRARIES
YD
3)1*39
6i
aa ON
VlNflOdnVD JO AllS*i3AINn
STAt,
5AVQ
d3JJV a311VO3d 39
AVIAI
SXOO9 11V
IPHSUDA300L
01